1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*- 2@c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 3@c 4@c %**start of header 5@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use 6@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o. 7@setfilename gdb.info 8@c 9@c man begin INCLUDE 10@include gdb-cfg.texi 11@c man end 12@c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN} 14@setchapternewpage odd 15@c %**end of header 16 17@iftex 18@c @smallbook 19@c @cropmarks 20@end iftex 21 22@finalout 23@c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when 24@c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a 25@c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the 26@c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest. 27@syncodeindex ky fn 28@syncodeindex tp fn 29 30@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable, 31@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex. 32@syncodeindex vr fn 33 34@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version! 35@c This is updated by GNU Press. 36@set EDITION Tenth 37 38@c !!set GDB edit command default editor 39@set EDITOR /bin/ex 40 41@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER. 42 43@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of 44@c manuals to an info tree. 45@dircategory Software development 46@direntry 47* Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger. 48* gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server. 49@end direntry 50 51@copying 52@c man begin COPYRIGHT 53Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 54 55Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document 56under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or 57any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the 58Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs 59Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' 60and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. 61 62(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify 63this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in 64developing GNU and promoting software freedom.'' 65@c man end 66@end copying 67 68@ifnottex 69This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}. 70 71This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with 72@value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN} 73@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 74@value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 75@end ifset 76Version @value{GDBVN}. 77 78@insertcopying 79@end ifnottex 80 81@titlepage 82@title Debugging with @value{GDBN} 83@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger 84@sp 1 85@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} 86@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 87@sp 1 88@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 89@end ifset 90@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al. 91@page 92@tex 93{\parskip=0pt 94\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par 95\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par 96\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par 97} 98@end tex 99 100@vskip 0pt plus 1filll 101Published by the Free Software Foundation @* 10251 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, 103Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@* 104ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @* 105 106@insertcopying 107@end titlepage 108@page 109 110@ifnottex 111@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir) 112 113@top Debugging with @value{GDBN} 114 115This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger. 116 117This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} 118@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE 119@value{VERSION_PACKAGE} 120@end ifset 121Version @value{GDBVN}. 122 123Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 124 125This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred 126Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free 127software in general. We will miss him. 128 129@menu 130* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN} 131* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session 132 133* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN} 134* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands 135* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN} 136* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing 137* Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward 138* Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it 139* Stack:: Examining the stack 140* Source:: Examining source files 141* Data:: Examining data 142* Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code 143* Macros:: Preprocessor Macros 144* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively 145* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays 146 147* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages 148 149* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table 150* Altering:: Altering execution 151* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files 152* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target 153* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs 154* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information 155* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN} 156* Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN} 157* Interpreters:: Command Interpreters 158* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface 159* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs 160* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface. 161* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface. 162* JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface. 163* In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent 164 165* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN} 166 167@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 168* Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing 169* Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively 170@end ifset 171@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 172* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing 173* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively 174@end ifclear 175* In Memoriam:: In Memoriam 176* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation 177* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB 178* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands 179* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol 180* Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism 181* Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to 182 @value{GDBN} 183* Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from 184 the operating system 185* Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format 186* Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format 187* Man Pages:: Manual pages 188* Copying:: GNU General Public License says 189 how you can copy and share GDB 190* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation 191* Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts 192* Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables, 193 functions, and Python data types 194@end menu 195 196@end ifnottex 197 198@contents 199 200@node Summary 201@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN} 202 203The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is 204going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another 205program was doing at the moment it crashed. 206 207@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of 208these) to help you catch bugs in the act: 209 210@itemize @bullet 211@item 212Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior. 213 214@item 215Make your program stop on specified conditions. 216 217@item 218Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped. 219 220@item 221Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the 222effects of one bug and go on to learn about another. 223@end itemize 224 225You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}. 226For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}. 227For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}. 228 229Support for D is partial. For information on D, see 230@ref{D,,D}. 231 232@cindex Modula-2 233Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see 234@ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. 235 236Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see 237@ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}. 238 239@cindex Pascal 240Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or 241nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support 242entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal 243syntax. 244 245@cindex Fortran 246@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although 247it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing 248underscore. 249 250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C, 251using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime. 252 253@menu 254* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software 255* Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation 256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB 257@end menu 258 259@node Free Software 260@unnumberedsec Free Software 261 262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu} 263General Public License 264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed 265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the 266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to 267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies. 268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the 269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms. 270 271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that 272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away 273from anyone else. 274 275@node Free Documentation 276@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation 277 278The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in 279the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can 280include with the free software. Many of our most important 281programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory 282texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package; 283when an important free software package does not come with a free 284manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such 285gaps today. 286 287Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people 288normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the 289authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no 290copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude 291them from the free software world. 292 293That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far 294from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a 295manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community, 296only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication 297contract to make it non-free. 298 299Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not 300price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers 301charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free 302Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The 303problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals 304are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and 305modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this. 306 307The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for 308free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of 309commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can 310accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper. 311 312Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too. 313When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they 314are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can 315provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A 316manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document 317a changed version of the program is not really available to our 318community. 319 320Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are 321acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original 322author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of 323authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions 324to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that 325may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal 326with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions 327are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use 328of the manual. 329 330However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical} 331content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual 332media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions 333obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another 334manual to replace it. 335 336Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to 337lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that 338free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps 339the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will 340realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to 341the free software community. 342 343If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under 344the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation 345license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you 346don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers 347will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the 348option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is 349what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please 350try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license 351is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}. 352 353You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted 354manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying 355copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major 356improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation 357at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it, 358and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom. 359Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that 360have paid or pay the authors to work on it. 361 362The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation 363published by other publishers, at 364@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}. 365 366@node Contributors 367@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN} 368 369Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many 370other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its 371development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One 372of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute 373to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The 374file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a 375blow-by-blow account. 376 377Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time. 378 379@quotation 380@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you 381or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly 382omitted from this list, we would like to add your names! 383@end quotation 384 385So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we 386particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major 387releases: 388Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0); 389Jim Blandy (release 4.18); 390Jason Molenda (release 4.17); 391Stan Shebs (release 4.14); 392Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9); 393Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4); 394John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9); 395Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3); 396and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0). 397 398Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris 399Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8. 400 401Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support 402in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per 403Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} 404demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did 405much general update work leading to release 3.0). 406 407@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple 408object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V. 409Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore. 410 411David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did 412the original support for encapsulated COFF. 413 414Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support. 415 416Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support. 417Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS 418support. 419Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support. 420Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support. 421Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support. 422David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support. 423Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support. 424Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support. 425Keith Packard contributed NS32K support. 426Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support. 427Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support. 428Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging). 429Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support. 430Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support. 431Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode. 432Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support. 433Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support. 434Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support. 435 436Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support. 437 438Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared 439libraries. 440 441Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree 442about several machine instruction sets. 443 444Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop 445remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM 446contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI, 447and RDI targets, respectively. 448 449Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing 450command-line editing and command history. 451 452Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the 453Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual. 454 455Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4. 456He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded 457symbols. 458 459Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for 460H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors. 461 462NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors. 463 464Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D 465processors. 466 467Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor. 468 469Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors. 470 471Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors. 472 473Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware 474watchpoints. 475 476Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints. 477 478Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver. 479 480Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made 481nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}. 482 483The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed 484support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0 485(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++} 486compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface): 487Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, 488Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase 489provided HP-specific information in this manual. 490 491DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project. 492Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port. 493 494Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its 495development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN} 496fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin 497Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim 498Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler, 499Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek 500Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In 501addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton, 502JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug 503Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff 504Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner, 505Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin 506Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela 507Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David 508Zuhn have made contributions both large and small. 509 510Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for 511Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface. 512 513Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red 514Hat. 515 516Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many 517people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick 518Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei 519Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason 520Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped 521with the migration of old architectures to this new framework. 522 523Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s 524unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring 525frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark 526Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the 527libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and 528trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a 529complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by 530Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane 531Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel 532Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei 533Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich 534Weigand. 535 536Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from 537Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others 538who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include 539Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner. 540 541Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the 542Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture. 543 544@node Sample Session 545@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session 546 547You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}. 548However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the 549debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands. 550 551@iftex 552In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input}, 553to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output. 554@end iftex 555 556@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where 557@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use. 558 559One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro 560processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its 561quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro 562definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4} 563session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we 564then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the 565same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to 566@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same 567procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}: 568 569@smallexample 570$ @b{cd gnu/m4} 571$ @b{./m4} 572@b{define(foo,0000)} 573 574@b{foo} 5750000 576@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))} 577 578@b{bar} 5790000 580@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} 581 582@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} 583@b{baz} 584@b{Ctrl-d} 585m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string 586@end smallexample 587 588@noindent 589Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on. 590 591@smallexample 592$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4} 593@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook 594@c FIXME... format to come out better. 595@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies 596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see 597 the conditions. 598There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty" 599 for details. 600 601@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc... 602(@value{GDBP}) 603@end smallexample 604 605@noindent 606@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the 607rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly. 608We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so 609that examples fit in this manual. 610 611@smallexample 612(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70} 613@end smallexample 614 615@noindent 616We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works. 617Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is 618@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN} 619@code{break} command. 620 621@smallexample 622(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote} 623Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879. 624@end smallexample 625 626@noindent 627Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN} 628control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote} 629subroutine, the program runs as usual: 630 631@smallexample 632(@value{GDBP}) @b{run} 633Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4 634@b{define(foo,0000)} 635 636@b{foo} 6370000 638@end smallexample 639 640@noindent 641To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN} 642suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the 643context where it stops. 644 645@smallexample 646@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)} 647 648Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) 649 at builtin.c:879 650879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3)) 651@end smallexample 652 653@noindent 654Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to 655the next line of the current function. 656 657@smallexample 658(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 659882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\ 660 : nil, 661@end smallexample 662 663@noindent 664@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it 665by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}. 666@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any} 667subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}. 668 669@smallexample 670(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 671set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") 672 at input.c:530 673530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 674@end smallexample 675 676@noindent 677The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now 678suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It 679shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace} 680command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are 681in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a 682stack frame for each active subroutine. 683 684@smallexample 685(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt} 686#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>") 687 at input.c:530 688#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70) 689 at builtin.c:882 690#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242 691#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30) 692 at macro.c:71 693#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40 694#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195 695@end smallexample 696 697@noindent 698We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two 699times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid 700falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine. 701 702@smallexample 703(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 7040x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote) 705(@value{GDBP}) @b{s} 7060x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \ 707def_lquote : xstrdup(lq); 708(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 709536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\ 710 : xstrdup(rq); 711(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 712538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); 713@end smallexample 714 715@noindent 716The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables 717@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left 718and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p} 719(@code{print}) to see their values. 720 721@smallexample 722(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote} 723$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>" 724(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote} 725$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>" 726@end smallexample 727 728@noindent 729@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes. 730To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source 731surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command. 732 733@smallexample 734(@value{GDBP}) @b{l} 735533 xfree(rquote); 736534 737535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\ 738 : xstrdup (lq); 739536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\ 740 : xstrdup (rq); 741537 742538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote); 743539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); 744540 @} 745541 746542 void 747@end smallexample 748 749@noindent 750Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and 751@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables. 752 753@smallexample 754(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 755539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote); 756(@value{GDBP}) @b{n} 757540 @} 758(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote} 759$3 = 9 760(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote} 761$4 = 7 762@end smallexample 763 764@noindent 765That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and 766@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and 767@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using 768the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of 769any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and 770assignments. 771 772@smallexample 773(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)} 774$5 = 7 775(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)} 776$6 = 9 777@end smallexample 778 779@noindent 780Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the 781@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue 782executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the 783example that caused trouble initially: 784 785@smallexample 786(@value{GDBP}) @b{c} 787Continuing. 788 789@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))} 790 791baz 7920000 793@end smallexample 794 795@noindent 796Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The 797problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong 798lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input: 799 800@smallexample 801@b{Ctrl-d} 802Program exited normally. 803@end smallexample 804 805@noindent 806The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it 807indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN} 808session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command. 809 810@smallexample 811(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit} 812@end smallexample 813 814@node Invocation 815@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN} 816 817This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it. 818The essentials are: 819@itemize @bullet 820@item 821type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}. 822@item 823type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit. 824@end itemize 825 826@menu 827* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN} 828* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN} 829* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN} 830* Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file 831@end menu 832 833@node Invoking GDB 834@section Invoking @value{GDBN} 835 836Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started, 837@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit. 838 839You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options, 840to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset. 841 842The command-line options described here are designed 843to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these 844options may effectively be unavailable. 845 846The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument, 847specifying an executable program: 848 849@smallexample 850@value{GDBP} @var{program} 851@end smallexample 852 853@noindent 854You can also start with both an executable program and a core file 855specified: 856 857@smallexample 858@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core} 859@end smallexample 860 861You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want 862to debug a running process: 863 864@smallexample 865@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234 866@end smallexample 867 868@noindent 869would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file 870named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first). 871 872Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly 873complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote 874debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of 875``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN} 876will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps. 877 878You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the 879executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops 880option processing. 881@smallexample 882@value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c 883@end smallexample 884This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set 885@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}. 886 887You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes 888@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent} 889(or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}): 890 891@smallexample 892@value{GDBP} --silent 893@end smallexample 894 895@noindent 896You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line 897options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available. 898 899@noindent 900Type 901 902@smallexample 903@value{GDBP} -help 904@end smallexample 905 906@noindent 907to display all available options and briefly describe their use 908(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent). 909 910All options and command line arguments you give are processed 911in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the 912@samp{-x} option is used. 913 914 915@menu 916* File Options:: Choosing files 917* Mode Options:: Choosing modes 918* Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup 919@end menu 920 921@node File Options 922@subsection Choosing Files 923 924When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as 925specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is 926the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and 927@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the 928first argument that does not have an associated option flag as 929equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the 930second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as 931equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.) 932If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will 933first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt 934to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with 935a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by 936prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}. 937 938If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support, 939such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second 940argument and ignore it. 941 942Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the 943following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate 944them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous. 945(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather 946than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.) 947 948@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This 949@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find 950@c it. 951 952@table @code 953@item -symbols @var{file} 954@itemx -s @var{file} 955@cindex @code{--symbols} 956@cindex @code{-s} 957Read symbol table from file @var{file}. 958 959@item -exec @var{file} 960@itemx -e @var{file} 961@cindex @code{--exec} 962@cindex @code{-e} 963Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate, 964and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump. 965 966@item -se @var{file} 967@cindex @code{--se} 968Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable 969file. 970 971@item -core @var{file} 972@itemx -c @var{file} 973@cindex @code{--core} 974@cindex @code{-c} 975Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine. 976 977@item -pid @var{number} 978@itemx -p @var{number} 979@cindex @code{--pid} 980@cindex @code{-p} 981Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command. 982 983@item -command @var{file} 984@itemx -x @var{file} 985@cindex @code{--command} 986@cindex @code{-x} 987Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is 988evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would. 989@xref{Command Files,, Command files}. 990 991@item -eval-command @var{command} 992@itemx -ex @var{command} 993@cindex @code{--eval-command} 994@cindex @code{-ex} 995Execute a single @value{GDBN} command. 996 997This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may 998also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required. 999 1000@smallexample 1001@value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \ 1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out 1003@end smallexample 1004 1005@item -init-command @var{file} 1006@itemx -ix @var{file} 1007@cindex @code{--init-command} 1008@cindex @code{-ix} 1009Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but 1010after loading gdbinit files). 1011@xref{Startup}. 1012 1013@item -init-eval-command @var{command} 1014@itemx -iex @var{command} 1015@cindex @code{--init-eval-command} 1016@cindex @code{-iex} 1017Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but 1018after loading gdbinit files). 1019@xref{Startup}. 1020 1021@item -directory @var{directory} 1022@itemx -d @var{directory} 1023@cindex @code{--directory} 1024@cindex @code{-d} 1025Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files. 1026 1027@item -r 1028@itemx -readnow 1029@cindex @code{--readnow} 1030@cindex @code{-r} 1031Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than 1032the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed. 1033This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster. 1034 1035@end table 1036 1037@node Mode Options 1038@subsection Choosing Modes 1039 1040You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in 1041batch mode or quiet mode. 1042 1043@table @code 1044@anchor{-nx} 1045@item -nx 1046@itemx -n 1047@cindex @code{--nx} 1048@cindex @code{-n} 1049Do not execute commands found in any initialization file. 1050There are three init files, loaded in the following order: 1051 1052@table @code 1053@item @file{system.gdbinit} 1054This is the system-wide init file. 1055Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit} 1056configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). 1057It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options 1058have been processed. 1059@item @file{~/.gdbinit} 1060This is the init file in your home directory. 1061It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before 1062command options have been processed. 1063@item @file{./.gdbinit} 1064This is the init file in the current directory. 1065It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and 1066@code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and 1067@code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded. 1068@end table 1069 1070For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}. 1071For documentation on how to write command files, 1072@xref{Command Files,,Command Files}. 1073 1074@anchor{-nh} 1075@item -nh 1076@cindex @code{--nh} 1077Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file 1078in your home directory. 1079@xref{Startup}. 1080 1081@item -quiet 1082@itemx -silent 1083@itemx -q 1084@cindex @code{--quiet} 1085@cindex @code{--silent} 1086@cindex @code{-q} 1087``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These 1088messages are also suppressed in batch mode. 1089 1090@item -batch 1091@cindex @code{--batch} 1092Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the 1093command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from 1094initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with 1095nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands 1096in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited 1097terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm 1098off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}). 1099 1100Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for 1101example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to 1102make this more useful, the message 1103 1104@smallexample 1105Program exited normally. 1106@end smallexample 1107 1108@noindent 1109(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under 1110@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch 1111mode. 1112 1113@item -batch-silent 1114@cindex @code{--batch-silent} 1115Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All 1116@value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is 1117unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless 1118for an interactive session. 1119 1120This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section} 1121messages, for example. 1122 1123Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to 1124writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent. 1125 1126@item -return-child-result 1127@cindex @code{--return-child-result} 1128The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child 1129process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions: 1130 1131@itemize @bullet 1132@item 1133@value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an 1134internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been 1135without @samp{-return-child-result}. 1136@item 1137The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}. 1138@item 1139The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case 1140the exit code will be -1. 1141@end itemize 1142 1143This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent}, 1144when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator 1145interface. 1146 1147@item -nowindows 1148@itemx -nw 1149@cindex @code{--nowindows} 1150@cindex @code{-nw} 1151``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface 1152(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line 1153interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect. 1154 1155@item -windows 1156@itemx -w 1157@cindex @code{--windows} 1158@cindex @code{-w} 1159If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be 1160used if possible. 1161 1162@item -cd @var{directory} 1163@cindex @code{--cd} 1164Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory, 1165instead of the current directory. 1166 1167@item -data-directory @var{directory} 1168@itemx -D @var{directory} 1169@cindex @code{--data-directory} 1170@cindex @code{-D} 1171Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory. 1172The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its 1173auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}. 1174 1175@item -fullname 1176@itemx -f 1177@cindex @code{--fullname} 1178@cindex @code{-f} 1179@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a 1180subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line 1181number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is 1182displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This 1183recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by 1184the file name, line number and character position separated by colons, 1185and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two 1186@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the 1187frame. 1188 1189@item -annotate @var{level} 1190@cindex @code{--annotate} 1191This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its 1192effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}} 1193(@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much 1194information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of 1195expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the 1196normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of 1197@sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs 1198that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated. 1199 1200The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi} 1201(@pxref{GDB/MI}). 1202 1203@item --args 1204@cindex @code{--args} 1205Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the 1206executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior. 1207This option stops option processing. 1208 1209@item -baud @var{bps} 1210@itemx -b @var{bps} 1211@cindex @code{--baud} 1212@cindex @code{-b} 1213Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial 1214interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging. 1215 1216@item -l @var{timeout} 1217@cindex @code{-l} 1218Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN} 1219for remote debugging. 1220 1221@item -tty @var{device} 1222@itemx -t @var{device} 1223@cindex @code{--tty} 1224@cindex @code{-t} 1225Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output. 1226@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate. 1227 1228@c resolve the situation of these eventually 1229@item -tui 1230@cindex @code{--tui} 1231Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User 1232Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing 1233source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs 1234(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this 1235option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, , 1236Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}). 1237 1238@item -interpreter @var{interp} 1239@cindex @code{--interpreter} 1240Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling 1241program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which 1242communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. 1243@xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}. 1244 1245@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes 1246@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , 1247The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The 1248previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and 1249selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier 1250@sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported. 1251 1252@item -write 1253@cindex @code{--write} 1254Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This 1255is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN} 1256(@pxref{Patching}). 1257 1258@item -statistics 1259@cindex @code{--statistics} 1260This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and 1261memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt. 1262 1263@item -version 1264@cindex @code{--version} 1265This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and 1266no-warranty blurb, and exit. 1267 1268@item -configuration 1269@cindex @code{--configuration} 1270This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time 1271configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be 1272important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}). 1273 1274@end table 1275 1276@node Startup 1277@subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup 1278@cindex @value{GDBN} startup 1279 1280Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup: 1281 1282@enumerate 1283@item 1284Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line 1285(@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}). 1286 1287@item 1288@cindex init file 1289Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was 1290used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration, 1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in 1292that file. 1293 1294@anchor{Home Directory Init File} 1295@item 1296Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On 1297DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the 1298@code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in 1299that file. 1300 1301@anchor{Option -init-eval-command} 1302@item 1303Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and 1304@samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the 1305@samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply 1306settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior 1307gets loaded. 1308 1309@item 1310Processes command line options and operands. 1311 1312@anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup} 1313@item 1314Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current 1315working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to 1316@samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}). 1317This is only done if the current directory is 1318different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one 1319init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific 1320to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke 1321@value{GDBN}. 1322 1323@item 1324If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to 1325attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded 1326scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries. 1327@xref{Auto-loading}. 1328 1329If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup, 1330you must do something like the following: 1331 1332@smallexample 1333$ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram 1334@end smallexample 1335 1336Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned 1337off too late. 1338 1339@item 1340Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and 1341@samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for 1342more details about @value{GDBN} command files. 1343 1344@item 1345Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}. 1346@xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the 1347files where @value{GDBN} records it. 1348@end enumerate 1349 1350Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command 1351Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init 1352file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set 1353complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options 1354and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx} 1355option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}). 1356 1357To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you 1358can use @kbd{gdb --help}. 1359 1360@cindex init file name 1361@cindex @file{.gdbinit} 1362@cindex @file{gdb.ini} 1363The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}. 1364The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to 1365the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows 1366port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a 1367@file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that 1368and suggests to rename the file to the standard name. 1369 1370 1371@node Quitting GDB 1372@section Quitting @value{GDBN} 1373@cindex exiting @value{GDBN} 1374@cindex leaving @value{GDBN} 1375 1376@table @code 1377@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]} 1378@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})} 1379@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]} 1380@itemx q 1381To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated 1382@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you 1383do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally; 1384otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the 1385error code. 1386@end table 1387 1388@cindex interrupt 1389An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather 1390terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and 1391returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt 1392character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect 1393until a time when it is safe. 1394 1395If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or 1396device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command 1397(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}). 1398 1399@node Shell Commands 1400@section Shell Commands 1401 1402If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your 1403debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can 1404just use the @code{shell} command. 1405 1406@table @code 1407@kindex shell 1408@kindex ! 1409@cindex shell escape 1410@item shell @var{command-string} 1411@itemx !@var{command-string} 1412Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}. 1413Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}. 1414If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which 1415shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell 1416(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.). 1417@end table 1418 1419The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments. 1420You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in 1421@value{GDBN}: 1422 1423@table @code 1424@kindex make 1425@cindex calling make 1426@item make @var{make-args} 1427Execute the @code{make} program with the specified 1428arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}. 1429@end table 1430 1431@node Logging Output 1432@section Logging Output 1433@cindex logging @value{GDBN} output 1434@cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file 1435 1436You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file. 1437There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging. 1438 1439@table @code 1440@kindex set logging 1441@item set logging on 1442Enable logging. 1443@item set logging off 1444Disable logging. 1445@cindex logging file name 1446@item set logging file @var{file} 1447Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}. 1448@item set logging overwrite [on|off] 1449By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if 1450you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead. 1451@item set logging redirect [on|off] 1452By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile. 1453Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file. 1454@kindex show logging 1455@item show logging 1456Show the current values of the logging settings. 1457@end table 1458 1459@node Commands 1460@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands 1461 1462You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command 1463name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain 1464@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB} 1465key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to 1466show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility). 1467 1468@menu 1469* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN} 1470* Completion:: Command completion 1471* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help 1472@end menu 1473 1474@node Command Syntax 1475@section Command Syntax 1476 1477A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on 1478how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by 1479arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the 1480command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to 1481step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command 1482with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments. 1483 1484@cindex abbreviation 1485@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is 1486unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the 1487documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous 1488abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as 1489equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose 1490names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as 1491arguments to the @code{help} command. 1492 1493@cindex repeating commands 1494@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)} 1495A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to 1496repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run}) 1497will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional 1498repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to 1499repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see 1500@ref{Define, dont-repeat}. 1501 1502The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with 1503@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating 1504exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory. 1505 1506@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy 1507output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more} 1508(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one 1509@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command 1510repetition after any command that generates this sort of display. 1511 1512@kindex # @r{(a comment)} 1513@cindex comment 1514Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does 1515nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command 1516Files,,Command Files}). 1517 1518@cindex repeating command sequences 1519@kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)} 1520The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of 1521commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and 1522then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history 1523for editing. 1524 1525@node Completion 1526@section Command Completion 1527 1528@cindex completion 1529@cindex word completion 1530@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is 1531only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities 1532are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN} 1533commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program. 1534 1535Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest 1536of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the 1537word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to 1538enter it). For example, if you type 1539 1540@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit 1541@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity. 1542@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to 1543@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following... 1544@smallexample 1545(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB} 1546@end smallexample 1547 1548@noindent 1549@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is 1550the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}: 1551 1552@smallexample 1553(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints 1554@end smallexample 1555 1556@noindent 1557You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info 1558breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if 1559@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you 1560were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you 1561might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre}, 1562to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion). 1563 1564If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press 1565@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more 1566characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time; 1567@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For 1568example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name 1569begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN} 1570just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the 1571function names in your program that begin with those characters, for 1572example: 1573 1574@smallexample 1575(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB} 1576@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see: 1577make_a_section_from_file make_environ 1578make_abs_section make_function_type 1579make_blockvector make_pointer_type 1580make_cleanup make_reference_type 1581make_command make_symbol_completion_list 1582(@value{GDBP}) b make_ 1583@end smallexample 1584 1585@noindent 1586After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your 1587partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the 1588command. 1589 1590If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you 1591can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?} 1592means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a 1593key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is 1594one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}. 1595 1596If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will 1597print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message 1598indicating that the list may be truncated. 1599 1600@smallexample 1601(@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB} 1602main 1603<... the rest of the possible completions ...> 1604*** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. *** 1605(@value{GDBP}) b m 1606@end smallexample 1607 1608@noindent 1609This behavior can be controlled with the following commands: 1610 1611@table @code 1612@kindex set max-completions 1613@item set max-completions @var{limit} 1614@itemx set max-completions unlimited 1615Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will 1616stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates. 1617This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting 1618all the possible candidates can be time consuming. 1619The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion. 1620Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make 1621completion slow. 1622@kindex show max-completions 1623@item show max-completions 1624Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show 1625during completion. 1626@end table 1627 1628@cindex quotes in commands 1629@cindex completion of quoted strings 1630Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain 1631parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from 1632its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this 1633situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in 1634@value{GDBN} commands. 1635 1636The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the 1637name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function 1638overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished 1639by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you 1640may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} 1641that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version 1642that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the 1643word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote 1644@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts 1645@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual 1646when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion: 1647 1648@smallexample 1649(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?} 1650bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int) 1651(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( 1652@end smallexample 1653 1654In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using 1655quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while 1656completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first 1657place: 1658 1659@smallexample 1660(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB} 1661@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell: 1662(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( 1663@end smallexample 1664 1665@noindent 1666In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if 1667you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for 1668completion on an overloaded symbol. 1669 1670For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus 1671Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set 1672overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution; 1673see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}. 1674 1675@cindex completion of structure field names 1676@cindex structure field name completion 1677@cindex completion of union field names 1678@cindex union field name completion 1679When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a 1680structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be 1681confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only 1682examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to 1683limit completions to the field names available in the type of the 1684left-hand-side: 1685 1686@smallexample 1687(@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?} 1688magic to_fputs to_rewind 1689to_data to_isatty to_write 1690to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe 1691to_flush to_read 1692@end smallexample 1693 1694@noindent 1695This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type 1696@code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as 1697follows: 1698 1699@smallexample 1700struct ui_file 1701@{ 1702 int *magic; 1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush; 1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write; 1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe; 1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs; 1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read; 1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete; 1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty; 1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind; 1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put; 1712 void *to_data; 1713@} 1714@end smallexample 1715 1716 1717@node Help 1718@section Getting Help 1719@cindex online documentation 1720@kindex help 1721 1722You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands, 1723using the command @code{help}. 1724 1725@table @code 1726@kindex h @r{(@code{help})} 1727@item help 1728@itemx h 1729You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to 1730display a short list of named classes of commands: 1731 1732@smallexample 1733(@value{GDBP}) help 1734List of classes of commands: 1735 1736aliases -- Aliases of other commands 1737breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points 1738data -- Examining data 1739files -- Specifying and examining files 1740internals -- Maintenance commands 1741obscure -- Obscure features 1742running -- Running the program 1743stack -- Examining the stack 1744status -- Status inquiries 1745support -- Support facilities 1746tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without 1747 stopping the program 1748user-defined -- User-defined commands 1749 1750Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of 1751commands in that class. 1752Type "help" followed by command name for full 1753documentation. 1754Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. 1755(@value{GDBP}) 1756@end smallexample 1757@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull... 1758 1759@item help @var{class} 1760Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a 1761list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the 1762help display for the class @code{status}: 1763 1764@smallexample 1765(@value{GDBP}) help status 1766Status inquiries. 1767 1768List of commands: 1769 1770@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed 1771@c to fit in smallbook page size. 1772info -- Generic command for showing things 1773 about the program being debugged 1774show -- Generic command for showing things 1775 about the debugger 1776 1777Type "help" followed by command name for full 1778documentation. 1779Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous. 1780(@value{GDBP}) 1781@end smallexample 1782 1783@item help @var{command} 1784With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a 1785short paragraph on how to use that command. 1786 1787@kindex apropos 1788@item apropos @var{args} 1789The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN} 1790commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in 1791@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example: 1792 1793@smallexample 1794apropos alias 1795@end smallexample 1796 1797@noindent 1798results in: 1799 1800@smallexample 1801@c @group 1802alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command 1803aliases -- Aliases of other commands 1804d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions 1805del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions 1806delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions 1807@c @end group 1808@end smallexample 1809 1810@kindex complete 1811@item complete @var{args} 1812The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions 1813for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the 1814command you want completed. For example: 1815 1816@smallexample 1817complete i 1818@end smallexample 1819 1820@noindent results in: 1821 1822@smallexample 1823@group 1824if 1825ignore 1826info 1827inspect 1828@end group 1829@end smallexample 1830 1831@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs. 1832@end table 1833 1834In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info} 1835and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state 1836of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this 1837manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings 1838under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and 1839Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable 1840Index}. 1841 1842@c @group 1843@table @code 1844@kindex info 1845@kindex i @r{(@code{info})} 1846@item info 1847This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your 1848program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function 1849with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info 1850registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}. 1851You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with 1852@w{@code{help info}}. 1853 1854@kindex set 1855@item set 1856You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with 1857@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with 1858@code{set prompt $}. 1859 1860@kindex show 1861@item show 1862In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of 1863@value{GDBN} itself. 1864You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the 1865related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number 1866system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire 1867which is currently in use with @code{show radix}. 1868 1869@kindex info set 1870To display all the settable parameters and their current 1871values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use 1872@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display. 1873@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of 1874@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else, 1875@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"? 1876@end table 1877@c @end group 1878 1879Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are 1880exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands: 1881 1882@table @code 1883@kindex show version 1884@cindex @value{GDBN} version number 1885@item show version 1886Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this 1887information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of 1888@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which 1889version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new 1890commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many 1891system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are 1892variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well. 1893The version number is the same as the one announced when you start 1894@value{GDBN}. 1895 1896@kindex show copying 1897@kindex info copying 1898@cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright 1899@item show copying 1900@itemx info copying 1901Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}. 1902 1903@kindex show warranty 1904@kindex info warranty 1905@item show warranty 1906@itemx info warranty 1907Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty, 1908if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one. 1909 1910@kindex show configuration 1911@item show configuration 1912Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured 1913when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the 1914@file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected 1915automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN} 1916bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in 1917your report. 1918 1919@end table 1920 1921@node Running 1922@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN} 1923 1924When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate 1925debugging information when you compile it. 1926 1927You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment 1928of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect 1929your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or 1930kill a child process. 1931 1932@menu 1933* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging 1934* Starting:: Starting your program 1935* Arguments:: Your program's arguments 1936* Environment:: Your program's environment 1937 1938* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory 1939* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output 1940* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process 1941* Kill Process:: Killing the child process 1942 1943* Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs 1944* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads 1945* Forks:: Debugging forks 1946* Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later 1947@end menu 1948 1949@node Compilation 1950@section Compiling for Debugging 1951 1952In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate 1953debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information 1954is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each 1955variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers 1956and addresses in the executable code. 1957 1958To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run 1959the compiler. 1960 1961Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with 1962optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some 1963compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options 1964together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized 1965executables containing debugging information. 1966 1967@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or 1968without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We 1969recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a 1970program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense 1971in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}. 1972 1973Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option 1974@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this 1975format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it. 1976 1977@value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their 1978expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information 1979about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify 1980the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, 1981the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using 1982the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}. 1983 1984@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC, 1985gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more 1986information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information. 1987 1988You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest 1989version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports. 1990DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging 1991format in @value{GDBN}. 1992 1993@need 2000 1994@node Starting 1995@section Starting your Program 1996@cindex starting 1997@cindex running 1998 1999@table @code 2000@kindex run 2001@kindex r @r{(@code{run})} 2002@item run 2003@itemx r 2004Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}. 2005You must first specify the program name with an argument to 2006@value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of 2007@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} 2008command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 2009 2010@end table 2011 2012If you are running your program in an execution environment that 2013supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes 2014that process run your program. In some environments without processes, 2015@code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets, 2016like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error 2017message like this one: 2018 2019@smallexample 2020The "remote" target does not support "run". 2021Try "help target" or "continue". 2022@end smallexample 2023 2024@noindent 2025then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load} 2026first (@pxref{load}). 2027 2028The execution of a program is affected by certain information it 2029receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this 2030information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You 2031can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect 2032your program the next time you start it.) This information may be 2033divided into four categories: 2034 2035@table @asis 2036@item The @emph{arguments.} 2037Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the 2038@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell 2039is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions 2040(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing 2041the arguments. 2042In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the 2043@code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, 2044@value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable 2045use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see 2046below for details). 2047 2048@item The @emph{environment.} 2049Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can 2050use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset 2051environment} to change parts of the environment that affect 2052your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}. 2053 2054@item The @emph{working directory.} 2055Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set 2056the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}. 2057@xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}. 2058 2059@item The @emph{standard input and output.} 2060Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and 2061standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output 2062in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to 2063set a different device for your program. 2064@xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}. 2065 2066@cindex pipes 2067@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use 2068pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another 2069program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the 2070wrong program. 2071@end table 2072 2073When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute 2074immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion 2075of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has 2076stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print} 2077or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}. 2078 2079If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last 2080time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol 2081table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain 2082your current breakpoints. 2083 2084@table @code 2085@kindex start 2086@item start 2087@cindex run to main procedure 2088The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language. 2089With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but 2090other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their 2091main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the 2092execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main 2093procedure, depending on the language used. 2094 2095The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary 2096breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking 2097the @samp{run} command. 2098 2099@cindex elaboration phase 2100Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is 2101executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the 2102languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance, 2103constructors for static and global objects are executed before 2104@code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops 2105before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint 2106will remain to halt execution. 2107 2108Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the 2109@samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the 2110underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be 2111reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to 2112@samp{start} or @samp{run}. 2113 2114It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In 2115these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of 2116your program too late, as the program would have already completed the 2117elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your 2118elaboration code before running your program. 2119 2120@anchor{set exec-wrapper} 2121@kindex set exec-wrapper 2122@item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper} 2123@itemx show exec-wrapper 2124@itemx unset exec-wrapper 2125When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to 2126launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program 2127with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper} 2128@var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its 2129arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if 2130appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes 2131your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control. 2132 2133You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with 2134its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do 2135this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending 2136with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work. 2137 2138For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to 2139the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's 2140environment: 2141 2142@smallexample 2143(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so' 2144(@value{GDBP}) run 2145@end smallexample 2146 2147This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding 2148@sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino. 2149 2150@kindex set startup-with-shell 2151@item set startup-with-shell 2152@itemx set startup-with-shell on 2153@itemx set startup-with-shell off 2154@itemx show set startup-with-shell 2155On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target, 2156@value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the 2157@code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable 2158substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of 2159I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a 2160shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing 2161startup failures such as: 2162 2163@smallexample 2164(@value{GDBP}) run 2165Starting program: ./a.out 2166During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault. 2167@end smallexample 2168 2169@noindent 2170which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with 2171@samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is 2172caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode 2173initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, 2174$@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the 2175@samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH. 2176 2177@anchor{set auto-connect-native-target} 2178@kindex set auto-connect-native-target 2179@item set auto-connect-native-target 2180@itemx set auto-connect-native-target on 2181@itemx set auto-connect-native-target off 2182@itemx show auto-connect-native-target 2183 2184By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with 2185@code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a 2186native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're 2187sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can 2188tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically 2189with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command. 2190 2191If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not 2192connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly 2193connects to the native target, if one is available. 2194 2195If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target 2196already, the @code{run} command fails with an error: 2197 2198@smallexample 2199(@value{GDBP}) run 2200Don't know how to run. Try "help target". 2201@end smallexample 2202 2203If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always 2204uses it with the @code{run} command. 2205 2206In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the 2207@code{target native} command. For example, 2208 2209@smallexample 2210(@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off 2211(@value{GDBP}) run 2212Don't know how to run. Try "help target". 2213(@value{GDBP}) target native 2214(@value{GDBP}) run 2215Starting program: ./a.out 2216[Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally] 2217@end smallexample 2218 2219In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target, 2220@value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for 2221the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to 2222disconnect. 2223 2224Examples of other commands that likewise respect the 2225@code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info 2226proc}, @code{info os}. 2227 2228@kindex set disable-randomization 2229@item set disable-randomization 2230@itemx set disable-randomization on 2231This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native 2232randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option 2233is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better 2234reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions. 2235 2236This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux. 2237On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using 2238 2239@smallexample 2240(@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R 2241@end smallexample 2242 2243@item set disable-randomization off 2244Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their 2245ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug 2246disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because 2247@value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such 2248as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set 2249disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs. 2250 2251On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization 2252protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these 2253cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable 2254code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing 2255a code at its expected addresses. 2256 2257Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it 2258makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by 2259having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared 2260library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code 2261misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new 2262random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the 2263startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at 2264a randomly chosen address. 2265 2266Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code 2267similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at 2268a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even 2269already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such 2270executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}. 2271 2272Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly 2273(as long as the randomization is enabled). 2274 2275@item show disable-randomization 2276Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of 2277the virtual address space of the started program. 2278 2279@end table 2280 2281@node Arguments 2282@section Your Program's Arguments 2283 2284@cindex arguments (to your program) 2285The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the 2286@code{run} command. 2287They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and 2288performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your 2289@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell 2290@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses 2291the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix). 2292 2293On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by 2294@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system 2295calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of 2296the program, not by the shell. 2297 2298@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous 2299@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command. 2300 2301@table @code 2302@kindex set args 2303@item set args 2304Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If 2305@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program 2306with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments, 2307using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run 2308it again without arguments. 2309 2310@kindex show args 2311@item show args 2312Show the arguments to give your program when it is started. 2313@end table 2314 2315@node Environment 2316@section Your Program's Environment 2317 2318@cindex environment (of your program) 2319The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and 2320their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as 2321your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search 2322path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with 2323the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When 2324debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified 2325environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again. 2326 2327@table @code 2328@kindex path 2329@item path @var{directory} 2330Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable 2331(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program. 2332The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change. 2333You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a 2334system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on 2335MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it 2336is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner. 2337 2338You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current 2339working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you 2340use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the 2341@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the 2342@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding 2343@var{directory} to the search path. 2344@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to 2345@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op. 2346 2347@kindex show paths 2348@item show paths 2349Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH} 2350environment variable). 2351 2352@kindex show environment 2353@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]} 2354Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to 2355your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname}, 2356print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to 2357your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}. 2358 2359@kindex set environment 2360@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]} 2361Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value 2362changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch 2363it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the 2364values of environment variables are just strings, and any 2365interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value} 2366parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a 2367null value. 2368@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing 2369@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care? 2370 2371For example, this command: 2372 2373@smallexample 2374set env USER = foo 2375@end smallexample 2376 2377@noindent 2378tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named 2379@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they 2380are not actually required.) 2381 2382Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell, 2383which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}. 2384If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a 2385wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set 2386exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that. 2387 2388@kindex unset environment 2389@item unset environment @var{varname} 2390Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your 2391program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =}; 2392@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment, 2393rather than assigning it an empty value. 2394@end table 2395 2396@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using 2397the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it 2398exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable 2399names a shell that runs an initialization file when started 2400non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv} 2401for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV} 2402environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file 2403affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment 2404variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as 2405@file{.login} or @file{.profile}. 2406 2407@node Working Directory 2408@section Your Program's Working Directory 2409 2410@cindex working directory (of your program) 2411Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its 2412working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}. 2413The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited 2414from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new 2415working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command. 2416 2417The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands 2418that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to 2419Specify Files}. 2420 2421@table @code 2422@kindex cd 2423@cindex change working directory 2424@item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]} 2425Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not 2426given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}. 2427 2428@kindex pwd 2429@item pwd 2430Print the @value{GDBN} working directory. 2431@end table 2432 2433It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of 2434the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory 2435during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is 2436configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info 2437proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the 2438current working directory of the debuggee. 2439 2440@node Input/Output 2441@section Your Program's Input and Output 2442 2443@cindex redirection 2444@cindex i/o 2445@cindex terminal 2446By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to 2447the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal 2448to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal 2449modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue 2450running your program. 2451 2452@table @code 2453@kindex info terminal 2454@item info terminal 2455Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your 2456program is using. 2457@end table 2458 2459You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell 2460redirection with the @code{run} command. For example, 2461 2462@smallexample 2463run > outfile 2464@end smallexample 2465 2466@noindent 2467starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}. 2468 2469@kindex tty 2470@cindex controlling terminal 2471Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is 2472with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as 2473argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run} 2474commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child 2475process, for future @code{run} commands. For example, 2476 2477@smallexample 2478tty /dev/ttyb 2479@end smallexample 2480 2481@noindent 2482directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands 2483default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have 2484that as their controlling terminal. 2485 2486An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's 2487effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling 2488terminal. 2489 2490When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run} 2491command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input 2492for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias 2493for @code{set inferior-tty}. 2494 2495@cindex inferior tty 2496@cindex set inferior controlling terminal 2497You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to 2498display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your 2499program. 2500 2501@table @code 2502@item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ] 2503@kindex set inferior-tty 2504Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty} 2505restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as 2506@value{GDBN}. 2507 2508@item show inferior-tty 2509@kindex show inferior-tty 2510Show the current tty for the program being debugged. 2511@end table 2512 2513@node Attach 2514@section Debugging an Already-running Process 2515@kindex attach 2516@cindex attach 2517 2518@table @code 2519@item attach @var{process-id} 2520This command attaches to a running process---one that was started 2521outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active 2522targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to 2523find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility, 2524or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command. 2525 2526@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after 2527executing the command. 2528@end table 2529 2530To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment 2531which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for 2532programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must 2533also have permission to send the process a signal. 2534 2535When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in 2536the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if 2537the program is not found) by using the source file search path 2538(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use 2539the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to 2540Specify Files}. 2541 2542The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified 2543process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process 2544with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when 2545you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you 2546can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the 2547process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after 2548attaching @value{GDBN} to the process. 2549 2550@table @code 2551@kindex detach 2552@item detach 2553When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the 2554@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching 2555the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command, 2556that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you 2557are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}. 2558@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after 2559executing the command. 2560@end table 2561 2562If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach 2563that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process. 2564By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these 2565things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the 2566@code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 2567Messages}). 2568 2569@node Kill Process 2570@section Killing the Child Process 2571 2572@table @code 2573@kindex kill 2574@item kill 2575Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}. 2576@end table 2577 2578This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a 2579running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program 2580is running. 2581 2582On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN} 2583while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the 2584@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program 2585outside the debugger. 2586 2587The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and 2588relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an 2589executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you 2590next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and 2591reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current 2592breakpoint settings). 2593 2594@node Inferiors and Programs 2595@section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs 2596 2597@value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single 2598session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run 2599several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one 2600before starting another). In the most general case, you can have 2601multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched 2602from multiple executables. 2603 2604@cindex inferior 2605@value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an 2606object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to 2607a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not 2608have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and 2609may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique 2610identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each 2611inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some 2612embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts 2613of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple 2614threads running in it. 2615 2616To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info 2617inferiors}}: 2618 2619@table @code 2620@kindex info inferiors 2621@item info inferiors 2622Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}. 2623 2624@value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order): 2625 2626@enumerate 2627@item 2628the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2629 2630@item 2631the target system's inferior identifier 2632 2633@item 2634the name of the executable the inferior is running. 2635 2636@end enumerate 2637 2638@noindent 2639An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number 2640indicates the current inferior. 2641 2642For example, 2643@end table 2644@c end table here to get a little more width for example 2645 2646@smallexample 2647(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2648 Num Description Executable 2649 2 process 2307 hello 2650* 1 process 3401 goodbye 2651@end smallexample 2652 2653To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command: 2654 2655@table @code 2656@kindex inferior @var{infno} 2657@item inferior @var{infno} 2658Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument 2659@var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown 2660in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display. 2661@end table 2662 2663@vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable} 2664The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the 2665number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing 2666breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. 2667@xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general 2668information on convenience variables. 2669 2670You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the 2671@code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some 2672systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session 2673automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To 2674remove inferiors from the debugging session use the 2675@w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command. 2676 2677@table @code 2678@kindex add-inferior 2679@item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ] 2680Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the 2681executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified, 2682the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or 2683change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the 2684@code{file} command with the executable name as its argument. 2685 2686@kindex clone-inferior 2687@item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ] 2688Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior 2689@var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the 2690number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you 2691want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging. 2692 2693@smallexample 2694(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2695 Num Description Executable 2696* 1 process 29964 helloworld 2697(@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior 2698Added inferior 2. 26991 inferiors added. 2700(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 2701 Num Description Executable 2702 2 <null> helloworld 2703* 1 process 29964 helloworld 2704@end smallexample 2705 2706You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it. 2707 2708@kindex remove-inferiors 2709@item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2710Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not 2711possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For 2712those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first. 2713 2714@end table 2715 2716To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current 2717inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach 2718inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it 2719using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command: 2720 2721@table @code 2722@kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2723@item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{} 2724Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} 2725inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry 2726still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, 2727but its Description will show @samp{<null>}. 2728 2729@kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2730@item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{} 2731Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior 2732number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still 2733stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its 2734Description will show @samp{<null>}. 2735@end table 2736 2737After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach}, 2738@code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after 2739a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with 2740@code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted. 2741 2742 2743To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s 2744control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}: 2745 2746@table @code 2747@kindex set print inferior-events 2748@cindex print messages on inferior start and exit 2749@item set print inferior-events 2750@itemx set print inferior-events on 2751@itemx set print inferior-events off 2752The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or 2753disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new 2754inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been 2755detached. By default, these messages will not be printed. 2756 2757@kindex show print inferior-events 2758@item show print inferior-events 2759Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that 2760inferiors have started, exited or have been detached. 2761@end table 2762 2763Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a 2764single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the 2765value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior. 2766 2767 2768Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to 2769get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address 2770spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint 2771info program-spaces}} command. 2772 2773@table @code 2774@kindex maint info program-spaces 2775@item maint info program-spaces 2776Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by 2777@value{GDBN}. 2778 2779@value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order): 2780 2781@enumerate 2782@item 2783the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2784 2785@item 2786the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g., 2787the @code{file} command. 2788 2789@end enumerate 2790 2791@noindent 2792An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number 2793indicates the current program space. 2794 2795In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra 2796information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For 2797example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space. 2798 2799@smallexample 2800(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces 2801 Id Executable 2802* 1 hello 2803 2 goodbye 2804 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561) 2805@end smallexample 2806 2807Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello}, 2808while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On 2809some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the 2810same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both 2811the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example, 2812 2813@smallexample 2814(@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces 2815 Id Executable 2816* 1 vfork-test 2817 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045) 2818@end smallexample 2819 2820Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program 2821space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call. 2822@end table 2823 2824@node Threads 2825@section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads 2826 2827@cindex threads of execution 2828@cindex multiple threads 2829@cindex switching threads 2830In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program 2831may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics 2832of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general 2833the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except 2834that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and 2835modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own 2836registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory. 2837 2838@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread 2839programs: 2840 2841@itemize @bullet 2842@item automatic notification of new threads 2843@item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads 2844@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads 2845@item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}}, 2846a command to apply a command to a list of threads 2847@item thread-specific breakpoints 2848@item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of 2849messages on thread start and exit. 2850@item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets 2851the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice 2852isn't compatible with the program. 2853@end itemize 2854 2855@cindex focus of debugging 2856@cindex current thread 2857The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all 2858threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes 2859control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging. 2860This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show 2861program information from the perspective of the current thread. 2862 2863@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message 2864@cindex thread identifier (system) 2865@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message 2866@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that 2867@c thread without first checking `info threads'. 2868Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays 2869the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the 2870form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier 2871whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on 2872@sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see 2873 2874@smallexample 2875[New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)] 2876@end smallexample 2877 2878@noindent 2879when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems, 2880the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no 2881further qualifier. 2882 2883@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first 2884@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the 2885@c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread 2886@c program? 2887@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some 2888@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple 2889@c threads ab initio? 2890 2891@anchor{thread numbers} 2892@cindex thread number, per inferior 2893@cindex thread identifier (GDB) 2894For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number 2895---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This 2896number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique 2897between threads of different inferiors. 2898 2899@cindex qualified thread ID 2900You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified 2901@var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as 2902@dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior 2903number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given 2904inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of 2905inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}), 2906then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current 2907inferior. 2908 2909Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the 2910@var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use 2911the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads 2912of inferior 1, the initial inferior. 2913 2914@anchor{thread ID lists} 2915@cindex thread ID lists 2916Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as 2917argument. A list element can be: 2918 2919@enumerate 2920@item 2921A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} 2922display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or 2923@samp{1}. 2924 2925@item 2926A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior 2927qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or 2928@var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}. 2929 2930@item 2931All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or 2932without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g., 2933@samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the 2934given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier 2935refers to all threads of the current inferior. 2936 2937@end enumerate 2938 2939For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one 2940thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*} 2941includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads 29427 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in 2943expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9 29447.1}. 2945 2946 2947@anchor{global thread numbers} 2948@cindex global thread number 2949@cindex global thread identifier (GDB) 2950In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also 2951assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global 2952thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of 2953the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when 2954you're debugging multiple inferiors. 2955 2956From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one 2957thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the 2958program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded. 2959 2960@vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable} 2961@vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable} 2962The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and 2963@samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number 2964and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this 2965useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, 2966and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for 2967general information on convenience variables. 2968 2969If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the 2970usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of 2971the thread that hit the breakpoint. 2972 2973@smallexample 2974Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68 2975@end smallexample 2976 2977Likewise when the program receives a signal: 2978 2979@smallexample 2980Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt. 2981@end smallexample 2982 2983@table @code 2984@kindex info threads 2985@item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]} 2986 2987Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments 2988displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of 2989threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax 2990(@pxref{thread ID lists}). 2991 2992@value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order): 2993 2994@enumerate 2995@item 2996the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN} 2997 2998@item 2999the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid} 3000option was specified 3001 3002@item 3003the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag}) 3004 3005@item 3006the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by 3007the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the 3008program itself. 3009 3010@item 3011the current stack frame summary for that thread 3012@end enumerate 3013 3014@noindent 3015An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number 3016indicates the current thread. 3017 3018For example, 3019@end table 3020@c end table here to get a little more width for example 3021 3022@smallexample 3023(@value{GDBP}) info threads 3024 Id Target Id Frame 3025* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8) 3026 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3027 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3028 at threadtest.c:68 3029@end smallexample 3030 3031If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread 3032IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format. 3033Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown. 3034 3035If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column 3036indicating each thread's global thread ID: 3037 3038@smallexample 3039(@value{GDBP}) info threads 3040 Id GId Target Id Frame 3041 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8) 3042 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3043 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause () 3044* 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8) 3045@end smallexample 3046 3047On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a 3048Solaris-specific command: 3049 3050@table @code 3051@item maint info sol-threads 3052@kindex maint info sol-threads 3053@cindex thread info (Solaris) 3054Display info on Solaris user threads. 3055@end table 3056 3057@table @code 3058@kindex thread @var{thread-id} 3059@item thread @var{thread-id} 3060Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command 3061argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in 3062the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an 3063inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}). 3064 3065@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the 3066thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary: 3067 3068@smallexample 3069(@value{GDBP}) thread 2 3070[Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))] 3071#0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8 30728 printf ("hello\n"); 3073@end smallexample 3074 3075@noindent 3076As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after 3077@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying 3078threads. 3079 3080@kindex thread apply 3081@cindex apply command to several threads 3082@item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command} 3083The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named 3084@var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you 3085want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID 3086lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a 3087command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all 3088@var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order, 3089type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}. 3090 3091 3092@kindex thread name 3093@cindex name a thread 3094@item thread name [@var{name}] 3095This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is 3096given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name 3097appears in the @samp{info threads} display. 3098 3099On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to 3100determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these 3101systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the 3102system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause 3103@value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name. 3104 3105@kindex thread find 3106@cindex search for a thread 3107@item thread find [@var{regexp}] 3108Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag} 3109matches the supplied regular expression. 3110 3111As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command, 3112this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target 3113@var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag} 3114is the LWP id. 3115 3116@smallexample 3117(@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688 3118Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)' 3119(@value{GDBN}) info thread 4 3120 Id Target Id Frame 3121 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select () 3122@end smallexample 3123 3124@kindex set print thread-events 3125@cindex print messages on thread start and exit 3126@item set print thread-events 3127@itemx set print thread-events on 3128@itemx set print thread-events off 3129The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or 3130disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have 3131started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will 3132be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target. 3133Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets. 3134 3135@kindex show print thread-events 3136@item show print thread-events 3137Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads 3138have started and exited. 3139@end table 3140 3141@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for 3142more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start 3143programs with multiple threads. 3144 3145@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about 3146watchpoints in programs with multiple threads. 3147 3148@anchor{set libthread-db-search-path} 3149@table @code 3150@kindex set libthread-db-search-path 3151@cindex search path for @code{libthread_db} 3152@item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]} 3153If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 3154directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}. 3155If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to 3156its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems). 3157Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH} 3158macro. 3159 3160On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper'' 3161@code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the 3162inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path} 3163to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior 3164specific thread debugging library loading is enabled 3165by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}). 3166 3167A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} 3168refers to the default system directories that are 3169normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry 3170is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} 3171(@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}). 3172 3173A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} 3174refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread} 3175was loaded in the inferior process. 3176 3177For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories, 3178@value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process. 3179If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version 3180mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN} 3181will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory. 3182If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully, 3183@value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled. 3184 3185Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented 3186only on some platforms. 3187 3188@kindex show libthread-db-search-path 3189@item show libthread-db-search-path 3190Display current libthread_db search path. 3191 3192@kindex set debug libthread-db 3193@kindex show debug libthread-db 3194@cindex debugging @code{libthread_db} 3195@item set debug libthread-db 3196@itemx show debug libthread-db 3197Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events. 3198Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable. 3199@end table 3200 3201@node Forks 3202@section Debugging Forks 3203 3204@cindex fork, debugging programs which call 3205@cindex multiple processes 3206@cindex processes, multiple 3207On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging 3208programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork} 3209function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the 3210parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have 3211set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child 3212will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal) 3213will cause it to terminate. 3214 3215However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround 3216which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which 3217the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep 3218only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists, 3219so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN} 3220on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to 3221get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of 3222@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to 3223the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug 3224the child process just like any other process which you attached to. 3225 3226On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs 3227that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} 3228functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported 3229with kernel version 2.5.46 and later. 3230 3231The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when 3232connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or 3233@code{target extended-remote} mode. 3234 3235By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug 3236the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. 3237 3238If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process, 3239use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}. 3240 3241@table @code 3242@kindex set follow-fork-mode 3243@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode} 3244Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or 3245@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new 3246process. The @var{mode} argument can be: 3247 3248@table @code 3249@item parent 3250The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs 3251unimpeded. This is the default. 3252 3253@item child 3254The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs 3255unimpeded. 3256 3257@end table 3258 3259@kindex show follow-fork-mode 3260@item show follow-fork-mode 3261Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call. 3262@end table 3263 3264@cindex debugging multiple processes 3265On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the 3266command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}. 3267 3268@table @code 3269@kindex set detach-on-fork 3270@item set detach-on-fork @var{mode} 3271Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or 3272retain debugger control over them both. 3273 3274@table @code 3275@item on 3276The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of 3277@code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run 3278independently. This is the default. 3279 3280@item off 3281Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}. 3282One process (child or parent, depending on the value of 3283@code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other 3284is held suspended. 3285 3286@end table 3287 3288@kindex show detach-on-fork 3289@item show detach-on-fork 3290Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off. 3291@end table 3292 3293If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN} 3294will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks). 3295You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by 3296using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork 3297to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and 3298Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}). 3299 3300To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach 3301from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it 3302to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} 3303command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors 3304and Programs}. 3305 3306If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an 3307@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first 3308breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on 3309@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on 3310the child process's @code{main}. 3311 3312On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you 3313cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes. 3314 3315If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec} 3316call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent 3317process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name 3318as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes, 3319@value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image. 3320You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}} 3321command. 3322 3323@table @code 3324@kindex set follow-exec-mode 3325@item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode} 3326 3327Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An 3328@code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process. 3329 3330@code{follow-exec-mode} can be: 3331 3332@table @code 3333@item new 3334@value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this 3335new inferior. The program the process was running before the 3336@code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the 3337original inferior. 3338 3339For example: 3340 3341@smallexample 3342(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3343(gdb) info inferior 3344 Id Description Executable 3345* 1 <null> prog1 3346(@value{GDBP}) run 3347process 12020 is executing new program: prog2 3348Program exited normally. 3349(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3350 Id Description Executable 3351 1 <null> prog1 3352* 2 <null> prog2 3353@end smallexample 3354 3355@item same 3356@value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new 3357executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the 3358inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with 3359e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was 3360running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode. 3361 3362For example: 3363 3364@smallexample 3365(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3366 Id Description Executable 3367* 1 <null> prog1 3368(@value{GDBP}) run 3369process 12020 is executing new program: prog2 3370Program exited normally. 3371(@value{GDBP}) info inferiors 3372 Id Description Executable 3373* 1 <null> prog2 3374@end smallexample 3375 3376@end table 3377@end table 3378 3379@code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and 3380@code{target extended-remote} mode. 3381 3382You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever 3383a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set 3384Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}. 3385 3386@node Checkpoint/Restart 3387@section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later 3388 3389@cindex checkpoint 3390@cindex restart 3391@cindex bookmark 3392@cindex snapshot of a process 3393@cindex rewind program state 3394 3395On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only 3396@sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a 3397program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it 3398later. 3399 3400Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has 3401happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This 3402includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits) 3403system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the 3404moment when the checkpoint was saved. 3405 3406Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're 3407getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save 3408a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss 3409the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program 3410from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and 3411start again from there. 3412 3413This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or 3414steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs. 3415 3416To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging: 3417 3418@table @code 3419@kindex checkpoint 3420@item checkpoint 3421Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state. 3422The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint 3423is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id. 3424 3425@kindex info checkpoints 3426@item info checkpoints 3427List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging 3428session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be 3429listed: 3430 3431@table @code 3432@item Checkpoint ID 3433@item Process ID 3434@item Code Address 3435@item Source line, or label 3436@end table 3437 3438@kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id} 3439@item restart @var{checkpoint-id} 3440Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number 3441@var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames 3442etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint 3443was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point 3444in time when the checkpoint was saved. 3445 3446Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc. 3447are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint 3448only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in 3449the debugger. 3450 3451@kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id} 3452@item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id} 3453Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}. 3454 3455@end table 3456 3457Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state 3458of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system 3459(OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from 3460a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location, 3461so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files 3462opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the 3463previously read data can be read again. 3464 3465Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other 3466external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received 3467from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers, 3468but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to 3469be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have 3470been changed cannot be restored (at this time). 3471 3472However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your 3473program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it 3474again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a 3475different execution path this time. 3476 3477@cindex checkpoints and process id 3478Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be 3479different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process 3480id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}), 3481and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}. 3482If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could 3483potentially pose a problem. 3484 3485@subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints 3486 3487On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization 3488is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it 3489difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an 3490absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the 3491absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the 3492next. 3493 3494A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process. 3495Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main, 3496and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the 3497process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and 3498your symbols will all stay in the same place. 3499 3500@node Stopping 3501@chapter Stopping and Continuing 3502 3503The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your 3504program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into 3505trouble, you can investigate and find out why. 3506 3507Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons, 3508such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a 3509@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and 3510change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then 3511continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide 3512ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also 3513explicitly request this information at any time. 3514 3515@table @code 3516@kindex info program 3517@item info program 3518Display information about the status of your program: whether it is 3519running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped. 3520@end table 3521 3522@menu 3523* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints 3524* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution 3525* Skipping Over Functions and Files:: 3526 Skipping over functions and files 3527* Signals:: Signals 3528* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs 3529@end menu 3530 3531@node Breakpoints 3532@section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints 3533 3534@cindex breakpoints 3535A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in 3536the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to 3537control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set 3538breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set 3539Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program 3540should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the 3541program. 3542 3543On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before 3544the executable is run. 3545 3546@cindex watchpoints 3547@cindex data breakpoints 3548@cindex memory tracing 3549@cindex breakpoint on memory address 3550@cindex breakpoint on variable modification 3551A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program 3552when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value 3553of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables 3554combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called 3555@dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set 3556watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside 3557from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you 3558enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the 3559same commands. 3560 3561You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically 3562whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,, 3563Automatic Display}. 3564 3565@cindex catchpoints 3566@cindex breakpoint on events 3567A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program 3568when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++} 3569exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a 3570different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting 3571Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any 3572other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the 3573@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.) 3574 3575@cindex breakpoint numbers 3576@cindex numbers for breakpoints 3577@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or 3578catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers 3579starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various 3580features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which 3581breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or 3582@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you 3583enable it again. 3584 3585@cindex breakpoint ranges 3586@cindex ranges of breakpoints 3587Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to 3588operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like 3589@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a 3590hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command, 3591all breakpoints in that range are operated on. 3592 3593@menu 3594* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints 3595* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints 3596* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints 3597* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints 3598* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints 3599* Conditions:: Break conditions 3600* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists 3601* Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf 3602* Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file 3603* Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points 3604* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints'' 3605* Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...'' 3606@end menu 3607 3608@node Set Breaks 3609@subsection Setting Breakpoints 3610 3611@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt? 3612@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization. 3613@c 3614@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init? 3615 3616@kindex break 3617@kindex b @r{(@code{break})} 3618@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable} 3619@cindex latest breakpoint 3620Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated 3621@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the 3622number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience 3623Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with 3624convenience variables. 3625 3626@table @code 3627@item break @var{location} 3628Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a 3629function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction. 3630(@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to 3631specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just 3632before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}. 3633 3634When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as 3635C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break. 3636@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of 3637that situation. 3638 3639It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program 3640only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints}) 3641or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint. 3642 3643@item break 3644When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at 3645the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame 3646(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the 3647innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control 3648returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a 3649@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except 3650that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use 3651@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops 3652the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful 3653inside loops. 3654 3655@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at 3656least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you 3657would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the 3658breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already 3659existed when your program stopped. 3660 3661@item break @dots{} if @var{cond} 3662Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression 3663@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the 3664value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true. 3665@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described 3666above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions, 3667,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions. 3668 3669@kindex tbreak 3670@item tbreak @var{args} 3671Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the 3672same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same 3673way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your 3674program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}. 3675 3676@kindex hbreak 3677@cindex hardware breakpoints 3678@item hbreak @var{args} 3679Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the 3680@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the 3681breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not 3682have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code 3683debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without 3684changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation 3685provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets 3686will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction 3687address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware 3688breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For 3689example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and 3690@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete 3691or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones 3692(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}). 3693@xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}. 3694For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware 3695breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote 3696hardware-breakpoint-limit}. 3697 3698@kindex thbreak 3699@item thbreak @var{args} 3700Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} 3701are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in 3702the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command, 3703the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the 3704first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak} 3705command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware 3706may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}. 3707See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}. 3708 3709@kindex rbreak 3710@cindex regular expression 3711@cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp 3712@cindex set breakpoints in many functions 3713@item rbreak @var{regex} 3714Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression 3715@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all 3716matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these 3717breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with 3718the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make 3719them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint. 3720 3721The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools 3722like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by 3723shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include 3724an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit 3725@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to 3726match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}. 3727 3728@cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in 3729When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting 3730breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special 3731classes. 3732 3733@cindex set breakpoints on all functions 3734The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in 3735@strong{all} the functions in a program, like this: 3736 3737@smallexample 3738(@value{GDBP}) rbreak . 3739@end smallexample 3740 3741@item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex} 3742If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits 3743the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the 3744specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on 3745every function in a given file: 3746 3747@smallexample 3748(@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:. 3749@end smallexample 3750 3751The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may 3752optionally be surrounded by spaces. 3753 3754@kindex info breakpoints 3755@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints} 3756@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 3757@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 3758Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and 3759not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only 3760about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)). 3761For each breakpoint, following columns are printed: 3762 3763@table @emph 3764@item Breakpoint Numbers 3765@item Type 3766Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint. 3767@item Disposition 3768Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit. 3769@item Enabled or Disabled 3770Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints 3771that are not enabled. 3772@item Address 3773Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a 3774pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will 3775contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared 3776library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded. 3777See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will 3778have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details. 3779@item What 3780Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and 3781line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to 3782the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until 3783the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future. 3784@end table 3785 3786@noindent 3787If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and 3788``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by 3789@value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition 3790is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows 3791the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with 3792its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses. 3793 3794Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is 3795allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for 3796validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending 3797breakpoint to resolve to a valid location. 3798 3799@noindent 3800@code{info break} with a breakpoint 3801number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The 3802convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for 3803the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint 3804listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). 3805 3806@noindent 3807@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint 3808has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the 3809@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint 3810hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint 3811was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This 3812will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint. 3813 3814@noindent 3815For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1, 3816@code{info break} also displays that count. 3817 3818@end table 3819 3820@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in 3821your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When 3822the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful 3823(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 3824 3825@cindex multiple locations, breakpoints 3826@cindex breakpoints, multiple locations 3827It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations 3828in your program. Examples of this situation are: 3829 3830@itemize @bullet 3831@item 3832Multiple functions in the program may have the same name. 3833 3834@item 3835For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several 3836instances of the function body, used in different cases. 3837 3838@item 3839For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can 3840correspond to any number of instantiations. 3841 3842@item 3843For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to 3844several places where that function is inlined. 3845@end itemize 3846 3847In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all 3848the relevant locations. 3849 3850A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint 3851table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for 3852each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the 3853address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual 3854addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those 3855locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form 3856@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}. 3857 3858For example: 3859 3860@smallexample 3861Num Type Disp Enb Address What 38621 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE> 3863 stop only if i==1 3864 breakpoint already hit 1 time 38651.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8 38661.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8 3867@end smallexample 3868 3869Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing 3870@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the 3871@code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot 3872delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the 3873entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with 3874the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of 3875the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling 3876the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations 3877that belong to that breakpoint. 3878 3879@cindex pending breakpoints 3880It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library. 3881Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly, 3882and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support 3883this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever 3884any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would 3885set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your 3886debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the 3887symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set 3888breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set 3889a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address 3890is not yet resolved. 3891 3892After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded, 3893@value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded 3894shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some 3895pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an 3896ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints 3897that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again. 3898 3899This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For 3900example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and 3901a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template, 3902a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint. 3903 3904Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not 3905differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands, 3906enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations. 3907 3908@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what 3909happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint 3910address specification to an address: 3911 3912@kindex set breakpoint pending 3913@kindex show breakpoint pending 3914@table @code 3915@item set breakpoint pending auto 3916This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint 3917location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created. 3918 3919@item set breakpoint pending on 3920This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically 3921result in a pending breakpoint being created. 3922 3923@item set breakpoint pending off 3924This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any 3925unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does 3926not affect any pending breakpoints previously created. 3927 3928@item show breakpoint pending 3929Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints. 3930@end table 3931 3932The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its 3933variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated 3934as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded. 3935 3936@cindex automatic hardware breakpoints 3937For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or 3938software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the 3939breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to 3940breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal 3941breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For 3942breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware 3943breakpoints. 3944 3945You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:: 3946 3947@kindex set breakpoint auto-hw 3948@kindex show breakpoint auto-hw 3949@table @code 3950@item set breakpoint auto-hw on 3951This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it 3952will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware 3953breakpoint must be used. 3954 3955@item set breakpoint auto-hw off 3956This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint 3957type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when 3958trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address. 3959@end table 3960 3961@value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code 3962at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when 3963executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program 3964code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as 3965the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This 3966behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the 3967target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote 3968targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance. 3969This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:: 3970 3971@kindex set breakpoint always-inserted 3972@kindex show breakpoint always-inserted 3973@table @code 3974@item set breakpoint always-inserted off 3975All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in 3976the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are 3977removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode. 3978 3979@item set breakpoint always-inserted on 3980Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If 3981the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the 3982breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is 3983removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted. 3984@end table 3985 3986@value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions 3987when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being 3988debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed. 3989 3990If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may 3991download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it. 3992 3993This feature can be controlled via the following commands: 3994 3995@kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation 3996@kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation 3997@table @code 3998@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host 3999This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint 4000conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to 4001the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB 4002for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode. 4003 4004@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target 4005This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions 4006to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target 4007is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting 4008breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition 4009is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions 4010cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data 4011that is only known to the host. Examples include 4012conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types 4013that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions 4014that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the 4015target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be 4016evaluated by @value{GDBN}. 4017 4018@item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto 4019This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint 4020conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to 4021the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does 4022not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback 4023to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side. 4024@end table 4025 4026 4027@cindex negative breakpoint numbers 4028@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints 4029@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for 4030special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C 4031programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, 4032starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them. 4033You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command 4034@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}). 4035 4036 4037@node Set Watchpoints 4038@subsection Setting Watchpoints 4039 4040@cindex setting watchpoints 4041You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an 4042expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where 4043this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.) 4044The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or 4045as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include: 4046 4047@itemize @bullet 4048@item 4049A reference to the value of a single variable. 4050 4051@item 4052An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example, 4053@samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified 4054address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes). 4055 4056@item 4057An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The 4058expression can use any operators valid in the program's native 4059language (@pxref{Languages}). 4060@end itemize 4061 4062You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can 4063not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on 4064@samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized. 4065@value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and 4066the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes 4067valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory 4068pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a 4069@code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time 4070the expression changes. 4071 4072@cindex software watchpoints 4073@cindex hardware watchpoints 4074Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or 4075hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your 4076program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of 4077times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to 4078catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the 4079culprit.) 4080 4081On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets, 4082@value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not 4083slow down the running of your program. 4084 4085@table @code 4086@kindex watch 4087@item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]} 4088Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the 4089expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value 4090changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is 4091to watch the value of a single variable: 4092 4093@smallexample 4094(@value{GDBP}) watch foo 4095@end smallexample 4096 4097If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}} 4098argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by 4099@var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads 4100change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note 4101that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work 4102with Hardware Watchpoints. 4103 4104Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr} 4105(see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to 4106instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case, 4107@value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result, 4108and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used 4109to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's 4110result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an 4111error. 4112 4113The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation 4114of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this 4115feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC 4116Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition 4117to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address 4118(the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching 4119the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address. 4120Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those 4121addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the 4122watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}. 4123Examples: 4124 4125@smallexample 4126(@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff 4127(@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00 4128@end smallexample 4129 4130@kindex rwatch 4131@item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]} 4132Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read 4133by the program. 4134 4135@kindex awatch 4136@item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]} 4137Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from 4138or written into by the program. 4139 4140@kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 4141@item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 4142This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as 4143@code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}). 4144@end table 4145 4146If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to 4147dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will 4148never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches 4149a never-changing value: 4150 4151@smallexample 4152(@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850 4153Cannot watch constant value 0x600850. 4154(@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850 4155Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584 4156@end smallexample 4157 4158@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware 4159watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in 4160value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN} 4161cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which 4162executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next 4163@emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs. 4164 4165@cindex use only software watchpoints 4166You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the 4167@kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to 4168zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if 4169the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted 4170watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting 4171@code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware 4172mechanism of watching expression values.) 4173 4174@table @code 4175@item set can-use-hw-watchpoints 4176@kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints 4177Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints. 4178 4179@item show can-use-hw-watchpoints 4180@kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints 4181Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints. 4182@end table 4183 4184For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware 4185watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote 4186hardware-breakpoint-limit}. 4187 4188When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports 4189 4190@smallexample 4191Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr} 4192@end smallexample 4193 4194@noindent 4195if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint. 4196 4197Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set 4198hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the 4199value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining 4200every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do 4201that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a 4202hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it 4203will print a message like this: 4204 4205@smallexample 4206Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint. 4207@end smallexample 4208 4209Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the 4210data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware 4211watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems 4212can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you 4213cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a 4214double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes 4215wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region 4216into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints. 4217 4218If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable 4219to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program. 4220Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such 4221time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be 4222able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the 4223warning will be printed only when the program is resumed: 4224 4225@smallexample 4226Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint 4227@end smallexample 4228 4229@noindent 4230If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints. 4231 4232Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also 4233exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints. 4234That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the 4235expression with separately allocated resources. 4236 4237If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call}, 4238any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another 4239kind of breakpoint or the call completes. 4240 4241@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local 4242(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when 4243they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in 4244which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program 4245being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope, 4246and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you 4247rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One 4248way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the 4249@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints. 4250 4251@cindex watchpoints and threads 4252@cindex threads and watchpoints 4253In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the 4254watched expression from every thread. 4255 4256@quotation 4257@emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints 4258have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software 4259watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a 4260single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only 4261change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also 4262confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use 4263software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice 4264when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware 4265watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.) 4266@end quotation 4267 4268@xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}. 4269 4270@node Set Catchpoints 4271@subsection Setting Catchpoints 4272@cindex catchpoints, setting 4273@cindex exception handlers 4274@cindex event handling 4275 4276You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain 4277kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a 4278shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint. 4279 4280@table @code 4281@kindex catch 4282@item catch @var{event} 4283Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following: 4284 4285@table @code 4286@item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 4287@itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 4288@itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 4289@kindex catch throw 4290@kindex catch rethrow 4291@kindex catch catch 4292@cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions 4293The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception. 4294 4295If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the 4296regular expression will be caught. 4297 4298@vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable} 4299The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an 4300exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the 4301exception being thrown. 4302 4303There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in 4304@value{GDBN}: 4305 4306@itemize @bullet 4307@item 4308The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only 4309systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are 4310supported. 4311 4312@item 4313The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience 4314variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}. 4315If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used. 4316These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether 4317or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was 4318built. 4319 4320@item 4321The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the 4322instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set. 4323 4324@item 4325When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a 4326location in the system library which implements runtime exception 4327support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up} 4328(@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code. 4329 4330@item 4331If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns 4332control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call 4333raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that 4334returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to 4335simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal 4336that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if 4337you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are 4338disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on 4339controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}. 4340 4341@item 4342You cannot raise an exception interactively. 4343 4344@item 4345You cannot install an exception handler interactively. 4346@end itemize 4347 4348@item exception 4349@kindex catch exception 4350@cindex Ada exception catching 4351@cindex catch Ada exceptions 4352An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified 4353at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}), 4354the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised. 4355Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised. 4356 4357When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose 4358name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the 4359fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise, 4360@value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception 4361rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception 4362called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then 4363the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception 4364Pck.Constraint_Error}. 4365 4366@item exception unhandled 4367@kindex catch exception unhandled 4368An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program. 4369 4370@item assert 4371@kindex catch assert 4372A failed Ada assertion. 4373 4374@item exec 4375@kindex catch exec 4376@cindex break on fork/exec 4377A call to @code{exec}. 4378 4379@item syscall 4380@itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{} 4381@kindex catch syscall 4382@cindex break on a system call. 4383A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A 4384syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service 4385from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services. 4386@value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the 4387debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no 4388argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls 4389will be caught. 4390 4391@var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the 4392underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On 4393GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall 4394names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}. 4395 4396@c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers 4397@c can be found, e.g., on this URL: 4398@c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html 4399@c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet. 4400 4401Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for 4402each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion 4403facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the 4404available choices. 4405 4406You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's 4407number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to 4408identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its 4409name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name 4410into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly 4411may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete 4412list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags 4413behind the OS upgrades). 4414 4415You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using 4416the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For 4417instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all 4418network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network} 4419to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are 4420available in every system. You can use the command completion 4421facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the 4422syscall groups available on your environment. 4423 4424The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide 4425arguments to it: 4426 4427@smallexample 4428(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 4429Catchpoint 1 (syscall) 4430(@value{GDBP}) r 4431Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4432 4433Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \ 4434 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4435(@value{GDBP}) c 4436Continuing. 4437 4438Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \ 4439 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4440(@value{GDBP}) 4441@end smallexample 4442 4443Here is an example of catching a system call by name: 4444 4445@smallexample 4446(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot 4447Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61]) 4448(@value{GDBP}) r 4449Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4450 4451Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \ 4452 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4453(@value{GDBP}) c 4454Continuing. 4455 4456Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \ 4457 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4458(@value{GDBP}) 4459@end smallexample 4460 4461An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case 4462below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML 4463file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it: 4464 4465@smallexample 4466(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252 4467Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group') 4468(@value{GDBP}) r 4469Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4470 4471Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \ 4472 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall () 4473(@value{GDBP}) c 4474Continuing. 4475 4476Program exited normally. 4477(@value{GDBP}) 4478@end smallexample 4479 4480Here is an example of catching a syscall group: 4481 4482@smallexample 4483(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process 4484Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7] 4485'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190] 4486'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310]) 4487(@value{GDBP}) r 4488Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall 4489 4490Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 () 4491 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2 4492 4493(@value{GDBP}) c 4494Continuing. 4495@end smallexample 4496 4497However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name 4498in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints 4499a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name, 4500but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below: 4501 4502@smallexample 4503(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764 4504warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall. 4505Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764) 4506(@value{GDBP}) 4507@end smallexample 4508 4509If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option, 4510it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your 4511architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls, 4512you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to 4513notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall 4514name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this: 4515 4516@smallexample 4517(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 4518warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml" 4519warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'. 4520GDB will not be able to display syscall names. 4521Catchpoint 1 (syscall) 4522(@value{GDBP}) 4523@end smallexample 4524 4525Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system. 4526 4527Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its 4528number. In this case, you would see something like: 4529 4530@smallexample 4531(@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252 4532Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252) 4533@end smallexample 4534 4535Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names. 4536 4537@item fork 4538@kindex catch fork 4539A call to @code{fork}. 4540 4541@item vfork 4542@kindex catch vfork 4543A call to @code{vfork}. 4544 4545@item load @r{[}regexp@r{]} 4546@itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]} 4547@kindex catch load 4548@kindex catch unload 4549The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is 4550given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression 4551matches one of the affected libraries. 4552 4553@item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]} 4554@kindex catch signal 4555The delivery of a signal. 4556 4557With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not 4558used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except 4559@samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}. 4560 4561With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by 4562@value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other 4563signal names. 4564 4565Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to 4566@code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list 4567will be caught. 4568 4569One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than 4570@code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the 4571catchpoint. 4572 4573When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and 4574@code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored. 4575However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends 4576on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's 4577commands. 4578 4579@end table 4580 4581@item tcatch @var{event} 4582@kindex tcatch 4583Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is 4584automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught. 4585 4586@end table 4587 4588Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints. 4589 4590 4591@node Delete Breaks 4592@subsection Deleting Breakpoints 4593 4594@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints 4595@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints 4596It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or 4597catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program 4598to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A 4599breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten. 4600 4601With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to 4602where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can 4603delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying 4604their breakpoint numbers. 4605 4606It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN} 4607automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed 4608when you continue execution without changing the execution address. 4609 4610@table @code 4611@kindex clear 4612@item clear 4613Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the 4614selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When 4615the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a 4616breakpoint where your program just stopped. 4617 4618@item clear @var{location} 4619Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}. 4620@xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the 4621most useful ones are listed below: 4622 4623@table @code 4624@item clear @var{function} 4625@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function} 4626Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}. 4627 4628@item clear @var{linenum} 4629@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum} 4630Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified 4631@var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}. 4632@end table 4633 4634@cindex delete breakpoints 4635@kindex delete 4636@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})} 4637@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4638Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint 4639ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all 4640breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set 4641confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}. 4642@end table 4643 4644@node Disabling 4645@subsection Disabling Breakpoints 4646 4647@cindex enable/disable a breakpoint 4648Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might 4649prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if 4650it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so 4651that you can @dfn{enable} it again later. 4652 4653You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with 4654the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying 4655one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to 4656print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you 4657do not know which numbers to use. 4658 4659Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations 4660affects all of its locations. 4661 4662A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several 4663different states of enablement: 4664 4665@itemize @bullet 4666@item 4667Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set 4668with the @code{break} command starts out in this state. 4669@item 4670Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program. 4671@item 4672Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes 4673disabled. 4674@item 4675Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next 4676N times, then becomes disabled. 4677@item 4678Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but 4679immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint 4680set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state. 4681@end itemize 4682 4683You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints, 4684watchpoints, and catchpoints: 4685 4686@table @code 4687@kindex disable 4688@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})} 4689@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4690Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are 4691listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All 4692options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in 4693case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate 4694@code{disable} as @code{dis}. 4695 4696@kindex enable 4697@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4698Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They 4699become effective once again in stopping your program. 4700 4701@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{} 4702Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any 4703of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program. 4704 4705@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{} 4706Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records 4707@var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a 4708breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0, 4709@value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore 4710count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be 4711decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected. 4712 4713@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{} 4714Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN} 4715deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there. 4716Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state. 4717@end table 4718 4719@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is 4720@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled. 4721Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks, 4722,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled; 4723subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of 4724the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a 4725breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other 4726breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and 4727Stepping}.) 4728 4729@node Conditions 4730@subsection Break Conditions 4731@cindex conditional breakpoints 4732@cindex breakpoint conditions 4733 4734@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted? 4735@c in particular for a watchpoint? 4736The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a 4737specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a 4738breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your 4739programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with 4740a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it, 4741and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}. 4742 4743This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that 4744situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is, 4745when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed 4746by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition 4747@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint. 4748 4749Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them, 4750since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but 4751it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name, 4752and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting 4753one. 4754 4755Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in 4756your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions 4757that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to 4758format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable 4759unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In 4760that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your 4761program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that 4762breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break 4763conditions for the 4764purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached 4765(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}). 4766 4767Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if 4768the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally, 4769@value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression 4770(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target, 4771independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory 4772locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth. 4773 4774In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger 4775when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster 4776response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target 4777since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about 4778every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions. 4779 4780Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using 4781@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set 4782Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time 4783with the @code{condition} command. 4784 4785You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command. 4786The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword; 4787@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a 4788catchpoint. 4789 4790@table @code 4791@kindex condition 4792@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression} 4793Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint, 4794watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition, 4795breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of 4796@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use 4797@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for 4798syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have 4799referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses 4800symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN} 4801prints an error message: 4802 4803@smallexample 4804No symbol "foo" in current context. 4805@end smallexample 4806 4807@noindent 4808@value{GDBN} does 4809not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition} 4810command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like 4811@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 4812 4813@item condition @var{bnum} 4814Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes 4815an ordinary unconditional breakpoint. 4816@end table 4817 4818@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint) 4819A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the 4820breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so 4821useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore 4822count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which 4823is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and 4824therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose 4825ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements 4826the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count 4827value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times 4828your program reaches it. 4829 4830@table @code 4831@kindex ignore 4832@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count} 4833Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}. 4834The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's 4835execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN} 4836takes no action. 4837 4838To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify 4839a count of zero. 4840 4841When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a 4842breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to 4843@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and 4844Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}. 4845 4846If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the 4847condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero, 4848@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition. 4849 4850You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such 4851as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that 4852is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 4853Variables}. 4854@end table 4855 4856Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints. 4857 4858 4859@node Break Commands 4860@subsection Breakpoint Command Lists 4861 4862@cindex breakpoint commands 4863You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of 4864commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For 4865example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or 4866enable other breakpoints. 4867 4868@table @code 4869@kindex commands 4870@kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)} 4871@item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]} 4872@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{} 4873@itemx end 4874Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands 4875themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just 4876@code{end} to terminate the commands. 4877 4878To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and 4879follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands. 4880 4881With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint, 4882watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently 4883encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single 4884command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints 4885set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by 4886@code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command 4887creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous 4888Expressions}). 4889@end table 4890 4891Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is 4892disabled within a @var{command-list}. 4893 4894You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply 4895use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command 4896that resumes execution. 4897 4898Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes 4899execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution 4900(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter 4901another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to 4902ambiguities about which list to execute. 4903 4904@kindex silent 4905If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the 4906usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may 4907be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and 4908then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you 4909see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is 4910meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list. 4911 4912The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to 4913print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent 4914breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}. 4915 4916For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the 4917value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive. 4918 4919@smallexample 4920break foo if x>0 4921commands 4922silent 4923printf "x is %d\n",x 4924cont 4925end 4926@end smallexample 4927 4928One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so 4929you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line 4930of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something 4931erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values 4932to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command 4933so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent} 4934command so that no output is produced. Here is an example: 4935 4936@smallexample 4937break 403 4938commands 4939silent 4940set x = y + 4 4941cont 4942end 4943@end smallexample 4944 4945@node Dynamic Printf 4946@subsection Dynamic Printf 4947 4948@cindex dynamic printf 4949@cindex dprintf 4950The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with 4951formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of 4952inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without 4953having to recompile it. 4954 4955In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However, 4956you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling. 4957For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your 4958program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the 4959characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in 4960redirects to files and so forth. 4961 4962If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also 4963ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to 4964ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along 4965with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that 4966the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote 4967target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do 4968everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}. 4969 4970@table @code 4971@kindex dprintf 4972@item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}] 4973Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or 4974more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}. 4975To print several values, separate them with commas. 4976 4977@item set dprintf-style @var{style} 4978Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different 4979styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing 4980dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the 4981print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with 4982explicitly-supplied command lists.) 4983 4984@item gdb 4985@kindex dprintf-style gdb 4986Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command. 4987 4988@item call 4989@kindex dprintf-style call 4990Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally 4991@code{printf}). 4992 4993@item agent 4994@kindex dprintf-style agent 4995Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle 4996the output itself. This style is only available for agents that 4997support running commands on the target. 4998 4999@item set dprintf-function @var{function} 5000Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By 5001default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression. 5002that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call} 5003command. 5004 5005@item set dprintf-channel @var{channel} 5006Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value, 5007@value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as 5008a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of 5009@code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format 5010string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}. 5011 5012As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile 5013that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog}, 5014you could do the following: 5015 5016@example 5017(gdb) set dprintf-style call 5018(gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf 5019(gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog 5020(gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob 5021Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25. 5022(gdb) info break 50231 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25 5024 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob) 5025 continue 5026(gdb) 5027@end example 5028 5029Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands 5030as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of 5031the variable settings. 5032 5033@item set disconnected-dprintf on 5034@itemx set disconnected-dprintf off 5035@kindex set disconnected-dprintf 5036Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if 5037@value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies 5038if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}. 5039 5040@item show disconnected-dprintf off 5041@kindex show disconnected-dprintf 5042Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}. 5043 5044@end table 5045 5046@value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel, 5047relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts 5048in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel 5049may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then 5050all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of 5051those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error. 5052 5053@node Save Breakpoints 5054@subsection How to save breakpoints to a file 5055 5056To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save 5057breakpoints}} command. 5058 5059@table @code 5060@kindex save breakpoints 5061@cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions 5062@item save breakpoints [@var{filename}] 5063This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with 5064their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}} 5065suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all 5066types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints, 5067tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the 5068@code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints 5069with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated 5070because it may not be possible to access the context where the 5071watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions 5072are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the 5073breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program, 5074and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or 5075that can no longer be recreated. 5076@end table 5077 5078@node Static Probe Points 5079@subsection Static Probe Points 5080 5081@cindex static probe point, SystemTap 5082@cindex static probe point, DTrace 5083@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands 5084for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny 5085runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations. 5086 5087Currently, the following types of probes are supported on 5088ELF-compatible systems: 5089 5090@itemize @bullet 5091 5092@item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/}) 5093@acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See 5094@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps} 5095for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT} 5096probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable 5097from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See 5098@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation} 5099for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}. 5100 5101@item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace}) 5102@acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and 5103C@t{++} languages. 5104@end itemize 5105 5106@cindex semaphores on static probe points 5107Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable; 5108for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe 5109using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore, 5110@value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a 5111breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a 5112breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g., 5113@code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set 5114the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores. 5115 5116You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info 5117probes}, with optional arguments: 5118 5119@table @code 5120@kindex info probes 5121@item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]} 5122If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing 5123@code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace} 5124probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types. 5125 5126If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider 5127names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all 5128probes from all providers are listed. 5129 5130If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names 5131when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not 5132considered when deciding whether to display them. 5133 5134If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which 5135object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not 5136given, all object files are considered. 5137 5138@item info probes all 5139List the available static probes, from all types. 5140@end table 5141 5142@cindex enabling and disabling probes 5143Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of 5144enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being 5145handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or 5146disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled. 5147 5148You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following 5149commands, with optional arguments: 5150 5151@table @code 5152@kindex enable probes 5153@item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]} 5154If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against 5155provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, 5156all probes from all providers are enabled. 5157 5158If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe 5159names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names 5160are not considered when deciding whether to enable them. 5161 5162If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which 5163object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not 5164given, all object files are considered. 5165 5166@kindex disable probes 5167@item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]} 5168See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the 5169optional arguments accepted by this command. 5170@end table 5171 5172@vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable} 5173A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the 5174point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is 5175at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the 5176convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) 5177@code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap} 5178probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size; 5179types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved 5180provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise 5181the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The 5182convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments 5183at the current probe point. 5184 5185These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at 5186any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give 5187an error message. 5188 5189 5190@c @ifclear BARETARGET 5191@node Error in Breakpoints 5192@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints'' 5193 5194If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and 5195watchpoints, you will see this error message: 5196 5197@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant 5198@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999). 5199@smallexample 5200Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints. 5201You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints. 5202@end smallexample 5203 5204@noindent 5205This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since 5206only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and 5207watchpoints it needs to insert. 5208 5209When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the 5210hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue. 5211 5212@node Breakpoint-related Warnings 5213@subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...'' 5214@cindex breakpoint address adjusted 5215 5216Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at 5217which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained, 5218@value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply 5219with the constraints dictated by the architecture. 5220 5221One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is 5222a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be 5223bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture 5224constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a 5225bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN} 5226honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the 5227first in the bundle. 5228 5229It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain 5230instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that 5231a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to 5232another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s 5233breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is 5234printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint 5235is hit. 5236 5237A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint 5238that's been subject to address adjustment: 5239 5240@smallexample 5241warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410. 5242@end smallexample 5243 5244Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s 5245internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should 5246verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the 5247desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and 5248other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior. 5249E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later 5250instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some 5251cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often. 5252 5253@value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these 5254adjusted breakpoints: 5255 5256@smallexample 5257warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414 5258to 0x00010410. 5259@end smallexample 5260 5261When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial 5262action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more 5263frequently than expected. 5264 5265@node Continuing and Stepping 5266@section Continuing and Stepping 5267 5268@cindex stepping 5269@cindex continuing 5270@cindex resuming execution 5271@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program 5272completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just 5273one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one 5274line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what 5275particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping, 5276your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If 5277it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use 5278@samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}), 5279or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal 5280handlers}).) 5281 5282@table @code 5283@kindex continue 5284@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})} 5285@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)} 5286@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5287@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5288@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 5289Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped; 5290any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument 5291@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to 5292ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of 5293@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 5294 5295The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program 5296stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to 5297@code{continue} is ignored. 5298 5299The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the 5300debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided 5301purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as 5302@code{continue}. 5303@end table 5304 5305To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return} 5306(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the 5307calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a 5308Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program. 5309 5310A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint 5311(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the 5312beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem 5313is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint, 5314and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are 5315interesting, until you see the problem happen. 5316 5317@table @code 5318@kindex step 5319@kindex s @r{(@code{step})} 5320@item step 5321Continue running your program until control reaches a different source 5322line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is 5323abbreviated @code{s}. 5324 5325@quotation 5326@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line 5327@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but 5328@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that 5329@c distinction here. 5330@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is 5331within a function that was compiled without debugging information, 5332execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have 5333debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which 5334is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions 5335without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described 5336below. 5337@end quotation 5338 5339The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source 5340line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in 5341@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues 5342to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within 5343the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions 5344called within the line. 5345 5346Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line 5347number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the 5348@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl} 5349on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there 5350was any debugging information about the routine. 5351 5352@item step @var{count} 5353Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a 5354breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before 5355@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away. 5356 5357@kindex next 5358@kindex n @r{(@code{next})} 5359@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 5360Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame. 5361This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within 5362the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when 5363control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level 5364that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command 5365is abbreviated @code{n}. 5366 5367An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}. 5368 5369 5370@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with 5371@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria 5372@c 5373@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like 5374@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the 5375@c function are executed without stopping. 5376 5377The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a 5378source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in 5379@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. 5380 5381@kindex set step-mode 5382@item set step-mode 5383@cindex functions without line info, and stepping 5384@cindex stepping into functions with no line info 5385@itemx set step-mode on 5386The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to 5387stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line 5388information rather than stepping over it. 5389 5390This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the 5391machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not 5392want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function. 5393 5394@item set step-mode off 5395Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no 5396debug information. This is the default. 5397 5398@item show step-mode 5399Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without 5400source line debug information. 5401 5402@kindex finish 5403@kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})} 5404@item finish 5405Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame 5406returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be 5407abbreviated as @code{fin}. 5408 5409Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning, 5410,Returning from a Function}). 5411 5412@kindex until 5413@kindex u @r{(@code{until})} 5414@cindex run until specified location 5415@item until 5416@itemx u 5417Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the 5418current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single 5419stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next} 5420command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it 5421automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater 5422than the address of the jump. 5423 5424This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping 5425though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it 5426exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop 5427simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step 5428through the next iteration. 5429 5430@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current 5431stack frame. 5432 5433@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order 5434of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For 5435example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f} 5436(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line 5437@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}: 5438 5439@smallexample 5440(@value{GDBP}) f 5441#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206 5442206 expand_input(); 5443(@value{GDBP}) until 5444195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{ 5445@end smallexample 5446 5447This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had 5448generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the 5449start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is 5450written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared 5451to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this 5452expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier 5453statement---not in terms of the actual machine code. 5454 5455@code{until} with no argument works by means of single 5456instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an 5457argument. 5458 5459@item until @var{location} 5460@itemx u @var{location} 5461Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is 5462reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of 5463the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}. 5464This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and 5465hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified 5466location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This 5467implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function 5468invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is 5469line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to 5470line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner 5471invocations have returned. 5472 5473@smallexample 547494 int factorial (int value) 547595 @{ 547696 if (value > 1) @{ 547797 value *= factorial (value - 1); 547898 @} 547999 return (value); 5480100 @} 5481@end smallexample 5482 5483 5484@kindex advance @var{location} 5485@item advance @var{location} 5486Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is 5487required, which should be of one of the forms described in 5488@ref{Specify Location}. 5489Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack 5490frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will 5491not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't 5492have to be in the same frame as the current one. 5493 5494 5495@kindex stepi 5496@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})} 5497@item stepi 5498@itemx stepi @var{arg} 5499@itemx si 5500Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger. 5501 5502It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine 5503instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next 5504instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto 5505Display,, Automatic Display}. 5506 5507An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}. 5508 5509@need 750 5510@kindex nexti 5511@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})} 5512@item nexti 5513@itemx nexti @var{arg} 5514@itemx ni 5515Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call, 5516proceed until the function returns. 5517 5518An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}. 5519 5520@end table 5521 5522@anchor{range stepping} 5523@cindex range stepping 5524@cindex target-assisted range stepping 5525By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of 5526target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you 5527use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN} 5528tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction 5529addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up 5530line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should 5531be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's 5532possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for 5533remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line 5534stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is 5535enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping 5536if necessary: 5537 5538@table @code 5539@kindex set range-stepping 5540@kindex show range-stepping 5541@item set range-stepping 5542@itemx show range-stepping 5543Control whether range stepping is enabled. 5544 5545If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the 5546target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing 5547multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues 5548single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The 5549default is @code{on}. 5550 5551@end table 5552 5553@node Skipping Over Functions and Files 5554@section Skipping Over Functions and Files 5555@cindex skipping over functions and files 5556 5557The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are 5558uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to 5559skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in 5560a particular file when stepping. 5561 5562For example, consider the following C function: 5563 5564@smallexample 5565101 int func() 5566102 @{ 5567103 foo(boring()); 5568104 bar(boring()); 5569105 @} 5570@end smallexample 5571 5572@noindent 5573Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you 5574are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step} 5575at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll 5576step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}! 5577 5578One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish} 5579command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring} 5580is called from many places. 5581 5582A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs 5583@value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute 5584@code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into 5585@code{foo}. 5586 5587Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec 5588(@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's 5589name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name. 5590 5591On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is 5592``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex} 5593on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular 5594expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of 5595the underlying system. 5596See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a 5597description of @code{glob}-style patterns. 5598 5599@table @code 5600@kindex skip 5601@item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]} 5602The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options 5603that specify what to skip. 5604The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following: 5605 5606@table @code 5607@item -file @var{file} 5608@itemx -fi @var{file} 5609Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping. 5610 5611@item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern} 5612@itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern} 5613@cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns 5614Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped 5615over when stepping. 5616 5617@smallexample 5618(gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c 5619@end smallexample 5620 5621@item -function @var{linespec} 5622@itemx -fu @var{linespec} 5623Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line 5624named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping. 5625@xref{Specify Location}. 5626 5627@item -rfunction @var{regexp} 5628@itemx -rfu @var{regexp} 5629@cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions 5630Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping. 5631 5632This form is useful for complex function names. 5633For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string} 5634constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to 5635write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what 5636the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a 5637regular expression makes this easier. 5638 5639@smallexample 5640(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\( 5641@end smallexample 5642 5643If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor 5644in the @code{std} namespace you can do: 5645 5646@smallexample 5647(gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\( 5648@end smallexample 5649@end table 5650 5651If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging 5652will be skipped. 5653 5654@kindex skip function 5655@item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]} 5656After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the 5657function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when 5658stepping. @xref{Specify Location}. 5659 5660If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging 5661will be skipped. 5662 5663(If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use 5664@kbd{skip function file}.) 5665 5666@kindex skip file 5667@item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 5668After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename} 5669will be skipped over when stepping. 5670 5671@smallexample 5672(gdb) skip file boring.c 5673File boring.c will be skipped when stepping. 5674@end smallexample 5675 5676If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file 5677you're currently debugging will be skipped. 5678@end table 5679 5680Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints. 5681These are the commands for managing your list of skips: 5682 5683@table @code 5684@kindex info skip 5685@item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5686Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, 5687print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping. 5688@code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip: 5689 5690@table @emph 5691@item Identifier 5692A number identifying this skip. 5693@item Enabled or Disabled 5694Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. 5695Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}. 5696@item Glob 5697If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}. 5698Otherwise it is @samp{n}. 5699@item File 5700The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped. 5701If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}. 5702@item RE 5703If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}. 5704Otherwise it is @samp{n}. 5705@item Function 5706The name or regular expression of the function to skip. 5707If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}. 5708@end table 5709 5710@kindex skip delete 5711@item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5712Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all 5713skips. 5714 5715@kindex skip enable 5716@item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5717Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all 5718skips. 5719 5720@kindex skip disable 5721@item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]} 5722Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all 5723skips. 5724 5725@end table 5726 5727@node Signals 5728@section Signals 5729@cindex signals 5730 5731A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The 5732operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each 5733kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the 5734signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}); 5735@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in 5736memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when 5737the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has 5738requested an alarm). 5739 5740@cindex fatal signals 5741Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the 5742functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate 5743errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the 5744program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal. 5745@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally 5746fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program. 5747 5748@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your 5749program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of 5750signal. 5751 5752@cindex handling signals 5753Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like 5754@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program 5755(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning) 5756but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens. 5757You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command. 5758 5759@table @code 5760@kindex info signals 5761@kindex info handle 5762@item info signals 5763@itemx info handle 5764Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to 5765handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all 5766the defined types of signals. 5767 5768@item info signals @var{sig} 5769Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number. 5770 5771@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}. 5772 5773@item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]} 5774Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints}, 5775for details about this command. 5776 5777@kindex handle 5778@item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]} 5779Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} 5780can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the 5781@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form 5782@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the 5783known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below, 5784say what change to make. 5785@end table 5786 5787@c @group 5788The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated. 5789Their full names are: 5790 5791@table @code 5792@item nostop 5793@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may 5794still print a message telling you that the signal has come in. 5795 5796@item stop 5797@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies 5798the @code{print} keyword as well. 5799 5800@item print 5801@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens. 5802 5803@item noprint 5804@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This 5805implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well. 5806 5807@item pass 5808@itemx noignore 5809@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program 5810can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal 5811and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms. 5812 5813@item nopass 5814@itemx ignore 5815@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal. 5816@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms. 5817@end table 5818@c @end group 5819 5820When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the 5821program until you 5822continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in 5823effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words, 5824after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle} 5825command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your 5826program sees that signal when you continue. 5827 5828The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for 5829non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and 5830@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the 5831erroneous signals. 5832 5833You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from 5834seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see, 5835or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped 5836due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct 5837values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more 5838execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as 5839a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this, 5840you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your 5841Program a Signal}. 5842 5843@cindex stepping and signal handlers 5844@anchor{stepping and signal handlers} 5845 5846@value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal 5847that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while 5848a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is 5849in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes 5850stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other 5851words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents 5852signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle 5853nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that 5854the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another 5855signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event 5856that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also 5857note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a 5858signal if @code{handle print} is set. 5859 5860@anchor{stepping into signal handlers} 5861 5862If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a 5863handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step} 5864or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will 5865step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that). 5866 5867Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal 5868to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread 5869resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a 5870stepping command will step into the signal handler. 5871 5872Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction 5873of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler: 5874 5875@smallexample 5876(@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1 5877Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description 5878SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1 5879(@value{GDBP}) c 5880Continuing. 5881 5882Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1. 5883main () sigusr1.c:28 588428 p = 0; 5885(@value{GDBP}) si 5886sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9 58879 @{ 5888@end smallexample 5889 5890The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the 5891program to receive the signal first: 5892 5893@smallexample 5894(@value{GDBP}) n 589528 p = 0; 5896(@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1 5897(@value{GDBP}) si 5898sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9 58999 @{ 5900(@value{GDBP}) 5901@end smallexample 5902 5903@cindex extra signal information 5904@anchor{extra signal information} 5905 5906On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information 5907associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually 5908delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported 5909by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data 5910that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the 5911receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is 5912target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype 5913$_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the 5914standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h} 5915system header. 5916 5917Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray 5918referenced address that raised a segmentation fault. 5919 5920@smallexample 5921@group 5922(@value{GDBP}) continue 5923Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault. 59240x0000000000400766 in main () 592569 *(int *)p = 0; 5926(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo 5927type = struct @{ 5928 int si_signo; 5929 int si_errno; 5930 int si_code; 5931 union @{ 5932 int _pad[28]; 5933 struct @{...@} _kill; 5934 struct @{...@} _timer; 5935 struct @{...@} _rt; 5936 struct @{...@} _sigchld; 5937 struct @{...@} _sigfault; 5938 struct @{...@} _sigpoll; 5939 @} _sifields; 5940@} 5941(@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault 5942type = struct @{ 5943 void *si_addr; 5944@} 5945(@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr 5946$1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000 5947@end group 5948@end smallexample 5949 5950Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable. 5951 5952@cindex Intel MPX boundary violations 5953@cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX 5954On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary 5955violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range. 5956In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information, 5957depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal. 5958With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation 5959kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the 5960bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional 5961information is displayed. 5962 5963The usual output of a segfault is: 5964@smallexample 5965Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault 59660x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68 596768 value = *(p + len); 5968@end smallexample 5969 5970While a bound violation is presented as: 5971@smallexample 5972Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault 5973Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3 5974Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3] 59750x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68 597668 value = *(p + len); 5977@end smallexample 5978 5979@node Thread Stops 5980@section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs 5981 5982@cindex stopped threads 5983@cindex threads, stopped 5984 5985@cindex continuing threads 5986@cindex threads, continuing 5987 5988@value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads 5989(@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There 5990are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the 5991debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode}, 5992when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint 5993or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by 5994@value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports 5995@dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while 5996you examine the stopped thread in the debugger. 5997 5998@menu 5999* All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control 6000* Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute 6001* Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously 6002* Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints 6003* Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls 6004* Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior 6005@end menu 6006 6007@node All-Stop Mode 6008@subsection All-Stop Mode 6009 6010@cindex all-stop mode 6011 6012In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason, 6013@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This 6014allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including 6015switching between threads, without worrying that things may change 6016underfoot. 6017 6018Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start 6019executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands 6020like @code{step} or @code{next}. 6021 6022In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep. 6023Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating 6024system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may 6025execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a 6026single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a 6027statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program 6028stops. 6029 6030You might even find your program stopped in another thread after 6031continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other 6032thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the 6033first thread completes whatever you requested. 6034 6035@cindex automatic thread selection 6036@cindex switching threads automatically 6037@cindex threads, automatic switching 6038Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a 6039signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or 6040signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a 6041message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the 6042thread. 6043 6044On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by 6045locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run. 6046 6047@table @code 6048@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode} 6049@cindex scheduler locking mode 6050@cindex lock scheduler 6051Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution, 6052record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no 6053locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only 6054the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The 6055@code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other 6056threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so 6057that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other 6058threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are 6059completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue}, 6060@samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a 6061breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the 6062current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The 6063@code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like 6064@code{on} in replay mode. 6065 6066@item show scheduler-locking 6067Display the current scheduler locking mode. 6068@end table 6069 6070@cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously 6071By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as 6072@code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only 6073threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN} 6074is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the 6075@code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current 6076inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that 6077forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance, 6078it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other 6079situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state 6080of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want 6081to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case, 6082you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the 6083inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command. 6084 6085@table @code 6086@kindex set schedule-multiple 6087@item set schedule-multiple 6088Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed 6089when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of 6090all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads 6091of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The 6092@code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on}, 6093or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}. 6094 6095@item show schedule-multiple 6096Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of 6097multiple processes. 6098@end table 6099 6100@node Non-Stop Mode 6101@subsection Non-Stop Mode 6102 6103@cindex non-stop mode 6104 6105@c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded 6106@c with more details. 6107 6108For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional 6109mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in 6110the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This 6111minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs 6112where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to 6113respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode. 6114 6115In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event, 6116@emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other 6117threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally, 6118execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default 6119only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as 6120in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in 6121ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping 6122one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping 6123one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads 6124independently and simultaneously. 6125 6126To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run 6127or attach to your program: 6128 6129@smallexample 6130# If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop. 6131set pagination off 6132 6133# Finally, turn it on! 6134set non-stop on 6135@end smallexample 6136 6137You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting: 6138 6139@table @code 6140@kindex set non-stop 6141@item set non-stop on 6142Enable selection of non-stop mode. 6143@item set non-stop off 6144Disable selection of non-stop mode. 6145@kindex show non-stop 6146@item show non-stop 6147Show the current non-stop enablement setting. 6148@end table 6149 6150Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled, 6151not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode. 6152In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when 6153@value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally 6154not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore, 6155since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled 6156non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by 6157default. 6158 6159In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread 6160by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread. 6161To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}. 6162 6163You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands 6164(@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background 6165while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}. 6166The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are 6167always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode. 6168 6169Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when 6170running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution. 6171In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process; 6172but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread. 6173To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}. 6174 6175Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option. 6176 6177In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make 6178that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the 6179thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s 6180command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly 6181changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the 6182previously current thread. 6183 6184@node Background Execution 6185@subsection Background Execution 6186 6187@cindex foreground execution 6188@cindex background execution 6189@cindex asynchronous execution 6190@cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous 6191 6192@value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal 6193foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background 6194(asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for 6195the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for 6196another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives 6197a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs. 6198 6199If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error 6200message if you attempt to use the background execution commands. 6201 6202To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example, 6203the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or 6204just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution 6205are: 6206 6207@table @code 6208@kindex run& 6209@item run 6210@xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}. 6211 6212@item attach 6213@kindex attach& 6214@xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}. 6215 6216@item step 6217@kindex step& 6218@xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}. 6219 6220@item stepi 6221@kindex stepi& 6222@xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}. 6223 6224@item next 6225@kindex next& 6226@xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}. 6227 6228@item nexti 6229@kindex nexti& 6230@xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}. 6231 6232@item continue 6233@kindex continue& 6234@xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}. 6235 6236@item finish 6237@kindex finish& 6238@xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}. 6239 6240@item until 6241@kindex until& 6242@xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}. 6243 6244@end table 6245 6246Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop 6247mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. 6248However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with 6249the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the 6250previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop 6251mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}. 6252 6253You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by 6254using the @code{interrupt} command. 6255 6256@table @code 6257@kindex interrupt 6258@item interrupt 6259@itemx interrupt -a 6260 6261Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode, 6262@code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops 6263only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode, 6264use @code{interrupt -a}. 6265@end table 6266 6267@node Thread-Specific Breakpoints 6268@subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints 6269 6270When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging 6271Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set 6272breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread. 6273 6274@table @code 6275@cindex breakpoints and threads 6276@cindex thread breakpoints 6277@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id} 6278@item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} 6279@itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{} 6280@var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of 6281writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to 6282specify some source line. 6283 6284Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command 6285to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a 6286particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier 6287is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown 6288in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display. 6289 6290If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a 6291breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your 6292program. 6293 6294You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as 6295well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or 6296after the breakpoint condition, like this: 6297 6298@smallexample 6299(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim 6300@end smallexample 6301 6302@end table 6303 6304Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when 6305@value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the 6306thread list. For example: 6307 6308@smallexample 6309(@value{GDBP}) c 6310Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list. 6311@end smallexample 6312 6313There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular 6314thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the 6315@code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running 6316Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection 6317(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets, 6318@value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user 6319explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads} 6320command. 6321 6322@node Interrupted System Calls 6323@subsection Interrupted System Calls 6324 6325@cindex thread breakpoints and system calls 6326@cindex system calls and thread breakpoints 6327@cindex premature return from system calls 6328There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug 6329multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a 6330breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a 6331system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a 6332consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals 6333that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that 6334stop execution. 6335 6336To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of 6337each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming 6338style anyways. 6339 6340For example, do not write code like this: 6341 6342@smallexample 6343 sleep (10); 6344@end smallexample 6345 6346The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops 6347at a breakpoint or for some other reason. 6348 6349Instead, write this: 6350 6351@smallexample 6352 int unslept = 10; 6353 while (unslept > 0) 6354 unslept = sleep (unslept); 6355@end smallexample 6356 6357A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still 6358conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your 6359multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without 6360@value{GDBN}. 6361 6362Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to 6363monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction. 6364When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return 6365prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop. 6366 6367@node Observer Mode 6368@subsection Observer Mode 6369 6370If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior 6371without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set 6372variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state, 6373whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate 6374at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands. 6375 6376When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to 6377be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable 6378@code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop 6379mode. 6380 6381Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical 6382combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled 6383@code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory}, 6384then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code 6385stream will still not be able to be placed. 6386 6387@table @code 6388 6389@kindex observer 6390@item set observer on 6391@itemx set observer off 6392When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables 6393below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables 6394non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to 6395normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode. 6396 6397@item show observer 6398Show whether observer mode is on or off. 6399 6400@kindex may-write-registers 6401@item set may-write-registers on 6402@itemx set may-write-registers off 6403This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of 6404registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the 6405@code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}. 6406 6407@item show may-write-registers 6408Show the current permission to write registers. 6409 6410@kindex may-write-memory 6411@item set may-write-memory on 6412@itemx set may-write-memory off 6413This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents 6414of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It 6415defaults to @code{on}. 6416 6417@item show may-write-memory 6418Show the current permission to write memory. 6419 6420@kindex may-insert-breakpoints 6421@item set may-insert-breakpoints on 6422@itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off 6423This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints. 6424This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined 6425by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6426 6427@item show may-insert-breakpoints 6428Show the current permission to insert breakpoints. 6429 6430@kindex may-insert-tracepoints 6431@item set may-insert-tracepoints on 6432@itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off 6433This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular) 6434tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only 6435non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of 6436@code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6437 6438@item show may-insert-tracepoints 6439Show the current permission to insert tracepoints. 6440 6441@kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints 6442@item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on 6443@itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off 6444This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast 6445tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only 6446fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the 6447control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6448 6449@item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints 6450Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints. 6451 6452@kindex may-interrupt 6453@item set may-interrupt on 6454@itemx set may-interrupt off 6455This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop 6456program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the 6457@code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will 6458@kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}. 6459 6460@item show may-interrupt 6461Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program. 6462 6463@end table 6464 6465@node Reverse Execution 6466@chapter Running programs backward 6467@cindex reverse execution 6468@cindex running programs backward 6469 6470When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that 6471you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened. 6472If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to 6473``rewind'' the program by running it backward. 6474 6475A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able 6476to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the 6477program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should 6478revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great 6479deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not 6480all target environments can support reverse execution. 6481 6482When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that 6483have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse 6484order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous 6485thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'', 6486the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that 6487instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing 6488a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code 6489should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their 6490prior values@footnote{ 6491Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance, 6492memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some 6493targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not. 6494 6495The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target 6496requires only that the target do something reasonable when 6497@value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the 6498results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to 6499@value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN} 6500assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a 6501consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given. 6502}. 6503 6504If you are debugging in a target environment that supports 6505reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands. 6506 6507@table @code 6508@kindex reverse-continue 6509@kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})} 6510@item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 6511@itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]} 6512Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing 6513in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous 6514exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of 6515asynchronous signals depends on the target environment. 6516 6517@kindex reverse-step 6518@kindex rs @r{(@code{step})} 6519@item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6520Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a 6521different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}. 6522 6523Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop 6524at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously 6525executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to 6526debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into 6527the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last} 6528statement in the called function (typically a return statement). 6529 6530Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are 6531called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping. 6532 6533@kindex reverse-stepi 6534@kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})} 6535@item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6536Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction 6537to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program 6538counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance, 6539if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you 6540back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself. 6541 6542@kindex reverse-next 6543@kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})} 6544@item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6545Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in 6546the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function 6547calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from 6548the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back 6549to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called, 6550just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last 6551line of a function back to its return to its caller 6552@footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}. 6553 6554@kindex reverse-nexti 6555@kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})} 6556@item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 6557Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction 6558in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically. 6559That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from 6560another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute 6561in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack 6562frame) is reached. 6563 6564@kindex reverse-finish 6565@item reverse-finish 6566Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the 6567current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point 6568where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current 6569function invocation, you end up at the beginning. 6570 6571@kindex set exec-direction 6572@item set exec-direction 6573Set the direction of target execution. 6574@item set exec-direction reverse 6575@cindex execute forward or backward in time 6576@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the 6577exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include 6578@code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return} 6579command cannot be used in reverse mode. 6580@item set exec-direction forward 6581@value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion. 6582This is the default. 6583@end table 6584 6585 6586@node Process Record and Replay 6587@chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It 6588@cindex process record and replay 6589@cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it 6590 6591On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record 6592and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and 6593replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands. 6594 6595@cindex replay mode 6596When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record 6597for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay 6598mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code 6599instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during 6600code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not 6601really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the 6602program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still 6603changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the 6604execution log. 6605 6606@cindex record mode 6607If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log, 6608@value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the 6609inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log 6610for future replay. 6611 6612The process record and replay target supports reverse execution 6613(@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the 6614inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in 6615this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution 6616log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't 6617support it directly can only be done in the replay mode. 6618 6619When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in 6620replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the 6621previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the 6622platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not. 6623 6624For architecture environments that support process record and replay, 6625@value{GDBN} provides the following commands: 6626 6627@table @code 6628@kindex target record 6629@kindex target record-full 6630@kindex target record-btrace 6631@kindex record 6632@kindex record full 6633@kindex record btrace 6634@kindex record btrace bts 6635@kindex record btrace pt 6636@kindex record bts 6637@kindex record pt 6638@kindex rec 6639@kindex rec full 6640@kindex rec btrace 6641@kindex rec btrace bts 6642@kindex rec btrace pt 6643@kindex rec bts 6644@kindex rec pt 6645@item record @var{method} 6646This command starts the process record and replay target. The 6647recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter 6648the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following 6649recording methods are available: 6650 6651@table @code 6652@item full 6653Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and 6654replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse 6655execution. 6656 6657@item btrace @var{format} 6658Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record 6659data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will 6660be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse 6661execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse 6662execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect. 6663Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may 6664be stopped using @code{record stop}. 6665 6666The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter 6667the command chooses the recording format. The following recording 6668formats are available: 6669 6670@table @code 6671@item bts 6672@cindex branch trace store 6673Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In 6674this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed 6675branch in the btrace ring buffer. 6676 6677@item pt 6678@cindex Intel Processor Trace 6679Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this 6680format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form 6681that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}. 6682 6683The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed 6684trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big 6685number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}. 6686 6687Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more 6688expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the 6689increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the 6690buffer-size with care. 6691@end table 6692 6693Not all recording formats may be available on all processors. 6694@end table 6695 6696The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is 6697already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with 6698the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording 6699with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command. 6700 6701@cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay 6702Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping}) 6703will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target 6704is started. That's because the process record and replay target 6705doesn't support displaced stepping. 6706 6707@cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay 6708@cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay 6709If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in 6710the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not 6711all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method 6712does not support these two modes. 6713 6714@kindex record stop 6715@kindex rec s 6716@item record stop 6717Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and 6718replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the 6719inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state. 6720 6721When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at 6722the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the 6723next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if 6724you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process 6725will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened. 6726 6727On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped 6728while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log, 6729but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live'' 6730at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the 6731usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state. 6732 6733When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it, 6734process record and replay target will automatically stop itself. 6735 6736@kindex record goto 6737@item record goto 6738Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several 6739ways to specify the location to go to: 6740 6741@table @code 6742@item record goto begin 6743@itemx record goto start 6744Go to the beginning of the execution log. 6745 6746@item record goto end 6747Go to the end of the execution log. 6748 6749@item record goto @var{n} 6750Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log. 6751@end table 6752 6753@kindex record save 6754@item record save @var{filename} 6755Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}. 6756Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where 6757@var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior. 6758 6759This command may not be available for all recording methods. 6760 6761@kindex record restore 6762@item record restore @var{filename} 6763Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}. 6764File must have been created with @code{record save}. 6765 6766@kindex set record full 6767@item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit} 6768@itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited 6769Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full} 6770recording method. Default value is 200000. 6771 6772If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start 6773deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record 6774instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded 6775instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded 6776instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit. 6777(Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN} 6778lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of 6779the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.) 6780 6781If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never 6782delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of 6783recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory. 6784 6785@kindex show record full 6786@item show record full insn-number-max 6787Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full} 6788recording method. 6789 6790@item set record full stop-at-limit 6791Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the 6792number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the 6793default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the 6794first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or 6795continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide 6796to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the 6797oldest one to be deleted. 6798 6799If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the 6800oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking. 6801 6802@item show record full stop-at-limit 6803Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}. 6804 6805@item set record full memory-query 6806Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory 6807changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method. 6808If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that 6809case. 6810 6811If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically 6812ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when 6813@value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this 6814instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay 6815results. 6816 6817@item show record full memory-query 6818Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}. 6819 6820@kindex set record btrace 6821The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a 6822convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off 6823the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the 6824read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to 6825disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables. 6826In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful. 6827You can use the following command for that: 6828 6829@item set record btrace replay-memory-access 6830Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when 6831accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default), 6832@value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory. 6833If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only 6834and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds 6835to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay 6836position. 6837 6838@kindex show record btrace 6839@item show record btrace replay-memory-access 6840Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}. 6841 6842@kindex set record btrace bts 6843@item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size} 6844@itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited 6845Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS} 6846format. Default is 64KB. 6847 6848If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to 6849allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread 6850that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format. 6851The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested 6852@var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual 6853buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and 6854the @acronym{BTS} format. 6855 6856If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to 6857allocate a buffer of 4MB. 6858 6859Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will 6860also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used. 6861 6862@item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size} 6863Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch 6864tracing in @acronym{BTS} format. 6865 6866@kindex set record btrace pt 6867@item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size} 6868@itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited 6869Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel 6870Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB. 6871 6872If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to 6873allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread 6874that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace 6875format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the 6876requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the 6877actual buffer size for each thread. 6878 6879If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to 6880allocate a buffer of 4MB. 6881 6882Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will 6883also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used. 6884 6885@item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size} 6886Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch 6887tracing in Intel Processor Trace format. 6888 6889@kindex info record 6890@item info record 6891Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording 6892method: 6893 6894@table @code 6895@item full 6896For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process 6897record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including: 6898 6899@itemize @bullet 6900@item 6901Whether in record mode or replay mode. 6902@item 6903Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions). 6904@item 6905Highest recorded instruction number. 6906@item 6907Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode). 6908@item 6909Number of instructions contained in the execution log. 6910@item 6911Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log. 6912@end itemize 6913 6914@item btrace 6915For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows: 6916 6917@itemize @bullet 6918@item 6919Recording format. 6920@item 6921Number of instructions that have been recorded. 6922@item 6923Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded 6924instructions. 6925@item 6926Whether in record mode or replay mode. 6927@end itemize 6928 6929For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows: 6930@itemize @bullet 6931@item 6932Size of the perf ring buffer. 6933@end itemize 6934 6935For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows: 6936@itemize @bullet 6937@item 6938Size of the perf ring buffer. 6939@end itemize 6940@end table 6941 6942@kindex record delete 6943@kindex rec del 6944@item record delete 6945When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the 6946subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting 6947from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously 6948recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''. 6949 6950@kindex record instruction-history 6951@kindex rec instruction-history 6952@item record instruction-history 6953Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By 6954default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using 6955the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions 6956are printed in execution order. 6957 6958It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the 6959@code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex 6960as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier. 6961 6962The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the 6963current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple 6964times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed 6965every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the 6966@code{/p} modifier. 6967 6968To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains 6969instructions from more than one function, the function name may be 6970omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier. 6971 6972Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This 6973feature is not available for all recording formats. 6974 6975There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to 6976disassemble: 6977 6978@table @code 6979@item record instruction-history @var{insn} 6980Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number 6981@var{insn}. 6982 6983@item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n} 6984Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number 6985@var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles 6986@var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If 6987@var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n} 6988instructions before instruction number @var{insn}. 6989 6990@item record instruction-history 6991Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly. 6992 6993@item record instruction-history - 6994Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly. 6995 6996@item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end} 6997Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number 6998@var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction 6999number @var{end} is included. 7000@end table 7001 7002This command may not be available for all recording methods. 7003 7004@kindex set record 7005@item set record instruction-history-size @var{size} 7006@itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited 7007Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record 7008instruction-history} command. The default value is 10. 7009A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions. 7010 7011@kindex show record 7012@item show record instruction-history-size 7013Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record 7014instruction-history} command. 7015 7016@kindex record function-call-history 7017@kindex rec function-call-history 7018@item record function-call-history 7019Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one 7020line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same 7021function giving the name of that function, the source lines 7022for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is 7023specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if 7024the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented 7025to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is 7026specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be 7027given together. 7028 7029@smallexample 7030(@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10} 70311 void foo (void) 70322 @{ 70333 @} 70344 70355 void bar (void) 70366 @{ 70377 ... 70388 foo (); 70399 ... 704010 @} 7041(@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc} 70421 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8 70432 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3 70443 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10 7045@end smallexample 7046 7047By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the 7048@code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are 7049printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what 7050to print: 7051 7052@table @code 7053@item record function-call-history @var{func} 7054Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}. 7055 7056@item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n} 7057Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If 7058@var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after 7059function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, 7060prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}. 7061 7062@item record function-call-history 7063Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print. 7064 7065@item record function-call-history - 7066Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print. 7067 7068@item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end} 7069Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until 7070function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included. 7071@end table 7072 7073This command may not be available for all recording methods. 7074 7075@item set record function-call-history-size @var{size} 7076@itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited 7077Define how many lines to print in the 7078@code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10. 7079A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines. 7080 7081@item show record function-call-history-size 7082Show how many lines to print in the 7083@code{record function-call-history} command. 7084@end table 7085 7086 7087@node Stack 7088@chapter Examining the Stack 7089 7090When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it 7091stopped and how it got there. 7092 7093@cindex call stack 7094Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call 7095is generated. 7096That information includes the location of the call in your program, 7097the arguments of the call, 7098and the local variables of the function being called. 7099The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}. 7100The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call 7101stack}. 7102 7103When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the 7104stack allow you to see all of this information. 7105 7106@cindex selected frame 7107One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many 7108@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In 7109particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in 7110your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are 7111special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are 7112interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 7113 7114When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the 7115currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the 7116@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}). 7117 7118@menu 7119* Frames:: Stack frames 7120* Backtrace:: Backtraces 7121* Selection:: Selecting a frame 7122* Frame Info:: Information on a frame 7123* Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters 7124 7125@end menu 7126 7127@node Frames 7128@section Stack Frames 7129 7130@cindex frame, definition 7131@cindex stack frame 7132The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack 7133frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated 7134with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given 7135to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at 7136which the function is executing. 7137 7138@cindex initial frame 7139@cindex outermost frame 7140@cindex innermost frame 7141When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the 7142function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the 7143@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is 7144made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation 7145is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for 7146the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is 7147actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most 7148recently created of all the stack frames that still exist. 7149 7150@cindex frame pointer 7151Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A 7152stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each 7153kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose 7154address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept 7155in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} 7156(@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame. 7157 7158@cindex frame number 7159@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with 7160zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it, 7161and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program; 7162they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack 7163frames in @value{GDBN} commands. 7164 7165@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow 7166@c underflow problems. 7167@cindex frameless execution 7168Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate 7169without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option 7170@smallexample 7171@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer} 7172@end smallexample 7173generates functions without a frame.) 7174This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save 7175the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing 7176with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation 7177has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though 7178it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing 7179correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has 7180no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack. 7181 7182@node Backtrace 7183@section Backtraces 7184 7185@cindex traceback 7186@cindex call stack traces 7187A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one 7188line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing 7189frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the 7190stack. 7191 7192@anchor{backtrace-command} 7193@table @code 7194@kindex backtrace 7195@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})} 7196@item backtrace 7197@itemx bt 7198Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all 7199frames in the stack. 7200 7201You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt 7202character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}. 7203 7204@item backtrace @var{n} 7205@itemx bt @var{n} 7206Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames. 7207 7208@item backtrace -@var{n} 7209@itemx bt -@var{n} 7210Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames. 7211 7212@item backtrace full 7213@itemx bt full 7214@itemx bt full @var{n} 7215@itemx bt full -@var{n} 7216Print the values of the local variables also. As described above, 7217@var{n} specifies the number of frames to print. 7218 7219@item backtrace no-filters 7220@itemx bt no-filters 7221@itemx bt no-filters @var{n} 7222@itemx bt no-filters -@var{n} 7223@itemx bt no-filters full 7224@itemx bt no-filters full @var{n} 7225@itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n} 7226Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame 7227Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable 7228frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only 7229relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python} 7230support. 7231@end table 7232 7233@kindex where 7234@kindex info stack 7235The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s}) 7236are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}. 7237 7238@cindex multiple threads, backtrace 7239In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the 7240backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for 7241several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply} 7242(@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread 7243apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all 7244the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a 7245multi-threaded program. 7246 7247Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name. 7248The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set 7249print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and 7250line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program 7251counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that 7252line number. 7253 7254Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command 7255@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames. 7256 7257@smallexample 7258@group 7259#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8) 7260 at builtin.c:993 7261#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242 7262#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08) 7263 at macro.c:71 7264(More stack frames follow...) 7265@end group 7266@end smallexample 7267 7268@noindent 7269The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter 7270value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the 7271code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}. 7272 7273@noindent 7274The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by 7275@code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter 7276only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command 7277@kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details 7278on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed. 7279 7280@cindex optimized out, in backtrace 7281@cindex function call arguments, optimized out 7282If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will 7283optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are 7284never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that 7285passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments 7286in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such 7287arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what 7288such a backtrace might look like: 7289 7290@smallexample 7291@group 7292#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8) 7293 at builtin.c:993 7294#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242 7295#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08) 7296 at macro.c:71 7297(More stack frames follow...) 7298@end group 7299@end smallexample 7300 7301@noindent 7302The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are 7303shown as @samp{<optimized out>}. 7304 7305If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments, 7306either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one 7307you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations. 7308 7309@cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function 7310@cindex program entry point 7311@cindex startup code, and backtrace 7312Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system 7313libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is 7314@code{main}@footnote{ 7315Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing'' 7316environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the 7317entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}. 7318When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace 7319it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly 7320system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code. 7321 7322If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels 7323in a backtrace, you can change this behavior: 7324 7325@table @code 7326@item set backtrace past-main 7327@itemx set backtrace past-main on 7328@kindex set backtrace 7329Backtraces will continue past the user entry point. 7330 7331@item set backtrace past-main off 7332Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the 7333default. 7334 7335@item show backtrace past-main 7336@kindex show backtrace 7337Display the current user entry point backtrace policy. 7338 7339@item set backtrace past-entry 7340@itemx set backtrace past-entry on 7341Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application. 7342This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built, 7343and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called. 7344 7345@item set backtrace past-entry off 7346Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an 7347application. This is the default. 7348 7349@item show backtrace past-entry 7350Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy. 7351 7352@item set backtrace limit @var{n} 7353@itemx set backtrace limit 0 7354@itemx set backtrace limit unlimited 7355@cindex backtrace limit 7356Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited} 7357or zero means unlimited levels. 7358 7359@item show backtrace limit 7360Display the current limit on backtrace levels. 7361@end table 7362 7363You can control how file names are displayed. 7364 7365@table @code 7366@item set filename-display 7367@itemx set filename-display relative 7368@cindex filename-display 7369Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default. 7370 7371@item set filename-display basename 7372Display only basename of a filename. 7373 7374@item set filename-display absolute 7375Display an absolute filename. 7376 7377@item show filename-display 7378Show the current way to display filenames. 7379@end table 7380 7381@node Selection 7382@section Selecting a Frame 7383 7384Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on 7385whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for 7386selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description 7387of the stack frame just selected. 7388 7389@table @code 7390@kindex frame@r{, selecting} 7391@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})} 7392@item frame @var{n} 7393@itemx f @var{n} 7394Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost 7395(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the 7396innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for 7397@code{main}. 7398 7399@item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ] 7400@itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ] 7401Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the 7402chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it 7403impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In 7404addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and 7405switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to 7406specify the value of PC for the stack frame. 7407 7408@kindex up 7409@item up @var{n} 7410Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive 7411numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher 7412frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer. 7413 7414@kindex down 7415@kindex do @r{(@code{down})} 7416@item down @var{n} 7417Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For 7418positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to 7419lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently. 7420You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}. 7421@end table 7422 7423All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the 7424frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the 7425arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that 7426frame. The second line shows the text of that source line. 7427 7428@need 1000 7429For example: 7430 7431@smallexample 7432@group 7433(@value{GDBP}) up 7434#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc) 7435 at env.c:10 743610 read_input_file (argv[i]); 7437@end group 7438@end smallexample 7439 7440After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments 7441prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame. 7442You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite 7443editing program by typing @code{edit}. 7444@xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines}, 7445for details. 7446 7447@table @code 7448@kindex select-frame 7449@item select-frame 7450The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does 7451not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is 7452intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the 7453output might be unnecessary and distracting. 7454 7455@kindex down-silently 7456@kindex up-silently 7457@item up-silently @var{n} 7458@itemx down-silently @var{n} 7459These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down}, 7460respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without 7461causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use 7462in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and 7463distracting. 7464@end table 7465 7466@node Frame Info 7467@section Information About a Frame 7468 7469There are several other commands to print information about the selected 7470stack frame. 7471 7472@table @code 7473@item frame 7474@itemx f 7475When used without any argument, this command does not change which 7476frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently 7477selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an 7478argument, this command is used to select a stack frame. 7479@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 7480 7481@kindex info frame 7482@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})} 7483@item info frame 7484@itemx info f 7485This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame, 7486including: 7487 7488@itemize @bullet 7489@item 7490the address of the frame 7491@item 7492the address of the next frame down (called by this frame) 7493@item 7494the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame) 7495@item 7496the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written 7497@item 7498the address of the frame's arguments 7499@item 7500the address of the frame's local variables 7501@item 7502the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame) 7503@item 7504which registers were saved in the frame 7505@end itemize 7506 7507@noindent The verbose description is useful when 7508something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit 7509the usual conventions. 7510 7511@item info frame @var{addr} 7512@itemx info f @var{addr} 7513Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without 7514selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this 7515command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some 7516architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command. 7517@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}. 7518 7519@kindex info args 7520@item info args 7521Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line. 7522 7523@item info locals 7524@kindex info locals 7525Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate 7526line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic) 7527accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame. 7528 7529@end table 7530 7531@node Frame Filter Management 7532@section Management of Frame Filters. 7533@cindex managing frame filters 7534 7535Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the 7536output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information. 7537 7538Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available 7539within @value{GDBN}, detailed here. 7540 7541@table @code 7542@kindex info frame-filter 7543@item info frame-filter 7544Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing 7545their name, priority and enabled status. 7546 7547@kindex disable frame-filter 7548@anchor{disable frame-filter all} 7549@item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} 7550Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7551@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The 7552@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global}, 7553@code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7554dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters 7555across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name 7556of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for 7557@var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it 7558may be enabled again later. 7559 7560@kindex enable frame-filter 7561@item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} 7562Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7563@var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The 7564@var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global}, 7565@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7566dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across 7567all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame 7568filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for 7569@var{filter-dictionary}. 7570 7571Example: 7572 7573@smallexample 7574(gdb) info frame-filter 7575 7576global frame-filters: 7577 Priority Enabled Name 7578 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter 7579 100 Yes Reverse 7580 7581progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7582 Priority Enabled Name 7583 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7584 7585objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7586 Priority Enabled Name 7587 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter 7588 7589(gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter 7590(gdb) info frame-filter 7591 7592global frame-filters: 7593 Priority Enabled Name 7594 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter 7595 100 Yes Reverse 7596 7597progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7598 Priority Enabled Name 7599 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7600 7601objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7602 Priority Enabled Name 7603 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7604 7605(gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter 7606(gdb) info frame-filter 7607 7608global frame-filters: 7609 Priority Enabled Name 7610 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter 7611 100 Yes Reverse 7612 7613progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7614 Priority Enabled Name 7615 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7616 7617objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7618 Priority Enabled Name 7619 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7620@end smallexample 7621 7622@kindex set frame-filter priority 7623@item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority} 7624Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7625@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching 7626@var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global}, 7627@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7628dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer. 7629 7630@kindex show frame-filter priority 7631@item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} 7632Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching 7633@var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching 7634@var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global}, 7635@code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter 7636dictionary resides. 7637 7638Example: 7639 7640@smallexample 7641(gdb) info frame-filter 7642 7643global frame-filters: 7644 Priority Enabled Name 7645 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter 7646 100 Yes Reverse 7647 7648progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7649 Priority Enabled Name 7650 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7651 7652objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7653 Priority Enabled Name 7654 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7655 7656(gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50 7657(gdb) info frame-filter 7658 7659global frame-filters: 7660 Priority Enabled Name 7661 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter 7662 50 Yes Reverse 7663 7664progspace /build/test frame-filters: 7665 Priority Enabled Name 7666 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter 7667 7668objfile /build/test frame-filters: 7669 Priority Enabled Name 7670 999 No BuildProgramFilter 7671@end smallexample 7672@end table 7673 7674@node Source 7675@chapter Examining Source Files 7676 7677@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging 7678information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were 7679used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints 7680the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame 7681(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where 7682execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of 7683source files by explicit command. 7684 7685If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may 7686prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using 7687@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}. 7688 7689@menu 7690* List:: Printing source lines 7691* Specify Location:: How to specify code locations 7692* Edit:: Editing source files 7693* Search:: Searching source files 7694* Source Path:: Specifying source directories 7695* Machine Code:: Source and machine code 7696@end menu 7697 7698@node List 7699@section Printing Source Lines 7700 7701@kindex list 7702@kindex l @r{(@code{list})} 7703To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command 7704(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed. 7705There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to 7706print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list. 7707 7708Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used: 7709 7710@table @code 7711@item list @var{linenum} 7712Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the 7713current source file. 7714 7715@item list @var{function} 7716Print lines centered around the beginning of function 7717@var{function}. 7718 7719@item list 7720Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a 7721@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines 7722printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed 7723as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the 7724Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line. 7725 7726@item list - 7727Print lines just before the lines last printed. 7728@end table 7729 7730@cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display 7731By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of 7732the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}: 7733 7734@table @code 7735@kindex set listsize 7736@item set listsize @var{count} 7737@itemx set listsize unlimited 7738Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless 7739the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number). 7740Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit. 7741 7742@kindex show listsize 7743@item show listsize 7744Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints. 7745@end table 7746 7747Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument, 7748so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful 7749than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an 7750argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that 7751each repetition moves up in the source file. 7752 7753In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two 7754@dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways 7755of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always 7756to specify some source line. 7757 7758Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}: 7759 7760@table @code 7761@item list @var{location} 7762Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}. 7763 7764@item list @var{first},@var{last} 7765Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are 7766locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the 7767source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to 7768the same source file as the first location. 7769 7770@item list ,@var{last} 7771Print lines ending with @var{last}. 7772 7773@item list @var{first}, 7774Print lines starting with @var{first}. 7775 7776@item list + 7777Print lines just after the lines last printed. 7778 7779@item list - 7780Print lines just before the lines last printed. 7781 7782@item list 7783As described in the preceding table. 7784@end table 7785 7786@node Specify Location 7787@section Specifying a Location 7788@cindex specifying location 7789@cindex location 7790@cindex source location 7791 7792@menu 7793* Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations 7794* Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations 7795* Address Locations:: Address locations 7796@end menu 7797 7798Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location 7799of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level 7800debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code. 7801Locations may be specified using three different formats: 7802linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations. 7803 7804@node Linespec Locations 7805@subsection Linespec Locations 7806@cindex linespec locations 7807 7808A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such 7809as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of 7810specifying a linespec: 7811 7812@table @code 7813@item @var{linenum} 7814Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file. 7815 7816@item -@var{offset} 7817@itemx +@var{offset} 7818Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current 7819line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one 7820printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which 7821execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame} 7822(@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When 7823used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command, 7824this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first 7825linespec. 7826 7827@item @var{filename}:@var{linenum} 7828Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}. 7829If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any 7830source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if 7831@var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file 7832name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not 7833@file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}. 7834 7835@item @var{function} 7836Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}. 7837For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace. 7838 7839@item @var{function}:@var{label} 7840Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}. 7841 7842@item @var{filename}:@var{function} 7843Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function} 7844in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a 7845function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named 7846functions in different source files. 7847 7848@item @var{label} 7849Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears 7850in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame. 7851If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior 7852is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label. 7853 7854@cindex breakpoint at static probe point 7855@item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name} 7856The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for 7857applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more 7858information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec 7859specifies the location of such a static probe. 7860 7861If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library 7862or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered. 7863If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered. 7864If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at 7865each one of those probes. 7866@end table 7867 7868@node Explicit Locations 7869@subsection Explicit Locations 7870@cindex explicit locations 7871 7872@dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source 7873location's parameters using option-value pairs. 7874 7875Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or 7876file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's 7877sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source 7878line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using 7879explicit locations might be faster in large programs. 7880 7881For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar} 7882defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function 7883named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or 7884the symbol table to know. 7885 7886The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the 7887following table: 7888 7889@table @code 7890@item -source @var{filename} 7891The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between 7892files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary 7893to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise 7894@value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base 7895name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}. 7896 7897@item -function @var{function} 7898The value specifies the name of a function. Operations 7899on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label} 7900or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function. 7901In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace. 7902 7903@item -label @var{label} 7904The value specifies the name of a label. When the function 7905name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently 7906selected stack frame. 7907 7908@item -line @var{number} 7909The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either 7910be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on 7911the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is 7912relative to the current line. 7913@end table 7914 7915Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique 7916trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @code{break -s main.c -li 3}. 7917 7918@node Address Locations 7919@subsection Address Locations 7920@cindex address locations 7921 7922@dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have 7923the generalized form *@var{address}. 7924 7925For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this 7926specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and 7927other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in 7928parts of your program which do not have debugging information or 7929source files. 7930 7931Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working 7932language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code 7933address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the 7934semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations 7935that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms 7936of @var{address}: 7937 7938@table @code 7939@item @var{expression} 7940Any expression valid in the current working language. 7941 7942@item @var{funcaddr} 7943An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C, 7944C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is 7945simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case 7946of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is 7947@code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address} 7948(although the Pascal form also works). 7949 7950This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction, 7951before the stack frame and arguments have been set up. 7952 7953@item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr} 7954Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source 7955file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not 7956specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several 7957functions with identical names in different source files. 7958@end table 7959 7960@node Edit 7961@section Editing Source Files 7962@cindex editing source files 7963 7964@kindex edit 7965@kindex e @r{(@code{edit})} 7966To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command. 7967The editing program of your choice 7968is invoked with the current line set to 7969the active line in the program. 7970Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you 7971want to print if you want to see other parts of the program: 7972 7973@table @code 7974@item edit @var{location} 7975Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at 7976that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the 7977specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms 7978of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit} 7979command most commonly used: 7980 7981@table @code 7982@item edit @var{number} 7983Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number. 7984 7985@item edit @var{function} 7986Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition. 7987@end table 7988 7989@end table 7990 7991@subsection Choosing your Editor 7992You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want 7993@footnote{ 7994The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the 7995following command-line syntax: 7996@smallexample 7997ex +@var{number} file 7998@end smallexample 7999The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in 8000the file where to start editing.}. 8001By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this 8002by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using 8003@value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the 8004@code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell: 8005@smallexample 8006EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi 8007export EDITOR 8008gdb @dots{} 8009@end smallexample 8010or in the @code{csh} shell, 8011@smallexample 8012setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi 8013gdb @dots{} 8014@end smallexample 8015 8016@node Search 8017@section Searching Source Files 8018@cindex searching source files 8019 8020There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a 8021regular expression. 8022 8023@table @code 8024@kindex search 8025@kindex forward-search 8026@kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})} 8027@item forward-search @var{regexp} 8028@itemx search @var{regexp} 8029The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, 8030starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for 8031@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the 8032synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as 8033@code{fo}. 8034 8035@kindex reverse-search 8036@item reverse-search @var{regexp} 8037The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting 8038with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match 8039for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate 8040this command as @code{rev}. 8041@end table 8042 8043@node Source Path 8044@section Specifying Source Directories 8045 8046@cindex source path 8047@cindex directories for source files 8048Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source 8049files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do, 8050the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging 8051session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files; 8052this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file, 8053it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present 8054in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. 8055 8056For example, suppose an executable references the file 8057@file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is 8058@file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this 8059fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this 8060fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error 8061message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the 8062source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. 8063Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if 8064the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to 8065@file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under 8066@file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}. 8067 8068Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file 8069names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for 8070instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file 8071is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try 8072@file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after 8073that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}. 8074 8075Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the 8076source files. 8077 8078Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out 8079any information it has cached about where source files are found and where 8080each line is in the file. 8081 8082@kindex directory 8083@kindex dir 8084When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir} 8085and @samp{cwd}, in that order. 8086To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command. 8087 8088The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN} 8089script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command). 8090 8091In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands 8092that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution 8093rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's 8094debug information in case the sources were moved to a different 8095directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of 8096two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in 8097the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten. 8098In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and 8099@var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement 8100of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the 8101source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file 8102name to look up the sources. 8103 8104Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been 8105moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell 8106@value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with 8107@file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be 8108@file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location 8109of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path 8110substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command 8111(@pxref{set substitute-path}). 8112 8113To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the 8114@var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator. 8115For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into 8116@file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but 8117not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution 8118is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will 8119not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either. 8120 8121In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory} 8122command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in 8123the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple 8124subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each 8125subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while 8126preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path} 8127allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single 8128command. 8129 8130@code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command. 8131The source path is only used if the file at the original location no 8132longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies 8133the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if 8134for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is 8135located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only 8136method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location. 8137 8138@cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources} 8139@cindex default source path substitution 8140You can configure a default source path substitution rule by 8141configuring @value{GDBN} with the 8142@samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir} 8143should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured 8144prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and 8145directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted 8146automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 8147location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables 8148with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved 8149together. 8150 8151@table @code 8152@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{} 8153@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{} 8154Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several 8155directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:} 8156(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as 8157part of absolute file names) or 8158whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source 8159path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner. 8160 8161@kindex cdir 8162@kindex cwd 8163@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable} 8164@vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable} 8165@cindex compilation directory 8166@cindex current directory 8167@cindex working directory 8168@cindex directory, current 8169@cindex directory, compilation 8170You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation 8171directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current 8172working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former 8173tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN} 8174session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current 8175directory at the time you add an entry to the source path. 8176 8177@item directory 8178Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation. 8179 8180@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since 8181@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS) 8182 8183@item set directories @var{path-list} 8184@kindex set directories 8185Set the source path to @var{path-list}. 8186@samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing. 8187 8188@item show directories 8189@kindex show directories 8190Print the source path: show which directories it contains. 8191 8192@anchor{set substitute-path} 8193@item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to} 8194@kindex set substitute-path 8195Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the 8196current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same 8197@var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted. 8198 8199For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to 8200@file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command 8201 8202@smallexample 8203(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross 8204@end smallexample 8205 8206@noindent 8207will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with 8208@samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file 8209@file{baz.c} even though it was moved. 8210 8211In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined, 8212the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been 8213defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform 8214the substitution. 8215 8216For instance, if we had entered the following commands: 8217 8218@smallexample 8219(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include 8220(@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src 8221@end smallexample 8222 8223@noindent 8224@value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into 8225@file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would 8226use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into 8227@file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}. 8228 8229 8230@item unset substitute-path [path] 8231@kindex unset substitute-path 8232If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules 8233for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found. 8234A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found. 8235 8236If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted. 8237 8238@item show substitute-path [path] 8239@kindex show substitute-path 8240If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule 8241which would rewrite that path, if any. 8242 8243If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution 8244rules. 8245 8246@end table 8247 8248If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of 8249interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong 8250versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows: 8251 8252@enumerate 8253@item 8254Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value. 8255 8256@item 8257Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the 8258directories you want in the source path. You can add all the 8259directories in one command. 8260@end enumerate 8261 8262@node Machine Code 8263@section Source and Machine Code 8264@cindex source line and its code address 8265 8266You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program 8267addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display 8268a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command 8269@code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next 8270source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs 8271mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the 8272line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as 8273well as hex. 8274 8275@table @code 8276@kindex info line 8277@item info line @var{location} 8278Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for 8279source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of 8280the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. 8281@end table 8282 8283For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of 8284the object code for the first line of function 8285@code{m4_changequote}: 8286 8287@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in 8288@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed. 8289@smallexample 8290(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote 8291Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350. 8292@end smallexample 8293 8294@noindent 8295@cindex code address and its source line 8296We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for 8297@var{location}) what source line covers a particular address: 8298@smallexample 8299(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff 8300Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404. 8301@end smallexample 8302 8303@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line} 8304@cindex @code{x} command, default address 8305@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line 8306After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command 8307is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is 8308sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory, 8309,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the 8310convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 8311Variables}). 8312 8313@table @code 8314@kindex disassemble 8315@cindex assembly instructions 8316@cindex instructions, assembly 8317@cindex machine instructions 8318@cindex listing machine instructions 8319@item disassemble 8320@itemx disassemble /m 8321@itemx disassemble /s 8322@itemx disassemble /r 8323This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine 8324instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying 8325the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex 8326as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier. 8327The default memory range is the function surrounding the 8328program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this 8329command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function 8330surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should 8331be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The 8332arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms: 8333 8334@table @code 8335@item @var{start},@var{end} 8336the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive) 8337@item @var{start},+@var{length} 8338the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to 8339@code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive). 8340@end table 8341 8342@noindent 8343When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also 8344printed (since there could be several functions in the given range). 8345 8346The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as 8347@samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}. 8348 8349If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter, 8350the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker. 8351@end table 8352 8353The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of 8354HP PA-RISC 2.0 code: 8355 8356@smallexample 8357(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4 8358Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4: 8359 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp 8360 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26 8361 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31 8362 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31) 8363 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp 8364 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp 8365 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26 8366 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31 8367End of assembler dump. 8368@end smallexample 8369 8370Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86 8371with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after 8372function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code. 8373 8374@smallexample 8375(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main 8376Dump of assembler code for function main: 83775 @{ 8378 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp 8379 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp 8380 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp 8381 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp 8382 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp 8383 83846 printf ("Hello.\n"); 8385=> 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp) 8386 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt> 8387 83887 return 0; 83898 @} 8390 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax 8391 0x0804834d <+29>: leave 8392 0x0804834e <+30>: ret 8393 8394End of assembler dump. 8395@end smallexample 8396 8397The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when 8398there is either inlined code or re-ordered code. 8399The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice. 8400Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between 8401@code{/m} output and @code{/s} output. 8402This example has one inline function defined in a header file, 8403and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization. 8404Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of 8405several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output. 8406 8407@file{foo.h}: 8408 8409@smallexample 8410int 8411foo (int a) 8412@{ 8413 if (a < 0) 8414 return a * 2; 8415 if (a == 0) 8416 return 1; 8417 return a + 10; 8418@} 8419@end smallexample 8420 8421@file{foo.c}: 8422 8423@smallexample 8424#include "foo.h" 8425volatile int x, y; 8426int 8427main () 8428@{ 8429 x = foo (y); 8430 return 0; 8431@} 8432@end smallexample 8433 8434@smallexample 8435(@value{GDBP}) disas /m main 8436Dump of assembler code for function main: 84375 @{ 8438 84396 x = foo (y); 8440 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y> 8441 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x> 8442 84437 return 0; 84448 @} 8445 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax 8446 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq 8447 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax 8448 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23> 8449 8450End of assembler dump. 8451(@value{GDBP}) disas /s main 8452Dump of assembler code for function main: 8453foo.c: 84545 @{ 84556 x = foo (y); 8456 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y> 8457 8458foo.h: 84594 if (a < 0) 8460 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax 8461 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32> 8462 84636 if (a == 0) 84647 return 1; 84658 return a + 10; 8466 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx 8467 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax 8468 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax 8469 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax 8470 8471foo.c: 84726 x = foo (y); 8473 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x> 8474 84757 return 0; 84768 @} 8477 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax 8478 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq 8479 8480foo.h: 84815 return a * 2; 8482 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax 8483 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23> 8484End of assembler dump. 8485@end smallexample 8486 8487Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64, 8488 8489@smallexample 8490(gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10 8491Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b: 8492 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi) 8493 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax 8494 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx) 8495 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al 8496End of assembler dump. 8497@end smallexample 8498 8499Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}). 8500So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar} 8501in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar} 8502and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}. 8503 8504Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction 8505mnemonics or other syntax. 8506 8507For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries, 8508instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared 8509libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a 8510location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN} 8511might be able to resolve these to actual function names. 8512 8513@table @code 8514@kindex set disassembly-flavor 8515@cindex Intel disassembly flavor 8516@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor 8517@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set} 8518Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the 8519program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands. 8520 8521Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You 8522can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}. 8523The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix 8524assemblers for x86-based targets. 8525 8526@kindex show disassembly-flavor 8527@item show disassembly-flavor 8528Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor. 8529@end table 8530 8531@table @code 8532@kindex set disassemble-next-line 8533@kindex show disassemble-next-line 8534@item set disassemble-next-line 8535@itemx show disassemble-next-line 8536Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source 8537line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will 8538display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the 8539program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to 8540displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if 8541possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason 8542(e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line 8543info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the 8544next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If 8545AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only 8546if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes 8547@value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function 8548with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is 8549OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or 8550instruction. 8551@end table 8552 8553 8554@node Data 8555@chapter Examining Data 8556 8557@cindex printing data 8558@cindex examining data 8559@kindex print 8560@kindex inspect 8561The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print} 8562command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It 8563evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your 8564program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with 8565Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a 8566Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}). 8567 8568@table @code 8569@item print @var{expr} 8570@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr} 8571@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the 8572value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type; 8573you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where 8574@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output 8575Formats}. 8576 8577@item print 8578@itemx print /@var{f} 8579@cindex reprint the last value 8580If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the 8581@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to 8582conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format. 8583@end table 8584 8585A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command. 8586It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a 8587specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}. 8588 8589If you are interested in information about types, or about how the 8590fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}} 8591command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol 8592Table}. 8593 8594@cindex exploring hierarchical data structures 8595@kindex explore 8596Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is 8597through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if 8598the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It 8599offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most 8600abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type 8601itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields 8602embedded in the higher level data types. 8603 8604@table @code 8605@item explore @var{arg} 8606@var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type 8607visible in the current context of the program being debugged. 8608@end table 8609 8610The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an 8611example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your 8612C program as 8613 8614@smallexample 8615struct SimpleStruct 8616@{ 8617 int i; 8618 double d; 8619@}; 8620 8621struct ComplexStruct 8622@{ 8623 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p; 8624 int arr[10]; 8625@}; 8626@end smallexample 8627 8628@noindent 8629followed by variable declarations as 8630 8631@smallexample 8632struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @}; 8633struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @}; 8634@end smallexample 8635 8636@noindent 8637then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the 8638@code{explore} command as follows. 8639 8640@smallexample 8641(gdb) explore cs 8642The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with 8643the following fields: 8644 8645 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'> 8646 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'> 8647 8648Enter the field number of choice: 8649@end smallexample 8650 8651@noindent 8652Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being 8653prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose 8654the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a 8655pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From 8656the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single 8657value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will 8658be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this 8659field will be explored as if it were an array. 8660 8661@smallexample 8662`cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct' 8663Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y 8664The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct 8665SimpleStruct' with the following fields: 8666 8667 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int') 8668 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double') 8669 8670Press enter to return to parent value: 8671@end smallexample 8672 8673@noindent 8674If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by 8675entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be 8676prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want 8677to explore. 8678 8679@smallexample 8680`cs.arr' is an array of `int'. 8681Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5 8682 8683`(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'. 8684 8685(cs.arr)[5] = 4 8686 8687Press enter to return to parent value: 8688@end smallexample 8689 8690In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the 8691leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the 8692return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher} 8693level data structure). 8694 8695Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to 8696explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a 8697variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the 8698program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the 8699same example as above, your can explore the type 8700@code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument 8701@code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command. 8702 8703@smallexample 8704(gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct 8705@end smallexample 8706 8707@noindent 8708By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive 8709session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a 8710manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above 8711example. 8712 8713The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands, 8714@code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is 8715a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is 8716being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type 8717exploration of the argument is being invoked. 8718 8719@table @code 8720@item explore value @var{expr} 8721@cindex explore value 8722This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the 8723expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the 8724current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this 8725command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore} 8726command being passed the argument @var{expr}. 8727 8728@item explore type @var{arg} 8729@cindex explore type 8730This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if 8731@var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being 8732debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg} 8733is an expression valid in the current context of the program being 8734debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is 8735identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the 8736argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of 8737this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command 8738being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument. 8739@end table 8740 8741@menu 8742* Expressions:: Expressions 8743* Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions 8744* Variables:: Program variables 8745* Arrays:: Artificial arrays 8746* Output Formats:: Output formats 8747* Memory:: Examining memory 8748* Auto Display:: Automatic display 8749* Print Settings:: Print settings 8750* Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing 8751* Value History:: Value history 8752* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables 8753* Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions 8754* Registers:: Registers 8755* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware 8756* Vector Unit:: Vector Unit 8757* OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system 8758* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes 8759* Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file 8760* Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core 8761* Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different 8762 character set than GDB does 8763* Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets 8764* Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes 8765* Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values 8766@end menu 8767 8768@node Expressions 8769@section Expressions 8770 8771@cindex expressions 8772@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and 8773compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined 8774by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in 8775@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, 8776casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if 8777you compiled your program to include this information; see 8778@ref{Compilation}. 8779 8780@cindex arrays in expressions 8781@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by 8782the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example, 8783you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array 8784of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it 8785to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that 8786is @code{malloc}ed in the target program. 8787 8788Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in 8789this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different 8790Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other 8791languages. 8792 8793In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN} 8794expressions regardless of your programming language. 8795 8796@cindex casts, in expressions 8797Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so 8798useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure 8799at that address in memory. 8800@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true? 8801 8802@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common 8803to programming languages: 8804 8805@table @code 8806@item @@ 8807@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays. 8808@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information. 8809 8810@item :: 8811@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or 8812function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}. 8813 8814@cindex @{@var{type}@} 8815@cindex type casting memory 8816@cindex memory, viewing as typed object 8817@cindex casts, to view memory 8818@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr} 8819Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in 8820memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is 8821an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary 8822operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless 8823of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}. 8824@end table 8825 8826@node Ambiguous Expressions 8827@section Ambiguous Expressions 8828@cindex ambiguous expressions 8829 8830Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance, 8831some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit 8832a single function name to be defined several times, for application in 8833different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example 8834involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++} 8835templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in 8836the same function name being defined in different contexts. 8837 8838In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust 8839the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you 8840can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in 8841@kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully 8842qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous 8843as well. 8844 8845When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger 8846has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each 8847possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}. 8848The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}} 8849aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was 8850used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the 8851menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible 8852choices. 8853 8854For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a 8855breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}. 8856We choose three particular definitions of that function name: 8857 8858@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least 8859@smallexample 8860@group 8861(@value{GDBP}) b String::after 8862[0] cancel 8863[1] all 8864[2] file:String.cc; line number:867 8865[3] file:String.cc; line number:860 8866[4] file:String.cc; line number:875 8867[5] file:String.cc; line number:853 8868[6] file:String.cc; line number:846 8869[7] file:String.cc; line number:735 8870> 2 4 6 8871Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867. 8872Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875. 8873Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846. 8874Multiple breakpoints were set. 8875Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted 8876 breakpoints. 8877(@value{GDBP}) 8878@end group 8879@end smallexample 8880 8881@table @code 8882@kindex set multiple-symbols 8883@item set multiple-symbols @var{mode} 8884@cindex multiple-symbols menu 8885 8886This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression 8887is ambiguous. 8888 8889By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which 8890the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN} 8891automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting 8892a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint 8893inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made, 8894then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression. 8895For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result 8896in the use of the menu. 8897 8898When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu 8899when an ambiguity is detected. 8900 8901Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports 8902an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted. 8903 8904@kindex show multiple-symbols 8905@item show multiple-symbols 8906Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting. 8907@end table 8908 8909@node Variables 8910@section Program Variables 8911 8912The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable 8913in your program. 8914 8915Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame 8916(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either: 8917 8918@itemize @bullet 8919@item 8920global (or file-static) 8921@end itemize 8922 8923@noindent or 8924 8925@itemize @bullet 8926@item 8927visible according to the scope rules of the 8928programming language from the point of execution in that frame 8929@end itemize 8930 8931@noindent This means that in the function 8932 8933@smallexample 8934foo (a) 8935 int a; 8936@{ 8937 bar (a); 8938 @{ 8939 int b = test (); 8940 bar (b); 8941 @} 8942@} 8943@end smallexample 8944 8945@noindent 8946you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is 8947executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or 8948examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside 8949the block where @code{b} is declared. 8950 8951@cindex variable name conflict 8952There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose 8953scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not 8954in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or 8955function with the same name (in different source files). If that 8956happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish, 8957you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by 8958using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation: 8959 8960@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions 8961@ifnotinfo 8962@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers? 8963@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions 8964@end ifnotinfo 8965@smallexample 8966@var{file}::@var{variable} 8967@var{function}::@var{variable} 8968@end smallexample 8969 8970@noindent 8971Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the 8972static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to 8973make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example, 8974to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}: 8975 8976@smallexample 8977(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x 8978@end smallexample 8979 8980The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to 8981static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables 8982in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the 8983simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation 8984to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame: 8985 8986@smallexample 8987void 8988foo (int a) 8989@{ 8990 if (a < 10) 8991 bar (a); 8992 else 8993 process (a); /* Stop here */ 8994@} 8995 8996int 8997bar (int a) 8998@{ 8999 foo (a + 5); 9000@} 9001@end smallexample 9002 9003@noindent 9004For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line, 9005here is what you might see 9006when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}: 9007 9008@smallexample 9009(@value{GDBP}) p a 9010$1 = 10 9011(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a 9012$2 = 5 9013(@value{GDBP}) up 2 9014#2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12 9015(@value{GDBP}) p a 9016$3 = 5 9017(@value{GDBP}) p bar::a 9018$4 = 0 9019@end smallexample 9020 9021@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution 9022These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very 9023similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in 9024conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be 9025overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes. 9026 9027For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class 9028that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an 9029include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable, 9030@code{some_global}. 9031 9032@smallexample 9033(@value{GDBP}) p includefile 9034$1 = 23 9035(@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global 9036A syntax error in expression, near `'. 9037(@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global 9038$2 = 27 9039@end smallexample 9040 9041@cindex wrong values 9042@cindex variable values, wrong 9043@cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables 9044@cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables 9045@quotation 9046@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the 9047wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new 9048scope, and just before exit. 9049@end quotation 9050You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions. 9051This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to 9052set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are 9053stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong 9054values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually 9055also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame; 9056after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local 9057variable definitions may be gone. 9058 9059This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations. 9060To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization 9061when compiling. 9062 9063@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context'' 9064Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize 9065unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as 9066opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases 9067offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN} 9068might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that 9069happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this: 9070 9071@smallexample 9072No symbol "foo" in current context. 9073@end smallexample 9074 9075To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a 9076different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such 9077formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler 9078options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug 9079info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs. 9080 9081If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to 9082@value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified 9083by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete 9084type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this. 9085 9086If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its 9087value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an 9088error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers. 9089Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according 9090to @ref{set print entry-values}. 9091 9092@smallexample 9093Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29 909429 i++; 9095(gdb) next 909630 e (i); 9097(gdb) print i 9098$1 = 31 9099(gdb) print i@@entry 9100$2 = 30 9101@end smallexample 9102 9103Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified 9104signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get 9105printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or 9106@code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN} 9107defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign. 9108For program code 9109 9110@smallexample 9111char var0[] = "A"; 9112signed char var1[] = "A"; 9113@end smallexample 9114 9115You get during debugging 9116@smallexample 9117(gdb) print var0 9118$1 = "A" 9119(gdb) print var1 9120$2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@} 9121@end smallexample 9122 9123@node Arrays 9124@section Artificial Arrays 9125 9126@cindex artificial array 9127@cindex arrays 9128@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array} 9129It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the 9130same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of 9131dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the 9132program. 9133 9134You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an 9135@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left 9136operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array 9137and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length 9138of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of 9139the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left 9140argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately 9141following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an 9142example. If a program says 9143 9144@smallexample 9145int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int)); 9146@end smallexample 9147 9148@noindent 9149you can print the contents of @code{array} with 9150 9151@smallexample 9152p *array@@len 9153@end smallexample 9154 9155The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made 9156with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of 9157subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions. 9158Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history 9159(@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out. 9160 9161Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast. 9162This re-interprets a value as if it were an array. 9163The value need not be in memory: 9164@smallexample 9165(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678 9166$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@} 9167@end smallexample 9168 9169As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in 9170@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill 9171the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}: 9172@smallexample 9173(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678 9174$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@} 9175@end smallexample 9176 9177Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in 9178moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not 9179actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values 9180of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is 9181to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience 9182Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first 9183interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For 9184instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to 9185structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv} 9186in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type: 9187 9188@smallexample 9189set $i = 0 9190p dtab[$i++]->fv 9191@key{RET} 9192@key{RET} 9193@dots{} 9194@end smallexample 9195 9196@node Output Formats 9197@section Output Formats 9198 9199@cindex formatted output 9200@cindex output formats 9201By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes 9202this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number 9203in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory 9204at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do 9205these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value. 9206 9207The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value 9208already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the 9209@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format 9210letters supported are: 9211 9212@table @code 9213@item x 9214Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in 9215hexadecimal. 9216 9217@item d 9218Print as integer in signed decimal. 9219 9220@item u 9221Print as integer in unsigned decimal. 9222 9223@item o 9224Print as integer in octal. 9225 9226@item t 9227Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''. 9228@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also 9229used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte''; 9230see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.} 9231 9232@item a 9233@cindex unknown address, locating 9234@cindex locate address 9235Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from 9236the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover 9237where (in what function) an unknown address is located: 9238 9239@smallexample 9240(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320 9241$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396> 9242@end smallexample 9243 9244@noindent 9245The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results. 9246@xref{Symbols, info symbol}. 9247 9248@item c 9249Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This 9250prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The 9251character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn} 9252for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range. 9253 9254Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char}, 9255@w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character 9256constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer 9257data. 9258 9259@item f 9260Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print 9261using typical floating point syntax. 9262 9263@item s 9264@cindex printing strings 9265@cindex printing byte arrays 9266Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte 9267data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data 9268are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their 9269natural types. 9270 9271Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of 9272@code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as 9273strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer 9274array. 9275 9276@item z 9277Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and 9278printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value 9279to the size of the integer type. 9280 9281@item r 9282@cindex raw printing 9283Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will 9284use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty 9285Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the 9286value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python 9287pretty-printer which might exist. 9288@end table 9289 9290For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type 9291 9292@smallexample 9293p/x $pc 9294@end smallexample 9295 9296@noindent 9297Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command 9298names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash. 9299 9300To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format, 9301you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no 9302expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex. 9303 9304@node Memory 9305@section Examining Memory 9306 9307You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in 9308any of several formats, independently of your program's data types. 9309 9310@cindex examining memory 9311@table @code 9312@kindex x @r{(examine memory)} 9313@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr} 9314@itemx x @var{addr} 9315@itemx x 9316Use the @code{x} command to examine memory. 9317@end table 9318 9319@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how 9320much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an 9321expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory. 9322If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}. 9323Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}. 9324 9325@table @r 9326@item @var{n}, the repeat count 9327The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies 9328how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative 9329number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}. 9330@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB 9331@c 4.1.2. 9332 9333@item @var{f}, the display format 9334The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print} 9335(@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c}, 9336@samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions). 9337The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes 9338each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}. 9339 9340@item @var{u}, the unit size 9341The unit size is any of 9342 9343@table @code 9344@item b 9345Bytes. 9346@item h 9347Halfwords (two bytes). 9348@item w 9349Words (four bytes). This is the initial default. 9350@item g 9351Giant words (eight bytes). 9352@end table 9353 9354Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the 9355default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format, 9356the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format, 9357the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given. 9358Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display 935932-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings. 9360Note that the results depend on the programming language of the 9361current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s} 9362modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use 9363UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot 9364be altered. 9365 9366@item @var{addr}, starting display address 9367@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying 9368memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may); 9369it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory. 9370@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for 9371@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several 9372other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to 9373the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the 9374starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display 9375a value from memory). 9376@end table 9377 9378For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords 9379(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}), 9380starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four 9381words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp}; 9382@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}). 9383 9384You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward 9385from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three 9386halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}. 9387 9388Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the 9389letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether 9390unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output 9391specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing. 9392(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.) 9393 9394Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s} 9395and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example, 9396@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions, 9397including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with 9398the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay 9399slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately 9400follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command 9401@code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine 9402instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}. 9403 9404If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i}, 9405the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given 9406address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i} 9407format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate 9408instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not 9409available, the command stops examining memory with an error message. 9410 9411All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it 9412easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time 9413you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine 9414instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven 9415with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command, 9416the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as 9417for successive uses of @code{x}. 9418 9419When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program 9420counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example: 9421 9422@smallexample 9423(@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6 9424 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp 9425 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx 9426 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp 9427=> 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp) 9428 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt> 9429@end smallexample 9430 9431@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history 9432The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved 9433in the value history because there is often too much of them and they 9434would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for 9435subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables 9436@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address 9437examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable 9438@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in 9439the convenience variable @code{$__}. 9440 9441If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved 9442are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last 9443address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output. 9444 9445@anchor{addressable memory unit} 9446@cindex addressable memory unit 9447Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means 9448that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some 9449targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes. 9450Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term 9451@dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used 9452when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word 9453@dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of 9454the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems, 9455addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte. 9456 9457@cindex remote memory comparison 9458@cindex target memory comparison 9459@cindex verify remote memory image 9460@cindex verify target memory image 9461When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine 9462(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image 9463in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you 9464downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check 9465whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The 9466@code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations. 9467 9468@table @code 9469@kindex compare-sections 9470@item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]} 9471Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the 9472executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in 9473the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no 9474arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of 9475@code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections. 9476 9477Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the 9478target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory 9479(@pxref{qCRC packet}). 9480@end table 9481 9482@node Auto Display 9483@section Automatic Display 9484@cindex automatic display 9485@cindex display of expressions 9486 9487If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently 9488(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic 9489display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops. 9490Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it; 9491to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number. 9492The automatic display looks like this: 9493 9494@smallexample 94952: foo = 38 94963: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804 9497@end smallexample 9498 9499@noindent 9500This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with 9501displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can 9502specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides 9503whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format 9504specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i} 9505or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}. 9506 9507@table @code 9508@kindex display 9509@item display @var{expr} 9510Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display 9511each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 9512 9513@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. 9514 9515@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr} 9516For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or 9517count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but 9518arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}. 9519@xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}. 9520 9521@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr} 9522For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a 9523number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to 9524be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect 9525doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}. 9526@end table 9527 9528For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine 9529instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc} 9530is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}). 9531 9532@table @code 9533@kindex delete display 9534@kindex undisplay 9535@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{} 9536@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{} 9537Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the 9538numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command 9539argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the 9540numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display; 9541or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 9542 9543@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 9544(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.) 9545 9546@kindex disable display 9547@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{} 9548Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display 9549item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be 9550enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you 9551want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a 9552single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of 9553the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display 9554numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 9555 9556@kindex enable display 9557@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{} 9558Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once 9559again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise. 9560Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the 9561command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one 9562of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} 9563display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}. 9564 9565@item display 9566Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is 9567done when your program stops. 9568 9569@kindex info display 9570@item info display 9571Print the list of expressions previously set up to display 9572automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the 9573values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such. 9574It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now 9575because they refer to automatic variables not currently available. 9576@end table 9577 9578@cindex display disabled out of scope 9579If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make 9580sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an 9581expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its 9582variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command 9583@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument 9584@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program 9585continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where 9586there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled 9587automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char} 9588is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again. 9589 9590@node Print Settings 9591@section Print Settings 9592 9593@cindex format options 9594@cindex print settings 9595@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures, 9596and symbols are printed. 9597 9598@noindent 9599These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language: 9600 9601@table @code 9602@kindex set print 9603@item set print address 9604@itemx set print address on 9605@cindex print/don't print memory addresses 9606@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack 9607traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth, 9608even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default 9609is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with 9610@code{set print address on}: 9611 9612@smallexample 9613@group 9614(@value{GDBP}) f 9615#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>") 9616 at input.c:530 9617530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 9618@end group 9619@end smallexample 9620 9621@item set print address off 9622Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example, 9623this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}: 9624 9625@smallexample 9626@group 9627(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off 9628(@value{GDBP}) f 9629#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530 9630530 if (lquote != def_lquote) 9631@end group 9632@end smallexample 9633 9634You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine 9635dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with 9636@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on 9637all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments. 9638 9639@kindex show print 9640@item show print address 9641Show whether or not addresses are to be printed. 9642@end table 9643 9644When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the 9645closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely 9646identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single 9647source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with 9648@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately, 9649you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when 9650it prints a symbolic address: 9651 9652@table @code 9653@item set print symbol-filename on 9654@cindex source file and line of a symbol 9655@cindex symbol, source file and line 9656Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a 9657symbol in the symbolic form of an address. 9658 9659@item set print symbol-filename off 9660Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the 9661default. 9662 9663@item show print symbol-filename 9664Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and 9665line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address. 9666@end table 9667 9668Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line 9669numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line 9670number and source file that corresponds to each instruction. 9671 9672Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being 9673printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol: 9674 9675@table @code 9676@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset} 9677@itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited 9678@cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol 9679Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the 9680offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than 9681@var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN} 9682to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes 9683it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}. 9684 9685@item show print max-symbolic-offset 9686Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a 9687symbolic address. 9688@end table 9689 9690@cindex wild pointer, interpreting 9691@cindex pointer, finding referent 9692If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try 9693@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name 9694and source file location of the variable where it points, using 9695@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form. 9696For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points 9697at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}: 9698 9699@smallexample 9700(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on 9701(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt 9702$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c> 9703@end smallexample 9704 9705@quotation 9706@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a} 9707does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with 9708the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on. 9709@end quotation 9710 9711You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using 9712@samp{set print symbol on}: 9713 9714@table @code 9715@item set print symbol on 9716Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if 9717one exists. 9718 9719@item set print symbol off 9720Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an 9721address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol 9722corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default. 9723 9724@item show print symbol 9725Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an 9726address. 9727@end table 9728 9729Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed: 9730 9731@table @code 9732@item set print array 9733@itemx set print array on 9734@cindex pretty print arrays 9735Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read, 9736but uses more space. The default is off. 9737 9738@item set print array off 9739Return to compressed format for arrays. 9740 9741@item show print array 9742Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying 9743arrays. 9744 9745@cindex print array indexes 9746@item set print array-indexes 9747@itemx set print array-indexes on 9748Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more 9749convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the 9750index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off. 9751 9752@item set print array-indexes off 9753Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays. 9754 9755@item show print array-indexes 9756Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying 9757arrays. 9758 9759@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements} 9760@itemx set print elements unlimited 9761@cindex number of array elements to print 9762@cindex limit on number of printed array elements 9763Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print. 9764If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has 9765printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command. 9766This limit also applies to the display of strings. 9767When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200. 9768Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means 9769that the number of elements to print is unlimited. 9770 9771@item show print elements 9772Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print. 9773If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited. 9774 9775@item set print frame-arguments @var{value} 9776@kindex set print frame-arguments 9777@cindex printing frame argument values 9778@cindex print all frame argument values 9779@cindex print frame argument values for scalars only 9780@cindex do not print frame argument values 9781This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed 9782when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible 9783values are: 9784 9785@table @code 9786@item all 9787The values of all arguments are printed. 9788 9789@item scalars 9790Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more 9791complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced 9792by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where 9793only scalar arguments are shown: 9794 9795@smallexample 9796#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green) 9797 at frame-args.c:23 9798@end smallexample 9799 9800@item none 9801None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument 9802is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes: 9803 9804@smallexample 9805#1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{}) 9806 at frame-args.c:23 9807@end smallexample 9808@end table 9809 9810By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used 9811to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless 9812of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value 9813of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of 9814information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable. 9815Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because 9816the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive, 9817especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments} 9818to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation, 9819thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame. 9820 9821@item show print frame-arguments 9822Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame. 9823 9824@item set print raw frame-arguments on 9825Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form. 9826 9827@item set print raw frame-arguments off 9828Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer 9829for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}), 9830otherwise print the value in raw form. 9831This is the default. 9832 9833@item show print raw frame-arguments 9834Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form. 9835 9836@anchor{set print entry-values} 9837@item set print entry-values @var{value} 9838@kindex set print entry-values 9839Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases 9840@value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by 9841the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function 9842and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be 9843unavailable, but the entry value may still be known. 9844 9845The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older 9846@value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting 9847this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the 9848@code{no} setting. 9849 9850This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and 9851the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With 9852@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get 9853this information. 9854 9855The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following: 9856 9857@table @code 9858@item no 9859Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry 9860point. 9861@smallexample 9862#0 equal (val=5) 9863#0 different (val=6) 9864#0 lost (val=<optimized out>) 9865#0 born (val=10) 9866#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9867@end smallexample 9868 9869@item only 9870Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter 9871values are never printed. 9872@smallexample 9873#0 equal (val@@entry=5) 9874#0 different (val@@entry=5) 9875#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9876#0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9877#0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9878@end smallexample 9879 9880@item preferred 9881Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function 9882entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual 9883value for such parameter. 9884@smallexample 9885#0 equal (val@@entry=5) 9886#0 different (val@@entry=5) 9887#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9888#0 born (val=10) 9889#0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9890@end smallexample 9891 9892@item if-needed 9893Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while 9894value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such 9895parameter. 9896@smallexample 9897#0 equal (val=5) 9898#0 different (val=6) 9899#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9900#0 born (val=10) 9901#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9902@end smallexample 9903 9904@item both 9905Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry 9906point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler 9907optimizations. 9908@smallexample 9909#0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5) 9910#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5) 9911#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5) 9912#0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9913#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>) 9914@end smallexample 9915 9916@item compact 9917Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from 9918function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual 9919value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both 9920values are known and identical, print the shortened 9921@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation. 9922@smallexample 9923#0 equal (val=val@@entry=5) 9924#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5) 9925#0 lost (val@@entry=5) 9926#0 born (val=10) 9927#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9928@end smallexample 9929 9930@item default 9931Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function 9932entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and 9933if both values are known and identical, print the shortened 9934@code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation. 9935@smallexample 9936#0 equal (val=val@@entry=5) 9937#0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5) 9938#0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5) 9939#0 born (val=10) 9940#0 invalid (val=<optimized out>) 9941@end smallexample 9942@end table 9943 9944For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function 9945entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}. 9946 9947@item show print entry-values 9948Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function 9949entry. 9950 9951@item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats} 9952@itemx set print repeats unlimited 9953@cindex repeated array elements 9954Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array 9955elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an 9956array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string 9957@code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of 9958identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements 9959themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will 9960cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold 9961is 10. 9962 9963@item show print repeats 9964Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical 9965elements. 9966 9967@item set print null-stop 9968@cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays 9969Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first 9970@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually 9971contain only short strings. 9972The default is off. 9973 9974@item show print null-stop 9975Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first 9976@sc{null} character. 9977 9978@item set print pretty on 9979@cindex print structures in indented form 9980@cindex indentation in structure display 9981Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member 9982per line, like this: 9983 9984@smallexample 9985@group 9986$1 = @{ 9987 next = 0x0, 9988 flags = @{ 9989 sweet = 1, 9990 sour = 1 9991 @}, 9992 meat = 0x54 "Pork" 9993@} 9994@end group 9995@end smallexample 9996 9997@item set print pretty off 9998Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this: 9999 10000@smallexample 10001@group 10002$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \ 10003meat = 0x54 "Pork"@} 10004@end group 10005@end smallexample 10006 10007@noindent 10008This is the default format. 10009 10010@item show print pretty 10011Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures. 10012 10013@item set print sevenbit-strings on 10014@cindex eight-bit characters in strings 10015@cindex octal escapes in strings 10016Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set, 10017@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or 10018character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is 10019best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the 10020high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit. 10021 10022@item set print sevenbit-strings off 10023Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more 10024international character sets, and is the default. 10025 10026@item show print sevenbit-strings 10027Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters. 10028 10029@item set print union on 10030@cindex unions in structures, printing 10031Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures 10032and other unions. This is the default setting. 10033 10034@item set print union off 10035Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in 10036structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"} 10037instead. 10038 10039@item show print union 10040Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in 10041structures and other unions. 10042 10043For example, given the declarations 10044 10045@smallexample 10046typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species; 10047typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms; 10048typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@} 10049 Bug_forms; 10050 10051struct thing @{ 10052 Species it; 10053 union @{ 10054 Tree_forms tree; 10055 Bug_forms bug; 10056 @} form; 10057@}; 10058 10059struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@}; 10060@end smallexample 10061 10062@noindent 10063with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print 10064 10065@smallexample 10066$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@} 10067@end smallexample 10068 10069@noindent 10070and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print 10071 10072@smallexample 10073$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@} 10074@end smallexample 10075 10076@noindent 10077@code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages 10078and in Pascal. 10079@end table 10080 10081@need 1000 10082@noindent 10083These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs: 10084 10085@table @code 10086@cindex demangling C@t{++} names 10087@item set print demangle 10088@itemx set print demangle on 10089Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded 10090(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe 10091linkage. The default is on. 10092 10093@item show print demangle 10094Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form. 10095 10096@item set print asm-demangle 10097@itemx set print asm-demangle on 10098Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even 10099in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies. 10100The default is off. 10101 10102@item show print asm-demangle 10103Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled 10104or demangled form. 10105 10106@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style 10107@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++} 10108@kindex set demangle-style 10109@item set demangle-style @var{style} 10110Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to 10111represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently: 10112 10113@table @code 10114@item auto 10115Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program. 10116This is the default. 10117 10118@item gnu 10119Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm. 10120 10121@item hp 10122Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm. 10123 10124@item lucid 10125Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm. 10126 10127@item arm 10128Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}. 10129@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow 10130debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would 10131require further enhancement to permit that. 10132 10133@end table 10134If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats. 10135 10136@item show demangle-style 10137Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols. 10138 10139@item set print object 10140@itemx set print object on 10141@cindex derived type of an object, printing 10142@cindex display derived types 10143When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual} 10144(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using 10145the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is 10146required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time 10147type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared 10148type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when 10149working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}). 10150 10151@item set print object off 10152Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the 10153virtual function table. This is the default setting. 10154 10155@item show print object 10156Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed. 10157 10158@item set print static-members 10159@itemx set print static-members on 10160@cindex static members of C@t{++} objects 10161Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on. 10162 10163@item set print static-members off 10164Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. 10165 10166@item show print static-members 10167Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not. 10168 10169@item set print pascal_static-members 10170@itemx set print pascal_static-members on 10171@cindex static members of Pascal objects 10172@cindex Pascal objects, static members display 10173Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on. 10174 10175@item set print pascal_static-members off 10176Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object. 10177 10178@item show print pascal_static-members 10179Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not. 10180 10181@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet. 10182@item set print vtbl 10183@itemx set print vtbl on 10184@cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables 10185@cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display 10186@cindex VTBL display 10187Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off. 10188(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP 10189ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).) 10190 10191@item set print vtbl off 10192Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. 10193 10194@item show print vtbl 10195Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not. 10196@end table 10197 10198@node Pretty Printing 10199@section Pretty Printing 10200 10201@value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using 10202Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This 10203mechanism works for both MI and the CLI. 10204 10205@menu 10206* Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers 10207* Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer 10208* Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands 10209@end menu 10210 10211@node Pretty-Printer Introduction 10212@subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction 10213 10214When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer 10215registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the 10216pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally. 10217 10218Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage. 10219The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed 10220pretty-printers with their names. 10221If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its 10222@dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types. 10223Each such subprinter has its own name. 10224The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}. 10225 10226Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}. 10227Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding 10228debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to 10229do anything special. 10230 10231There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered. 10232 10233@itemize @bullet 10234@item 10235Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging 10236all inferiors. 10237 10238@item 10239Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only 10240when debugging that program. 10241@xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python. 10242 10243@item 10244Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded 10245with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library). 10246@xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python. 10247@end itemize 10248 10249@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how 10250pretty-printers are selected, 10251 10252@xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers 10253for new types. 10254 10255@node Pretty-Printer Example 10256@subsection Pretty-Printer Example 10257 10258Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer: 10259 10260@smallexample 10261(@value{GDBP}) print s 10262$1 = @{ 10263 static npos = 4294967295, 10264 _M_dataplus = @{ 10265 <std::allocator<char>> = @{ 10266 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{ 10267 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields> 10268 @}, 10269 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>, 10270 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider: 10271 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd" 10272 @} 10273@} 10274@end smallexample 10275 10276With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed: 10277 10278@smallexample 10279(@value{GDBP}) print s 10280$2 = "abcd" 10281@end smallexample 10282 10283@node Pretty-Printer Commands 10284@subsection Pretty-Printer Commands 10285@cindex pretty-printer commands 10286 10287@table @code 10288@kindex info pretty-printer 10289@item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 10290Print the list of installed pretty-printers. 10291This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such. 10292 10293@var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects 10294whose pretty-printers to list. 10295Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file 10296(@pxref{Progspaces In Python}), 10297and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}). 10298@xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN} 10299looks up a printer from these three objects. 10300 10301@var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers 10302to list. 10303 10304@kindex disable pretty-printer 10305@item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 10306Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}. 10307A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later. 10308 10309@kindex enable pretty-printer 10310@item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]] 10311Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}. 10312@end table 10313 10314Example: 10315 10316Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so 10317named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and 10318another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects, 10319@code{bar1} and @code{bar2}. 10320 10321@smallexample 10322(gdb) info pretty-printer 10323library1.so: 10324 foo 10325library2.so: 10326 bar 10327 bar1 10328 bar2 10329(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 10330library2.so: 10331 bar 10332 bar1 10333 bar2 10334(gdb) disable pretty-printer library1 103351 printer disabled 103362 of 3 printers enabled 10337(gdb) info pretty-printer 10338library1.so: 10339 foo [disabled] 10340library2.so: 10341 bar 10342 bar1 10343 bar2 10344(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1 103451 printer disabled 103461 of 3 printers enabled 10347(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 10348library1.so: 10349 foo [disabled] 10350library2.so: 10351 bar 10352 bar1 [disabled] 10353 bar2 10354(gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar 103551 printer disabled 103560 of 3 printers enabled 10357(gdb) info pretty-printer library2 10358library1.so: 10359 foo [disabled] 10360library2.so: 10361 bar [disabled] 10362 bar1 [disabled] 10363 bar2 10364@end smallexample 10365 10366Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled, 10367as can each individual subprinter. 10368 10369@node Value History 10370@section Value History 10371 10372@cindex value history 10373@cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN} 10374Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN} 10375@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions. 10376Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded 10377(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands). 10378When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded, 10379since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the 10380symbol table. 10381 10382@cindex @code{$} 10383@cindex @code{$$} 10384@cindex history number 10385The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can 10386refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one. 10387@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by 10388printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the 10389history number. 10390 10391To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's 10392history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to 10393remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in 10394the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that. 10395@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2} 10396is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to 10397@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}. 10398 10399For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and 10400want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type 10401 10402@smallexample 10403p *$ 10404@end smallexample 10405 10406If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points 10407to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this: 10408 10409@smallexample 10410p *$.next 10411@end smallexample 10412 10413@noindent 10414You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this 10415command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}. 10416 10417Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of 10418@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands: 10419 10420@smallexample 10421print x 10422set x=5 10423@end smallexample 10424 10425@noindent 10426then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command 10427remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed. 10428 10429@table @code 10430@kindex show values 10431@item show values 10432Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers. 10433This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show 10434values} does not change the history. 10435 10436@item show values @var{n} 10437Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}. 10438 10439@item show values + 10440Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more 10441values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display. 10442@end table 10443 10444Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the 10445same effect as @samp{show values +}. 10446 10447@node Convenience Vars 10448@section Convenience Variables 10449 10450@cindex convenience variables 10451@cindex user-defined variables 10452@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within 10453@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables 10454exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and 10455setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution 10456of your program. That is why you can use them freely. 10457 10458Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by 10459@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of 10460the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}). 10461(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded 10462by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.) 10463 10464You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment 10465expression, just as you would set a variable in your program. 10466For example: 10467 10468@smallexample 10469set $foo = *object_ptr 10470@end smallexample 10471 10472@noindent 10473would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by 10474@code{object_ptr}. 10475 10476Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its 10477value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the 10478value with another assignment at any time. 10479 10480Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience 10481variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if 10482that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience 10483variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value. 10484 10485@table @code 10486@kindex show convenience 10487@cindex show all user variables and functions 10488@item show convenience 10489Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values, 10490as well as a list of the convenience functions. 10491Abbreviated @code{show conv}. 10492 10493@kindex init-if-undefined 10494@cindex convenience variables, initializing 10495@item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression} 10496Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful 10497for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept, 10498to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that 10499convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to 10500override default values used in a command script. 10501 10502If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so 10503any side-effects do not occur. 10504@end table 10505 10506One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be 10507incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print 10508a field from successive elements of an array of structures: 10509 10510@smallexample 10511set $i = 0 10512print bar[$i++]->contents 10513@end smallexample 10514 10515@noindent 10516Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}. 10517 10518Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given 10519values likely to be useful. 10520 10521@table @code 10522@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable} 10523@item $_ 10524The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to 10525the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other 10526commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also 10527set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line} 10528and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *} 10529except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer 10530to the type of @code{$__}. 10531 10532@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable} 10533@item $__ 10534The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command 10535to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen 10536to match the format in which the data was printed. 10537 10538@item $_exitcode 10539@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable} 10540When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN} 10541automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and 10542resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}. 10543 10544@item $_exitsignal 10545@vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable} 10546When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal, 10547@value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number, 10548and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}. 10549 10550To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited 10551(i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e., 10552@code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function 10553@code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience 10554Functions}). For example, considering the following source code: 10555 10556@smallexample 10557#include <signal.h> 10558 10559int 10560main (int argc, char *argv[]) 10561@{ 10562 raise (SIGALRM); 10563 return 0; 10564@} 10565@end smallexample 10566 10567A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited 10568or signalled would be: 10569 10570@smallexample 10571(@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled 10572Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''. 10573End with a line saying just ``end''. 10574>if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal) 10575 >echo The program has exited\n 10576 >else 10577 >echo The program has signalled\n 10578 >end 10579>end 10580(@value{GDBP}) run 10581Starting program: 10582 10583Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock. 10584The program no longer exists. 10585(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled 10586The program has signalled 10587@end smallexample 10588 10589As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being 10590debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a 10591@code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called 10592@code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit: 10593 10594@smallexample 10595(@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled 10596The program has exited 10597@end smallexample 10598 10599@item $_exception 10600The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being 10601thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}. 10602 10603@item $_probe_argc 10604@itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11 10605Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}. 10606 10607@item $_sdata 10608@vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable} 10609The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint 10610data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that 10611@code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or 10612if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected. 10613 10614@item $_siginfo 10615@vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable} 10616The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information 10617(@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo} 10618could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals. 10619For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command. 10620 10621@item $_tlb 10622@vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable} 10623The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging 10624applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to 10625gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request. 10626@xref{General Query Packets}. 10627This variable contains the address of the thread information block. 10628 10629@item $_inferior 10630The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and 10631Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}. 10632 10633@item $_thread 10634The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}. 10635 10636@item $_gthread 10637The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}. 10638 10639@end table 10640 10641@node Convenience Funs 10642@section Convenience Functions 10643 10644@cindex convenience functions 10645@value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These 10646have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience 10647function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function; 10648however, a convenience function is implemented internally to 10649@value{GDBN}. 10650 10651These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with 10652@code{Python} support, which means that they are always available. 10653 10654@table @code 10655 10656@item $_isvoid (@var{expr}) 10657@findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function} 10658Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it 10659returns zero. 10660 10661A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result 10662is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable 10663(see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether 10664it is @code{void}: 10665 10666@smallexample 10667(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode 10668$1 = void 10669(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode) 10670$2 = 1 10671(@value{GDBP}) run 10672Starting program: ./a.out 10673[Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally] 10674(@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode 10675$3 = 0 10676(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode) 10677$4 = 0 10678@end smallexample 10679 10680In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether 10681@code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the 10682program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to 10683be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the 10684execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore 10685@code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void} 10686anymore. 10687 10688The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the 10689program being debugged. For example, given the following function: 10690 10691@smallexample 10692void 10693foo (void) 10694@{ 10695@} 10696@end smallexample 10697 10698The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}: 10699 10700@smallexample 10701(@value{GDBP}) print foo () 10702$1 = void 10703(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ()) 10704$2 = 1 10705(@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo () 10706(@value{GDBP}) print $v 10707$3 = void 10708(@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v) 10709$4 = 1 10710@end smallexample 10711 10712@end table 10713 10714These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with 10715@code{Python} support. 10716 10717@table @code 10718 10719@item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length}) 10720@findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function} 10721Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by 10722@var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal. 10723Otherwise it returns zero. 10724 10725@item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex}) 10726@findex $_regex@r{, convenience function} 10727Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression 10728@var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero. 10729The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s 10730regular expression support. 10731 10732@item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2}) 10733@findex $_streq@r{, convenience function} 10734Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal. 10735Otherwise it returns zero. 10736 10737@item $_strlen(@var{str}) 10738@findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function} 10739Returns the length of string @var{str}. 10740 10741@item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10742@findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function} 10743Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}. 10744Otherwise it returns zero. 10745 10746If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10747it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10748The default is 1. 10749 10750Example: 10751 10752@smallexample 10753(gdb) backtrace 10754#0 bottom_func () 10755 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21 10756#1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func () 10757 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27 10758#2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func () 10759 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33 10760#3 0x00000000004005b6 in main () 10761 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39 10762(gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func") 10763$1 = 1 10764(gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2) 10765$1 = 1 10766@end smallexample 10767 10768@item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10769@findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function} 10770Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression 10771@var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero. 10772 10773If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10774it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10775The default is 1. 10776 10777@item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10778@findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function} 10779Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}. 10780Otherwise it returns zero. 10781 10782If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10783it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10784The default is 1. 10785 10786This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function 10787checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified 10788by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the 10789frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}. 10790 10791@item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]}) 10792@findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function} 10793Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression 10794@var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero. 10795 10796If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided, 10797it is the number of frames up in the stack to look. 10798The default is 1. 10799 10800This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function 10801checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified 10802by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the 10803frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}. 10804 10805@item $_as_string(@var{value}) 10806@findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function} 10807Return the string representation of @var{value}. 10808 10809This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an 10810enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of 10811an enumerated type: 10812 10813@smallexample 10814(gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node) 10815Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER 10816@end smallexample 10817 10818@end table 10819 10820@value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on 10821convenience functions. 10822 10823@table @code 10824@item help function 10825@kindex help function 10826@cindex show all convenience functions 10827Print a list of all convenience functions. 10828@end table 10829 10830@node Registers 10831@section Registers 10832 10833@cindex registers 10834You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables 10835with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different 10836for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on 10837your machine. 10838 10839@table @code 10840@kindex info registers 10841@item info registers 10842Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point 10843and vector registers (in the selected stack frame). 10844 10845@kindex info all-registers 10846@cindex floating point registers 10847@item info all-registers 10848Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point 10849and vector registers (in the selected stack frame). 10850 10851@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{} 10852Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}. 10853As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to 10854the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on 10855the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}. 10856@end table 10857 10858@anchor{standard registers} 10859@cindex stack pointer register 10860@cindex program counter register 10861@cindex process status register 10862@cindex frame pointer register 10863@cindex standard registers 10864@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in 10865expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an 10866architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names 10867@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and 10868the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a 10869pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a 10870register that contains the processor status. For example, 10871you could print the program counter in hex with 10872 10873@smallexample 10874p/x $pc 10875@end smallexample 10876 10877@noindent 10878or print the instruction to be executed next with 10879 10880@smallexample 10881x/i $pc 10882@end smallexample 10883 10884@noindent 10885or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing 10886one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in 10887memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost 10888stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other 10889stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack, 10890regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return}; 10891see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with 10892 10893@smallexample 10894set $sp += 4 10895@end smallexample 10896 10897Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on 10898your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics, 10899so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command 10900shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info 10901registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you 10902can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps} 10903is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register. 10904 10905@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an 10906integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have 10907special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these 10908registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way 10909to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value 10910(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with 10911@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}). 10912 10913Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This 10914means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by 10915the operating system is not the same one that your program normally 10916sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point 10917coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C 10918programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such 10919cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format 10920that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command 10921prints the data in both formats. 10922 10923@cindex SSE registers (x86) 10924@cindex MMX registers (x86) 10925Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted 10926in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines 10927have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed 10928together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such 10929registers in @code{struct} notation: 10930 10931@smallexample 10932(@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1 10933$1 = @{ 10934 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@}, 10935 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@}, 10936 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000", 10937 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@}, 10938 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@}, 10939 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@}, 10940 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000 10941@} 10942@end smallexample 10943 10944@noindent 10945To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which 10946view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning 10947value to a @code{struct} member: 10948 10949@smallexample 10950 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF 10951@end smallexample 10952 10953Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame 10954(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the 10955value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in 10956were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the 10957true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost 10958frame (with @samp{frame 0}). 10959 10960@cindex caller-saved registers 10961@cindex call-clobbered registers 10962@cindex volatile registers 10963@cindex <not saved> values 10964Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the 10965callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile'' 10966registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know 10967the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer 10968frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee. 10969@value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved 10970(``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the 10971machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not 10972saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via 10973its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info 10974explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN} 10975displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets 10976that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention, 10977if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location 10978in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame. 10979This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered, 10980the caller either does not care what is in the register after the 10981call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note, 10982however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you 10983may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the 10984frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered 10985register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually 10986represent the value the register had just before the call. 10987 10988@node Floating Point Hardware 10989@section Floating Point Hardware 10990@cindex floating point 10991 10992Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give 10993you more information about the status of the floating point hardware. 10994 10995@table @code 10996@kindex info float 10997@item info float 10998Display hardware-dependent information about the floating 10999point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the 11000floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on 11001the ARM and x86 machines. 11002@end table 11003 11004@node Vector Unit 11005@section Vector Unit 11006@cindex vector unit 11007 11008Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you 11009more information about the status of the vector unit. 11010 11011@table @code 11012@kindex info vector 11013@item info vector 11014Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and 11015layout vary depending on the hardware. 11016@end table 11017 11018@node OS Information 11019@section Operating System Auxiliary Information 11020@cindex OS information 11021 11022@value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help 11023you debug your program. 11024 11025@cindex auxiliary vector 11026@cindex vector, auxiliary 11027Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at 11028startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you 11029specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of 11030binary values that tell system libraries important details about the 11031hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is 11032identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific. 11033Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities, 11034@value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote 11035targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's 11036support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see 11037@ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}. 11038 11039@table @code 11040@kindex info auxv 11041@item info auxv 11042Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a 11043live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value 11044numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized 11045tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some 11046pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the 11047most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for 11048an unrecognized tag. 11049@end table 11050 11051On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific 11052information and show it to you. The types of information available 11053will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the 11054target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in 11055@ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this 11056functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the 11057@samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}. 11058 11059@table @code 11060@kindex info os 11061@item info os @var{infotype} 11062 11063Display OS information of the requested type. 11064 11065On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid: 11066 11067@anchor{linux info os infotypes} 11068@table @code 11069@kindex info os cpus 11070@item cpus 11071Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints 11072the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture 11073different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives 11074CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during 11075kernel initialization. 11076 11077@kindex info os files 11078@item files 11079Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each 11080file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process 11081owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value 11082of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor. 11083 11084@kindex info os modules 11085@item modules 11086Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each 11087module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in 11088bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the 11089module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module 11090in memory. 11091 11092@kindex info os msg 11093@item msg 11094Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each 11095message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message 11096queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes 11097on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes 11098that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group 11099of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a 11100message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which 11101the message queue was last changed. 11102 11103@kindex info os processes 11104@item processes 11105Display the list of processes on the target. For each process, 11106@value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the 11107command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores 11108that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these 11109properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult 11110the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.) 11111 11112@kindex info os procgroups 11113@item procgroups 11114Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process, 11115@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs 11116to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process 11117identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted 11118first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier, 11119so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together 11120and the process group leader is listed first. 11121 11122@kindex info os semaphores 11123@item semaphores 11124Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each 11125semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore 11126set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the 11127set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set, 11128and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed. 11129 11130@kindex info os shm 11131@item shm 11132Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target. 11133For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key, 11134the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the 11135region, the process that created the region, the process that last 11136attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live 11137attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last 11138attached to, detach from, and changed. 11139 11140@kindex info os sockets 11141@item sockets 11142Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each 11143socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and 11144remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of 11145the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the 11146connection. 11147 11148@kindex info os threads 11149@item threads 11150Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread, 11151@value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread 11152belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the 11153processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a 11154process is not listed. 11155@end table 11156 11157@item info os 11158If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for 11159@var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each 11160@var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible 11161types, this command will report an error. 11162@end table 11163 11164@node Memory Region Attributes 11165@section Memory Region Attributes 11166@cindex memory region attributes 11167 11168@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling 11169required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses 11170attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory 11171accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache 11172target memory. By default the description of memory regions is 11173fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the 11174user can override the fetched regions. 11175 11176Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a 11177memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when 11178accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have 11179been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing 11180all memory. 11181 11182When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it; 11183to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number. 11184 11185@table @code 11186@kindex mem 11187@item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{} 11188Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with 11189attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions 11190monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special 11191case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address. 11192(0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.) 11193 11194@item mem auto 11195Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied 11196regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support. 11197 11198@kindex delete mem 11199@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{} 11200Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions 11201monitored by @value{GDBN}. 11202 11203@kindex disable mem 11204@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{} 11205Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}. 11206A disabled memory region is not forgotten. 11207It may be enabled again later. 11208 11209@kindex enable mem 11210@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{} 11211Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}. 11212 11213@kindex info mem 11214@item info mem 11215Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns 11216for each region: 11217 11218@table @emph 11219@item Memory Region Number 11220@item Enabled or Disabled. 11221Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}. 11222Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}. 11223 11224@item Lo Address 11225The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region. 11226 11227@item Hi Address 11228The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region. 11229 11230@item Attributes 11231The list of attributes set for this memory region. 11232@end table 11233@end table 11234 11235 11236@subsection Attributes 11237 11238@subsubsection Memory Access Mode 11239The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or 11240write accesses to a memory region. 11241 11242While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid 11243memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA, 11244etc.@: from accessing memory. 11245 11246@table @code 11247@item ro 11248Memory is read only. 11249@item wo 11250Memory is write only. 11251@item rw 11252Memory is read/write. This is the default. 11253@end table 11254 11255@subsubsection Memory Access Size 11256The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized 11257accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers 11258require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is 11259specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size. 11260 11261@table @code 11262@item 8 11263Use 8 bit memory accesses. 11264@item 16 11265Use 16 bit memory accesses. 11266@item 32 11267Use 32 bit memory accesses. 11268@item 64 11269Use 64 bit memory accesses. 11270@end table 11271 11272@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints 11273@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN} 11274@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints 11275@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands. 11276@c 11277@c @table @code 11278@c @item hwbreak 11279@c Always use hardware breakpoints 11280@c @item swbreak (default) 11281@c @end table 11282 11283@subsubsection Data Cache 11284The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target 11285memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug 11286protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN} 11287does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device 11288registers. 11289 11290@table @code 11291@item cache 11292Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory. 11293@item nocache 11294Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default. 11295@end table 11296 11297@subsection Memory Access Checking 11298@value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is 11299not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such 11300regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide 11301better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour. 11302 11303@table @code 11304@kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default 11305@item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off] 11306If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not 11307explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses 11308to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one 11309memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN} 11310treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM. 11311The default value is @code{on}. 11312@kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default 11313@item show mem inaccessible-by-default 11314Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory. 11315@end table 11316 11317 11318@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification 11319@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN} 11320@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful. 11321@c 11322@c @table @code 11323@c @item verify 11324@c @item noverify (default) 11325@c @end table 11326 11327@node Dump/Restore Files 11328@section Copy Between Memory and a File 11329@cindex dump/restore files 11330@cindex append data to a file 11331@cindex dump data to a file 11332@cindex restore data from a file 11333 11334You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and 11335@code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The 11336@code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the 11337@code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's 11338memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, 11339Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only 11340append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files. 11341 11342@table @code 11343 11344@kindex dump 11345@item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr} 11346@itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr} 11347Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr}, 11348or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format. 11349 11350The @var{format} parameter may be any one of: 11351@table @code 11352@item binary 11353Raw binary form. 11354@item ihex 11355Intel hex format. 11356@item srec 11357Motorola S-record format. 11358@item tekhex 11359Tektronix Hex format. 11360@item verilog 11361Verilog Hex format. 11362@end table 11363 11364@value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the 11365@sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If 11366@var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary 11367form. 11368 11369@kindex append 11370@item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr} 11371@itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr} 11372Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr}, 11373or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form. 11374(@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.) 11375 11376@kindex restore 11377@item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end} 11378Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The 11379@code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd} 11380file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you 11381must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename. 11382 11383If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses 11384contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so 11385they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have 11386a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias} 11387from that location. 11388 11389If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between 11390file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored. 11391These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before 11392the @var{bias} argument is applied. 11393 11394@end table 11395 11396@node Core File Generation 11397@section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program 11398@cindex dump core from inferior 11399 11400A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory 11401image of a running process and its process status (register values 11402etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that 11403crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes 11404automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by 11405the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in 11406the post-mortem debugging mode. 11407 11408Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you 11409are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state. 11410@value{GDBN} has a special command for that. 11411 11412@table @code 11413@kindex gcore 11414@kindex generate-core-file 11415@item generate-core-file [@var{file}] 11416@itemx gcore [@var{file}] 11417Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument 11418@var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not 11419specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where 11420@var{pid} is the inferior process ID. 11421 11422Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of 11423this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390). 11424 11425On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the 11426file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core 11427dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}). 11428 11429@kindex set use-coredump-filter 11430@anchor{set use-coredump-filter} 11431@item set use-coredump-filter on 11432@itemx set use-coredump-filter off 11433Enable or disable the use of the file 11434@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump 11435files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of 11436memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump 11437file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. 11438 11439To make use of this feature, you have to write in the 11440@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal, 11441which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit 11442is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding 11443types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This 11444configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information 11445about the bits that can be set in the 11446@file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the 11447manpage of @code{core(5)}. 11448 11449By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned 11450@code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file 11451and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order 11452to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This 11453value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0} 11454(anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings), 11455@code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active. 11456This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically. 11457@end table 11458 11459@node Character Sets 11460@section Character Sets 11461@cindex character sets 11462@cindex charset 11463@cindex translating between character sets 11464@cindex host character set 11465@cindex target character set 11466 11467If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to 11468represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself, 11469@value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for 11470you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host 11471character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the 11472@dfn{target character set}. 11473 11474For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which 11475uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s 11476remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program 11477running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set, 11478then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is 11479@sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set 11480target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between 11481@sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use 11482character and string literals in expressions. 11483 11484@value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set 11485the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set 11486target-charset} command, described below. 11487 11488Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set 11489support: 11490 11491@table @code 11492@item set target-charset @var{charset} 11493@kindex set target-charset 11494Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the 11495list of supported target character sets, type 11496@kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}. 11497 11498@item set host-charset @var{charset} 11499@kindex set host-charset 11500Set the current host character set to @var{charset}. 11501 11502By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the 11503system it is running on; you can override that default using the 11504@code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot 11505automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this 11506case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}. 11507 11508@value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character 11509set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}, 11510@value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports. 11511 11512@item set charset @var{charset} 11513@kindex set charset 11514Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As 11515above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}, 11516@value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used 11517for both host and target. 11518 11519@item show charset 11520@kindex show charset 11521Show the names of the current host and target character sets. 11522 11523@item show host-charset 11524@kindex show host-charset 11525Show the name of the current host character set. 11526 11527@item show target-charset 11528@kindex show target-charset 11529Show the name of the current target character set. 11530 11531@item set target-wide-charset @var{charset} 11532@kindex set target-wide-charset 11533Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is 11534the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To 11535display the list of supported wide character sets, type 11536@kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}. 11537 11538@item show target-wide-charset 11539@kindex show target-wide-charset 11540Show the name of the current target's wide character set. 11541@end table 11542 11543Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action. 11544Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file 11545@file{charset-test.c}: 11546 11547@smallexample 11548#include <stdio.h> 11549 11550char ascii_hello[] 11551 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119, 11552 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@}; 11553char ibm1047_hello[] 11554 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166, 11555 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@}; 11556 11557main () 11558@{ 11559 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 11560@} 11561@end smallexample 11562 11563In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays 11564containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline, 11565encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets. 11566 11567We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it: 11568 11569@smallexample 11570$ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test 11571$ gdb -nw charset-test 11572GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs 11573Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 11574@dots{} 11575(@value{GDBP}) 11576@end smallexample 11577 11578We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets 11579@value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and 11580strings: 11581 11582@smallexample 11583(@value{GDBP}) show charset 11584The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'. 11585(@value{GDBP}) 11586@end smallexample 11587 11588For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our 11589initial character set: 11590@smallexample 11591(@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII 11592(@value{GDBP}) show charset 11593The current host and target character set is `ASCII'. 11594(@value{GDBP}) 11595@end smallexample 11596 11597Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our 11598host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints 11599characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display 11600them properly. Since our current target character set is also 11601@sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly: 11602 11603@smallexample 11604(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello 11605$1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n" 11606(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0] 11607$2 = 72 'H' 11608(@value{GDBP}) 11609@end smallexample 11610 11611@value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string 11612literals you use in expressions: 11613 11614@smallexample 11615(@value{GDBP}) print '+' 11616$3 = 43 '+' 11617(@value{GDBP}) 11618@end smallexample 11619 11620The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+} 11621character. 11622 11623@value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the 11624target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target 11625character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish: 11626 11627@smallexample 11628(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello 11629$4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%" 11630(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0] 11631$5 = 200 '\310' 11632(@value{GDBP}) 11633@end smallexample 11634 11635If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, 11636@value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports: 11637 11638@smallexample 11639(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset 11640ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1 11641(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset 11642@end smallexample 11643 11644We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the 11645program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but 11646@value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the 11647target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set, 11648@sc{ascii}, and they display correctly: 11649 11650@smallexample 11651(@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047 11652(@value{GDBP}) show charset 11653The current host character set is `ASCII'. 11654The current target character set is `IBM1047'. 11655(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello 11656$6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012" 11657(@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0] 11658$7 = 72 '\110' 11659(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello 11660$8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n" 11661(@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0] 11662$9 = 200 'H' 11663(@value{GDBP}) 11664@end smallexample 11665 11666As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and 11667string literals you use in expressions: 11668 11669@smallexample 11670(@value{GDBP}) print '+' 11671$10 = 78 '+' 11672(@value{GDBP}) 11673@end smallexample 11674 11675The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+} 11676character. 11677 11678@node Caching Target Data 11679@section Caching Data of Targets 11680@cindex caching data of targets 11681 11682@value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target. 11683Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior. 11684@xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space. 11685Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging 11686(@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the 11687remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. 11688Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results, 11689since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile 11690values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode 11691(@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command 11692is executing. 11693Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data 11694known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately 11695rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread 11696in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of 11697stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or 11698in the code segment. 11699Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as 11700cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}. 11701 11702@table @code 11703@kindex set remotecache 11704@item set remotecache on 11705@itemx set remotecache off 11706This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility 11707with old scripts. 11708 11709@kindex show remotecache 11710@item show remotecache 11711Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag. 11712 11713@kindex set stack-cache 11714@item set stack-cache on 11715@itemx set stack-cache off 11716Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use 11717caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. 11718 11719@kindex show stack-cache 11720@item show stack-cache 11721Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses. 11722 11723@kindex set code-cache 11724@item set code-cache on 11725@itemx set code-cache off 11726Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on}, 11727use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves 11728performance of disassembly in remote debugging. 11729 11730@kindex show code-cache 11731@item show code-cache 11732Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment 11733accesses. 11734 11735@kindex info dcache 11736@item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]} 11737Print the information about the performance of data cache of the 11738current inferior's address space. The information displayed 11739includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its 11740number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This 11741command is useful for debugging the data cache operation. 11742 11743If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be 11744printed in hex. 11745 11746@item set dcache size @var{size} 11747@cindex dcache size 11748@kindex set dcache size 11749Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above). 11750 11751@item set dcache line-size @var{line-size} 11752@cindex dcache line-size 11753@kindex set dcache line-size 11754Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above). 11755Must be a power of 2. 11756 11757@item show dcache size 11758@kindex show dcache size 11759Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}. 11760 11761@item show dcache line-size 11762@kindex show dcache line-size 11763Show default size of dcache lines. 11764 11765@end table 11766 11767@node Searching Memory 11768@section Search Memory 11769@cindex searching memory 11770 11771Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the 11772@code{find} command. 11773 11774@table @code 11775@kindex find 11776@item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]} 11777@itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]} 11778Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2}, 11779etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either 11780@var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive. 11781@end table 11782 11783@var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters. 11784They may be specified in either order, apart or together. 11785 11786@table @r 11787@item @var{s}, search query size 11788The size of each search query value. 11789 11790@table @code 11791@item b 11792bytes 11793@item h 11794halfwords (two bytes) 11795@item w 11796words (four bytes) 11797@item g 11798giant words (eight bytes) 11799@end table 11800 11801All values are interpreted in the current language. 11802This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++} 11803then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'. 11804 11805If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the 11806value's type in the current language. 11807This is useful when one wants to specify the search 11808pattern as a mixture of types. 11809Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages 11810a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42} 11811which is typically four bytes. 11812 11813@item @var{n}, maximum number of finds 11814The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds. 11815@end table 11816 11817You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes 11818 (@code{"}). 11819The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte, 11820regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification. 11821 11822The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the 11823number of matches found. 11824 11825The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable 11826@samp{$_}. 11827A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}. 11828 11829For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function: 11830 11831@smallexample 11832void 11833hello () 11834@{ 11835 static char hello[] = "hello-hello"; 11836 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @} 11837 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed 11838 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @}; 11839 printf ("%s\n", hello); 11840@} 11841@end smallexample 11842 11843@noindent 11844you get during debugging: 11845 11846@smallexample 11847(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello" 118480x804956d <hello.1620+6> 118491 pattern found 11850(gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o' 118510x8049567 <hello.1620> 118520x804956d <hello.1620+6> 118532 patterns found 11854(gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l' 118550x8049567 <hello.1620> 118561 pattern found 11857(gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321 118580x8049560 <mixed.1625> 118591 pattern found 11860(gdb) print $numfound 11861$1 = 1 11862(gdb) print $_ 11863$2 = (void *) 0x8049560 11864@end smallexample 11865 11866@node Value Sizes 11867@section Value Sizes 11868 11869Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within 11870@value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in 11871some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program 11872may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause 11873@value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory. 11874 11875@table @code 11876@kindex set max-value-size 11877@item set max-value-size @var{bytes} 11878@itemx set max-value-size unlimited 11879Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the 11880contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that 11881requires more memory than that will result in an error. 11882 11883Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been 11884allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations. 11885 11886There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in 11887order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is 11888currently 16 bytes. 11889 11890The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to 11891complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple 11892integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of 11893@var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand, 11894@value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where 11895@var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally 11896succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component 11897size is less than @var{bytes}. 11898 11899The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k. 11900 11901@kindex show max-value-size 11902@item show max-value-size 11903Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will 11904allocate for the contents of a value. 11905@end table 11906 11907@node Optimized Code 11908@chapter Debugging Optimized Code 11909@cindex optimized code, debugging 11910@cindex debugging optimized code 11911 11912Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization 11913disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds 11914directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler 11915applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code 11916diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging 11917information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from 11918the running program back to constructs from your original source. 11919 11920@value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you 11921can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the 11922progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases 11923where you may need to debug an optimized version. 11924 11925When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the 11926optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is 11927really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not 11928exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a 11929variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that 11930variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence. 11931 11932Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just 11933@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in 11934doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem, 11935please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!). 11936@xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code. 11937 11938@menu 11939* Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining 11940* Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions 11941@end menu 11942 11943@node Inline Functions 11944@section Inline Functions 11945@cindex inline functions, debugging 11946 11947@dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function 11948body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared 11949routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like 11950non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their 11951arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip 11952them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}. 11953You can check whether a function was inlined by using the 11954@code{info frame} command. 11955 11956For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must 11957record information about inlining in the debug information --- 11958@value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several 11959other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions 11960when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1 11961do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and 11962@samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined 11963function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead 11964displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as 11965local variables in the caller. 11966 11967The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site; 11968unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to 11969the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the 11970start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to 11971the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows 11972the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional 11973instructions are executed. 11974 11975This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the 11976context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by 11977a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do 11978this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body. 11979 11980There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined 11981function calls are the same as normal calls: 11982 11983@itemize @bullet 11984@item 11985Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not 11986work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN} 11987may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing 11988function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future 11989version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line 11990or inside the inlined function instead. 11991 11992@item 11993@value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after 11994using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated 11995debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line 11996and print a variable where your program stored the return value. 11997 11998@end itemize 11999 12000@node Tail Call Frames 12001@section Tail Call Frames 12002@cindex tail call frames, debugging 12003 12004Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In 12005unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return 12006instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the 12007call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C} 12008instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}. 12009 12010During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the 12011function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function 12012@code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C}, 12013then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in 12014some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from 12015@code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the 12016return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally. 12017 12018This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and 12019the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With 12020@value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get 12021this information. 12022 12023@kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame 12024kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output: 12025 12026@smallexample 12027(gdb) x/i $pc - 2 12028 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)> 12029(gdb) info frame 12030Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30: 12031 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5 12032 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30 12033 source language c++. 12034 Arglist at unknown address. 12035 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30 12036@end smallexample 12037 12038The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous. 12039There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never 12040used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known 12041callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still 12042tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the 12043unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any. 12044 12045@table @code 12046@anchor{set debug entry-values} 12047@item set debug entry-values 12048@kindex set debug entry-values 12049When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument 12050values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid 12051tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection 12052of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path 12053result. 12054 12055@item show debug entry-values 12056@kindex show debug entry-values 12057Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument 12058values at function entry and tail calls. 12059@end table 12060 12061The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail 12062call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect 12063reference by variable @code{x}): 12064 12065@smallexample 12066static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void); 12067void (*x) (void) = c; 12068static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @} 12069static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @} 12070int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @} 12071 12072Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find 12073DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main 12074a () at t.c:3 120753 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @} 12076(gdb) bt 12077#0 a () at t.c:3 12078#1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5 12079@end smallexample 12080 12081Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution: 12082 12083@smallexample 12084int i; 12085static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @} 12086static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @} 12087static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @} 12088static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @} 12089static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void) 12090@{ if (i) c (); else e (); @} 12091static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @} 12092int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @} 12093 12094tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d) 12095tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e) 12096tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) | 12097(gdb) bt 12098#0 f () at t.c:2 12099#1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8 12100#2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9 12101@end smallexample 12102 12103@set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f} 12104@set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f} 12105 12106@c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK. 12107@ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK 12108@set ARROW @click{} 12109@set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}} 12110@set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}} 12111@end ifset 12112@ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK 12113@set ARROW -> 12114@set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A} 12115@set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A} 12116@end ifclear 12117 12118Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame. 12119The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or 12120@value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state. 12121 12122@code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN} 12123has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is 12124prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is 12125printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many 12126futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain 12127any non-ambiguous sequence entries. 12128 12129For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible 12130@code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is 12131also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a}, 12132therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are 12133omitted. 12134 12135There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function 12136entry may fail: 12137 12138@smallexample 12139int v; 12140static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @} 12141static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i); 12142static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @} 12143static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i) 12144@{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @} 12145int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @} 12146 12147(gdb) bt 12148#0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2 12149#1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found 12150function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls 12151i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6 12152#2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7 12153@end smallexample 12154 12155@value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did 12156function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be 12157tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore 12158@value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN} 12159prints @code{<optimized out>} instead. 12160 12161@node Macros 12162@chapter C Preprocessor Macros 12163 12164Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke 12165``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens. 12166@value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show 12167the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including 12168where it was defined. 12169 12170You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN} 12171with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not 12172include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile 12173with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}. 12174 12175A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later, 12176and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different 12177points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have 12178no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN} 12179uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise, 12180@value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location; 12181see @ref{List}. 12182 12183Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any 12184macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides 12185the following commands for working with macros explicitly. 12186 12187@table @code 12188 12189@kindex macro expand 12190@cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor 12191@cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of 12192@cindex expanding preprocessor macros 12193@item macro expand @var{expression} 12194@itemx macro exp @var{expression} 12195Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in 12196@var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does 12197not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; 12198it can be any string of tokens. 12199 12200@kindex macro exp1 12201@item macro expand-once @var{expression} 12202@itemx macro exp1 @var{expression} 12203@cindex expand macro once 12204@i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of 12205expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in 12206@var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are 12207left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a 12208particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further 12209expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not 12210parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it 12211can be any string of tokens. 12212 12213@kindex info macro 12214@cindex macro definition, showing 12215@cindex definition of a macro, showing 12216@cindex macros, from debug info 12217@item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro} 12218Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro}, 12219and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that 12220definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of 12221argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where 12222the macro may begin with a hyphen. 12223 12224@kindex info macros 12225@item info macros @var{location} 12226Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified 12227by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler 12228command-line where those definitions were established. 12229 12230@kindex macro define 12231@cindex user-defined macros 12232@cindex defining macros interactively 12233@cindex macros, user-defined 12234@item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list} 12235@itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list} 12236Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, 12237invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in 12238@var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an 12239``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form 12240defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in 12241@var{arglist}. 12242 12243A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every 12244expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the 12245@code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides 12246all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, 12247as well as any previous user-supplied definition. 12248 12249@kindex macro undef 12250@item macro undef @var{macro} 12251Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}. 12252This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro 12253define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present 12254in the program being debugged. 12255 12256@kindex macro list 12257@item macro list 12258List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command. 12259@end table 12260 12261@cindex macros, example of debugging with 12262Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we 12263show our source files: 12264 12265@smallexample 12266$ cat sample.c 12267#include <stdio.h> 12268#include "sample.h" 12269 12270#define M 42 12271#define ADD(x) (M + x) 12272 12273main () 12274@{ 12275#define N 28 12276 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 12277#undef N 12278 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 12279#define N 1729 12280 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n"); 12281@} 12282$ cat sample.h 12283#define Q < 12284$ 12285@end smallexample 12286 12287Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, 12288@value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the 12289minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3} 12290and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent 12291version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler 12292includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging 12293information. 12294 12295@smallexample 12296$ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample 12297$ 12298@end smallexample 12299 12300Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program: 12301 12302@smallexample 12303$ gdb -nw sample 12304GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs 12305Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 12306GDB is free software, @dots{} 12307(@value{GDBP}) 12308@end smallexample 12309 12310We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the 12311program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position 12312to decide which macro definitions are in scope: 12313 12314@smallexample 12315(@value{GDBP}) list main 123163 123174 #define M 42 123185 #define ADD(x) (M + x) 123196 123207 main () 123218 @{ 123229 #define N 28 1232310 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 1232411 #undef N 1232512 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 12326(@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD 12327Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5 12328#define ADD(x) (M + x) 12329(@value{GDBP}) info macro Q 12330Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1 12331 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2 12332#define Q < 12333(@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1) 12334expands to: (42 + 1) 12335(@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1) 12336expands to: once (M + 1) 12337(@value{GDBP}) 12338@end smallexample 12339 12340In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only 12341the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of 12342@code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M}, 12343which was introduced by @code{ADD}. 12344 12345Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in 12346force at the source line of the current stack frame: 12347 12348@smallexample 12349(@value{GDBP}) break main 12350Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10. 12351(@value{GDBP}) run 12352Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample 12353 12354Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10 1235510 printf ("Hello, world!\n"); 12356(@value{GDBP}) 12357@end smallexample 12358 12359At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force: 12360 12361@smallexample 12362(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 12363Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9 12364#define N 28 12365(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M 12366expands to: 28 < 42 12367(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M 12368$1 = 1 12369(@value{GDBP}) 12370@end smallexample 12371 12372As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then 12373give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack 12374thereof) in force at each point: 12375 12376@smallexample 12377(@value{GDBP}) next 12378Hello, world! 1237912 printf ("We're so creative.\n"); 12380(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 12381The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro 12382at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12 12383(@value{GDBP}) next 12384We're so creative. 1238514 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n"); 12386(@value{GDBP}) info macro N 12387Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13 12388#define N 1729 12389(@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M 12390expands to: 1729 < 42 12391(@value{GDBP}) print N Q M 12392$2 = 0 12393(@value{GDBP}) 12394@end smallexample 12395 12396In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command 12397line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in 12398such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero 12399of the source file submitted to the compiler. 12400 12401@smallexample 12402(@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__ 12403Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0 12404-D__STDC__=1 12405(@value{GDBP}) 12406@end smallexample 12407 12408 12409@node Tracepoints 12410@chapter Tracepoints 12411@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael 12412@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni. 12413 12414@cindex tracepoints 12415In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt 12416the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn 12417anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness 12418depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger 12419might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps 12420fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able 12421to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it. 12422 12423Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can 12424specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and 12425arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached. 12426Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values 12427those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The 12428expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays, 12429for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting 12430a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were 12431in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these 12432values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and 12433unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior. 12434 12435The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote 12436targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know 12437how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the 12438remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} 12439support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote 12440packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint 12441Packets}. 12442 12443It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent 12444of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search 12445through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details. 12446 12447This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features. 12448 12449@menu 12450* Set Tracepoints:: 12451* Analyze Collected Data:: 12452* Tracepoint Variables:: 12453* Trace Files:: 12454@end menu 12455 12456@node Set Tracepoints 12457@section Commands to Set Tracepoints 12458 12459Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of 12460tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of 12461breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using 12462standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints, 12463tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many 12464of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number 12465as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on. 12466 12467For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set 12468of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when 12469it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers, 12470local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN} 12471commands to examine the values these data had at the time the 12472tracepoint was hit. 12473 12474Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on 12475tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN} 12476commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific 12477either. 12478 12479@cindex fast tracepoints 12480Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in 12481a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is 12482faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed. 12483 12484@cindex static tracepoints 12485@cindex markers, static tracepoints 12486@cindex probing markers, static tracepoints 12487Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning 12488that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location 12489in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static 12490tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of 12491instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in 12492the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or 12493address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate 12494investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s 12495support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation 12496points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level 12497tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of 12498@value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting 12499registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation 12500point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables. 12501The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an 12502instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a 12503static tracepoint marker. 12504 12505@code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems. 12506@xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}. 12507 12508This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated 12509conditions and actions. 12510 12511@menu 12512* Create and Delete Tracepoints:: 12513* Enable and Disable Tracepoints:: 12514* Tracepoint Passcounts:: 12515* Tracepoint Conditions:: 12516* Trace State Variables:: 12517* Tracepoint Actions:: 12518* Listing Tracepoints:: 12519* Listing Static Tracepoint Markers:: 12520* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments:: 12521* Tracepoint Restrictions:: 12522@end menu 12523 12524@node Create and Delete Tracepoints 12525@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints 12526 12527@table @code 12528@cindex set tracepoint 12529@kindex trace 12530@item trace @var{location} 12531The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command. 12532Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location. 12533@xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, 12534which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop, 12535collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint 12536or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub 12537supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint 12538in tracing}). 12539If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all 12540these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart} 12541command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will 12542not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition, 12543@value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose 12544address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.) 12545Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed 12546until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires 12547@value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and 12548@value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected 12549tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to 12550the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected. 12551 12552Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command: 12553 12554@smallexample 12555(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number 12556 12557(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward 12558 12559(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function 12560 12561(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function 12562 12563(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address 12564@end smallexample 12565 12566@noindent 12567You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}. 12568 12569@item trace @var{location} if @var{cond} 12570Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression 12571@var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only 12572if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true. 12573@xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more 12574information on tracepoint conditions. 12575 12576@item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ] 12577@cindex set fast tracepoint 12578@cindex fast tracepoints, setting 12579@kindex ftrace 12580The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that 12581support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly 12582less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump 12583instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It 12584may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired 12585location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory 12586message. 12587 12588@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for 12589@code{trace}. 12590 12591On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to 12592be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be 12593placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target 12594program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems, 12595such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's 12596address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible 12597to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command 12598to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in 12599 12600@example 12601sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768 12602@end example 12603 12604@noindent 12605which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for 12606trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary. 12607 12608@item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ] 12609@cindex set static tracepoint 12610@cindex static tracepoints, setting 12611@cindex probe static tracepoint marker 12612@kindex strace 12613The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that 12614support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static 12615instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not 12616be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in 12617which case the command will exit with an explanatory message. 12618 12619@value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for 12620@code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify 12621@code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker 12622identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier 12623depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is 12624using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field 12625of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output. 12626@xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint 12627Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST 12628tracing engine: 12629 12630@smallexample 12631main () 12632@{ 12633 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ"); 12634@} 12635@end smallexample 12636 12637@noindent 12638the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the 12639@code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to: 12640 12641@smallexample 12642(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers 12643Cnt Enb ID Address What 126441 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22 12645 Data: "str %s" 12646[etc...] 12647@end smallexample 12648 12649@noindent 12650so you may probe the marker above with: 12651 12652@smallexample 12653(@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33 12654@end smallexample 12655 12656Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect 12657$_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point 12658call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see 12659that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format 12660string. The user data is then the result of running that formating 12661string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info 12662static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in 12663the @samp{Data:} field. 12664 12665You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing 12666the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to 12667@value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. 12668 12669@vindex $tpnum 12670@cindex last tracepoint number 12671@cindex recent tracepoint number 12672@cindex tracepoint number 12673The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number 12674of the most recently set tracepoint. 12675 12676@kindex delete tracepoint 12677@cindex tracepoint deletion 12678@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12679Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the 12680default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular 12681@code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also. 12682 12683Examples: 12684 12685@smallexample 12686(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints 12687 12688(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints 12689@end smallexample 12690 12691@noindent 12692You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}. 12693@end table 12694 12695@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints 12696@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints 12697 12698These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}. 12699 12700@table @code 12701@kindex disable tracepoint 12702@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12703Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument 12704@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during 12705a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable 12706a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command. 12707If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target 12708has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the 12709change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the 12710next trace experiment. 12711 12712@kindex enable tracepoint 12713@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12714Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is 12715issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling 12716tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will 12717become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the 12718next time a trace experiment is run. 12719@end table 12720 12721@node Tracepoint Passcounts 12722@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts 12723 12724@table @code 12725@kindex passcount 12726@cindex tracepoint pass count 12727@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]} 12728Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to 12729automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is 12730@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on 12731the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number 12732@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the 12733passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is 12734given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the 12735user. 12736 12737Examples: 12738 12739@smallexample 12740(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of 12741@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2} 12742 12743(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the 12744@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.} 12745(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo} 12746(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3} 12747(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar} 12748(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2} 12749(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz} 12750(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been 12751@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has} 12752@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times} 12753@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.} 12754@end smallexample 12755@end table 12756 12757@node Tracepoint Conditions 12758@subsection Tracepoint Conditions 12759@cindex conditional tracepoints 12760@cindex tracepoint conditions 12761 12762The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program 12763reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for 12764a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your 12765programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A 12766tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your 12767program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition 12768is true. 12769 12770Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by 12771using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command. 12772@xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can 12773also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command, 12774just as with breakpoints. 12775 12776Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate 12777the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the 12778expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) 12779suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}. 12780Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack 12781accesses, and so forth. 12782 12783For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called 12784frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You 12785could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls 12786of that function that happen while the error code is propagating 12787through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up 12788collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to 12789search through. 12790 12791@smallexample 12792(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0} 12793@end smallexample 12794 12795@node Trace State Variables 12796@subsection Trace State Variables 12797@cindex trace state variables 12798 12799A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is 12800created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as 12801that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''), 12802but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly, 12803using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed 12804integers. 12805 12806Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded 12807to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace 12808experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of 12809trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target. 12810 12811@cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables 12812Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use 12813them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience 12814variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target 12815while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share 12816the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you 12817cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or 12818@code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience 12819variable with the same name. 12820 12821@table @code 12822 12823@item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ] 12824@kindex tvariable 12825The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named 12826@code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of 12827@var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is 12828entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible, 12829otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent 12830@code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a 12831variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the 12832existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial 12833value. The default initial value is 0. 12834 12835@item info tvariables 12836@kindex info tvariables 12837List all the trace state variables along with their initial values. 12838Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is 12839currently running. 12840 12841@item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]} 12842@kindex delete tvariable 12843Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments 12844are specified. 12845 12846@end table 12847 12848@node Tracepoint Actions 12849@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists 12850 12851@table @code 12852@kindex actions 12853@cindex tracepoint actions 12854@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]} 12855This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the 12856tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not 12857specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most 12858recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say 12859@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the 12860actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and 12861terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So 12862far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and 12863@code{while-stepping}. 12864 12865@code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break 12866Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined 12867actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected. 12868 12869@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint 12870To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}} 12871and follow it immediately with @samp{end}. 12872 12873@smallexample 12874(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data 12875 12876(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data 12877 12878(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions. 12879@end smallexample 12880 12881In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect} 12882commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is 12883hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data 12884following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used, 12885followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a 12886sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is 12887terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action 12888list is terminated by an @code{end} command. 12889 12890@smallexample 12891(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo} 12892(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 12893Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line: 12894> collect bar,baz 12895> collect $regs 12896> while-stepping 12 12897 > collect $pc, arr[i] 12898 > end 12899end 12900@end smallexample 12901 12902@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)} 12903@item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 12904Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. 12905This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions. 12906In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following 12907special arguments are supported: 12908 12909@table @code 12910@item $regs 12911Collect all registers. 12912 12913@item $args 12914Collect all function arguments. 12915 12916@item $locals 12917Collect all local variables. 12918 12919@item $_ret 12920Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more 12921of a backtrace. 12922 12923@emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably 12924determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up 12925collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher 12926for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite. 12927When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is 12928found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it). 12929 12930@item $_probe_argc 12931Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the 12932tracepoint is located. 12933@xref{Static Probe Points}. 12934 12935@item $_probe_arg@var{n} 12936@var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument 12937from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located. 12938@xref{Static Probe Points}. 12939 12940@item $_sdata 12941@vindex $_sdata@r{, collect} 12942Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for 12943static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action 12944Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an 12945instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The 12946tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a 12947character string using the format provided by the programmer that 12948instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms. 12949Here's an example of a UST marker call: 12950 12951@smallexample 12952 const char master_name[] = "$your_name"; 12953 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name) 12954@end smallexample 12955 12956In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string 12957@samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can 12958inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to 12959@value{GDBN}. 12960@end table 12961 12962You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one 12963with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several 12964arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same. 12965 12966The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments. 12967@code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in 12968particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up 12969to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the 12970@code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal 12971number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance 12972@samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at 12973@samp{mystr}. 12974 12975The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is 12976particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect. 12977 12978@kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)} 12979@item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 12980Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This 12981command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results 12982are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace 12983state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those 12984values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect} 12985action were used. 12986 12987@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)} 12988@item while-stepping @var{n} 12989Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint, 12990collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping} 12991command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping 12992(followed by its own @code{end} command): 12993 12994@smallexample 12995> while-stepping 12 12996 > collect $regs, myglobal 12997 > end 12998> 12999@end smallexample 13000 13001@noindent 13002Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by 13003@code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if 13004you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or 13005@code{stepping}. 13006 13007@item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{} 13008@kindex set default-collect 13009@cindex default collection action 13010This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint 13011hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended 13012to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed 13013individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named 13014@code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a 13015local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location. 13016 13017@item show default-collect 13018@kindex show default-collect 13019Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each 13020tracepoint hit. 13021 13022@end table 13023 13024@node Listing Tracepoints 13025@subsection Listing Tracepoints 13026 13027@table @code 13028@kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 13029@kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]} 13030@cindex information about tracepoints 13031@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]} 13032Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't 13033specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the 13034tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for 13035@code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same 13036command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints. 13037 13038A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to 13039tracing: 13040 13041@itemize @bullet 13042@item 13043its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command 13044 13045@item 13046the state about installed on target of each location 13047@end itemize 13048 13049@smallexample 13050(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace} 13051Num Type Disp Enb Address What 130521 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7 13053 while-stepping 20 13054 collect globfoo, $regs 13055 end 13056 collect globfoo2 13057 end 13058 pass count 1200 130592 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE> 13060 collect $eip 130612.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35 13062 installed on target 130632.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35 13064 installed on target 130652.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint 130663 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29 13067 not installed on target 13068(@value{GDBP}) 13069@end smallexample 13070 13071@noindent 13072This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}. 13073@end table 13074 13075@node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers 13076@subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers 13077 13078@table @code 13079@kindex info static-tracepoint-markers 13080@cindex information about static tracepoint markers 13081@item info static-tracepoint-markers 13082Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the 13083program. 13084 13085For each marker, the following columns are printed: 13086 13087@table @emph 13088@item Count 13089An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a 13090stable identifier. 13091@item ID 13092The marker ID, as reported by the target. 13093@item Enabled or Disabled 13094Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks 13095that are not enabled. 13096@item Address 13097Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address. 13098@item What 13099Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line 13100number. If the debug information included in the program does not 13101allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column 13102will be left blank. 13103@end table 13104 13105@noindent 13106In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker: 13107 13108@table @emph 13109@item Data 13110User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the 13111UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the 13112marker call. 13113@item Static tracepoints probing the marker 13114The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker. 13115@end table 13116 13117@smallexample 13118(@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers 13119Cnt ID Enb Address What 131201 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25 13121 Data: number1 %d number2 %d 13122 Probed by static tracepoints: #2 131232 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24 13124 Data: str %s 13125(@value{GDBP}) 13126@end smallexample 13127@end table 13128 13129@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments 13130@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments 13131 13132@table @code 13133@kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ] 13134@cindex start a new trace experiment 13135@cindex collected data discarded 13136@item tstart 13137This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data. 13138It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the 13139trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments 13140are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace 13141experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are 13142especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context; 13143the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact 13144information, and so forth. 13145 13146@kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ] 13147@cindex stop a running trace experiment 13148@item tstop 13149This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are 13150supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is 13151useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for 13152instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and 13153needs to be stopped quickly. 13154 13155@strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop 13156automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached 13157(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full. 13158 13159@kindex tstatus 13160@cindex status of trace data collection 13161@cindex trace experiment, status of 13162@item tstatus 13163This command displays the status of the current trace data 13164collection. 13165@end table 13166 13167Here is an example of the commands we described so far: 13168 13169@smallexample 13170(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test} 13171(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 13172Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line. 13173> collect $regs,$locals,$args 13174> while-stepping 11 13175 > collect $regs 13176 > end 13177> end 13178(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart} 13179 [time passes @dots{}] 13180(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop} 13181@end smallexample 13182 13183@anchor{disconnected tracing} 13184@cindex disconnected tracing 13185You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if 13186@value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or 13187involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will 13188ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected 13189terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be 13190unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable 13191@code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should 13192continue running without @value{GDBN}. 13193 13194@table @code 13195@item set disconnected-tracing on 13196@itemx set disconnected-tracing off 13197@kindex set disconnected-tracing 13198Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN} 13199has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or 13200@code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no 13201matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful 13202for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network. 13203 13204@item show disconnected-tracing 13205@kindex show disconnected-tracing 13206Show the current choice for disconnected tracing. 13207 13208@end table 13209 13210When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not 13211still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the 13212meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running, 13213it will continue after reconnection. 13214 13215Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the 13216tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that 13217information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt 13218to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may 13219have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of 13220the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the 13221debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with 13222which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is 13223necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being 13224created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use. 13225 13226@cindex circular trace buffer 13227If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you 13228can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace 13229buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace 13230frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue 13231collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being 13232hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the 13233buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set 13234@samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time, 13235including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change 13236buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until 13237the next run. 13238 13239@table @code 13240@item set circular-trace-buffer on 13241@itemx set circular-trace-buffer off 13242@kindex set circular-trace-buffer 13243Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer 13244for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may 13245fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace 13246data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits. 13247 13248@item show circular-trace-buffer 13249@kindex show circular-trace-buffer 13250Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not 13251match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to 13252match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run, 13253for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file. 13254 13255@end table 13256 13257@table @code 13258@item set trace-buffer-size @var{n} 13259@itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited 13260@kindex set trace-buffer-size 13261Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all 13262targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for 13263the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of 13264@code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it 13265likes. This is also the default. 13266 13267@item show trace-buffer-size 13268@kindex show trace-buffer-size 13269Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this 13270will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting, 13271and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the 13272target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will 13273not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus} 13274to get a report of the actual buffer size. 13275@end table 13276 13277@table @code 13278@item set trace-user @var{text} 13279@kindex set trace-user 13280 13281@item show trace-user 13282@kindex show trace-user 13283 13284@item set trace-notes @var{text} 13285@kindex set trace-notes 13286Set the trace run's notes. 13287 13288@item show trace-notes 13289@kindex show trace-notes 13290Show the trace run's notes. 13291 13292@item set trace-stop-notes @var{text} 13293@kindex set trace-stop-notes 13294Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for 13295@code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a 13296stop note that is mistaken or incomplete. 13297 13298@item show trace-stop-notes 13299@kindex show trace-stop-notes 13300Show the trace run's stop notes. 13301 13302@end table 13303 13304@node Tracepoint Restrictions 13305@subsection Tracepoint Restrictions 13306 13307@cindex tracepoint restrictions 13308There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As 13309described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target 13310without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of 13311the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data 13312examination time, you will be limited by only having what was 13313collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it 13314is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not 13315mentioned here. 13316 13317@itemize @bullet 13318 13319@item 13320Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus 13321the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available. 13322You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access 13323convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace 13324state variables). Some language features may implicitly call 13325functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore 13326cannot be collected either. 13327 13328@item 13329Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with 13330@code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may 13331behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for 13332instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable 13333may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The 13334tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the 13335variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the 13336tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine 13337where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the 13338program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped. 13339 13340@item 13341Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object 13342may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays 13343in a misleading way. 13344 13345@item 13346When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically 13347dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string 13348being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does 13349not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly 13350dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to 13351collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example, 13352@code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to 13353by @code{ptr}. 13354 13355@item 13356It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a 13357tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred 13358bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300} 13359(adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your 13360target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture). 13361Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when 13362using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined 13363depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that 13364if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the 13365stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an 13366invalid address. 13367 13368@item 13369If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can 13370infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of 13371the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame 13372for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has 13373multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was 13374inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases 13375@value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default 13376it to zero. 13377 13378@end itemize 13379 13380@node Analyze Collected Data 13381@section Using the Collected Data 13382 13383After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands 13384for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint 13385collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another 13386snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are 13387consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can 13388examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a 13389specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace 13390snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and 13391registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot, 13392rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being 13393debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands 13394(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will 13395behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was 13396when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in 13397the buffer will fail. 13398 13399@menu 13400* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot 13401* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot 13402* save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run 13403@end menu 13404 13405@node tfind 13406@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}} 13407 13408@kindex tfind 13409@cindex select trace snapshot 13410@cindex find trace snapshot 13411The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is 13412@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n}, 13413counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next 13414snapshot is selected. 13415 13416Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command. 13417 13418@table @code 13419@item tfind start 13420Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for 13421@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot). 13422 13423@item tfind none 13424Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging. 13425 13426@item tfind end 13427Same as @samp{tfind none}. 13428 13429@item tfind 13430No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first 13431one if no trace snapshot is selected. 13432 13433@item tfind - 13434Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits 13435retracing earlier steps. 13436 13437@item tfind tracepoint @var{num} 13438Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search 13439proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no 13440argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected 13441for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot. 13442 13443@item tfind pc @var{addr} 13444Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the 13445program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace 13446snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next 13447snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot. 13448 13449@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2} 13450Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of 13451addresses (exclusive). 13452 13453@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2} 13454Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and 13455@var{addr2} (inclusive). 13456 13457@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n} 13458Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If 13459the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in 13460that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined 13461trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the 13462next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying 13463@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as 13464stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session. 13465@end table 13466 13467The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically 13468designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For 13469instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace 13470snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous 13471trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then 13472simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace 13473snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting 13474@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order. 13475The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot 13476for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with 13477no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter 13478(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with 13479no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same 13480tracepoint as the current one. 13481 13482In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually, 13483these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that 13484scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data 13485you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP 13486registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this: 13487 13488@smallexample 13489(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 13490(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)} 13491> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \ 13492 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp 13493> tfind 13494> end 13495 13496Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44 13497Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44 13498Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44 13499Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44 13500Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44 13501Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44 13502Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44 13503Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44 13504Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44 13505Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44 13506Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14 13507@end smallexample 13508 13509Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in 13510the buffer: 13511 13512@smallexample 13513(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 13514(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)} 13515> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X 13516> tfind line 13517> end 13518 13519Frame 0, X = 1 13520Frame 7, X = 2 13521Frame 13, X = 255 13522@end smallexample 13523 13524@node tdump 13525@subsection @code{tdump} 13526@kindex tdump 13527@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint 13528@cindex tracepoint data, display 13529 13530This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at 13531the current trace snapshot. 13532 13533@smallexample 13534(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444} 13535(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions} 13536Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line: 13537> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test 13538> end 13539 13540(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart} 13541 13542(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444} 13543#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66) 13544at gdb_test.c:444 13545444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", ) 13546 13547(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump} 13548Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1: 13549d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707 13550d1 0x18 24 13551d2 0x80 128 13552d3 0x33 51 13553d4 0x71aea3d 119204413 13554d5 0x22 34 13555d6 0xe0 224 13556d7 0x380035 3670069 13557a0 0x19e24a 1696330 13558a1 0x3000668 50333288 13559a2 0x100 256 13560a3 0x322000 3284992 13561a4 0x3000698 50333336 13562a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156 13563fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c 13564sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34 13565ps 0x0 0 13566pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8 13567fpcontrol 0x0 0 13568fpstatus 0x0 0 13569fpiaddr 0x0 0 13570p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test" 13571p1 = (void *) 0x11 13572p2 = (void *) 0x22 13573p3 = (void *) 0x33 13574p4 = (void *) 0x44 13575p5 = (void *) 0x55 13576p6 = (void *) 0x66 13577gdb_long_test = 17 '\021' 13578 13579(@value{GDBP}) 13580@end smallexample 13581 13582@code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection 13583actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So 13584@code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's 13585actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run. 13586 13587Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump} 13588uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace 13589frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were 13590collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether 13591to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the 13592body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected, 13593then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection 13594list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the 13595same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit. 13596@c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good. 13597 13598@node save tracepoints 13599@subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}} 13600@kindex save tracepoints 13601@kindex save-tracepoints 13602@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions 13603 13604This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with 13605their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}} 13606suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved 13607tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command 13608Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated 13609alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}} 13610 13611@node Tracepoint Variables 13612@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints 13613@cindex tracepoint variables 13614@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints 13615 13616@table @code 13617@vindex $trace_frame 13618@item (int) $trace_frame 13619The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no 13620snapshot is selected. 13621 13622@vindex $tracepoint 13623@item (int) $tracepoint 13624The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot. 13625 13626@vindex $trace_line 13627@item (int) $trace_line 13628The line number for the current trace snapshot. 13629 13630@vindex $trace_file 13631@item (char []) $trace_file 13632The source file for the current trace snapshot. 13633 13634@vindex $trace_func 13635@item (char []) $trace_func 13636The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}. 13637@end table 13638 13639Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf}, 13640use @code{output} instead. 13641 13642Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for 13643stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their 13644data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables, 13645which are managed by the target. 13646 13647@smallexample 13648(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start} 13649 13650(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1} 13651> output $trace_file 13652> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint 13653> tfind 13654> end 13655@end smallexample 13656 13657@node Trace Files 13658@section Using Trace Files 13659@cindex trace files 13660 13661In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no 13662longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed 13663for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to 13664dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source 13665of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command. 13666 13667@table @code 13668 13669@kindex tsave 13670@item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename} 13671@itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname} 13672Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command 13673assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if 13674necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and 13675then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the 13676optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save 13677the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be 13678more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that 13679@code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.) 13680By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format. 13681You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF 13682format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format 13683that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to 13684@indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information. 13685 13686@kindex target tfile 13687@kindex tfile 13688@kindex target ctf 13689@kindex ctf 13690@item target tfile @var{filename} 13691@itemx target ctf @var{dirname} 13692Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as 13693a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with 13694a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments. 13695@code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment 13696the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining. 13697Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to 13698the host. 13699 13700@smallexample 13701(@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf 13702(@value{GDBP}) tfind 13703Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2 1370439 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */ 13705(@value{GDBP}) tdump 13706Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0: 13707i = 0 13708a = 0 13709b = 1 '\001' 13710c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@} 13711d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@} 13712(@value{GDBP}) p b 13713$1 = 1 13714@end smallexample 13715 13716@end table 13717 13718@node Overlays 13719@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays 13720@cindex overlays 13721 13722If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's 13723memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this 13724problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that 13725use overlays. 13726 13727@menu 13728* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays. 13729* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}. 13730* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are 13731 mapped by asking the inferior. 13732* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays. 13733@end menu 13734 13735@node How Overlays Work 13736@section How Overlays Work 13737@cindex mapped overlays 13738@cindex unmapped overlays 13739@cindex load address, overlay's 13740@cindex mapped address 13741@cindex overlay area 13742 13743Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64 13744kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by 13745other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory 13746management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to 13747adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system. 13748 13749One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively 13750independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules 13751@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place 13752their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in 13753instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the 13754largest overlay as well. 13755 13756Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that 13757overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside 13758for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point 13759there. 13760 13761@c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the 13762@c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer 13763@c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size. 13764 13765@smallexample 13766@group 13767 Data Instruction Larger 13768Address Space Address Space Address Space 13769+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+ 13770| | | | | | 13771+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1 13772| program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address 13773| variables | | program | | +-----------+ 13774| and heap | | | | | | 13775+-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2 13776| | +-----------+ | | | load address 13777+-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 | 13778 | | | | | | 13779 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+ 13780 address | | | | | | 13781 | overlay | <-' | | | 13782 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3 13783 | | <---. | | load address 13784 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 | 13785 | | | | 13786 +-----------+ | | 13787 +-----------+ 13788 | | 13789 +-----------+ 13790 13791 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay 13792@end group 13793@end smallexample 13794 13795The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data 13796and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies 13797its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space. 13798Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one 13799may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for 13800data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the 13801program variables and heap would share an address space with the main 13802program and the overlay area. 13803 13804An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a 13805@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the 13806instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present) 13807in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address} 13808is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called 13809the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also 13810called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}. 13811 13812Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a 13813program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of 13814global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program: 13815 13816@itemize @bullet 13817 13818@item 13819Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program 13820must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or 13821return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong 13822overlay, and your program will probably crash. 13823 13824@item 13825If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you 13826will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on 13827your program's performance. 13828 13829@item 13830The executable file you load onto your system must contain each 13831overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its 13832mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated 13833and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address. 13834You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation 13835addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,, 13836ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}. 13837 13838@item 13839The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able 13840to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the 13841instruction and data spaces. 13842 13843@end itemize 13844 13845The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be 13846improved in many ways: 13847 13848@itemize @bullet 13849 13850@item 13851If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management 13852hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area 13853contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space. 13854This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped 13855area in the usual way. 13856 13857@item 13858If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one 13859overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time. 13860 13861@item 13862You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In 13863general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than 13864code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or 13865return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access 13866the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you 13867must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a 13868different data overlay into the same mapped area. 13869 13870@end itemize 13871 13872 13873@node Overlay Commands 13874@section Overlay Commands 13875 13876To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must 13877correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's 13878virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's 13879mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows 13880@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or 13881variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not. 13882 13883@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay}; 13884you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are: 13885 13886@table @code 13887@item overlay off 13888@kindex overlay 13889Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is 13890disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are 13891always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s 13892overlay support is disabled. 13893 13894@item overlay manual 13895@cindex manual overlay debugging 13896Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN} 13897relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not, 13898using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay} 13899commands described below. 13900 13901@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay} 13902@itemx overlay map @var{overlay} 13903@cindex map an overlay 13904Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must 13905be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an 13906overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's 13907functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes 13908that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of 13909@var{overlay} are now unmapped. 13910 13911@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay} 13912@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay} 13913@cindex unmap an overlay 13914Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay} 13915must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. 13916When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the 13917overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses. 13918 13919@item overlay auto 13920Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN} 13921consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior 13922to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic 13923Overlay Debugging}. 13924 13925@item overlay load-target 13926@itemx overlay load 13927@cindex reloading the overlay table 13928Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN} 13929re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior 13930stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the 13931overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only 13932useful when using automatic overlay debugging. 13933 13934@item overlay list-overlays 13935@itemx overlay list 13936@cindex listing mapped overlays 13937Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped 13938addresses, load addresses, and sizes. 13939 13940@end table 13941 13942Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name 13943of the function the address falls in: 13944 13945@smallexample 13946(@value{GDBP}) print main 13947$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main> 13948@end smallexample 13949@noindent 13950When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in 13951unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with 13952asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an 13953unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way: 13954 13955@smallexample 13956(@value{GDBP}) overlay list 13957No sections are mapped. 13958(@value{GDBP}) print foo 13959$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*> 13960@end smallexample 13961@noindent 13962When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's 13963name normally: 13964 13965@smallexample 13966(@value{GDBP}) overlay list 13967Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034, 13968 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a 13969(@value{GDBP}) print foo 13970$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo> 13971@end smallexample 13972 13973When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct 13974address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the 13975overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like 13976@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped 13977code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations: 13978 13979@itemize @bullet 13980@item 13981@cindex breakpoints in overlays 13982@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in 13983You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as 13984@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address. 13985@item 13986@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in 13987unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your 13988overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if 13989you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its 13990breakpoints properly. 13991@end itemize 13992 13993 13994@node Automatic Overlay Debugging 13995@section Automatic Overlay Debugging 13996@cindex automatic overlay debugging 13997 13998@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which 13999are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the 14000inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the 14001@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN} 14002looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the 14003current state of the overlays. 14004 14005Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support 14006@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging: 14007 14008@table @asis 14009 14010@item @code{_ovly_table}: 14011This variable must be an array of the following structures: 14012 14013@smallexample 14014struct 14015@{ 14016 /* The overlay's mapped address. */ 14017 unsigned long vma; 14018 14019 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */ 14020 unsigned long size; 14021 14022 /* The overlay's load address. */ 14023 unsigned long lma; 14024 14025 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped; 14026 zero otherwise. */ 14027 unsigned long mapped; 14028@} 14029@end smallexample 14030 14031@item @code{_novlys}: 14032This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total 14033number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}. 14034 14035@end table 14036 14037To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN} 14038looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and 14039@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the 14040executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults 14041the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is 14042currently mapped. 14043 14044In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called 14045@code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN} 14046will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then 14047calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this 14048will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays 14049are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set 14050in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the 14051overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they 14052are not being executed. 14053 14054@node Overlay Sample Program 14055@section Overlay Sample Program 14056@cindex overlay example program 14057 14058When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays 14059at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped 14060addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay 14061Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately, 14062since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target 14063architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide 14064portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. 14065 14066However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid 14067program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test 14068suite. The program consists of the following files from 14069@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}: 14070 14071@table @file 14072@item overlays.c 14073The main program file. 14074@item ovlymgr.c 14075A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}. 14076@item foo.c 14077@itemx bar.c 14078@itemx baz.c 14079@itemx grbx.c 14080Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}. 14081@item d10v.ld 14082@itemx m32r.ld 14083Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf} 14084and @code{m32r-elf} targets. 14085@end table 14086 14087You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC 14088cross-compiler like this: 14089 14090@smallexample 14091$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c 14092$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c 14093$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c 14094$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c 14095$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c 14096$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c 14097$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \ 14098 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays 14099@end smallexample 14100 14101The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that 14102you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the 14103target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}. 14104 14105 14106@node Languages 14107@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages 14108@cindex languages 14109 14110Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are 14111rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C, 14112dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in 14113Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be 14114represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as 14115@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}. 14116 14117@cindex working language 14118Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages, 14119allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's 14120native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner 14121consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The 14122language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working 14123language}. 14124 14125@menu 14126* Setting:: Switching between source languages 14127* Show:: Displaying the language 14128* Checks:: Type and range checks 14129* Supported Languages:: Supported languages 14130* Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages 14131@end menu 14132 14133@node Setting 14134@section Switching Between Source Languages 14135 14136There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN} 14137set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the 14138@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN} 14139defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is 14140used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values 14141are printed, etc. 14142 14143In addition to the working language, every source file that 14144@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object 14145file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular 14146source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the 14147language from the name of the file. The language of a source file 14148controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can 14149show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to 14150set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can 14151set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, , 14152Displaying the Language}. 14153 14154This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such 14155as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in 14156another language. In that case, make the 14157program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way 14158@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original 14159program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code. 14160 14161@menu 14162* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages. 14163* Manually:: Setting the working language manually 14164* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language 14165@end menu 14166 14167@node Filenames 14168@subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages 14169 14170If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then 14171@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated. 14172 14173@table @file 14174@item .ada 14175@itemx .ads 14176@itemx .adb 14177@itemx .a 14178Ada source file. 14179 14180@item .c 14181C source file 14182 14183@item .C 14184@itemx .cc 14185@itemx .cp 14186@itemx .cpp 14187@itemx .cxx 14188@itemx .c++ 14189C@t{++} source file 14190 14191@item .d 14192D source file 14193 14194@item .m 14195Objective-C source file 14196 14197@item .f 14198@itemx .F 14199Fortran source file 14200 14201@item .mod 14202Modula-2 source file 14203 14204@item .s 14205@itemx .S 14206Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but 14207@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping. 14208@end table 14209 14210In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename 14211extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}. 14212 14213@node Manually 14214@subsection Setting the Working Language 14215 14216If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, 14217expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and 14218your program. 14219 14220@kindex set language 14221If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the 14222command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of 14223a language, such as 14224@code{c} or @code{modula-2}. 14225For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}. 14226 14227Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working 14228language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try 14229to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the 14230source language, when an expression is acceptable to both 14231languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current 14232source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a 14233command such as: 14234 14235@smallexample 14236print a = b + c 14237@end smallexample 14238 14239@noindent 14240might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add 14241@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result 14242printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare 14243@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value. 14244 14245@node Automatically 14246@subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language 14247 14248To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use 14249@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN} 14250then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a 14251frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the 14252working language to the language recorded for the function in that 14253frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function 14254or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that 14255does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is 14256not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning. 14257 14258This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written 14259entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries 14260written in one source language can be used by a main program written in 14261a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this 14262case frees you from having to set the working language manually. 14263 14264@node Show 14265@section Displaying the Language 14266 14267The following commands help you find out which language is the 14268working language, and also what language source files were written in. 14269 14270@table @code 14271@item show language 14272@anchor{show language} 14273@kindex show language 14274Display the current working language. This is the 14275language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to 14276build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program. 14277 14278@item info frame 14279@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language} 14280Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the 14281working language if you use an identifier from this frame. 14282@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other 14283information listed here. 14284 14285@item info source 14286@kindex info source@r{, show the source language} 14287Display the source language of this source file. 14288@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other 14289information listed here. 14290@end table 14291 14292In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions 14293not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated 14294with a language explicitly: 14295 14296@table @code 14297@item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language} 14298@kindex set extension-language 14299Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be 14300assumed as written in the source language @var{language}. 14301 14302@item info extensions 14303@kindex info extensions 14304List all the filename extensions and the associated languages. 14305@end table 14306 14307@node Checks 14308@section Type and Range Checking 14309 14310Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common 14311errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include 14312checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making 14313sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as 14314these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled 14315by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range 14316errors when your program is running. 14317 14318By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the 14319rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check 14320the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly 14321into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. 14322 14323@menu 14324* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking 14325* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking 14326@end menu 14327 14328@cindex type checking 14329@cindex checks, type 14330@node Type Checking 14331@subsection An Overview of Type Checking 14332 14333Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the 14334arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type, 14335otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch 14336errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example, 14337 14338@smallexample 14339int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @} 14340 14341(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0) 14342$1 = 2 14343@exdent but 14344(@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234) 14345Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance 14346@end smallexample 14347 14348The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant 14349@samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type. 14350 14351For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell 14352@value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or 14353to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression; 14354When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates 14355expressions like the second example above. 14356 14357Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons 14358related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression. 14359For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and 14360a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do 14361with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make 14362little sense to evaluate anyway. 14363 14364@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking: 14365 14366@kindex set check type 14367@kindex show check type 14368@table @code 14369@item set check type on 14370@itemx set check type off 14371Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in 14372evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a 14373message and aborts evaluation of the expression. 14374 14375@item show check type 14376Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN} 14377is enforcing strict type checking rules. 14378@end table 14379 14380@cindex range checking 14381@cindex checks, range 14382@node Range Checking 14383@subsection An Overview of Range Checking 14384 14385In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the 14386bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range 14387checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure 14388computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do 14389not exceed the bounds of the array. 14390 14391For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell 14392@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them, 14393always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue 14394warnings but evaluate the expression anyway. 14395 14396A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an 14397array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member 14398of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an 14399error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the 14400result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is 14401the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then 14402 14403@smallexample 14404@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s} 14405@end smallexample 14406 14407This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases 14408specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, , 14409Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages. 14410 14411@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker: 14412 14413@kindex set check range 14414@kindex show check range 14415@table @code 14416@item set check range auto 14417Set range checking on or off based on the current working language. 14418@xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for 14419each language. 14420 14421@item set check range on 14422@itemx set check range off 14423Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the 14424current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not 14425match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on, 14426then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted. 14427 14428@item set check range warn 14429Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error, 14430but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the 14431expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing 14432memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix 14433systems). 14434 14435@item show range 14436Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is 14437being set automatically by @value{GDBN}. 14438@end table 14439 14440@node Supported Languages 14441@section Supported Languages 14442 14443@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, 14444OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada. 14445@c This is false ... 14446Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the 14447language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators, 14448and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions, 14449,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported 14450language. 14451 14452The following sections detail to what degree each source language is 14453supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language 14454tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the 14455@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output 14456formats should look like for different languages. There are many good 14457books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a 14458language reference or tutorial. 14459 14460@menu 14461* C:: C and C@t{++} 14462* D:: D 14463* Go:: Go 14464* Objective-C:: Objective-C 14465* OpenCL C:: OpenCL C 14466* Fortran:: Fortran 14467* Pascal:: Pascal 14468* Rust:: Rust 14469* Modula-2:: Modula-2 14470* Ada:: Ada 14471@end menu 14472 14473@node C 14474@subsection C and C@t{++} 14475 14476@cindex C and C@t{++} 14477@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++} 14478 14479Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply 14480to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages 14481together. 14482 14483@cindex C@t{++} 14484@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler 14485@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++} 14486The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++} 14487compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code 14488effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported 14489C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++} 14490compiler (@code{aCC}). 14491 14492@menu 14493* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators 14494* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants 14495* C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions 14496* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++} 14497* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks 14498* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C 14499* Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++} 14500* Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format 14501@end menu 14502 14503@node C Operators 14504@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators 14505 14506@cindex C and C@t{++} operators 14507 14508Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 14509@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are 14510often defined on groups of types. 14511 14512For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold: 14513 14514@itemize @bullet 14515 14516@item 14517@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class 14518specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}. 14519 14520@item 14521@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and 14522@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform). 14523 14524@item 14525@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}. 14526 14527@item 14528@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above. 14529 14530@end itemize 14531 14532@noindent 14533The following operators are supported. They are listed here 14534in order of increasing precedence: 14535 14536@table @code 14537@item , 14538The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list 14539are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire 14540expression being the last expression evaluated. 14541 14542@item = 14543Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value 14544assigned. Defined on scalar types. 14545 14546@item @var{op}= 14547Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}}, 14548and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}. 14549@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator 14550@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&}, 14551@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}. 14552 14553@item ?: 14554The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought 14555of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a} 14556should be of an integral type. 14557 14558@item || 14559Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 14560 14561@item && 14562Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types. 14563 14564@item | 14565Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 14566 14567@item ^ 14568Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types. 14569 14570@item & 14571Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types. 14572 14573@item ==@r{, }!= 14574Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these 14575expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true. 14576 14577@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>= 14578Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal. 14579Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false 14580and non-zero for true. 14581 14582@item <<@r{, }>> 14583left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types. 14584 14585@item @@ 14586The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). 14587 14588@item +@r{, }- 14589Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and 14590pointer types. 14591 14592@item *@r{, }/@r{, }% 14593Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are 14594defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on 14595integral types. 14596 14597@item ++@r{, }-- 14598Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the 14599operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression; 14600when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the 14601operation takes place. 14602 14603@item * 14604Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as 14605@code{++}. 14606 14607@item & 14608Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}. 14609 14610For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is 14611allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})} 14612to examine the address 14613where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is 14614stored. 14615 14616@item - 14617Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same 14618precedence as @code{++}. 14619 14620@item ! 14621Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as 14622@code{++}. 14623 14624@item ~ 14625Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as 14626@code{++}. 14627 14628 14629@item .@r{, }-> 14630Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience, 14631@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a 14632pointer based on the stored type information. 14633Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data. 14634 14635@item .*@r{, }->* 14636Dereferences of pointers to members. 14637 14638@item [] 14639Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as 14640@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}. 14641 14642@item () 14643Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}. 14644 14645@item :: 14646C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union}, 14647and @code{class} types. 14648 14649@item :: 14650Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator 14651(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::}, 14652above. 14653@end table 14654 14655If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually 14656attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's 14657predefined meaning. 14658 14659@node C Constants 14660@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants 14661 14662@cindex C and C@t{++} constants 14663 14664@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the 14665following ways: 14666 14667@itemize @bullet 14668@item 14669Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are 14670specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants 14671by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter 14672@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a 14673@code{long} value. 14674 14675@item 14676Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal 14677point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an 14678exponent. An exponent is of the form: 14679@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another 14680sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents. 14681A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or 14682@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of 14683the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with 14684a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double} 14685constant. 14686 14687@item 14688Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their 14689integral equivalents. 14690 14691@item 14692Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes 14693(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character 14694(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may 14695be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of 14696the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation 14697of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where 14698@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example, 14699@samp{\n} for newline. 14700 14701Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character 14702constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide 14703form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when 14704computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}). 14705 14706@item 14707String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by 14708double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described 14709above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by 14710a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five 14711characters. 14712 14713Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant 14714with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when 14715computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}). 14716 14717@item 14718Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers 14719to constants using the C operator @samp{&}. 14720 14721@item 14722Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{} 14723and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of 14724integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array, 14725and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers. 14726@end itemize 14727 14728@node C Plus Plus Expressions 14729@subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions 14730 14731@cindex expressions in C@t{++} 14732@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions. 14733 14734@cindex debugging C@t{++} programs 14735@cindex C@t{++} compilers 14736@cindex debug formats and C@t{++} 14737@cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++} 14738@quotation 14739@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use 14740the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, 14741@value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled 14742with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF 14743debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most 14744popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to 14745work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++} 14746code. @xref{Compilation}. 14747@end quotation 14748 14749@enumerate 14750 14751@cindex member functions 14752@item 14753Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like 14754 14755@smallexample 14756count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y) 14757@end smallexample 14758 14759@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions} 14760@cindex namespace in C@t{++} 14761@item 14762While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your 14763expressions have the same namespace available as the member function; 14764that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance 14765pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using} 14766declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}. 14767 14768@cindex call overloaded functions 14769@cindex overloaded functions, calling 14770@cindex type conversions in C@t{++} 14771@item 14772You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function 14773call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not 14774perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions, 14775calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist 14776in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or 14777default arguments. 14778 14779It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point 14780promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of 14781class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of 14782functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the 14783number of function arguments. 14784 14785Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified 14786@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus, 14787,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}. 14788 14789You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an 14790explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in 14791@smallexample 14792p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13) 14793@end smallexample 14794 14795The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this; 14796see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}. 14797 14798@cindex reference declarations 14799@item 14800@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use 14801them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically 14802dereferenced. 14803 14804In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of 14805reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this 14806avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures. 14807The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless 14808you have specified @samp{set print address off}. 14809 14810@item 14811@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your 14812expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since 14813one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if 14814necessary, for example in an expression like 14815@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows 14816resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++} 14817debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}). 14818 14819@item 14820@value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++} 14821specification. 14822@end enumerate 14823 14824@node C Defaults 14825@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults 14826 14827@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults 14828 14829If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it 14830defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to 14831C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN} 14832selects the working language. 14833 14834If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it 14835recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or 14836@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of 14837these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}. 14838@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language}, 14839for further details. 14840 14841@node C Checks 14842@subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks 14843 14844@cindex C and C@t{++} checks 14845 14846By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type 14847checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN} 14848will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer 14849constants to pointers. 14850 14851Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array 14852indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer 14853that is not itself an array. 14854 14855@node Debugging C 14856@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C 14857 14858The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to 14859the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is 14860inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it 14861appears as @samp{@{...@}}. 14862 14863The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed 14864with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions, 14865,Expressions}. 14866 14867@node Debugging C Plus Plus 14868@subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++} 14869 14870@cindex commands for C@t{++} 14871 14872Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are 14873designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary: 14874 14875@table @code 14876@cindex break in overloaded functions 14877@item @r{breakpoint menus} 14878When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded, 14879@value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint 14880locations to help you specify which function definition you want. 14881@xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}. 14882 14883@cindex overloading in C@t{++} 14884@item rbreak @var{regex} 14885Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting 14886breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special 14887classes. 14888@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. 14889 14890@cindex C@t{++} exception handling 14891@item catch throw 14892@itemx catch rethrow 14893@itemx catch catch 14894Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set 14895Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}. 14896 14897@cindex inheritance 14898@item ptype @var{typename} 14899Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type 14900@var{typename}. 14901@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}. 14902 14903@item info vtbl @var{expression}. 14904The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual 14905method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows 14906one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when 14907multiple inheritance is in use. 14908 14909@cindex C@t{++} demangling 14910@item demangle @var{name} 14911Demangle @var{name}. 14912@xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command. 14913 14914@cindex C@t{++} symbol display 14915@item set print demangle 14916@itemx show print demangle 14917@itemx set print asm-demangle 14918@itemx show print asm-demangle 14919Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when 14920displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies. 14921@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 14922 14923@item set print object 14924@itemx show print object 14925Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects. 14926@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 14927 14928@item set print vtbl 14929@itemx show print vtbl 14930Control the format for printing virtual function tables. 14931@xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. 14932(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP 14933ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).) 14934 14935@kindex set overload-resolution 14936@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution 14937@item set overload-resolution on 14938Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default 14939is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments 14940and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types, 14941using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus 14942Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details). 14943If it cannot find a match, it emits a message. 14944 14945@item set overload-resolution off 14946Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For 14947overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN} 14948chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the 14949symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For 14950overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN} 14951searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the 14952argument types. 14953 14954@kindex show overload-resolution 14955@item show overload-resolution 14956Show the current setting of overload resolution. 14957 14958@item @r{Overloaded symbol names} 14959You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using 14960the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type 14961@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can 14962also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the 14963available choices, or to finish the type list for you. 14964@xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this. 14965@end table 14966 14967@node Decimal Floating Point 14968@subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format 14969@cindex decimal floating point format 14970 14971@value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in 14972decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the 14973@code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as 14974specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic. 14975 14976There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary 14977Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for 14978PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the 14979configured target. 14980 14981Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN} 14982to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert 14983(using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float. 14984 14985In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating 14986point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores 14987underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions. 14988 14989In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers 14990to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. 14991See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details. 14992 14993@node D 14994@subsection D 14995 14996@cindex D 14997@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with 14998GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D 14999specific feature --- dynamic arrays. 15000 15001@node Go 15002@subsection Go 15003 15004@cindex Go (programming language) 15005@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with 15006@file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers. 15007 15008Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions: 15009 15010@table @code 15011@cindex current Go package 15012@item The current Go package 15013The name of the current package does not need to be specified when 15014specifying global variables and functions. 15015 15016For example, given the program: 15017 15018@example 15019package main 15020var myglob = "Shall we?" 15021func main () @{ 15022 // ... 15023@} 15024@end example 15025 15026When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work: 15027 15028@example 15029(gdb) p myglob 15030(gdb) p main.myglob 15031@end example 15032 15033@cindex builtin Go types 15034@item Builtin Go types 15035The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed 15036as a string. 15037 15038@cindex builtin Go functions 15039@item Builtin Go functions 15040The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof} 15041function and handles it internally. 15042 15043@cindex restrictions on Go expressions 15044@item Restrictions on Go expressions 15045All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}. 15046The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported. 15047Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported. 15048@end table 15049 15050@node Objective-C 15051@subsection Objective-C 15052 15053@cindex Objective-C 15054This section provides information about some commands and command 15055options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also 15056@ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a 15057few more commands specific to Objective-C support. 15058 15059@menu 15060* Method Names in Commands:: 15061* The Print Command with Objective-C:: 15062@end menu 15063 15064@node Method Names in Commands 15065@subsubsection Method Names in Commands 15066 15067The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method 15068names as line specifications: 15069 15070@kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C} 15071@kindex break@r{, and Objective-C} 15072@kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C} 15073@kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C} 15074@kindex list@r{, and Objective-C} 15075@itemize 15076@item @code{clear} 15077@item @code{break} 15078@item @code{info line} 15079@item @code{jump} 15080@item @code{list} 15081@end itemize 15082 15083A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as 15084 15085@smallexample 15086-[@var{Class} @var{methodName}] 15087@end smallexample 15088 15089where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a 15090plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class 15091name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in 15092brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C 15093source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create} 15094instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being 15095debugged, enter: 15096 15097@smallexample 15098break -[Fruit create] 15099@end smallexample 15100 15101To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method, 15102enter: 15103 15104@smallexample 15105list +[NSText initialize] 15106@end smallexample 15107 15108In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is 15109required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus 15110sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It 15111is also possible to specify just a method name: 15112 15113@smallexample 15114break create 15115@end smallexample 15116 15117You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If 15118your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method, 15119you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that 15120method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if 15121none apply. 15122 15123As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the 15124@code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter: 15125 15126@smallexample 15127clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:] 15128@end smallexample 15129 15130@node The Print Command with Objective-C 15131@subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C 15132@cindex Objective-C, print objects 15133@kindex print-object 15134@kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})} 15135 15136The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example: 15137 15138@smallexample 15139print -[@var{object} hash] 15140@end smallexample 15141 15142@cindex print an Objective-C object description 15143@cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects 15144@noindent 15145will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object} 15146and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added, 15147@code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print 15148the description of an object. However, this command may only work 15149with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook 15150function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined. 15151 15152@node OpenCL C 15153@subsection OpenCL C 15154 15155@cindex OpenCL C 15156This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support. 15157 15158@menu 15159* OpenCL C Datatypes:: 15160* OpenCL C Expressions:: 15161* OpenCL C Operators:: 15162@end menu 15163 15164@node OpenCL C Datatypes 15165@subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes 15166 15167@cindex OpenCL C Datatypes 15168@value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified 15169by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point 15170data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL 15171extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}. 15172 15173@node OpenCL C Expressions 15174@subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions 15175 15176@cindex OpenCL C Expressions 15177@value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as 15178lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions 15179supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well. 15180 15181@node OpenCL C Operators 15182@subsubsection OpenCL C Operators 15183 15184@cindex OpenCL C Operators 15185@value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and 15186vector data types. 15187 15188@node Fortran 15189@subsection Fortran 15190@cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN} 15191 15192@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it 15193currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language. 15194 15195@cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols 15196Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers 15197among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and 15198functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you 15199will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing 15200underscore. 15201 15202@menu 15203* Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions 15204* Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran 15205* Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran 15206@end menu 15207 15208@node Fortran Operators 15209@subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions 15210 15211@cindex Fortran operators and expressions 15212 15213Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 15214@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non- 15215arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types. 15216 15217@table @code 15218@item ** 15219The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power 15220of the second one. 15221 15222@item : 15223The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to 15224represent a section of array. 15225 15226@item % 15227The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived 15228types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran, 15229this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined 15230union type. 15231@end table 15232 15233@node Fortran Defaults 15234@subsubsection Fortran Defaults 15235 15236@cindex Fortran Defaults 15237 15238Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by 15239default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can 15240change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see 15241@ref{Symbols}, for the details. 15242 15243@node Special Fortran Commands 15244@subsubsection Special Fortran Commands 15245 15246@cindex Special Fortran commands 15247 15248@value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features, 15249such as displaying common blocks. 15250 15251@table @code 15252@cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran 15253@kindex info common 15254@item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]} 15255This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON} 15256block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of 15257all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are 15258printed. 15259@end table 15260 15261@node Pascal 15262@subsection Pascal 15263 15264@cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations 15265Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or 15266nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support 15267entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal 15268syntax. 15269 15270The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members} 15271controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed. 15272@xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}. 15273 15274@node Rust 15275@subsection Rust 15276 15277@value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust 15278Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression 15279parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few 15280peculiarities and holes to be aware of. 15281 15282@itemize @bullet 15283@item 15284Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current 15285crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of 15286crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves. 15287 15288That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in 15289crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt 15290to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named 15291@samp{B}. 15292 15293As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to 15294items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}. 15295 15296@item 15297Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in 15298expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name. 15299For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate 15300@samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol 15301@samp{K::x::y}. 15302 15303However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when 15304debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to 15305circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before 15306a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global'' 15307scope. 15308 15309In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in 15310the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}. 15311 15312@item 15313The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like'' 15314expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions. 15315 15316@item 15317Tuple expressions are not implemented. 15318 15319@item 15320The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the 15321@code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will 15322never be destroyed. 15323 15324@item 15325@value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order 15326to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you 15327will have to specify the type parameters manually. 15328 15329@item 15330@value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most 15331cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression 15332context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically 15333invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::} 15334operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For 15335example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like 15336@code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require 15337@code{crate::f::<u32>}. 15338 15339@item 15340As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in 15341the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain 15342features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}: 15343@itemize @bullet 15344 15345@item 15346Method calls cannot be made via traits. 15347 15348@item 15349Trait objects cannot be created or inspected. 15350 15351@item 15352Operator overloading is not implemented. 15353 15354@item 15355When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic 15356type names. 15357 15358@item 15359The type @code{Self} is not available. 15360 15361@item 15362@code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be 15363available in the crate. 15364@end itemize 15365@end itemize 15366 15367@node Modula-2 15368@subsection Modula-2 15369 15370@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support 15371 15372The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support 15373output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being 15374developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and 15375attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely 15376to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol 15377table. 15378 15379@cindex expressions in Modula-2 15380@menu 15381* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators 15382* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures 15383* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants 15384* M2 Types:: Modula-2 types 15385* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2 15386* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2 15387* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks 15388* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.} 15389* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 15390@end menu 15391 15392@node M2 Operators 15393@subsubsection Operators 15394@cindex Modula-2 operators 15395 15396Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance, 15397@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are 15398often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the 15399following definitions hold: 15400 15401@itemize @bullet 15402 15403@item 15404@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and 15405their subranges. 15406 15407@item 15408@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges. 15409 15410@item 15411@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}. 15412 15413@item 15414@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO 15415@var{type}}. 15416 15417@item 15418@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above. 15419 15420@item 15421@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types. 15422 15423@item 15424@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}. 15425@end itemize 15426 15427@noindent 15428The following operators are supported, and appear in order of 15429increasing precedence: 15430 15431@table @code 15432@item , 15433Function argument or array index separator. 15434 15435@item := 15436Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is 15437@var{value}. 15438 15439@item <@r{, }> 15440Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated 15441types. 15442 15443@item <=@r{, }>= 15444Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to 15445on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on 15446set types. Same precedence as @code{<}. 15447 15448@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }# 15449Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types. 15450Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is 15451available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script 15452comment character. 15453 15454@item IN 15455Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members. 15456Same precedence as @code{<}. 15457 15458@item OR 15459Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types. 15460 15461@item AND@r{, }& 15462Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types. 15463 15464@item @@ 15465The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). 15466 15467@item +@r{, }- 15468Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union 15469and difference on set types. 15470 15471@item * 15472Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection 15473on set types. 15474 15475@item / 15476Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set 15477types. Same precedence as @code{*}. 15478 15479@item DIV@r{, }MOD 15480Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same 15481precedence as @code{*}. 15482 15483@item - 15484Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data. 15485 15486@item ^ 15487Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. 15488 15489@item NOT 15490Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as 15491@code{^}. 15492 15493@item . 15494@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same 15495precedence as @code{^}. 15496 15497@item [] 15498Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}. 15499 15500@item () 15501Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence 15502as @code{^}. 15503 15504@item ::@r{, }. 15505@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators. 15506@end table 15507 15508@quotation 15509@emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN} 15510treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators 15511@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#}, 15512@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error. 15513@end quotation 15514 15515 15516@node Built-In Func/Proc 15517@subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures 15518@cindex Modula-2 built-ins 15519 15520Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions. 15521In describing these, the following metavariables are used: 15522 15523@table @var 15524 15525@item a 15526represents an @code{ARRAY} variable. 15527 15528@item c 15529represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable. 15530 15531@item i 15532represents a variable or constant of integral type. 15533 15534@item m 15535represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the 15536same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should 15537be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}). 15538 15539@item n 15540represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type. 15541 15542@item r 15543represents a variable or constant of floating-point type. 15544 15545@item t 15546represents a type. 15547 15548@item v 15549represents a variable. 15550 15551@item x 15552represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the 15553explanation of the function for details. 15554@end table 15555 15556All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below. 15557 15558@table @code 15559@item ABS(@var{n}) 15560Returns the absolute value of @var{n}. 15561 15562@item CAP(@var{c}) 15563If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case 15564equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument. 15565 15566@item CHR(@var{i}) 15567Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}. 15568 15569@item DEC(@var{v}) 15570Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value. 15571 15572@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i}) 15573Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the 15574new value. 15575 15576@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s}) 15577Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new 15578set. 15579 15580@item FLOAT(@var{i}) 15581Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}. 15582 15583@item HIGH(@var{a}) 15584Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}. 15585 15586@item INC(@var{v}) 15587Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value. 15588 15589@item INC(@var{v},@var{i}) 15590Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the 15591new value. 15592 15593@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s}) 15594Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already 15595there. Returns the new set. 15596 15597@item MAX(@var{t}) 15598Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}. 15599 15600@item MIN(@var{t}) 15601Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}. 15602 15603@item ODD(@var{i}) 15604Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number. 15605 15606@item ORD(@var{x}) 15607Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal 15608value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting 15609the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an 15610ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types. 15611 15612@item SIZE(@var{x}) 15613Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a 15614variable or a type. 15615 15616@item TRUNC(@var{r}) 15617Returns the integral part of @var{r}. 15618 15619@item TSIZE(@var{x}) 15620Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a 15621variable or a type. 15622 15623@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i}) 15624Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}. 15625@end table 15626 15627@quotation 15628@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so 15629@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as 15630an error. 15631@end quotation 15632 15633@cindex Modula-2 constants 15634@node M2 Constants 15635@subsubsection Constants 15636 15637@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following 15638ways: 15639 15640@itemize @bullet 15641 15642@item 15643Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an 15644expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the 15645rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a 15646trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}. 15647 15648@item 15649Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a 15650decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can 15651then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where 15652@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the 15653digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10) 15654digits. 15655 15656@item 15657Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of 15658like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may 15659also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually) 15660followed by a @samp{C}. 15661 15662@item 15663String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a 15664pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). 15665Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C 15666Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape 15667sequences. 15668 15669@item 15670Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier. 15671 15672@item 15673Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and 15674@code{FALSE}. 15675 15676@item 15677Pointer constants consist of integral values only. 15678 15679@item 15680Set constants are not yet supported. 15681@end itemize 15682 15683@node M2 Types 15684@subsubsection Modula-2 Types 15685@cindex Modula-2 types 15686 15687Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2 15688syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure 15689types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also 15690print the contents of variables declared using these type. 15691This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with 15692sample @value{GDBN} sessions. 15693 15694The first example contains the following section of code: 15695 15696@smallexample 15697VAR 15698 s: SET OF CHAR ; 15699 r: [20..40] ; 15700@end smallexample 15701 15702@noindent 15703and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of 15704@code{r} and @code{s}. 15705 15706@smallexample 15707(@value{GDBP}) print s 15708@{'A'..'C', 'Z'@} 15709(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15710SET OF CHAR 15711(@value{GDBP}) print r 1571221 15713(@value{GDBP}) ptype r 15714[20..40] 15715@end smallexample 15716 15717@noindent 15718Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as: 15719 15720@smallexample 15721VAR 15722 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ; 15723@end smallexample 15724 15725@noindent 15726then you may query the type of @code{s} by: 15727 15728@smallexample 15729(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15730type = SET ['A'..'Z'] 15731@end smallexample 15732 15733@noindent 15734Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set 15735expressions using the debugger. 15736 15737The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2 15738and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents: 15739 15740@smallexample 15741VAR 15742 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ; 15743@end smallexample 15744 15745@smallexample 15746(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15747ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR 15748@end smallexample 15749 15750Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type 15751is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all 15752arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example 15753above. 15754 15755Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples: 15756 15757@smallexample 15758TYPE 15759 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ; 15760 t = [blue..yellow] ; 15761VAR 15762 s: t ; 15763BEGIN 15764 s := blue ; 15765@end smallexample 15766 15767@noindent 15768The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type 15769and value of a variable. 15770 15771@smallexample 15772(@value{GDBP}) print s 15773$1 = blue 15774(@value{GDBP}) ptype t 15775type = [blue..yellow] 15776@end smallexample 15777 15778@noindent 15779In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents 15780displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as 15781their @code{C} counterparts. 15782 15783@smallexample 15784VAR 15785 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ; 15786BEGIN 15787 s[1] := 1 ; 15788@end smallexample 15789 15790@smallexample 15791(@value{GDBP}) print s 15792$1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@} 15793(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15794type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL 15795@end smallexample 15796 15797The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands 15798pointer types as shown in this example: 15799 15800@smallexample 15801VAR 15802 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ; 15803BEGIN 15804 NEW(s) ; 15805 s^[1] := 1 ; 15806@end smallexample 15807 15808@noindent 15809and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}. 15810 15811@smallexample 15812(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15813type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL 15814@end smallexample 15815 15816@value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example. 15817Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange 15818types: 15819 15820@smallexample 15821TYPE 15822 foo = RECORD 15823 f1: CARDINAL ; 15824 f2: CHAR ; 15825 f3: myarray ; 15826 END ; 15827 15828 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ; 15829 myrange = [-2..2] ; 15830VAR 15831 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ; 15832@end smallexample 15833 15834@noindent 15835and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown 15836below. 15837 15838@smallexample 15839(@value{GDBP}) ptype s 15840type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD 15841 f1 : CARDINAL; 15842 f2 : CHAR; 15843 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL; 15844END 15845@end smallexample 15846 15847@node M2 Defaults 15848@subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults 15849@cindex Modula-2 defaults 15850 15851If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they 15852both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to 15853Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN} 15854selected the working language. 15855 15856If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering 15857code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the 15858working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} 15859Infer the Source Language}, for further details. 15860 15861@node Deviations 15862@subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2 15863@cindex Modula-2, deviations from 15864 15865A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug. 15866This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness: 15867 15868@itemize @bullet 15869@item 15870Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by 15871integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during 15872debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a 15873pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified 15874through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that 15875returned a pointer.) 15876 15877@item 15878C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent 15879non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these 15880escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are 15881printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format. 15882 15883@item 15884The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand 15885argument. 15886 15887@item 15888All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument. 15889@end itemize 15890 15891@node M2 Checks 15892@subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks 15893@cindex Modula-2 checks 15894 15895@quotation 15896@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or 15897range checking. 15898@end quotation 15899@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added 15900 15901@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if: 15902 15903@itemize @bullet 15904@item 15905They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE 15906@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement 15907 15908@item 15909They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the 15910@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.) 15911@end itemize 15912 15913As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables 15914whose types are not equivalent is an error. 15915 15916Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array 15917index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures. 15918 15919@node M2 Scope 15920@subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.} 15921@cindex scope 15922@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator 15923@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator 15924@ifinfo 15925@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2} 15926@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can. 15927@end ifinfo 15928@ifnotinfo 15929@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2} 15930@end ifnotinfo 15931 15932There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator 15933(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have 15934similar syntax: 15935 15936@smallexample 15937 15938@var{module} . @var{id} 15939@var{scope} :: @var{id} 15940@end smallexample 15941 15942@noindent 15943where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure, 15944@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared 15945identifier within your program, except another module. 15946 15947Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope 15948specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not 15949found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes 15950enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}. 15951 15952Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for 15953the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the 15954definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is 15955an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition 15956module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in 15957@var{module}. 15958 15959@node GDB/M2 15960@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 15961 15962Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs. 15963Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply 15964specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle}, 15965@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four 15966apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct 15967analogue in Modula-2. 15968 15969The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available 15970with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its 15971intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be 15972created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an 15973address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct 15974@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful. 15975 15976@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2 15977In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is 15978interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead. 15979 15980@node Ada 15981@subsection Ada 15982@cindex Ada 15983 15984The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support 15985output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler. 15986Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and 15987attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely 15988to be difficult. 15989 15990 15991@cindex expressions in Ada 15992@menu 15993* Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax 15994 and semantics supported by Ada mode 15995 in @value{GDBN}. 15996* Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax. 15997* Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax. 15998* Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded 15999 subprograms. 16000* Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration. 16001* Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions 16002* Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks. 16003* Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files 16004* Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar 16005 Profile 16006* Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode. 16007@end menu 16008 16009@node Ada Mode Intro 16010@subsubsection Introduction 16011@cindex Ada mode, general 16012 16013The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression 16014syntax, with some extensions. 16015The philosophy behind the design of this subset is 16016 16017@itemize @bullet 16018@item 16019That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for 16020arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls, 16021leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the 16022program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}). 16023 16024@item 16025That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions 16026are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user. 16027 16028@item 16029That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user. 16030@end itemize 16031 16032Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in 16033user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible 16034according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most 16035names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes 16036ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent. 16037 16038The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program. 16039As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that 16040was translated from an Ada source file. 16041 16042While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful 16043mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment 16044(@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the 16045middle (to allow based literals). 16046 16047@node Omissions from Ada 16048@subsubsection Omissions from Ada 16049@cindex Ada, omissions from 16050 16051Here are the notable omissions from the subset: 16052 16053@itemize @bullet 16054@item 16055Only a subset of the attributes are supported: 16056 16057@itemize @minus 16058@item 16059@t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length} 16060 on array objects (not on types and subtypes). 16061 16062@item 16063@t{'Min} and @t{'Max}. 16064 16065@item 16066@t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}. 16067 16068@item 16069@t{'Tag}. 16070 16071@item 16072@t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right 16073operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator. 16074 16075@item 16076@t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and 16077@t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension). 16078 16079@item 16080@t{'Address}. 16081@end itemize 16082 16083@item 16084The names in 16085@code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and 16086concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are 16087not currently available. 16088 16089@item 16090Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise 16091equality of representations. They will generally work correctly 16092for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types. 16093They may not work correctly for arrays whose element 16094types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values 16095(in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative 16096zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with 16097indeterminate values. 16098 16099@item 16100The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or}, 16101@code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality) 16102are not implemented. 16103 16104@item 16105@cindex array aggregates (Ada) 16106@cindex record aggregates (Ada) 16107@cindex aggregates (Ada) 16108There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are 16109permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples: 16110 16111@smallexample 16112(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6) 16113(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0) 16114(@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6) 16115(@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9)) 16116(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True); 16117(@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True) 16118@end smallexample 16119 16120Changing a 16121discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an 16122undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record. 16123However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to 16124them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an 16125aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec} 16126declared to have a type such as: 16127 16128@smallexample 16129type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record 16130 Id : Integer; 16131 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len); 16132end record; 16133@end smallexample 16134 16135you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two 16136assignments: 16137 16138@smallexample 16139(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4 16140(@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4)) 16141@end smallexample 16142 16143As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual 16144rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the 16145components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len} 16146component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their 16147original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as 16148indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or 16149redundant component associations, although which component values are 16150assigned in such cases is not defined. 16151 16152@item 16153Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented. 16154 16155@item 16156The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective) 16157than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in 16158which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much 16159looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some 16160function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose 16161the proper resolution. 16162 16163@item 16164The @code{new} operator is not implemented. 16165 16166@item 16167Entry calls are not implemented. 16168 16169@item 16170Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point 16171formats are not supported. 16172 16173@item 16174It is not possible to slice a packed array. 16175 16176@item 16177The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name, 16178are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of 16179context. 16180Should your program 16181redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice), 16182you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions. 16183@end itemize 16184 16185@node Additions to Ada 16186@subsubsection Additions to Ada 16187@cindex Ada, deviations from 16188 16189As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic 16190extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}): 16191 16192@itemize @bullet 16193@item 16194If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically 16195a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer, 16196then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the 16197@var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In 16198Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is 16199in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in 16200Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in 16201which certain debugging information has been optimized away. 16202 16203@item 16204@code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that 16205appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, 16206you must typically surround it in single quotes. 16207 16208@item 16209The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type 16210@var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.'' 16211 16212@item 16213A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable 16214(@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}). 16215@end itemize 16216 16217In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright 16218additions specific to Ada: 16219 16220@itemize @bullet 16221@item 16222The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning 16223its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter 16224 16225@smallexample 16226(@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3 16227(@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1) 16228@end smallexample 16229 16230@item 16231The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value 16232the value of its right-hand operand. 16233This allows, for example, 16234complex conditional breaks: 16235 16236@smallexample 16237(@value{GDBP}) break f 16238(@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100) 16239@end smallexample 16240 16241@item 16242Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special 16243characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation, 16244which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form 16245@samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the 16246(single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The 16247sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark 16248in strings. For example, 16249@smallexample 16250 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]" 16251@end smallexample 16252@noindent 16253contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) 16254after each period. 16255 16256@item 16257The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and 16258@t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid 16259to write 16260 16261@smallexample 16262(@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y) 16263@end smallexample 16264 16265@item 16266When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the 16267array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise. 16268For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound 16269of 3 might print as 16270 16271@smallexample 16272(3 => 10, 17, 1) 16273@end smallexample 16274 16275@noindent 16276That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>} 16277clause. 16278 16279@item 16280You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique, 16281multi-character subsequence of 16282their names (an exact match gets preference). 16283For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh} 16284in place of @t{a'length}. 16285 16286@item 16287@cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers 16288Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type 16289to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for 16290some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users. 16291For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them, 16292enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping. 16293For example, 16294@smallexample 16295(@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0] 16296@end smallexample 16297 16298@item 16299Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an 16300access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's 16301specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component 16302selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the 16303object. 16304 16305@end itemize 16306 16307@node Overloading support for Ada 16308@subsubsection Overloading support for Ada 16309@cindex overloading, Ada 16310 16311The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which 16312the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of 16313actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow 16314the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring 16315procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and 16316functions to procedures elsewhere. 16317 16318If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than 16319one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should 16320use, for instance: 16321 16322@smallexample 16323(@value{GDBP}) print f(1) 16324Multiple matches for f 16325[0] cancel 16326[1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23 16327[2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28 16328> 16329@end smallexample 16330 16331In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation 16332(type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific 16333instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}). 16334 16335Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this 16336case: 16337 16338@table @code 16339 16340@kindex set ada print-signatures 16341@item set ada print-signatures 16342Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads 16343selection menus. It is @code{on} by default. 16344@xref{Overloading support for Ada}. 16345 16346@kindex show ada print-signatures 16347@item show ada print-signatures 16348Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in 16349overloads selection menu. 16350@xref{Overloading support for Ada}. 16351 16352@end table 16353 16354@node Stopping Before Main Program 16355@subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning 16356 16357@cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code 16358It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and 16359before reaching the main procedure. 16360As defined in the Ada Reference 16361Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called 16362@code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of 16363elaboration, simply use the following two commands: 16364@code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}. 16365 16366@node Ada Exceptions 16367@subsubsection Ada Exceptions 16368 16369A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions: 16370 16371@table @code 16372@kindex info exceptions 16373@item info exceptions 16374@itemx info exceptions @var{regexp} 16375The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions 16376defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses. 16377With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions 16378whose names match @var{regexp} are listed. 16379@end table 16380 16381Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first 16382without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an 16383argument. 16384 16385@smallexample 16386(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions 16387All defined Ada exceptions: 16388constraint_error: 0x613da0 16389program_error: 0x613d20 16390storage_error: 0x613ce0 16391tasking_error: 0x613ca0 16392const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00 16393(@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint 16394All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint": 16395constraint_error: 0x613da0 16396const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00 16397@end smallexample 16398 16399It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution 16400when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}. 16401 16402@node Ada Tasks 16403@subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks 16404@cindex Ada, tasking 16405 16406Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}). 16407@value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands: 16408 16409@table @code 16410@kindex info tasks 16411@item info tasks 16412This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example: 16413 16414 16415@smallexample 16416@iftex 16417@leftskip=0.5cm 16418@end iftex 16419(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16420 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16421 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16422 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b 16423 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a 16424* 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c 16425 16426@end smallexample 16427 16428@noindent 16429In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the 16430task currently being inspected. 16431 16432@table @asis 16433@item ID 16434Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number. 16435 16436@item TID 16437The Ada task ID. 16438 16439@item P-ID 16440The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number). 16441 16442@item Pri 16443The base priority of the task. 16444 16445@item State 16446Current state of the task. 16447 16448@table @code 16449@item Unactivated 16450The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be 16451executing. 16452 16453@item Runnable 16454The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting 16455for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode. 16456 16457@item Terminated 16458The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents 16459that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have 16460terminated themselves. 16461 16462@item Child Activation Wait 16463The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation. 16464 16465@item Accept Statement 16466The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement. 16467 16468@item Waiting on entry call 16469The task is waiting on an entry call. 16470 16471@item Async Select Wait 16472The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous 16473select statement. 16474 16475@item Delay Sleep 16476The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay 16477alternative open. 16478 16479@item Child Termination Wait 16480The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is 16481waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or 16482waiting on a terminate Phase. 16483 16484@item Wait Child in Term Alt 16485The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to 16486finish terminating. 16487 16488@item Accepting RV with @var{taskno} 16489The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}. 16490@end table 16491 16492@item Name 16493Name of the task in the program. 16494 16495@end table 16496 16497@kindex info task @var{taskno} 16498@item info task @var{taskno} 16499This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in 16500the following example: 16501@smallexample 16502@iftex 16503@leftskip=0.5cm 16504@end iftex 16505(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16506 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16507 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16508* 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1 16509(@value{GDBP}) info task 2 16510Ada Task: 0x807c468 16511Name: task_1 16512Thread: 0x807f378 16513Parent: 1 (main_task) 16514Base Priority: 15 16515State: Runnable 16516@end smallexample 16517 16518@item task 16519@kindex task@r{ (Ada)} 16520@cindex current Ada task ID 16521This command prints the ID of the current task. 16522 16523@smallexample 16524@iftex 16525@leftskip=0.5cm 16526@end iftex 16527(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16528 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16529 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16530* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t 16531(@value{GDBP}) task 16532[Current task is 2] 16533@end smallexample 16534 16535@item task @var{taskno} 16536@cindex Ada task switching 16537This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}} 16538command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging 16539from the current task to the given task. 16540 16541@smallexample 16542@iftex 16543@leftskip=0.5cm 16544@end iftex 16545(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16546 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16547 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16548* 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t 16549(@value{GDBP}) task 1 16550[Switching to task 1] 16551#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait () 16552(@value{GDBP}) bt 16553#0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait () 16554#1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait () 16555#2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep () 16556#3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks () 16557#4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5 16558@end smallexample 16559 16560@item break @var{location} task @var{taskno} 16561@itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{} 16562@cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada 16563@cindex task breakpoints, in Ada 16564@kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)} 16565These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}} 16566command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The 16567@var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described 16568in @ref{Specify Location}. 16569 16570Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command 16571to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a 16572particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the 16573numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first 16574column of the @samp{info tasks} display. 16575 16576If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a 16577breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your 16578program. 16579 16580You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as 16581well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the 16582breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}). 16583 16584For example, 16585 16586@smallexample 16587@iftex 16588@leftskip=0.5cm 16589@end iftex 16590(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16591 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16592 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16593 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2 16594 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1 16595* 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3 16596(@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2 16597Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15. 16598(@value{GDBP}) cont 16599Continuing. 16600task # 1 running 16601task # 2 running 16602 16603Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15 1660415 flush; 16605(@value{GDBP}) info tasks 16606 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name 16607 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task 16608* 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2 16609 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1 16610 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3 16611@end smallexample 16612@end table 16613 16614@node Ada Tasks and Core Files 16615@subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files 16616@cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging 16617 16618When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program, 16619tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on 16620the platform being used. 16621For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task 16622switching is not supported. 16623 16624On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some 16625memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting 16626a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write 16627privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}). 16628Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core 16629file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}. 16630 16631@node Ravenscar Profile 16632@subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile 16633@cindex Ravenscar Profile 16634 16635The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features, 16636specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time 16637requirements. 16638 16639@table @code 16640@kindex set ravenscar task-switching on 16641@cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile 16642@item set ravenscar task-switching on 16643Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar 16644Profile. This is the default. 16645 16646@kindex set ravenscar task-switching off 16647@item set ravenscar task-switching off 16648Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar 16649Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support 16650for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in 16651the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly. 16652To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started. 16653 16654@kindex show ravenscar task-switching 16655@item show ravenscar task-switching 16656Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program 16657using the Ravenscar Profile. 16658 16659@end table 16660 16661@node Ada Glitches 16662@subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode 16663@cindex Ada, problems 16664 16665Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}), 16666we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in 16667@value{GDBN}, 16668some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger 16669and the GNU Ada compiler. 16670 16671@itemize @bullet 16672@item 16673Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in 16674storage are invisible to the debugger. 16675 16676@item 16677Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the 16678argument lists are treated as positional). 16679 16680@item 16681Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger. 16682 16683@item 16684Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using 16685floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on 16686the host machine. 16687 16688@item 16689The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of 16690the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about 16691this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never 16692look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against 16693symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have 16694defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and 16695local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard}, 16696GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens, 16697you can usually resolve the confusion 16698by qualifying the problematic names with package 16699@code{Standard} explicitly. 16700@end itemize 16701 16702Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging 16703information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value 16704of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work 16705around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able 16706to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically 16707enabled. 16708 16709@kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS 16710@kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS 16711@table @code 16712 16713@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on 16714Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the 16715value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS} 16716types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for 16717a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler). 16718This is the default. 16719 16720@item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off 16721This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN} 16722sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada 16723trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix 16724the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to 16725@code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is 16726recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary. 16727 16728@end table 16729 16730@cindex GNAT descriptive types 16731@cindex GNAT encoding 16732Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number 16733of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in 16734@file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes 16735how the debugging information should be generated for certain types. 16736In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types}, 16737which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger. 16738 16739These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information 16740format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex 16741types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all 16742Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive 16743types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition, 16744a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore 16745those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how 16746well @value{GDBN} works without them. 16747 16748@table @code 16749 16750@kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types 16751@item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off] 16752Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types. 16753The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}). 16754 16755@kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types 16756@item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types 16757Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}. 16758 16759@end table 16760 16761@node Unsupported Languages 16762@section Unsupported Languages 16763 16764@cindex unsupported languages 16765@cindex minimal language 16766In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages, 16767@value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}. 16768It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set 16769of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide. 16770This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging 16771an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}. 16772 16773If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically 16774select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported 16775language. 16776 16777@node Symbols 16778@chapter Examining the Symbol Table 16779 16780The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the 16781symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your 16782program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and 16783does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your 16784program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN} 16785(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the 16786file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 16787 16788@cindex symbol names 16789@cindex names of symbols 16790@cindex quoting names 16791Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual 16792characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The 16793most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other 16794source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names 16795are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would 16796ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words 16797@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize 16798@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example, 16799 16800@smallexample 16801p 'foo.c'::x 16802@end smallexample 16803 16804@noindent 16805looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}. 16806 16807@table @code 16808@cindex case-insensitive symbol names 16809@cindex case sensitivity in symbol names 16810@kindex set case-sensitive 16811@item set case-sensitive on 16812@itemx set case-sensitive off 16813@itemx set case-sensitive auto 16814Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names 16815with case sensitivity determined by the current source language. 16816Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set 16817case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for 16818case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If 16819you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default 16820suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive 16821matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is 16822case-insensitive matches. 16823 16824@kindex show case-sensitive 16825@item show case-sensitive 16826This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols 16827lookups. 16828 16829@kindex set print type methods 16830@item set print type methods 16831@itemx set print type methods on 16832@itemx set print type methods off 16833Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods 16834declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by 16835passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set 16836print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to 16837display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will 16838cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods. 16839 16840@kindex show print type methods 16841@item show print type methods 16842This command shows the current setting of method display when printing 16843classes. 16844 16845@kindex set print type typedefs 16846@item set print type typedefs 16847@itemx set print type typedefs on 16848@itemx set print type typedefs off 16849 16850Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs 16851defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by 16852passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set 16853print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to 16854display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying 16855@code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions. 16856Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is 16857printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other 16858types. 16859 16860@kindex show print type typedefs 16861@item show print type typedefs 16862This command shows the current setting of typedef display when 16863printing classes. 16864 16865@kindex info address 16866@cindex address of a symbol 16867@item info address @var{symbol} 16868Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register 16869variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register 16870local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable 16871is always stored. 16872 16873Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work 16874at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints 16875the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable. 16876 16877@kindex info symbol 16878@cindex symbol from address 16879@cindex closest symbol and offset for an address 16880@item info symbol @var{addr} 16881Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}. 16882If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the 16883nearest symbol and an offset from it: 16884 16885@smallexample 16886(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320 16887_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text 16888@end smallexample 16889 16890@noindent 16891This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use 16892it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address. 16893 16894For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared 16895library containing the symbol is also printed: 16896 16897@smallexample 16898(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225 16899_start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out 16900(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf 16901__read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6 16902@end smallexample 16903 16904@kindex demangle 16905@cindex demangle 16906@item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name} 16907Demangle @var{name}. 16908If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle 16909@var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language. 16910 16911The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options, 16912and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash. 16913 16914The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind 16915of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}. 16916 16917@kindex whatis 16918@item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}] 16919Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression 16920or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of 16921@code{$}, the last value in the value history. 16922 16923If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it 16924is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as 16925assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. 16926 16927If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its 16928literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was 16929defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print 16930the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the 16931variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as 16932@code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their 16933fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class} 16934name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of 16935such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}. 16936 16937If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef}, 16938@code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}. 16939Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used 16940in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that 16941underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not 16942unroll it. 16943 16944For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class 16945@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union 16946@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}. 16947 16948@var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed. 16949Available flags are: 16950 16951@table @code 16952@item r 16953Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template 16954parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class' 16955members. The @code{/r} flag disables this. 16956 16957@item m 16958Do not print methods defined in the class. 16959 16960@item M 16961Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag 16962exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}. 16963 16964@item t 16965Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls 16966whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef 16967names are substituted when printing other types. 16968 16969@item T 16970Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag 16971exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}. 16972@end table 16973 16974@kindex ptype 16975@item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}] 16976@code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a 16977detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type. 16978@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. 16979 16980Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any 16981@code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is 16982a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype} 16983of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as 16984present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at 16985the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of 16986fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s, 16987@code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}. 16988 16989For example, for this variable declaration: 16990 16991@smallexample 16992typedef double real_t; 16993struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @}; 16994typedef struct complex complex_t; 16995complex_t var; 16996real_t *real_pointer_var; 16997@end smallexample 16998 16999@noindent 17000the two commands give this output: 17001 17002@smallexample 17003@group 17004(@value{GDBP}) whatis var 17005type = complex_t 17006(@value{GDBP}) ptype var 17007type = struct complex @{ 17008 real_t real; 17009 double imag; 17010@} 17011(@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t 17012type = struct complex 17013(@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex 17014type = struct complex 17015(@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex 17016type = struct complex @{ 17017 real_t real; 17018 double imag; 17019@} 17020(@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var 17021type = real_t * 17022(@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var 17023type = double * 17024@end group 17025@end smallexample 17026 17027@noindent 17028As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to 17029the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history. 17030 17031@cindex incomplete type 17032Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications 17033of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the 17034program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of 17035the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example, 17036given these declarations: 17037 17038@smallexample 17039 struct foo; 17040 struct foo *fooptr; 17041@end smallexample 17042 17043@noindent 17044but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say: 17045 17046@smallexample 17047 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo 17048 $1 = <incomplete type> 17049@end smallexample 17050 17051@noindent 17052``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not 17053completely specified. 17054 17055@kindex info types 17056@item info types @var{regexp} 17057@itemx info types 17058Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular 17059expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply 17060no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a 17061complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all 17062types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but 17063@samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete 17064name is @code{value}. 17065 17066This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like 17067@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it 17068lists all source files where a type is defined. 17069 17070@kindex info type-printers 17071@item info type-printers 17072Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may 17073have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or 17074@command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type 17075is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing 17076type printers. 17077 17078@code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers. 17079 17080@kindex enable type-printer 17081@kindex disable type-printer 17082@item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{} 17083@item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{} 17084These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers. 17085 17086@kindex info scope 17087@cindex local variables 17088@item info scope @var{location} 17089List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command 17090accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or 17091an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local 17092to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for 17093details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example: 17094 17095@smallexample 17096(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler} 17097Scope for command_line_handler: 17098Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4. 17099Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4. 17100Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4. 17101Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4. 17102Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4. 17103Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4. 17104Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4. 17105@end smallexample 17106 17107@noindent 17108This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect 17109during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions, 17110collect}. 17111 17112@kindex info source 17113@item info source 17114Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for 17115the function containing the current point of execution: 17116@itemize @bullet 17117@item 17118the name of the source file, and the directory containing it, 17119@item 17120the directory it was compiled in, 17121@item 17122its length, in lines, 17123@item 17124which programming language it is written in, 17125@item 17126if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file 17127(which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments), 17128@item 17129whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and 17130if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and 17131@item 17132whether the debugging information includes information about 17133preprocessor macros. 17134@end itemize 17135 17136 17137@kindex info sources 17138@item info sources 17139Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is 17140debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols 17141have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed. 17142 17143@kindex info functions 17144@item info functions 17145Print the names and data types of all defined functions. 17146 17147@item info functions @var{regexp} 17148Print the names and data types of all defined functions 17149whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}. 17150Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names 17151include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names 17152start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters 17153that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@: 17154@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash. 17155 17156@kindex info variables 17157@item info variables 17158Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined 17159outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables). 17160 17161@item info variables @var{regexp} 17162Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local 17163variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression 17164@var{regexp}. 17165 17166@kindex info classes 17167@cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors 17168@item info classes 17169@itemx info classes @var{regexp} 17170Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or 17171(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular 17172expression. 17173 17174@kindex info selectors 17175@item info selectors 17176@itemx info selectors @var{regexp} 17177Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or 17178(with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular 17179expression. 17180 17181@ignore 17182This was never implemented. 17183@kindex info methods 17184@item info methods 17185@itemx info methods @var{regexp} 17186The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined 17187methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a 17188specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many 17189C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output 17190from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The 17191@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those 17192which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}. 17193@end ignore 17194 17195@cindex opaque data types 17196@kindex set opaque-type-resolution 17197@item set opaque-type-resolution on 17198Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type 17199declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or 17200@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one 17201source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in 17202another source file. The default is on. 17203 17204A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until 17205the next time symbols for a file are loaded. 17206 17207@item set opaque-type-resolution off 17208Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type 17209is printed as follows: 17210@smallexample 17211@{<no data fields>@} 17212@end smallexample 17213 17214@kindex show opaque-type-resolution 17215@item show opaque-type-resolution 17216Show whether opaque types are resolved or not. 17217 17218@kindex set print symbol-loading 17219@cindex print messages when symbols are loaded 17220@item set print symbol-loading 17221@itemx set print symbol-loading full 17222@itemx set print symbol-loading brief 17223@itemx set print symbol-loading off 17224The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the 17225printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information. 17226By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each 17227shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when 17228debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages 17229can be annoying. 17230When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable, 17231and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once 17232it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared 17233libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed. 17234 17235@kindex show print symbol-loading 17236@item show print symbol-loading 17237Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command 17238entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded. 17239 17240@kindex maint print symbols 17241@cindex symbol dump 17242@kindex maint print psymbols 17243@cindex partial symbol dump 17244@kindex maint print msymbols 17245@cindex minimal symbol dump 17246@item maint print symbols @var{filename} 17247@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename} 17248@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename} 17249Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}. 17250These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only 17251symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print 17252symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already 17253collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for 17254only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the 17255command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you 17256use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about 17257symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in 17258files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally, 17259@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information 17260required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols. 17261@xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how 17262@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}). 17263 17264@kindex maint info symtabs 17265@kindex maint info psymtabs 17266@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables 17267@cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17268@cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17269@cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17270@item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 17271@itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 17272 17273List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab} 17274structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not 17275given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can 17276copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular 17277structure in more detail. For example: 17278 17279@smallexample 17280(@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read 17281@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb 17282 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0) 17283 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c 17284 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10) 17285 readin no 17286 fullname (null) 17287 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074 17288 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9) 17289 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882) 17290 dependencies (none) 17291 @} 17292@} 17293(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs 17294(@value{GDBP}) 17295@end smallexample 17296@noindent 17297We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains 17298the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable; 17299and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all. 17300If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to 17301read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function: 17302 17303@smallexample 17304(@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab 17305Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c, 17306line 1574. 17307(@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs 17308@{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb 17309 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0) 17310 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c 17311 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38) 17312 dirname (null) 17313 fullname (null) 17314 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary) 17315 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0) 17316 debugformat DWARF 2 17317 @} 17318@} 17319(@value{GDBP}) 17320@end smallexample 17321 17322@kindex maint info line-table 17323@cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables 17324@cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal 17325@item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]} 17326 17327List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab} 17328instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not 17329given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}. 17330 17331@kindex maint set symbol-cache-size 17332@cindex symbol cache size 17333@item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size} 17334Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}. 17335The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging 17336most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting 17337with different sizes. 17338 17339@kindex maint show symbol-cache-size 17340@item maint show symbol-cache-size 17341Show the size of the symbol cache. 17342 17343@kindex maint print symbol-cache 17344@cindex symbol cache, printing its contents 17345@item maint print symbol-cache 17346Print the contents of the symbol cache. 17347This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues. 17348 17349@kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics 17350@cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics 17351@item maint print symbol-cache-statistics 17352Print symbol cache usage statistics. 17353This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized. 17354 17355@kindex maint flush-symbol-cache 17356@cindex symbol cache, flushing 17357@item maint flush-symbol-cache 17358Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed. 17359This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache. 17360It is also useful when collecting performance data. 17361 17362@end table 17363 17364@node Altering 17365@chapter Altering Execution 17366 17367Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to 17368find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to 17369correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by 17370experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the 17371program. 17372 17373For example, you can store new values into variables or memory 17374locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different 17375address, or even return prematurely from a function. 17376 17377@menu 17378* Assignment:: Assignment to variables 17379* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address 17380* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal 17381* Returning:: Returning from a function 17382* Calling:: Calling your program's functions 17383* Patching:: Patching your program 17384* Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN} 17385@end menu 17386 17387@node Assignment 17388@section Assignment to Variables 17389 17390@cindex assignment 17391@cindex setting variables 17392To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression. 17393@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example, 17394 17395@smallexample 17396print x=4 17397@end smallexample 17398 17399@noindent 17400stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the 17401value of the assignment expression (which is 4). 17402@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more 17403information on operators in supported languages. 17404 17405@kindex set variable 17406@cindex variables, setting 17407If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the 17408@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is 17409really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is 17410not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History, 17411,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects. 17412 17413If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command 17414appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set 17415variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical 17416to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your 17417program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set 17418a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the 17419command @code{set width}: 17420 17421@smallexample 17422(@value{GDBP}) whatis width 17423type = double 17424(@value{GDBP}) p width 17425$4 = 13 17426(@value{GDBP}) set width=47 17427Invalid syntax in expression. 17428@end smallexample 17429 17430@noindent 17431The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In 17432order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use 17433 17434@smallexample 17435(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47 17436@end smallexample 17437 17438Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict 17439with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the 17440@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if 17441your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try 17442to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has 17443the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}: 17444 17445@smallexample 17446@group 17447(@value{GDBP}) whatis g 17448type = double 17449(@value{GDBP}) p g 17450$1 = 1 17451(@value{GDBP}) set g=4 17452(@value{GDBP}) p g 17453$2 = 1 17454(@value{GDBP}) r 17455The program being debugged has been started already. 17456Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y 17457Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out 17458"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols: 17459 Invalid bfd target. 17460(@value{GDBP}) show g 17461The current BFD target is "=4". 17462@end group 17463@end smallexample 17464 17465@noindent 17466The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the 17467@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable 17468@code{g}, use 17469 17470@smallexample 17471(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4 17472@end smallexample 17473 17474@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can 17475freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa, 17476and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the 17477same length or shorter. 17478@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions? 17479@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990 17480 17481To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}} 17482construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address 17483(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers 17484to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size 17485and representation in memory), and 17486 17487@smallexample 17488set @{int@}0x83040 = 4 17489@end smallexample 17490 17491@noindent 17492stores the value 4 into that memory location. 17493 17494@node Jumping 17495@section Continuing at a Different Address 17496 17497Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where 17498it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at 17499an address of your own choosing, with the following commands: 17500 17501@table @code 17502@kindex jump 17503@kindex j @r{(@code{jump})} 17504@item jump @var{location} 17505@itemx j @var{location} 17506Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately 17507if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description 17508of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common 17509practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with 17510@code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. 17511 17512The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or 17513the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any 17514register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in 17515a different function from the one currently executing, the results may 17516be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or 17517of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests 17518confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently 17519executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are 17520well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program. 17521@end table 17522 17523On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump} 17524command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The 17525difference is that this does not start your program running; it only 17526changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For 17527example, 17528 17529@smallexample 17530set $pc = 0x485 17531@end smallexample 17532 17533@noindent 17534makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at 17535address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped. 17536@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}. 17537 17538The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back 17539up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program 17540that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more 17541detail. 17542 17543@c @group 17544@node Signaling 17545@section Giving your Program a Signal 17546@cindex deliver a signal to a program 17547 17548@table @code 17549@kindex signal 17550@item signal @var{signal} 17551Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the 17552signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a 17553signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal 17554SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal. 17555 17556Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without 17557giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of 17558a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the 17559@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a 17560signal. 17561 17562@emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is 17563delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last 17564reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was 17565stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution 17566suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that 17567same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue 17568the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one, 17569@value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation. 17570 17571Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the 17572@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill} 17573causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on 17574the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command 17575passes the signal directly to your program. 17576 17577@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time 17578after executing the command. 17579 17580@kindex queue-signal 17581@item queue-signal @var{signal} 17582Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread 17583when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or 17584the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and 17585@code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal. 17586The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program, 17587otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. 17588You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the 17589@code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}). 17590 17591Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal 17592for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal 17593will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account 17594of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the 17595@code{continue} command. 17596 17597This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal 17598is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot 17599be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass} 17600(@pxref{Signals}). 17601@end table 17602@c @end group 17603 17604@xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping 17605commands behave when the thread has a signal queued. 17606 17607@node Returning 17608@section Returning from a Function 17609 17610@table @code 17611@cindex returning from a function 17612@kindex return 17613@item return 17614@itemx return @var{expression} 17615You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return} 17616command. If you give an 17617@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return 17618value. 17619@end table 17620 17621When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame 17622(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the 17623discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to 17624be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}. 17625 17626This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a 17627Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the 17628innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The 17629specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values 17630of functions. 17631 17632The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the 17633program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just 17634returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing 17635and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the 17636selected stack frame returns naturally. 17637 17638@value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for 17639the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the 17640type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for 17641OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in 17642CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU 17643registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have 17644specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its 17645current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the 17646assignment into the right register(s). 17647 17648Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always 17649use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the 17650debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the 17651function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long 17652int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1 17653into a @code{long long int}: 17654 17655@smallexample 17656Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29 1765729 return 31; 17658(@value{GDBP}) return -1 17659Make func return now? (y or n) y 17660#0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43 1766143 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ()); 17662(@value{GDBP}) 17663@end smallexample 17664 17665However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the 17666function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type 17667to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value 17668in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example, 17669typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part 17670of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit 17671architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by 17672an appropriate cast explicitly: 17673 17674@smallexample 17675Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func () 17676(@value{GDBP}) return -1 17677Return value type not available for selected stack frame. 17678Please use an explicit cast of the value to return. 17679(@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1 17680Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y 17681#0 0x00400526 in main () 17682(@value{GDBP}) 17683@end smallexample 17684 17685@node Calling 17686@section Calling Program Functions 17687 17688@table @code 17689@cindex calling functions 17690@cindex inferior functions, calling 17691@item print @var{expr} 17692Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value. 17693The expression may include calls to functions in the program being 17694debugged. 17695 17696@kindex call 17697@item call @var{expr} 17698Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void} 17699returned values. 17700 17701You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to 17702execute a function from your program that does not return anything 17703(a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output 17704with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise 17705print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the 17706value history. 17707@end table 17708 17709It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or 17710@code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in 17711the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens 17712in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command. 17713 17714Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you 17715call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an 17716exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy 17717frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has 17718an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a 17719dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot 17720seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens 17721in that case is controlled by the 17722@code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command. 17723 17724@table @code 17725@item set unwindonsignal 17726@kindex set unwindonsignal 17727@cindex unwind stack in called functions 17728@cindex call dummy stack unwinding 17729Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function 17730that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on, 17731@value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores 17732the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the 17733default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was 17734received. 17735 17736@item show unwindonsignal 17737@kindex show unwindonsignal 17738Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by 17739@value{GDBN}. 17740 17741@item set unwind-on-terminating-exception 17742@kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception 17743@cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions 17744@cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception. 17745Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left 17746unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being 17747debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack 17748it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before 17749the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to 17750the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated. 17751 17752@item show unwind-on-terminating-exception 17753@kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception 17754Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by 17755@value{GDBN}. 17756 17757@end table 17758 17759@cindex weak alias functions 17760Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias} 17761for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up 17762the type information, including the types of the function arguments, 17763which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly. 17764As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may 17765even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased 17766function instead. 17767 17768@node Patching 17769@section Patching Programs 17770 17771@cindex patching binaries 17772@cindex writing into executables 17773@cindex writing into corefiles 17774 17775By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's 17776executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental 17777alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally 17778patching your program's binary. 17779 17780If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that 17781explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might 17782want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency 17783repairs. 17784 17785@table @code 17786@kindex set write 17787@item set write on 17788@itemx set write off 17789If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and 17790core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write 17791off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only. 17792 17793If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the 17794@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set 17795write}, for your new setting to take effect. 17796 17797@item show write 17798@kindex show write 17799Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing 17800as well as reading. 17801@end table 17802 17803@node Compiling and Injecting Code 17804@section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN} 17805@cindex injecting code 17806@cindex writing into executables 17807@cindex compiling code 17808 17809@value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into 17810programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with 17811@file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled. 17812This functionality is implemented with the following commands. 17813 17814@table @code 17815@kindex compile code 17816@item compile code @var{source-code} 17817@itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code} 17818Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current 17819language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and 17820injection is not supported with the current language specified in 17821@value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error 17822message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links 17823successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted, 17824and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior. 17825It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately. 17826After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any 17827new types or variables you have defined will be deleted. 17828 17829The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways. 17830The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command. 17831E.g.: 17832 17833@smallexample 17834compile code printf ("hello world\n"); 17835@end smallexample 17836 17837If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they 17838may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options 17839from actual source code. E.g.: 17840 17841@smallexample 17842compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n"); 17843@end smallexample 17844 17845Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To 17846enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text 17847following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and 17848allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you 17849have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the 17850editor. 17851 17852@smallexample 17853compile code 17854>printf ("hello\n"); 17855>printf ("world\n"); 17856>end 17857@end smallexample 17858 17859Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the 17860provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must 17861specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named 17862@code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the 17863inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when 17864@var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with 17865inferior symbols otherwise. 17866 17867@kindex compile file 17868@item compile file @var{filename} 17869@itemx compile file -raw @var{filename} 17870Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}. 17871 17872@smallexample 17873compile file /home/user/example.c 17874@end smallexample 17875@end table 17876 17877@table @code 17878@item compile print @var{expr} 17879@itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr} 17880Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the 17881current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the 17882value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type; 17883you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where 17884@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output 17885Formats}. 17886 17887@item compile print 17888@itemx compile print /@var{f} 17889@cindex reprint the last value 17890Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as 17891multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print} 17892command without any text following the command. This will start the 17893multiple-line editor. 17894@end table 17895 17896@noindent 17897The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using: 17898 17899@table @code 17900@anchor{set debug compile} 17901@item set debug compile 17902@cindex compile command debugging info 17903Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and 17904injecting the code. The default is off. 17905 17906@item show debug compile 17907Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of 17908compiling and injecting the code. 17909@end table 17910 17911@subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command 17912 17913@value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code 17914to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior 17915and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s 17916injecting process. 17917 17918@noindent 17919The options used, in increasing precedence: 17920 17921@table @asis 17922@item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch}) 17923These options depend on target processor type and target operating 17924system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit 17925(@code{-m64}) compilation option. 17926 17927@item compilation options recorded in the target 17928@value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation 17929into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according 17930to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to 17931explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise 17932@value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for 17933platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may 17934try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}. 17935 17936@item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args} 17937@end table 17938 17939@noindent 17940You can override compilation options using the following command: 17941 17942@table @code 17943@item set compile-args 17944@cindex compile command options override 17945Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the 17946@code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones 17947from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior 17948compilation. 17949 17950@item show compile-args 17951Displays the current state of compilation options override. 17952This does not show all the options actually used during compilation, 17953use @ref{set debug compile} for that. 17954@end table 17955 17956@subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command 17957 17958There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile} 17959command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below 17960highlights specific issues on a per language basis. 17961 17962@table @asis 17963@item C code examples and caveats 17964When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will 17965attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source 17966code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same 17967access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of 17968the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}. 17969 17970Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that 17971follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN}, 17972much like any other normal debugging session. 17973 17974@smallexample 17975void function1 (void) 17976@{ 17977 int i = 42; 17978 printf ("function 1\n"); 17979@} 17980 17981void function2 (void) 17982@{ 17983 int j = 12; 17984 function1 (); 17985@} 17986 17987int main(void) 17988@{ 17989 int k = 6; 17990 int *p; 17991 function2 (); 17992 return 0; 17993@} 17994@end smallexample 17995 17996For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has 17997been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function 17998@code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user. 17999 18000To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the 18001program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The 18002@code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug 18003information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will 18004be very limited in what variables and types you can access. 18005 18006So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug 18007information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to 18008all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized 18009out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the 18010@code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to 18011the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command 18012and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also 18013read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in 18014@code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the 18015@code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example: 18016 18017@smallexample 18018compile code k = 3; 18019@end smallexample 18020 18021@noindent 18022the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until 18023something else in the example program changes it, or another 18024@code{compile} command changes it. 18025 18026Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and 18027injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables 18028@code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is 18029currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables 18030are not in scope. Therefore, the following command 18031 18032@smallexample 18033compile code j = 3; 18034@end smallexample 18035 18036@noindent 18037will result in a compilation error message. 18038 18039Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in 18040scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via 18041the @code{compile} command will be able to access them. 18042 18043You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as 18044part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part 18045of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for 18046the duration of its run. This example is valid: 18047 18048@smallexample 18049compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff); 18050@end smallexample 18051 18052However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that 18053command has completed: 18054 18055@smallexample 18056compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff); 18057@end smallexample 18058 18059@noindent 18060a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer 18061exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile} 18062command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised 18063when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the 18064code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid: 18065 18066@smallexample 18067compile code int ff = 5; k = ff; 18068@end smallexample 18069 18070The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable 18071@code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value 18072it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in 18073assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command 18074changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a 18075variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point 18076to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example 18077would likely cause issues with your debugged program: 18078 18079@smallexample 18080compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff; 18081@end smallexample 18082 18083In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the 18084@code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it. 18085However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their 18086assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid 18087location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed 18088in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers, 18089or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits. 18090 18091Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs 18092defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile} 18093command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command. 18094Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the 18095@code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future 18096need to resolve the type can be achieved. 18097 18098@smallexample 18099(gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v; 18100(gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a); 18101gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’ 18102Compilation failed. 18103(gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a); 1810442 18105@end smallexample 18106 18107Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not 18108accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command. 18109Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN} 18110will print to the console. 18111@end table 18112 18113@subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command 18114 18115@value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which 18116may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where 18117@value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from 18118shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN} 18119command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on 18120@value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the 18121target architecture and operating system. 18122 18123Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression 18124@code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being 18125debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for 18126example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern 18127@code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look 18128for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for 18129pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}. 18130 18131@node GDB Files 18132@chapter @value{GDBN} Files 18133 18134@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged, 18135both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your 18136program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell 18137@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file. 18138 18139@menu 18140* Files:: Commands to specify files 18141* File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching 18142* Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files 18143* MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section 18144* Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB 18145* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files 18146* Data Files:: GDB data files 18147@end menu 18148 18149@node Files 18150@section Commands to Specify Files 18151 18152@cindex symbol table 18153@cindex core dump file 18154 18155You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual 18156way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to 18157@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and 18158Out of @value{GDBN}}). 18159 18160Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a 18161@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to 18162specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target 18163via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver} 18164Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify 18165new files are useful. 18166 18167@table @code 18168@cindex executable file 18169@kindex file 18170@item file @var{filename} 18171Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its 18172symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program 18173executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a 18174directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory, 18175@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of 18176directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program 18177to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN} 18178and your program, using the @code{path} command. 18179 18180@cindex unlinked object files 18181@cindex patching object files 18182You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using 18183the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object 18184file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also, 18185if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use 18186@kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note 18187that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this 18188case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to 18189the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time. 18190 18191@item file 18192@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it 18193has on both executable file and the symbol table. 18194 18195@kindex exec-file 18196@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]} 18197Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found 18198in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH} 18199if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to 18200discard information on the executable file. 18201 18202@kindex symbol-file 18203@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]} 18204Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is 18205searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol 18206table and program to run from the same file. 18207 18208@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your 18209program's symbol table. 18210 18211The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of 18212some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may 18213contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types, 18214which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside 18215@value{GDBN}. 18216 18217@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after 18218executing it once. 18219 18220When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it 18221understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard 18222generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or 18223other compilers that adhere to the local conventions. 18224Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example, 18225using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for 18226optimized code. 18227 18228For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems 18229using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the 18230symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table 18231quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The 18232details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed. 18233 18234The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN} 18235start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for 18236occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source 18237file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these 18238pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional 18239Warnings and Messages}.) 18240 18241We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the 18242symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the 18243symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF'' 18244still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually 18245in stabs format. 18246 18247@kindex readnow 18248@cindex reading symbols immediately 18249@cindex symbols, reading immediately 18250@item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename} 18251@itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename} 18252You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol 18253tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that 18254load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the 18255entire symbol table available. 18256 18257@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in 18258@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in 18259@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing 18260@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now 18261@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy 18262@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol 18263@c files. 18264 18265@kindex core-file 18266@item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]} 18267@itemx core 18268Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents 18269of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the 18270address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the 18271executable file itself for other parts. 18272 18273@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is 18274to be used. 18275 18276Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running 18277under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you 18278wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which 18279the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command 18280(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}). 18281 18282@kindex add-symbol-file 18283@cindex dynamic linking 18284@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} 18285@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} 18286@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} 18287The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table 18288information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command 18289when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means) 18290into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory 18291address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure 18292this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number 18293of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit 18294section name and base address for that section. You can specify any 18295@var{address} as an expression. 18296 18297The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table 18298originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the 18299@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data 18300thus read is kept in addition to the old. 18301 18302Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}. 18303 18304@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from 18305@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from 18306@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files 18307@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files 18308@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from 18309Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an 18310executable file, or some other object file which has been fully 18311relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic 18312information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as: 18313 18314@itemize @bullet 18315@item 18316the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in 18317that file, not to symbols defined by other object files, 18318@item 18319every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually 18320been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and 18321@item 18322you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and 18323provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command. 18324@end itemize 18325 18326@noindent 18327Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load 18328relocatable files into an already running program; such systems 18329typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's 18330important to recognize that many native systems use complex link 18331procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table 18332assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In 18333general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a 18334relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect 18335as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal 18336way. 18337 18338@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 18339 18340@kindex remove-symbol-file 18341@item remove-symbol-file @var{filename} 18342@item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address} 18343Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The 18344file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address} 18345that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example: 18346 18347@smallexample 18348(gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480 18349add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at 18350 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480 18351(y or n) y 18352Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done. 18353(gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480 18354Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y 18355(gdb) 18356@end smallexample 18357 18358 18359@code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it. 18360 18361@kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory 18362@cindex @code{syscall DSO} 18363@cindex load symbols from memory 18364@item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address} 18365Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded 18366object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory. 18367For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each 18368process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for 18369some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose 18370evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header. 18371For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or 18372@code{exec-file} commands in advance. 18373 18374@kindex section 18375@item section @var{section} @var{addr} 18376The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named 18377@var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the 18378exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the 18379@code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file 18380itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The 18381@code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and 18382their addresses. 18383 18384@kindex info files 18385@kindex info target 18386@item info files 18387@itemx info target 18388@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the 18389current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}), 18390including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in 18391use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The 18392command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than 18393current ones. 18394 18395@kindex maint info sections 18396@item maint info sections 18397Another command that can give you extra information about program sections 18398is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information 18399displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file 18400offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition, 18401@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which 18402may be arbitrarily combined): 18403 18404@table @code 18405@item ALLOBJ 18406Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries. 18407@item @var{sections} 18408Display info only for named @var{sections}. 18409@item @var{section-flags} 18410Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true. 18411The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are: 18412@table @code 18413@item ALLOC 18414Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded. 18415Set for all sections except those containing debug information. 18416@item LOAD 18417Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory. 18418Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections. 18419@item RELOC 18420Section needs to be relocated before loading. 18421@item READONLY 18422Section cannot be modified by the child process. 18423@item CODE 18424Section contains executable code only. 18425@item DATA 18426Section contains data only (no executable code). 18427@item ROM 18428Section will reside in ROM. 18429@item CONSTRUCTOR 18430Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists. 18431@item HAS_CONTENTS 18432Section is not empty. 18433@item NEVER_LOAD 18434An instruction to the linker to not output the section. 18435@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY 18436A notification to the linker that the section contains 18437COFF shared library information. 18438@item IS_COMMON 18439Section contains common symbols. 18440@end table 18441@end table 18442@kindex set trust-readonly-sections 18443@cindex read-only sections 18444@item set trust-readonly-sections on 18445Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file 18446really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change). 18447In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections 18448out of the object file, rather than from the target program. 18449For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant 18450enhancement to debugging performance. 18451 18452The default is off. 18453 18454@item set trust-readonly-sections off 18455Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that 18456the contents of the section might change while the program is running, 18457and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed. 18458 18459@item show trust-readonly-sections 18460Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections. 18461@end table 18462 18463All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names 18464as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file 18465name and remembers it that way. 18466 18467@cindex shared libraries 18468@anchor{Shared Libraries} 18469@value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS, 18470Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and 18471DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries. 18472 18473On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support 18474shared libraries. @xref{Expat}. 18475 18476@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries 18477when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file. 18478(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand 18479references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are 18480debugging a core file). 18481 18482@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef 18483@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared 18484@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual 18485 18486There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load 18487symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are 18488particularly large or there are many of them. 18489 18490To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the 18491commands: 18492 18493@table @code 18494@kindex set auto-solib-add 18495@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode} 18496If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries 18497will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you 18498attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker 18499informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode} 18500is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the 18501@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}. 18502 18503@cindex memory used for symbol tables 18504If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that 18505takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN} 18506memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the 18507symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set 18508auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each 18509library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary 18510@var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches 18511the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded. 18512 18513@kindex show auto-solib-add 18514@item show auto-solib-add 18515Display the current autoloading mode. 18516@end table 18517 18518@cindex load shared library 18519To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary} 18520command: 18521 18522@table @code 18523@kindex info sharedlibrary 18524@kindex info share 18525@item info share @var{regex} 18526@itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex} 18527Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded 18528that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print 18529all shared libraries that are loaded. 18530 18531@kindex info dll 18532@item info dll @var{regex} 18533This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}. 18534 18535@kindex sharedlibrary 18536@kindex share 18537@item sharedlibrary @var{regex} 18538@itemx share @var{regex} 18539Load shared object library symbols for files matching a 18540Unix regular expression. 18541As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries 18542required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If 18543@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are 18544loaded. 18545 18546@item nosharedlibrary 18547@kindex nosharedlibrary 18548@cindex unload symbols from shared libraries 18549Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols 18550that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared 18551libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not 18552discarded. 18553@end table 18554 18555Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control 18556when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is 18557to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set 18558Catchpoints}). 18559 18560@value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events} 18561command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is 18562less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for 18563conditions or commands as a catchpoint does. 18564 18565@table @code 18566@item set stop-on-solib-events 18567@kindex set stop-on-solib-events 18568This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control 18569when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event. 18570The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new 18571shared library. 18572 18573@item show stop-on-solib-events 18574@kindex show stop-on-solib-events 18575Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared 18576library events happen. 18577@end table 18578 18579Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging 18580configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries; 18581this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries 18582on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the 18583libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are 18584provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the 18585copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are 18586not. 18587 18588@cindex where to look for shared libraries 18589For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target 18590libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it 18591may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables 18592to specify the search directories for target libraries. 18593 18594@table @code 18595@cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names 18596@cindex system root, alternate 18597@kindex set solib-absolute-prefix 18598@kindex set sysroot 18599@item set sysroot @var{path} 18600Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any 18601absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many 18602runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the 18603target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when 18604attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their 18605executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to 18606@value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use 18607@code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need 18608to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with 18609e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under 18610@var{path}. 18611 18612If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target 18613system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries 18614from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote 18615target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File 18616Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path} 18617following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system 18618root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the 18619sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence 18620@file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the 18621functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was 18622provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want 18623to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be 18624named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some 18625equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}. 18626 18627For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and 18628SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target 18629absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts, 18630@value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward 18631slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix: 18632 18633@smallexample 18634 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll 18635@end smallexample 18636 18637Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with 18638@var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file 18639system: 18640 18641@smallexample 18642 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll 18643@end smallexample 18644 18645If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing 18646the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and, 18647for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with 18648colons: 18649 18650@smallexample 18651 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll 18652@end smallexample 18653 18654This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target 18655with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local 18656copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs 18657@samp{z}): 18658 18659@smallexample 18660 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll} 18661 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll} 18662 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll} 18663@end smallexample 18664 18665@noindent 18666and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that 18667@value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both 18668@file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}. 18669 18670If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries 18671removing the whole drive spec from the target file name: 18672 18673@smallexample 18674 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll 18675@end smallexample 18676 18677This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name, 18678if you don't want or need to. 18679 18680The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set 18681sysroot}. 18682 18683@cindex default system root 18684@cindex @samp{--with-sysroot} 18685You can set the default system root by using the configure-time 18686@samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside 18687@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or 18688@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated 18689automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 18690location. 18691 18692@kindex show sysroot 18693@item show sysroot 18694Display the current executable and shared library prefix. 18695 18696@kindex set solib-search-path 18697@item set solib-search-path @var{path} 18698If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 18699directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} 18700is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the 18701path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to 18702use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set 18703@samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from 18704finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting 18705it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading 18706of shared library symbols. 18707 18708@kindex show solib-search-path 18709@item show solib-search-path 18710Display the current shared library search path. 18711 18712@cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names. 18713@kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto) 18714@kindex show target-file-system-kind 18715@item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind} 18716Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names. 18717 18718Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not 18719make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For 18720example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file 18721system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to 18722@value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as 18723@file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of 18724drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as 18725indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash 18726normally considered a directory separator character. In that case, 18727the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name 18728as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make 18729it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's 18730shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical 18731with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting 18732@code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN} 18733to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to 18734map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system 18735semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition 18736to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN} 18737tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the 18738current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the 18739Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are: 18740 18741@table @code 18742@item unix 18743Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix 18744kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character 18745are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also 18746the forward slash. 18747 18748@item dos-based 18749Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based. 18750File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter 18751followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and 18752both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are 18753considered directory separators. 18754 18755@item auto 18756Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the 18757target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}). 18758This is the default. 18759@end table 18760@end table 18761 18762@cindex file name canonicalization 18763@cindex base name differences 18764When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN} 18765frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the 18766program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the 18767@dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast 18768even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last 18769portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.) 18770This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files 18771cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but 18772references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem 18773facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files 18774using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN} 18775using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to 18776@code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each 18777pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name 18778comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown. 18779 18780@table @code 18781@item set basenames-may-differ 18782@kindex set basenames-may-differ 18783Set whether a source file may have multiple base names. 18784 18785@item show basenames-may-differ 18786@kindex show basenames-may-differ 18787Show whether a source file may have multiple base names. 18788@end table 18789 18790@node File Caching 18791@section File Caching 18792@cindex caching of opened files 18793@cindex caching of bfd objects 18794 18795To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will 18796reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, , 18797BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands 18798allow visibility and control of the caching behavior. 18799 18800@table @code 18801@kindex maint info bfds 18802@item maint info bfds 18803This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to 18804@value{GDBN}. 18805 18806@kindex maint set bfd-sharing 18807@kindex maint show bfd-sharing 18808@kindex bfd caching 18809@item maint set bfd-sharing 18810@item maint show bfd-sharing 18811Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is 18812enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather 18813than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause 18814already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files 18815that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly, 18816re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd} 18817objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object. 18818 18819@kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level} 18820@kindex bfd caching 18821@item set debug bfd-cache @var{level} 18822Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}. 18823 18824@kindex show debug bfd-cache 18825@kindex bfd caching 18826@item show debug bfd-cache 18827Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache. 18828@end table 18829 18830@node Separate Debug Files 18831@section Debugging Information in Separate Files 18832@cindex separate debugging information files 18833@cindex debugging information in separate files 18834@cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories 18835@cindex debugging information directory, global 18836@cindex global debugging information directories 18837@cindex build ID, and separate debugging files 18838@cindex @file{.build-id} directory 18839 18840@value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a 18841file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows 18842@value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically. 18843Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger 18844than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging 18845information for their executables in separate files, which users can 18846install only when they need to debug a problem. 18847 18848@value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info 18849file: 18850 18851@itemize @bullet 18852@item 18853The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of 18854the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is 18855usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the 18856name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories 18857(e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the 18858debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC) 18859checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that 18860the executable and the debug file came from the same build. 18861 18862@item 18863The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is 18864also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported 18865only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats 18866for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about 18867this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id} 18868command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info, 18869The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified 18870explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see 18871below. 18872@end itemize 18873 18874Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN} 18875uses two different methods of looking for the debug file: 18876 18877@itemize @bullet 18878@item 18879For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in 18880the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that 18881directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug 18882directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading 18883directories of the executable's absolute file name. 18884 18885@item 18886For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the 18887@file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for 18888a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the 18889first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn} 18890are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more 18891hex characters, not 10.) 18892@end itemize 18893 18894So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug 18895@file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the 18896file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is 18897@code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes 18898@file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following 18899debug information files, in the indicated order: 18900 18901@itemize @minus 18902@item 18903@file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug} 18904@item 18905@file{/usr/bin/ls.debug} 18906@item 18907@file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug} 18908@item 18909@file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}. 18910@end itemize 18911 18912@anchor{debug-file-directory} 18913Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN} 18914configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run 18915you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list 18916@value{GDBN} is currently using. 18917 18918@table @code 18919 18920@kindex set debug-file-directory 18921@item set debug-file-directory @var{directories} 18922Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging 18923information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set 18924concatenating them by a path separator. 18925 18926@kindex show debug-file-directory 18927@item show debug-file-directory 18928Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging 18929information files. 18930 18931@end table 18932 18933@cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections 18934@cindex debug link sections 18935A debug link is a special section of the executable file named 18936@code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain: 18937 18938@itemize 18939@item 18940A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by 18941a zero byte, 18942@item 18943zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte 18944boundary within the section, and 18945@item 18946a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the 18947executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging 18948information file's full contents by the function given below, passing 18949zero as the @var{crc} argument. 18950@end itemize 18951 18952Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can 18953contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents 18954described above. 18955 18956@cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections 18957@cindex build ID sections 18958The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other 18959ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is 18960often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory. 18961It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains 18962the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default 18963algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the 18964content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical 18965value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its 18966stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file. 18967 18968The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary 18969executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and 18970debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file 18971should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file, 18972but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section 18973in an ordinary executable. 18974 18975The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the 18976@samp{objcopy} utility that can produce 18977the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the 18978following commands: 18979 18980@smallexample 18981@kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug} 18982@kbd{strip -g foo} 18983@end smallexample 18984 18985@noindent 18986These commands remove the debugging 18987information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file 18988@file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the 18989two files: 18990 18991@itemize @bullet 18992@item 18993The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave 18994behind a debug link in @file{foo}: 18995 18996@smallexample 18997@kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo} 18998@end smallexample 18999 19000Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains 19001a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f 19002foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and 19003the @code{ln -s} command above, together. 19004 19005@item 19006Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or 19007the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus 19008compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary 19009utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18. 19010@end itemize 19011 19012@noindent 19013 19014@cindex CRC algorithm definition 19015The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in 19016IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial: 19017 19018@c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex 19019@c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using 19020@c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2 19021@c different ways! 19022@ifhtml 19023@display 19024@html 19025 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup> 19026 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1 19027@end html 19028@end display 19029@end ifhtml 19030@ifnothtml 19031@display 19032 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}} 19033 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1} 19034@end display 19035@end ifnothtml 19036 19037The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least 19038significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern 19039@code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and 19040the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the 19041CRC. 19042 19043@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the 19044@dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}). 19045However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed 19046@emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so 19047trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value. 19048 19049To complete the description, we show below the code of the function 19050which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the 19051initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to 19052this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using 19053@code{0xffffffff}. 19054 19055@kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32 19056@smallexample 19057unsigned long 19058gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc, 19059 unsigned char *buf, size_t len) 19060@{ 19061 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] = 19062 @{ 19063 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419, 19064 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4, 19065 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07, 19066 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de, 19067 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856, 19068 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9, 19069 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4, 19070 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b, 19071 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3, 19072 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a, 19073 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599, 19074 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924, 19075 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190, 19076 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f, 19077 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e, 19078 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01, 19079 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed, 19080 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950, 19081 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3, 19082 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2, 19083 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a, 19084 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5, 19085 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010, 19086 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f, 19087 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17, 19088 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6, 19089 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615, 19090 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8, 19091 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344, 19092 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb, 19093 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a, 19094 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5, 19095 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1, 19096 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c, 19097 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef, 19098 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236, 19099 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe, 19100 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31, 19101 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c, 19102 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713, 19103 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b, 19104 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242, 19105 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1, 19106 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c, 19107 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278, 19108 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7, 19109 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66, 19110 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9, 19111 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605, 19112 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8, 19113 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b, 19114 0x2d02ef8d 19115 @}; 19116 unsigned char *end; 19117 19118 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff; 19119 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf) 19120 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8); 19121 return ~crc & 0xffffffff; 19122@} 19123@end smallexample 19124 19125@noindent 19126This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method. 19127 19128@node MiniDebugInfo 19129@section Debugging information in a special section 19130@cindex separate debug sections 19131@cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section 19132 19133Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a 19134special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called 19135@dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and 19136is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces. 19137 19138The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging 19139information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a 19140replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate 19141Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however, 19142@value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of 19143debugging information might be included in the section. 19144 19145@value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists, 19146then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information 19147can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support. 19148 19149This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other 19150standard utilities: 19151 19152@smallexample 19153# Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need 19154# to also have these in the normal symbol table. 19155nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \ 19156 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms 19157 19158# Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo. 19159# (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit 19160# of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.) 19161nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \ 19162 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \ 19163 | sort > funcsyms 19164 19165# Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol 19166# table. 19167comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols 19168 19169# Separate full debug info into debug binary. 19170objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug 19171 19172# Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and 19173# removing some unnecessary sections. 19174objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \ 19175 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo 19176 19177# Drop the full debug info from the original binary. 19178strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary} 19179 19180# Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the 19181# original binary. 19182xz mini_debuginfo 19183objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary} 19184@end smallexample 19185 19186@node Index Files 19187@section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN} 19188@cindex index files 19189@cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section 19190 19191When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the 19192file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most 19193@value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early 19194on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so 19195@value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up 19196startup. 19197 19198The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can 19199write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file 19200using @command{objcopy}. 19201 19202To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command: 19203 19204@table @code 19205@item save gdb-index @var{directory} 19206@kindex save gdb-index 19207Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by 19208@value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file, 19209with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given 19210@var{directory}. 19211@end table 19212 19213Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol 19214file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}: 19215 19216@smallexample 19217$ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \ 19218 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile 19219@end smallexample 19220 19221@value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index} 19222sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because 19223they are missing a new feature or have performance issues. 19224To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway 19225specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}. 19226The default is @code{off}. 19227This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost. 19228@xref{Index Section Format}. 19229 19230@emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on} 19231must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work: 19232 19233@smallexample 19234$ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program> 19235@end smallexample 19236 19237Instead you must do, for example, 19238 19239@smallexample 19240$ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program> 19241@end smallexample 19242 19243There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when 19244for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not 19245currently work for programs using Ada. 19246 19247@node Symbol Errors 19248@section Errors Reading Symbol Files 19249 19250While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems, 19251such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler 19252output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since 19253they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people 19254debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information 19255about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print 19256only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many 19257times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages, 19258to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set 19259complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 19260Messages}). 19261 19262The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include: 19263 19264@table @code 19265@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol} 19266 19267The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end 19268(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This 19269error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained 19270in its outer scope blocks. 19271 19272@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had 19273the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol} 19274may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a 19275function. 19276 19277@item block at @var{address} out of order 19278 19279The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in 19280order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not 19281do so. 19282 19283@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble 19284locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You 19285can often determine what source file is affected by specifying 19286@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and 19287Messages}.) 19288 19289@item bad block start address patched 19290 19291The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address 19292smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known 19293to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler. 19294 19295@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as 19296starting on the previous source line. 19297 19298@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n} 19299 19300@cindex foo 19301Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is 19302larger than the size of the string table. 19303 19304@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the 19305name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up 19306with this name. 19307 19308@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}} 19309 19310The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does 19311not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the 19312uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal. 19313 19314@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information. 19315This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols 19316are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like 19317debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint 19318on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab} 19319and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol. 19320 19321@item stub type has NULL name 19322 19323@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class. 19324 19325@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{} 19326The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some 19327information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for 19328it. 19329 19330@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger 19331 19332@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler. 19333 19334@end table 19335 19336@node Data Files 19337@section GDB Data Files 19338 19339@cindex prefix for data files 19340@value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files 19341are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}. 19342 19343You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN} 19344is currently using. 19345 19346@table @code 19347@kindex set data-directory 19348@item set data-directory @var{directory} 19349Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files 19350to @var{directory}. 19351 19352@kindex show data-directory 19353@item show data-directory 19354Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files. 19355@end table 19356 19357@cindex default data directory 19358@cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} 19359You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time 19360@samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside 19361@value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or 19362@samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated 19363automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new 19364location. 19365 19366The data directory may also be specified with the 19367@code{--data-directory} command line option. 19368@xref{Mode Options}. 19369 19370@node Targets 19371@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target 19372 19373@cindex debugging target 19374A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program. 19375 19376Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program; 19377in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when 19378you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more 19379flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate 19380host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a 19381realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target} 19382command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN} 19383(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}). 19384 19385@cindex target architecture 19386It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target 19387architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose 19388one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture} 19389command. 19390 19391@table @code 19392@kindex set architecture 19393@kindex show architecture 19394@item set architecture @var{arch} 19395This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The 19396value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the 19397supported architectures. 19398 19399@item show architecture 19400Show the current target architecture. 19401 19402@item set processor 19403@itemx processor 19404@kindex set processor 19405@kindex show processor 19406These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture} 19407and @code{show architecture}. 19408@end table 19409 19410@menu 19411* Active Targets:: Active targets 19412* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets 19413* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order 19414@end menu 19415 19416@node Active Targets 19417@section Active Targets 19418 19419@cindex stacking targets 19420@cindex active targets 19421@cindex multiple targets 19422 19423There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or 19424recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file 19425and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently 19426on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for 19427example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to 19428the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process 19429recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are 19430presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target 19431remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution. 19432 19433Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core 19434file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To 19435specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach} 19436command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}). 19437 19438@node Target Commands 19439@section Commands for Managing Targets 19440 19441@table @code 19442@item target @var{type} @var{parameters} 19443Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or 19444process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging 19445facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or 19446protocol of the target machine. 19447 19448Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but 19449typically include things like device names or host names to connect 19450with, process numbers, and baud rates. 19451 19452The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again 19453after executing the command. 19454 19455@kindex help target 19456@item help target 19457Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets 19458currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files} 19459(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). 19460 19461@item help target @var{name} 19462Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to 19463select it. 19464 19465@kindex set gnutarget 19466@item set gnutarget @var{args} 19467@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN} 19468knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable}, 19469a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format 19470with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands, 19471with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine. 19472 19473@quotation 19474@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget}, 19475you must know the actual BFD name. 19476@end quotation 19477 19478@noindent 19479@xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}. 19480 19481@kindex show gnutarget 19482@item show gnutarget 19483Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format 19484@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget}, 19485@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically, 19486and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}. 19487@end table 19488 19489@cindex common targets 19490Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB 19491configuration): 19492 19493@table @code 19494@kindex target 19495@item target exec @var{program} 19496@cindex executable file target 19497An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as 19498@samp{exec-file @var{program}}. 19499 19500@item target core @var{filename} 19501@cindex core dump file target 19502A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as 19503@samp{core-file @var{filename}}. 19504 19505@item target remote @var{medium} 19506@cindex remote target 19507A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network 19508connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote 19509protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}. 19510 19511For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the 19512machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say: 19513 19514@smallexample 19515target remote /dev/ttya 19516@end smallexample 19517 19518@code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only 19519useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target 19520system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get 19521clobbered by the download. 19522 19523@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{} 19524@cindex built-in simulator target 19525Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures. 19526In general, 19527@smallexample 19528 target sim 19529 load 19530 run 19531@end smallexample 19532@noindent 19533works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device 19534drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do 19535provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details, 19536see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded 19537Processors}. 19538 19539@item target native 19540@cindex native target 19541Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the 19542@code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach}, 19543etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off} 19544(@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}). 19545 19546@end table 19547 19548Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN}; 19549your configuration may have more or fewer targets. 19550 19551Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once 19552you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control 19553various aspects of this process. 19554 19555@table @code 19556 19557@item set hash 19558@kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors} 19559@cindex hash mark while downloading 19560This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while 19561downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is 19562displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the 19563monitor. 19564 19565@item show hash 19566@kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors} 19567Show the current status of displaying the hash mark. 19568 19569@item set debug monitor 19570@kindex set debug monitor 19571@cindex display remote monitor communications 19572Enable or disable display of communications messages between 19573@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor. 19574 19575@item show debug monitor 19576@kindex show debug monitor 19577Show the current status of displaying communications between 19578@value{GDBN} and the remote monitor. 19579@end table 19580 19581@table @code 19582 19583@kindex load @var{filename} 19584@item load @var{filename} 19585@anchor{load} 19586Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into 19587@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it 19588is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging 19589on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example. 19590@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like 19591the @code{add-symbol-file} command. 19592 19593If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to 19594execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your 19595target is @dots{}}'' 19596 19597The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable. 19598For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you 19599link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format 19600specifies a fixed address. 19601@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc. 19602 19603Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to 19604load programs into flash memory. 19605 19606@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it. 19607@end table 19608 19609@node Byte Order 19610@section Choosing Target Byte Order 19611 19612@cindex choosing target byte order 19613@cindex target byte order 19614 19615Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH, 19616offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte 19617orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to 19618designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about 19619which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust 19620@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually. 19621 19622@table @code 19623@kindex set endian 19624@item set endian big 19625Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian. 19626 19627@item set endian little 19628Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian. 19629 19630@item set endian auto 19631Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the 19632executable. 19633 19634@item show endian 19635Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order. 19636 19637@end table 19638 19639Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic 19640data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the 19641target system. 19642 19643 19644@node Remote Debugging 19645@chapter Debugging Remote Programs 19646@cindex remote debugging 19647 19648If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run 19649@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging. 19650For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel, 19651or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system 19652powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger. 19653 19654Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces 19655to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition, 19656@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN}, 19657but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you 19658write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to 19659communicate with @value{GDBN}. 19660 19661Other remote targets may be available in your 19662configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them. 19663 19664@menu 19665* Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target 19666* File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system 19667* Server:: Using the gdbserver program 19668* Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration 19669* Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub 19670@end menu 19671 19672@node Connecting 19673@section Connecting to a Remote Target 19674@cindex remote debugging, connecting 19675@cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting 19676@cindex remote debugging, types of connections 19677@cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections 19678@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode 19679@cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode 19680 19681This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the 19682types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and 19683symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for 19684connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target. 19685 19686@subsection Types of Remote Connections 19687 19688@value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote} 19689mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets 19690support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major 19691differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here: 19692 19693@table @asis 19694 19695@cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit 19696@item Result of detach or program exit 19697@strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you 19698detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using 19699@code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit. 19700 19701@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or 19702you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even 19703though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a 19704running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target. 19705 19706When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was 19707invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option 19708was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the 19709@code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). 19710 19711@item Specifying the program to debug 19712For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the 19713program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are 19714some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the 19715target. 19716 19717@strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug 19718on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option 19719(@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}). 19720 19721@cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option 19722@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug 19723on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach 19724to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}. 19725 19726@anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections} 19727You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run 19728or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line 19729option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start 19730the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the 19731@code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which 19732@code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it 19733(@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The 19734@option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that. 19735 19736@item The @code{run} command 19737@strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not 19738supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all 19739the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The 19740remote program is already running, so you can use commands like 19741@kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}. 19742 19743@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is 19744supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by 19745@code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select 19746the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for 19747wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}). 19748 19749If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the 19750@code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can 19751resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with 19752@code{target remote} mode. 19753 19754@anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections} 19755@item Attaching 19756@strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is 19757not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you 19758must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}). 19759 19760@strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program, 19761you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been 19762established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke 19763@code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option 19764(@pxref{Running gdbserver}). 19765 19766@end table 19767 19768@anchor{Host and target files} 19769@subsection Host and Target Files 19770@cindex remote debugging, symbol files 19771@cindex symbol files, remote debugging 19772 19773@value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging 19774information for your program running on the target. This requires 19775access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated 19776symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target 19777remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. 19778 19779Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and 19780@pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over 19781the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a 19782target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is 19783@code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}). 19784 19785If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote 19786program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local 19787unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the 19788@code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on 19789the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with 19790the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you 19791may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates 19792target libraries. 19793 19794The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable 19795and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host 19796system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system 19797are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results 19798during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing 19799files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded 19800programs. 19801 19802@subsection Remote Connection Commands 19803@cindex remote connection commands 19804@value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or 19805over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In 19806each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your 19807program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The 19808@code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands 19809establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same 19810arguments, which indicate the medium to use: 19811 19812@table @code 19813 19814@item target remote @var{serial-device} 19815@itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device} 19816@cindex serial line, @code{target remote} 19817Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example, 19818to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}: 19819 19820@smallexample 19821target remote /dev/ttyb 19822@end smallexample 19823 19824If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the 19825@samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command 19826(@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the 19827@code{target} command. 19828 19829@item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} 19830@itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19831@itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} 19832@itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19833@cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote} 19834Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}. 19835The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP} 19836address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be 19837the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or 19838it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the 19839target. 19840 19841For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named 19842@code{manyfarms}: 19843 19844@smallexample 19845target remote manyfarms:2828 19846@end smallexample 19847 19848If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your 19849debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the 19850same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to 19851port 1234 on your local machine: 19852 19853@smallexample 19854target remote :1234 19855@end smallexample 19856@noindent 19857 19858Note that the colon is still required here. 19859 19860@item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19861@itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}} 19862@cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote} 19863Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to 19864connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}: 19865 19866@smallexample 19867target remote udp:manyfarms:2828 19868@end smallexample 19869 19870When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should 19871keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP} 19872can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will 19873cause havoc with your debugging session. 19874 19875@item target remote | @var{command} 19876@itemx target extended-remote | @var{command} 19877@cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to 19878Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a 19879pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded 19880by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote 19881protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its 19882standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator 19883that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections 19884using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks. 19885 19886If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting), 19887@value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the 19888program has already exited, this will have no effect.) 19889 19890@end table 19891 19892@cindex interrupting remote programs 19893@cindex remote programs, interrupting 19894Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the 19895interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the 19896program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware 19897and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the 19898interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt: 19899 19900@smallexample 19901Interrupted while waiting for the program. 19902Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n) 19903@end smallexample 19904 19905In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons 19906the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later, 19907you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type 19908@kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting. 19909 19910In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave 19911@value{GDBN} connected to the target. 19912 19913@table @code 19914@kindex detach (remote) 19915@item detach 19916When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the 19917@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. 19918Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results 19919will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach} 19920command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to 19921another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is 19922still connected to the target. 19923 19924@kindex disconnect 19925@item disconnect 19926The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and 19927the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN} 19928(this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After 19929the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to 19930another target. 19931 19932@cindex send command to remote monitor 19933@cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets 19934@cindex add new commands for external monitor 19935@kindex monitor 19936@item monitor @var{cmd} 19937This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the 19938remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it 19939sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you 19940can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand 19941and implement. 19942@end table 19943 19944@node File Transfer 19945@section Sending files to a remote system 19946@cindex remote target, file transfer 19947@cindex file transfer 19948@cindex sending files to remote systems 19949 19950Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same 19951connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient 19952for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems 19953running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets, 19954e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be 19955the only way to upload or download files. 19956 19957Not all remote targets support these commands. 19958 19959@table @code 19960@kindex remote put 19961@item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile} 19962Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running 19963@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system. 19964 19965@kindex remote get 19966@item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile} 19967Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile} 19968on the host system. 19969 19970@kindex remote delete 19971@item remote delete @var{targetfile} 19972Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system. 19973 19974@end table 19975 19976@node Server 19977@section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program 19978 19979@kindex gdbserver 19980@cindex remote connection without stubs 19981@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which 19982allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via 19983@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without 19984linking in the usual debugging stub. 19985 19986@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs, 19987because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities 19988that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run 19989@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run 19990@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless, 19991because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is 19992also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get 19993started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}. 19994Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that 19995the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to 19996do as much development work as possible on another system, for example 19997by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar 19998choice for debugging. 19999 20000@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line 20001or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial 20002protocol. 20003 20004@quotation 20005@emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security. 20006Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a 20007@value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the 20008target system with the same privileges as the user running 20009@code{gdbserver}. 20010@end quotation 20011 20012@anchor{Running gdbserver} 20013@subsection Running @code{gdbserver} 20014@cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver} 20015@cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments 20016 20017Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the 20018program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires. 20019@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can 20020strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host 20021system does all the symbol handling. 20022 20023To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN}; 20024the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual 20025syntax is: 20026 20027@smallexample 20028target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ] 20029@end smallexample 20030 20031@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP 20032hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use 20033stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. 20034For example, to debug Emacs with the argument 20035@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port 20036@file{/dev/com1}: 20037 20038@smallexample 20039target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt 20040@end smallexample 20041 20042@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate 20043with it. 20044 20045To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line: 20046 20047@smallexample 20048target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt 20049@end smallexample 20050 20051The only difference from the previous example is the first argument, 20052specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via 20053TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to 20054expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345. 20055(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number 20056you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any 20057TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is 20058reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that 20059conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message 20060and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN} 20061@code{target remote} command. 20062 20063The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver} 20064with ssh: 20065 20066@smallexample 20067(gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello 20068@end smallexample 20069 20070The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty, 20071and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when 20072a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit. 20073You could elide it if you want to. 20074 20075Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for 20076@code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for 20077display through a pipe connected to gdbserver. 20078Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe. 20079 20080@anchor{Attaching to a program} 20081@subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program 20082@cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver} 20083@cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option 20084 20085On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs. 20086This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is: 20087 20088@smallexample 20089target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 20090@end smallexample 20091 20092@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't 20093necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process. 20094 20095In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the 20096@value{GDBN} attach command 20097(@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}). 20098 20099@pindex pidof 20100You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the 20101@code{pidof} utility: 20102 20103@smallexample 20104target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}` 20105@end smallexample 20106 20107In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program} 20108has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the 20109@code{-s} option to only return the first process ID. 20110 20111@subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver} 20112 20113This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP 20114port. 20115 20116@code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have 20117terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target 20118extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left. 20119@value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit, 20120which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote} 20121mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN} 20122cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver} 20123stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode. 20124 20125When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later. 20126Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For 20127completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time. 20128 20129@cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option 20130By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that 20131subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver} 20132with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further 20133connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This 20134means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the 20135first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first 20136connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed 20137connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The 20138@option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to 20139multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each 20140instance closes its port after the first connection. 20141 20142@anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver} 20143@subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver} 20144 20145You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without 20146specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can 20147attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a 20148program. For more information, 20149@pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}. 20150 20151@cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option 20152The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra 20153status information about the debugging process. 20154@cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option 20155The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display 20156remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for 20157@code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers. 20158 20159@cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option 20160The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells 20161@code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output. 20162Possible options are: 20163 20164@table @code 20165@item none 20166Turn off all extra information in debugging output. 20167@item all 20168Turn on all extra information in debugging output. 20169@item timestamps 20170Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output. 20171@end table 20172 20173Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none} 20174appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output. 20175 20176@cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option 20177The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs 20178for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the 20179wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then 20180@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments. 20181 20182@code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined 20183command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the 20184program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper 20185runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control. 20186 20187You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with 20188its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do 20189this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending 20190with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work. 20191 20192For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to 20193the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s 20194environment: 20195 20196@smallexample 20197$ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog 20198@end smallexample 20199 20200@subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver} 20201 20202The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is: 20203@itemize 20204 20205@item 20206Run @value{GDBN} on the host system. 20207 20208@item 20209Make sure you have the necessary symbol files 20210(@pxref{Host and target files}). 20211Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you 20212connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your 20213@value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using 20214@code{--with-sysroot}). 20215 20216@item 20217Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}). 20218For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using 20219the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose 20220text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like 20221@samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load} 20222command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the 20223program is already on the target. 20224 20225@end itemize 20226 20227@anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver} 20228@subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver} 20229@cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver} 20230 20231During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the 20232@code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}. 20233Here are the available commands. 20234 20235@table @code 20236@item monitor help 20237List the available monitor commands. 20238 20239@item monitor set debug 0 20240@itemx monitor set debug 1 20241Disable or enable general debugging messages. 20242 20243@item monitor set remote-debug 0 20244@itemx monitor set remote-debug 1 20245Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote 20246protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}). 20247 20248@item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]} 20249Specify additional text to add to debugging messages. 20250Possible options are: 20251 20252@table @code 20253@item none 20254Turn off all extra information in debugging output. 20255@item all 20256Turn on all extra information in debugging output. 20257@item timestamps 20258Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output. 20259@end table 20260 20261Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none} 20262appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output. 20263 20264@item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH] 20265@cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db} 20266When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of 20267directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set 20268libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path}, 20269@samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value. 20270 20271The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is 20272not supported in @code{gdbserver}. 20273 20274@item monitor exit 20275Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by 20276@code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will 20277detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created. 20278Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end 20279of a multi-process mode debug session. 20280 20281@end table 20282 20283@subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver} 20284@cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver} 20285 20286On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast 20287tracepoints and static tracepoints. 20288 20289For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the 20290@dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process. 20291This library is built and distributed as an integral part of 20292@code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints 20293requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints 20294support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer, 20295@url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support 20296is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the 20297standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if 20298@code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust} 20299to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support 20300using @option{--with-ust=no}. 20301 20302There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program: 20303 20304@table @code 20305@item Specifying it as dependency at link time 20306 20307You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent 20308library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding 20309@code{-linproctrace} to the link command. 20310 20311@item Using the system's preloading mechanisms 20312 20313You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using 20314your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes 20315support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most 20316cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so} 20317in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s 20318@option{--wrapper} command line option. 20319 20320@item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time 20321 20322On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library, 20323by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care 20324of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix 20325systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call} 20326command for that. For example: 20327 20328@smallexample 20329(@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...) 20330@end smallexample 20331 20332Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be 20333available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}. 20334@end table 20335 20336On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix 20337systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target 20338remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic 20339loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the 20340program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that 20341case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints 20342features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared 20343libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the 20344main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start 20345@code{gdbserver} like so: 20346 20347@smallexample 20348$ gdbserver :9999 myprogram 20349@end smallexample 20350 20351Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main: 20352 20353@smallexample 20354$ gdb myprogram 20355(@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999 203560x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2 20357(@value{GDBP}) b main 20358(@value{GDBP}) continue 20359@end smallexample 20360 20361The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the 20362process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary} 20363command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the 20364process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static 20365tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start 20366tracing. 20367 20368@node Remote Configuration 20369@section Remote Configuration 20370 20371@kindex set remote 20372@kindex show remote 20373This section documents the configuration options available when 20374debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O 20375extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system, 20376system-call-allowed}. 20377 20378@table @code 20379@item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits} 20380@cindex address size for remote targets 20381@cindex bits in remote address 20382Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified 20383number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above 20384that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The 20385default value is the number of bits in the target's address. 20386 20387@item show remoteaddresssize 20388Show the current value of remote address size in bits. 20389 20390@item set serial baud @var{n} 20391@cindex baud rate for remote targets 20392Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The 20393value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging 20394remote targets. 20395 20396@item show serial baud 20397Show the current speed of the remote connection. 20398 20399@item set serial parity @var{parity} 20400Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are: 20401@code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}. 20402 20403@item show serial parity 20404Show the current parity of the serial port. 20405 20406@item set remotebreak 20407@cindex interrupt remote programs 20408@cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C 20409@anchor{set remotebreak} 20410If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote 20411when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running 20412on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C} 20413character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems 20414expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal. 20415 20416@item show remotebreak 20417Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to 20418interrupt the remote program. 20419 20420@item set remoteflow on 20421@itemx set remoteflow off 20422@kindex set remoteflow 20423Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS}) 20424on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target. 20425 20426@item show remoteflow 20427@kindex show remoteflow 20428Show the current setting of hardware flow control. 20429 20430@item set remotelogbase @var{base} 20431Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol 20432communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are: 20433@code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is 20434@code{ascii}. 20435 20436@item show remotelogbase 20437Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial 20438protocol. 20439 20440@item set remotelogfile @var{file} 20441@cindex record serial communications on file 20442Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The 20443default is not to record at all. 20444 20445@item show remotelogfile. 20446Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the 20447serial communications. 20448 20449@item set remotetimeout @var{num} 20450@cindex timeout for serial communications 20451@cindex remote timeout 20452Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to 20453@var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds. 20454 20455@item show remotetimeout 20456Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target 20457responses. 20458 20459@cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints 20460@cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints 20461@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit} 20462@anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit} 20463@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit} 20464@itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit} 20465Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or 20466watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited. 20467 20468@cindex limit hardware watchpoints length 20469@cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length 20470@anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit} 20471@item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit} 20472Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of 20473a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated 20474as unlimited. 20475 20476@item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit 20477Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of 20478a remote hardware watchpoint. 20479 20480@item set remote exec-file @var{filename} 20481@itemx show remote exec-file 20482@anchor{set remote exec-file} 20483@cindex executable file, for remote target 20484Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target 20485extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the 20486target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default 20487filename (e.g.@: the last program run). 20488 20489@item set remote interrupt-sequence 20490@cindex interrupt remote programs 20491@cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g 20492Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or 20493@samp{BREAK-g} as the 20494sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution. 20495@samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which 20496is high level of serial line for some certain time. 20497Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g. 20498It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}. 20499 20500@item show interrupt-sequence 20501Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g} 20502is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program. 20503@code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and 20504also known as Magic SysRq g. 20505 20506@item set remote interrupt-on-connect 20507@cindex send interrupt-sequence on start 20508Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when 20509@value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug 20510Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} 20511which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}. 20512 20513@item show interrupt-on-connect 20514Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent 20515to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it. 20516 20517@kindex set tcp 20518@kindex show tcp 20519@item set tcp auto-retry on 20520@cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target 20521Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote 20522debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race 20523condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection 20524before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is 20525enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts 20526to establish the connection using the timeout specified by 20527@code{set tcp connect-timeout}. 20528 20529@item set tcp auto-retry off 20530Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections. 20531 20532@item show tcp auto-retry 20533Show the current auto-retry setting. 20534 20535@item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds} 20536@itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited 20537@cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target 20538@cindex timeout, for remote target connection 20539Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to 20540@var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections 20541(enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections 20542that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative 20543value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and 20544@value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever, 20545unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds. 20546 20547@item show tcp connect-timeout 20548Show the current connection timeout setting. 20549@end table 20550 20551@cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling 20552The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by 20553your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you 20554can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each 20555packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this 20556packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet), 20557or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They 20558all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet, 20559see @ref{Remote Protocol}. 20560 20561During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands. 20562If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug 20563in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the 20564@value{GDBN} developers. 20565 20566For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the 20567packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings 20568are: 20569 20570@multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25 20571@item Command Name 20572@tab Remote Packet 20573@tab Related Features 20574 20575@item @code{fetch-register} 20576@tab @code{p} 20577@tab @code{info registers} 20578 20579@item @code{set-register} 20580@tab @code{P} 20581@tab @code{set} 20582 20583@item @code{binary-download} 20584@tab @code{X} 20585@tab @code{load}, @code{set} 20586 20587@item @code{read-aux-vector} 20588@tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read} 20589@tab @code{info auxv} 20590 20591@item @code{symbol-lookup} 20592@tab @code{qSymbol} 20593@tab Detecting multiple threads 20594 20595@item @code{attach} 20596@tab @code{vAttach} 20597@tab @code{attach} 20598 20599@item @code{verbose-resume} 20600@tab @code{vCont} 20601@tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads 20602 20603@item @code{run} 20604@tab @code{vRun} 20605@tab @code{run} 20606 20607@item @code{software-breakpoint} 20608@tab @code{Z0} 20609@tab @code{break} 20610 20611@item @code{hardware-breakpoint} 20612@tab @code{Z1} 20613@tab @code{hbreak} 20614 20615@item @code{write-watchpoint} 20616@tab @code{Z2} 20617@tab @code{watch} 20618 20619@item @code{read-watchpoint} 20620@tab @code{Z3} 20621@tab @code{rwatch} 20622 20623@item @code{access-watchpoint} 20624@tab @code{Z4} 20625@tab @code{awatch} 20626 20627@item @code{pid-to-exec-file} 20628@tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read} 20629@tab @code{attach}, @code{run} 20630 20631@item @code{target-features} 20632@tab @code{qXfer:features:read} 20633@tab @code{set architecture} 20634 20635@item @code{library-info} 20636@tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read} 20637@tab @code{info sharedlibrary} 20638 20639@item @code{memory-map} 20640@tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read} 20641@tab @code{info mem} 20642 20643@item @code{read-sdata-object} 20644@tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read} 20645@tab @code{print $_sdata} 20646 20647@item @code{read-spu-object} 20648@tab @code{qXfer:spu:read} 20649@tab @code{info spu} 20650 20651@item @code{write-spu-object} 20652@tab @code{qXfer:spu:write} 20653@tab @code{info spu} 20654 20655@item @code{read-siginfo-object} 20656@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read} 20657@tab @code{print $_siginfo} 20658 20659@item @code{write-siginfo-object} 20660@tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write} 20661@tab @code{set $_siginfo} 20662 20663@item @code{threads} 20664@tab @code{qXfer:threads:read} 20665@tab @code{info threads} 20666 20667@item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address} 20668@tab @code{qGetTLSAddr} 20669@tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables 20670 20671@item @code{get-thread-information-block-address} 20672@tab @code{qGetTIBAddr} 20673@tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block. 20674 20675@item @code{search-memory} 20676@tab @code{qSearch:memory} 20677@tab @code{find} 20678 20679@item @code{supported-packets} 20680@tab @code{qSupported} 20681@tab Remote communications parameters 20682 20683@item @code{catch-syscalls} 20684@tab @code{QCatchSyscalls} 20685@tab @code{catch syscall} 20686 20687@item @code{pass-signals} 20688@tab @code{QPassSignals} 20689@tab @code{handle @var{signal}} 20690 20691@item @code{program-signals} 20692@tab @code{QProgramSignals} 20693@tab @code{handle @var{signal}} 20694 20695@item @code{hostio-close-packet} 20696@tab @code{vFile:close} 20697@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20698 20699@item @code{hostio-open-packet} 20700@tab @code{vFile:open} 20701@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20702 20703@item @code{hostio-pread-packet} 20704@tab @code{vFile:pread} 20705@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20706 20707@item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet} 20708@tab @code{vFile:pwrite} 20709@tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put} 20710 20711@item @code{hostio-unlink-packet} 20712@tab @code{vFile:unlink} 20713@tab @code{remote delete} 20714 20715@item @code{hostio-readlink-packet} 20716@tab @code{vFile:readlink} 20717@tab Host I/O 20718 20719@item @code{hostio-fstat-packet} 20720@tab @code{vFile:fstat} 20721@tab Host I/O 20722 20723@item @code{hostio-setfs-packet} 20724@tab @code{vFile:setfs} 20725@tab Host I/O 20726 20727@item @code{noack-packet} 20728@tab @code{QStartNoAckMode} 20729@tab Packet acknowledgment 20730 20731@item @code{osdata} 20732@tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read} 20733@tab @code{info os} 20734 20735@item @code{query-attached} 20736@tab @code{qAttached} 20737@tab Querying remote process attach state. 20738 20739@item @code{trace-buffer-size} 20740@tab @code{QTBuffer:size} 20741@tab @code{set trace-buffer-size} 20742 20743@item @code{trace-status} 20744@tab @code{qTStatus} 20745@tab @code{tstatus} 20746 20747@item @code{traceframe-info} 20748@tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 20749@tab Traceframe info 20750 20751@item @code{install-in-trace} 20752@tab @code{InstallInTrace} 20753@tab Install tracepoint in tracing 20754 20755@item @code{disable-randomization} 20756@tab @code{QDisableRandomization} 20757@tab @code{set disable-randomization} 20758 20759@item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet} 20760@tab @code{Z0 and Z1} 20761@tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation} 20762 20763@item @code{multiprocess-extensions} 20764@tab @code{multiprocess extensions} 20765@tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness 20766 20767@item @code{swbreak-feature} 20768@tab @code{swbreak stop reason} 20769@tab @code{break} 20770 20771@item @code{hwbreak-feature} 20772@tab @code{hwbreak stop reason} 20773@tab @code{hbreak} 20774 20775@item @code{fork-event-feature} 20776@tab @code{fork stop reason} 20777@tab @code{fork} 20778 20779@item @code{vfork-event-feature} 20780@tab @code{vfork stop reason} 20781@tab @code{vfork} 20782 20783@item @code{exec-event-feature} 20784@tab @code{exec stop reason} 20785@tab @code{exec} 20786 20787@item @code{thread-events} 20788@tab @code{QThreadEvents} 20789@tab Tracking thread lifetime. 20790 20791@item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply} 20792@tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply} 20793@tab Tracking thread lifetime. 20794 20795@end multitable 20796 20797@node Remote Stub 20798@section Implementing a Remote Stub 20799 20800@cindex debugging stub, example 20801@cindex remote stub, example 20802@cindex stub example, remote debugging 20803The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the 20804communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the 20805@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow 20806these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're 20807implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start 20808with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best 20809organized, and therefore the easiest to read.) 20810 20811@cindex remote serial debugging, overview 20812To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging 20813@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual 20814prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C 20815program, you need: 20816 20817@enumerate 20818@item 20819A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually 20820have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by 20821your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own. 20822 20823@item 20824A C subroutine library to support your program's 20825subroutine calls, notably managing input and output. 20826 20827@item 20828A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a 20829download program. These are often supplied by the hardware 20830manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware 20831documentation. 20832@end enumerate 20833 20834The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to 20835communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host} 20836machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this: 20837 20838@table @emph 20839@item On the host, 20840@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything 20841else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command 20842(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 20843 20844@item On the target, 20845you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that 20846implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these 20847subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}. 20848 20849On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program 20850@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program. 20851@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details. 20852@end table 20853 20854The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote 20855machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on 20856@sc{sparc} boards. 20857 20858@cindex remote serial stub list 20859These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}: 20860 20861@table @code 20862 20863@item i386-stub.c 20864@cindex @file{i386-stub.c} 20865@cindex Intel 20866@cindex i386 20867For Intel 386 and compatible architectures. 20868 20869@item m68k-stub.c 20870@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c} 20871@cindex Motorola 680x0 20872@cindex m680x0 20873For Motorola 680x0 architectures. 20874 20875@item sh-stub.c 20876@cindex @file{sh-stub.c} 20877@cindex Renesas 20878@cindex SH 20879For Renesas SH architectures. 20880 20881@item sparc-stub.c 20882@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c} 20883@cindex Sparc 20884For @sc{sparc} architectures. 20885 20886@item sparcl-stub.c 20887@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c} 20888@cindex Fujitsu 20889@cindex SparcLite 20890For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures. 20891 20892@end table 20893 20894The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other 20895recently added stubs. 20896 20897@menu 20898* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you 20899* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub 20900* Debug Session:: Putting it all together 20901@end menu 20902 20903@node Stub Contents 20904@subsection What the Stub Can Do for You 20905 20906@cindex remote serial stub 20907The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three 20908subroutines: 20909 20910@table @code 20911@item set_debug_traps 20912@findex set_debug_traps 20913@cindex remote serial stub, initialization 20914This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your 20915program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your 20916program's startup code. 20917 20918@item handle_exception 20919@findex handle_exception 20920@cindex remote serial stub, main routine 20921This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it 20922explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to 20923run when a trap is triggered. 20924 20925@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during 20926execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications 20927with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications 20928protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN} 20929representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary 20930information on the state of your program, then continues to execute, 20931retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you 20932execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point, 20933@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target 20934machine. 20935 20936@item breakpoint 20937@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote 20938Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a 20939breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only 20940way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target 20941machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this; 20942pressing the interrupt button transfers control to 20943@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines, 20944simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap; 20945again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from 20946your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host 20947@value{GDBN} session gets control. 20948 20949Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want 20950to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the 20951start of your debugging session. 20952@end table 20953 20954@node Bootstrapping 20955@subsection What You Must Do for the Stub 20956 20957@cindex remote stub, support routines 20958The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular 20959chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your 20960debugging target machine. 20961 20962First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the 20963serial port. 20964 20965@table @code 20966@item int getDebugChar() 20967@findex getDebugChar 20968Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port. 20969It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a 20970different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish. 20971 20972@item void putDebugChar(int) 20973@findex putDebugChar 20974Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port. 20975It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a 20976different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish. 20977@end table 20978 20979@cindex control C, and remote debugging 20980@cindex interrupting remote targets 20981If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is 20982running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange 20983for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C 20984character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the 20985remote system to stop. 20986 20987Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN} 20988probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way 20989is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that 20990@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}). 20991 20992Other routines you need to supply are: 20993 20994@table @code 20995@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address}) 20996@findex exceptionHandler 20997Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception 20998handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any 20999way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system 21000are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom}, 21001containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}). 21002The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed; 21003its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers 21004might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this 21005exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to 21006@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers, 21007and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if 21008you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it 21009should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine. 21010 21011For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt 21012gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate 21013should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The 21014@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without 21015help from @code{exceptionHandler}. 21016 21017@item void flush_i_cache() 21018@findex flush_i_cache 21019On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the 21020instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no 21021instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op. 21022 21023On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this 21024function to make certain that the state of your program is stable. 21025@end table 21026 21027@noindent 21028You must also make sure this library routine is available: 21029 21030@table @code 21031@item void *memset(void *, int, int) 21032@findex memset 21033This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of 21034memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of 21035@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must 21036either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own. 21037@end table 21038 21039If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard 21040library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another, 21041but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library 21042subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code. 21043 21044 21045@node Debug Session 21046@subsection Putting it All Together 21047 21048@cindex remote serial debugging summary 21049In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these 21050steps. 21051 21052@enumerate 21053@item 21054Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines 21055(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}): 21056@display 21057@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar}, 21058@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}. 21059@end display 21060 21061@item 21062Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main 21063procedure is called: 21064 21065@smallexample 21066set_debug_traps(); 21067breakpoint(); 21068@end smallexample 21069 21070On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware 21071automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the 21072breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust 21073@code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction 21074after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program 21075doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making 21076progress. 21077 21078@item 21079For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called 21080@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use: 21081 21082@smallexample 21083void (*exceptionHook)() = 0; 21084@end smallexample 21085 21086@noindent 21087but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a 21088function in your program, that function is called when 21089@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus 21090error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with 21091one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number. 21092 21093@item 21094Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for 21095your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines. 21096 21097@item 21098Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and 21099the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host. 21100 21101@item 21102@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should 21103@c document that. FIXME. 21104Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by 21105whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it. 21106 21107@item 21108Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target 21109(@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}). 21110 21111@end enumerate 21112 21113@node Configurations 21114@chapter Configuration-Specific Information 21115 21116While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and 21117cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter 21118describes things that are only available in certain configurations. 21119 21120There are three major categories of configurations: native 21121configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded 21122operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several 21123different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which 21124are quite different from each other. 21125 21126@menu 21127* Native:: 21128* Embedded OS:: 21129* Embedded Processors:: 21130* Architectures:: 21131@end menu 21132 21133@node Native 21134@section Native 21135 21136This section describes details specific to particular native 21137configurations. 21138 21139@menu 21140* BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images 21141* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information 21142* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port 21143* Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port 21144* Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd 21145* Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin 21146@end menu 21147 21148@node BSD libkvm Interface 21149@subsection BSD libkvm Interface 21150 21151@cindex libkvm 21152@cindex kernel memory image 21153@cindex kernel crash dump 21154 21155BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory 21156interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual 21157memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN} 21158uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash 21159dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a 21160special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load 21161the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the 21162@code{kvm} target: 21163 21164@smallexample 21165(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm} 21166@end smallexample 21167 21168For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an 21169argument: 21170 21171@smallexample 21172(@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0} 21173@end smallexample 21174 21175Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are 21176available: 21177 21178@table @code 21179@kindex kvm 21180@item kvm pcb 21181Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address. 21182 21183@item kvm proc 21184Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on 21185modern FreeBSD systems. 21186@end table 21187 21188@node SVR4 Process Information 21189@subsection SVR4 Process Information 21190@cindex /proc 21191@cindex examine process image 21192@cindex process info via @file{/proc} 21193 21194Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called 21195@samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running 21196process using file-system subroutines. 21197 21198If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this 21199facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report 21200information about the process running your program, or about any 21201process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing, 21202@sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, for example. 21203 21204This command may also work on core files that were created on a system 21205that has the @samp{/proc} facility. 21206 21207@table @code 21208@kindex info proc 21209@cindex process ID 21210@item info proc 21211@itemx info proc @var{process-id} 21212Summarize available information about any running process. If a 21213process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about 21214that process; otherwise display information about the program being 21215debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command 21216line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its 21217executable file's absolute file name. 21218 21219On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form 21220@samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID 21221within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means 21222a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still 21223needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as 21224a process ID rather than a thread ID). 21225 21226@item info proc cmdline 21227@cindex info proc cmdline 21228Show the original command line of the process. This command is 21229specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux. 21230 21231@item info proc cwd 21232@cindex info proc cwd 21233Show the current working directory of the process. This command is 21234specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux. 21235 21236@item info proc exe 21237@cindex info proc exe 21238Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific 21239to @sc{gnu}/Linux. 21240 21241@item info proc mappings 21242@cindex memory address space mappings 21243Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with 21244information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access 21245rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range 21246includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the 21247memory access rights to that range. 21248 21249@item info proc stat 21250@itemx info proc status 21251@cindex process detailed status information 21252These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show 21253the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID; 21254how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage; 21255the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its 21256consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice} 21257value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page 21258(type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt). 21259 21260@item info proc all 21261Show all the information about the process described under all of the 21262above @code{info proc} subcommands. 21263 21264@ignore 21265@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when 21266@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around 21267@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in. 21268@kindex info proc times 21269@item info proc times 21270Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and 21271its children. 21272 21273@kindex info proc id 21274@item info proc id 21275Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID, 21276the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID. 21277@end ignore 21278 21279@item set procfs-trace 21280@kindex set procfs-trace 21281@cindex @code{procfs} API calls 21282This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls. 21283 21284@item show procfs-trace 21285@kindex show procfs-trace 21286Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing. 21287 21288@item set procfs-file @var{file} 21289@kindex set procfs-file 21290Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named 21291@var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous 21292contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the 21293standard output. 21294 21295@item show procfs-file 21296@kindex show procfs-file 21297Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written. 21298 21299@item proc-trace-entry 21300@itemx proc-trace-exit 21301@itemx proc-untrace-entry 21302@itemx proc-untrace-exit 21303@kindex proc-trace-entry 21304@kindex proc-trace-exit 21305@kindex proc-untrace-entry 21306@kindex proc-untrace-exit 21307These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits 21308from the @code{syscall} interface. 21309 21310@item info pidlist 21311@kindex info pidlist 21312@cindex process list, QNX Neutrino 21313For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the 21314processes and all the threads within each process. 21315 21316@item info meminfo 21317@kindex info meminfo 21318@cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino 21319For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos. 21320@end table 21321 21322@node DJGPP Native 21323@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs 21324@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging 21325@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging 21326@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands 21327 21328@cindex DPMI 21329@sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and 21330MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs 21331that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on 21332top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations. 21333 21334@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and 21335defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This 21336subsection describes those commands. 21337 21338@table @code 21339@kindex info dos 21340@item info dos 21341This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print 21342information about the target system and important OS structures. 21343 21344@kindex sysinfo 21345@cindex MS-DOS system info 21346@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS) 21347@item info dos sysinfo 21348This command displays assorted information about the underlying 21349platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the 21350DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory. 21351 21352@cindex GDT 21353@cindex LDT 21354@cindex IDT 21355@cindex segment descriptor tables 21356@cindex descriptor tables display 21357@item info dos gdt 21358@itemx info dos ldt 21359@itemx info dos idt 21360These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local, 21361and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor 21362tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment 21363that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a 21364descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the 21365descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access 21366rights. 21367 21368A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data 21369segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which 21370allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in 21371conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define 21372additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment. 21373 21374@cindex garbled pointers 21375These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables. 21376Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are 21377displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means 21378display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For 21379example, here's a convenient way to display information about the 21380debugged program's data segment: 21381 21382@smallexample 21383@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds} 21384@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)} 21385@end smallexample 21386 21387@noindent 21388This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside 21389the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}). 21390 21391@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS) 21392@item info dos pde 21393@itemx info dos pte 21394These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page 21395Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are 21396data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped 21397into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every 21398page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there 21399may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A 21400Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table 21401that is currently in use. 21402 21403Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page 21404Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of 21405the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the 21406@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page 21407Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command 21408means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by 21409the specified entry in the Page Directory. 21410 21411@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS 21412These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct 21413Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA 21414controller. 21415 21416These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers. 21417 21418@cindex physical address from linear address 21419@item info dos address-pte @var{addr} 21420This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear 21421address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should 21422already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it, 21423because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} 21424segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for 21425the page where a variable @code{i} is stored: 21426 21427@smallexample 21428@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i} 21429@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:} 21430@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30} 21431@end smallexample 21432 21433@noindent 21434This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page 21435whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the 21436attributes of that page. 21437 21438Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *}, 21439since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base 21440address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will 21441be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is 21442declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of 21443@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}. 21444 21445Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the 21446transfer buffer: 21447 21448@smallexample 21449@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)} 21450@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:} 21451@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110} 21452@end smallexample 21453 21454@noindent 21455(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the 214563rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output 21457clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional 21458memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and 21459linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical. 21460 21461This command is supported only with some DPMI servers. 21462@end table 21463 21464@cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging 21465In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote 21466debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific 21467to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}. 21468 21469@table @code 21470@kindex set com1base 21471@kindex set com1irq 21472@kindex set com2base 21473@kindex set com2irq 21474@kindex set com3base 21475@kindex set com3irq 21476@kindex set com4base 21477@kindex set com4irq 21478@item set com1base @var{addr} 21479This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial 21480port. 21481 21482@item set com1irq @var{irq} 21483This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use 21484for the @file{COM1} serial port. 21485 21486There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq}, 21487etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the 21488other 3 COM ports. 21489 21490@kindex show com1base 21491@kindex show com1irq 21492@kindex show com2base 21493@kindex show com2irq 21494@kindex show com3base 21495@kindex show com3irq 21496@kindex show com4base 21497@kindex show com4irq 21498The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@: 21499display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ} 21500lines used by the COM ports. 21501 21502@item info serial 21503@kindex info serial 21504@cindex DOS serial port status 21505This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each 21506port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and 21507IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the 21508counts of various errors encountered so far. 21509@end table 21510 21511 21512@node Cygwin Native 21513@subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables 21514@cindex MS Windows debugging 21515@cindex native Cygwin debugging 21516@cindex Cygwin-specific commands 21517 21518@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including 21519DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. 21520 21521@cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows 21522@cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows 21523MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the 21524special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted 21525by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows 21526supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key 21527sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it 21528ignores @kbd{C-c}. 21529 21530There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in 21531this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is 21532described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}. 21533 21534@table @code 21535@kindex info w32 21536@item info w32 21537This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print 21538information about the target system and important OS structures. 21539 21540@item info w32 selector 21541This command displays information returned by 21542the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function. 21543It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to 21544a long value to give the information about this given selector. 21545Without argument, this command displays information 21546about the six segment registers. 21547 21548@item info w32 thread-information-block 21549This command displays thread specific information stored in the 21550Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs} 21551selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs). 21552 21553@kindex signal-event 21554@item signal-event @var{id} 21555This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume 21556crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug). 21557 21558To use it, create or edit the following keys in 21559@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or 21560@code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} 21561(for x86_64 versions): 21562 21563@itemize @minus 21564@item 21565@code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger. 21566Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex 21567"attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}. 21568 21569The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the 21570crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of 21571the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN} 21572to attach. 21573 21574@item 21575@code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will 21576make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key 21577automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and 21578``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either 21579terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel). 21580@end itemize 21581 21582@kindex set cygwin-exceptions 21583@cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL 21584@cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging 21585@item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode} 21586If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that 21587happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off}, 21588@value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some 21589exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL 21590``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the 21591Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying 21592@value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals. 21593 21594@kindex show cygwin-exceptions 21595@item show cygwin-exceptions 21596Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen 21597inside the Cygwin DLL itself. 21598 21599@kindex set new-console 21600@item set new-console @var{mode} 21601If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will 21602be started in a new console on next start. 21603If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will 21604be started in the same console as the debugger. 21605 21606@kindex show new-console 21607@item show new-console 21608Displays whether a new console is used 21609when the debuggee is started. 21610 21611@kindex set new-group 21612@item set new-group @var{mode} 21613This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should 21614start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger. 21615This affects the way the Windows OS handles 21616@samp{Ctrl-C}. 21617 21618@kindex show new-group 21619@item show new-group 21620Displays current value of new-group boolean. 21621 21622@kindex set debugevents 21623@item set debugevents 21624This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related 21625to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that 21626signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and 21627unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the 21628Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call. 21629 21630@kindex set debugexec 21631@item set debugexec 21632This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events 21633(such as resume thread) seen by the debugger. 21634 21635@kindex set debugexceptions 21636@item set debugexceptions 21637This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the 21638debuggee seen by the debugger. 21639 21640@kindex set debugmemory 21641@item set debugmemory 21642This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads 21643and writes by the debugger. 21644 21645@kindex set shell 21646@item set shell 21647This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called 21648via a shell or directly (default value is on). 21649 21650@kindex show shell 21651@item show shell 21652Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell. 21653 21654@end table 21655 21656@menu 21657* Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols 21658@end menu 21659 21660@node Non-debug DLL Symbols 21661@subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols 21662@cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols 21663@cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs 21664 21665Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do 21666not include symbolic debugging information (for example, 21667@file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging 21668symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic 21669information contained in the DLL's export table. This section 21670describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as 21671``minimal symbols''. 21672 21673Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs 21674will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to 21675start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the 21676program run once to completion. 21677 21678@subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes 21679 21680In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging 21681tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the 21682DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is 21683also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often 21684sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program 21685(particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols) 21686necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the 21687contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the 21688exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator. 21689 21690Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even 21691though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since 21692symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause 21693some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and 21694@code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} 21695(@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example: 21696 21697@smallexample 21698(@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA 21699All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA": 21700 21701Non-debugging symbols: 217020x77e885f4 CreateFileA 217030x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA 21704@end smallexample 21705 21706@smallexample 21707(@value{GDBP}) info function ! 21708All functions matching regular expression "!": 21709 21710Non-debugging symbols: 217110x6100114c cygwin1!__assert 217120x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0 217130x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *) 21714[etc...] 21715@end smallexample 21716 21717@subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols 21718 21719Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much 21720type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol 21721refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that 21722contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory 21723contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This 21724means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble 21725a function within a DLL without a running program. 21726 21727Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced 21728automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a 21729variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit 21730type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of 21731problem: 21732 21733@smallexample 21734(@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv' 21735$1 = 268572168 21736@end smallexample 21737 21738@smallexample 21739(@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv' 217400x10021610: "\230y\"" 21741@end smallexample 21742 21743And two possible solutions: 21744 21745@smallexample 21746(@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0] 21747$2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram" 21748@end smallexample 21749 21750@smallexample 21751(@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv' 217520x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000 21753(@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608 217540x10021608: 0x0022fd98 21755(@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98 217560x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram" 21757@end smallexample 21758 21759Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program 21760starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't 21761examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the 21762function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&'' 21763to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address: 21764 21765@smallexample 21766(@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline' 21767Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0 21768@end smallexample 21769 21770The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a 21771break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely 21772safe. 21773 21774@node Hurd Native 21775@subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems 21776@cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging 21777 21778This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the 21779@sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging. 21780 21781@table @code 21782@item set signals 21783@itemx set sigs 21784@kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command} 21785@kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command} 21786This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by 21787@value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not 21788affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for 21789@code{signals}. 21790 21791@item show signals 21792@itemx show sigs 21793@kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command} 21794@kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command} 21795Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals. 21796 21797@item set signal-thread 21798@itemx set sigthread 21799@kindex set signal-thread 21800@kindex set sigthread 21801This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal 21802thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running 21803process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set 21804signal-thread}. 21805 21806@item show signal-thread 21807@itemx show sigthread 21808@kindex show signal-thread 21809@kindex show sigthread 21810These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is 21811delivered a signal. 21812 21813@item set stopped 21814@kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command} 21815This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped, 21816as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be 21817continued by delivering a signal to it. 21818 21819@item show stopped 21820@kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command} 21821This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is 21822stopped. 21823 21824@item set exceptions 21825@kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command} 21826Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior. 21827When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor 21828single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception 21829trapping on. 21830 21831@item show exceptions 21832@kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command} 21833Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior. 21834 21835@item set task pause 21836@kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands} 21837@cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 21838@cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 21839This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control. 21840Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended 21841whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take 21842effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set 21843to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set 21844thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads. 21845 21846@item show task pause 21847@kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands} 21848Show the current state of task suspension. 21849 21850@item set task detach-suspend-count 21851@cindex task suspend count 21852@cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21853This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when 21854@value{GDBN} detaches from it. 21855 21856@item show task detach-suspend-count 21857Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching. 21858 21859@item set task exception-port 21860@itemx set task excp 21861@cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21862This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will 21863forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send 21864rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias. 21865 21866@item set noninvasive 21867@cindex noninvasive task options 21868This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least 21869invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This 21870is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and 21871@code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults. 21872 21873@item info send-rights 21874@itemx info receive-rights 21875@itemx info port-rights 21876@itemx info port-sets 21877@itemx info dead-names 21878@itemx info ports 21879@itemx info psets 21880@cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21881@cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21882@cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21883@cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21884@cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21885These commands display information about, respectively, send rights, 21886receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task. 21887There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info 21888port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}. 21889 21890@item set thread pause 21891@kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command} 21892@cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21893@cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd) 21894This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has 21895control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current 21896thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to 21897off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued. 21898Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has 21899control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set 21900task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend 21901only the current thread. 21902 21903@item show thread pause 21904@kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command} 21905This command shows the state of current thread suspension. 21906 21907@item set thread run 21908This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run. 21909 21910@item show thread run 21911Show whether the current thread is allowed to run. 21912 21913@item set thread detach-suspend-count 21914@cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21915@cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21916This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a 21917thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count 21918found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread 21919takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value. 21920 21921@item show thread detach-suspend-count 21922Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when 21923detaching. 21924 21925@item set thread exception-port 21926@itemx set thread excp 21927Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This 21928overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above). 21929@code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias. 21930 21931@item set thread takeover-suspend-count 21932Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the 21933value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command 21934changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead. 21935 21936@item set thread default 21937@itemx show thread default 21938@cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd 21939Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread 21940default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set 21941thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default} 21942variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all 21943threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with 21944the non-default commands. 21945@end table 21946 21947@node Darwin 21948@subsection Darwin 21949@cindex Darwin 21950 21951@value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target: 21952 21953@table @code 21954@item set debug darwin @var{num} 21955@kindex set debug darwin 21956When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to 21957the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output. 21958 21959@item show debug darwin 21960@kindex show debug darwin 21961Show the current state of Darwin messages. 21962 21963@item set debug mach-o @var{num} 21964@kindex set debug mach-o 21965When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while 21966@value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the 21967file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher 21968values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose 21969problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal 21970usage. 21971 21972@item show debug mach-o 21973@kindex show debug mach-o 21974Show the current state of Mach-O file messages. 21975 21976@item set mach-exceptions on 21977@itemx set mach-exceptions off 21978@kindex set mach-exceptions 21979On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then 21980mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of 21981Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to 21982better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off. 21983 21984@item show mach-exceptions 21985@kindex show mach-exceptions 21986Show the current state of exceptions trapping. 21987@end table 21988 21989 21990@node Embedded OS 21991@section Embedded Operating Systems 21992 21993This section describes configurations involving the debugging of 21994embedded operating systems that are available for several different 21995architectures. 21996 21997@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on 21998various real-time operating systems. 21999 22000@node Embedded Processors 22001@section Embedded Processors 22002 22003This section goes into details specific to particular embedded 22004configurations. 22005 22006@cindex send command to simulator 22007Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN} 22008allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator. 22009 22010@table @code 22011@item sim @var{command} 22012@kindex sim@r{, a command} 22013Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the 22014documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about 22015acceptable commands. 22016@end table 22017 22018 22019@menu 22020* ARM:: ARM 22021* M68K:: Motorola M68K 22022* MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze 22023* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded 22024* PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded 22025* AVR:: Atmel AVR 22026* CRIS:: CRIS 22027* Super-H:: Renesas Super-H 22028@end menu 22029 22030@node ARM 22031@subsection ARM 22032 22033@value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands: 22034 22035@table @code 22036@item set arm disassembler 22037@kindex set arm 22038This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The 22039@code{"std"} style is the standard style. 22040 22041@item show arm disassembler 22042@kindex show arm 22043Show the current disassembly style. 22044 22045@item set arm apcs32 22046@cindex ARM 32-bit mode 22047This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit. 22048 22049@item show arm apcs32 22050Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode. 22051 22052@item set arm fpu @var{fputype} 22053This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The 22054argument @var{fputype} can be one of these: 22055 22056@table @code 22057@item auto 22058Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI. 22059@item softfpa 22060Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM 22061processors. 22062@item fpa 22063GCC-compiled FPA co-processor. 22064@item softvfp 22065Software FPU with pure-endian doubles. 22066@item vfp 22067VFP co-processor. 22068@end table 22069 22070@item show arm fpu 22071Show the current type of the FPU. 22072 22073@item set arm abi 22074This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI. 22075 22076@item show arm abi 22077Show the currently used ABI. 22078 22079@item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto) 22080@value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine 22081whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls 22082@value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not 22083available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to 22084use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR} 22085register). 22086 22087@item show arm fallback-mode 22088Show the current fallback instruction mode. 22089 22090@item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto) 22091This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether 22092instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which 22093causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting 22094of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}. 22095 22096@item show arm force-mode 22097Show the current forced instruction mode. 22098 22099@item set debug arm 22100Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM 22101target support subsystem. 22102 22103@item show debug arm 22104Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled. 22105@end table 22106 22107@table @code 22108@item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{} 22109The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments. 22110 22111@table @code 22112@item --swi-support=@var{type} 22113Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument 22114@var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values. 22115The default value is @code{all}. 22116 22117@table @code 22118@item none 22119@item demon 22120@item angel 22121@item redboot 22122@item all 22123@end table 22124@end table 22125@end table 22126 22127@node M68K 22128@subsection M68k 22129 22130The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support. 22131 22132@node MicroBlaze 22133@subsection MicroBlaze 22134@cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze 22135@cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger 22136 22137The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx 22138FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors 22139usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx 22140Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK). 22141This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to 22142the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program 22143communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and 22144presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default 22145@code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change 22146this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd} 22147commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.) 22148 22149Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor. 22150 22151@table @code 22152@item target remote :1234 22153Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN} 22154on the same system as @code{xmd}. 22155 22156@item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234 22157Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd} 22158running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}. 22159 22160@item load 22161Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target. 22162 22163@item set debug microblaze @var{n} 22164Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero. 22165 22166@item show debug microblaze @var{n} 22167Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level. 22168@end table 22169 22170@node MIPS Embedded 22171@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded 22172 22173@noindent 22174@value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets: 22175 22176@table @code 22177@item set mipsfpu double 22178@itemx set mipsfpu single 22179@itemx set mipsfpu none 22180@itemx set mipsfpu auto 22181@itemx show mipsfpu 22182@kindex set mipsfpu 22183@kindex show mipsfpu 22184@cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point 22185@cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote 22186If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point 22187coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you 22188need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init 22189file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of 22190functions which return floating point values. It also allows 22191@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling 22192functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor 22193with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650} 22194processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default 22195double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using 22196@samp{set mipsfpu double}. 22197 22198In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no 22199floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision 22200and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point. 22201 22202As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with 22203@samp{show mipsfpu}. 22204@end table 22205 22206@node PowerPC Embedded 22207@subsection PowerPC Embedded 22208 22209@cindex DVC register 22210@value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to 22211implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form: 22212 22213@smallexample 22214(@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \ 22215 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION} 22216@end smallexample 22217 22218The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects 22219such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one 22220debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the 22221variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature 22222is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34 22223or newer. 22224 22225When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses 22226ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on, 22227in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when 22228watching variables of scalar types. 22229 22230You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory 22231region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}): 22232 22233@smallexample 22234(@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length} 22235(@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address} 22236@end smallexample 22237 22238PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion 22239about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}. 22240 22241@cindex ranged breakpoint 22242PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated 22243@dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of 22244the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within 22245the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN}, 22246use the @code{break-range} command. 22247 22248@value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands: 22249 22250@table @code 22251@kindex break-range 22252@item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location} 22253Set a breakpoint for an address range given by 22254@var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name, 22255a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start 22256location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location}, 22257for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.) 22258The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it 22259executes an instruction at any address within the specified range, 22260(including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.) 22261 22262@kindex set powerpc 22263@item set powerpc soft-float 22264@itemx show powerpc soft-float 22265Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling 22266convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based 22267on the selected architecture and the provided executable file. 22268 22269@item set powerpc vector-abi 22270@itemx show powerpc vector-abi 22271Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector 22272arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto}; 22273@samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present; 22274@samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE 22275registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention 22276based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file. 22277 22278@item set powerpc exact-watchpoints 22279@itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints 22280Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable 22281of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the 22282address of its first byte. 22283 22284@end table 22285 22286@node AVR 22287@subsection Atmel AVR 22288@cindex AVR 22289 22290When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the 22291following AVR-specific commands: 22292 22293@table @code 22294@item info io_registers 22295@kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR} 22296@cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR) 22297This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For 22298each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value. 22299@end table 22300 22301@node CRIS 22302@subsection CRIS 22303@cindex CRIS 22304 22305When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the 22306following CRIS-specific commands: 22307 22308@table @code 22309@item set cris-version @var{ver} 22310@cindex CRIS version 22311Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}. 22312The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in 22313case autodetection of the CRIS version fails. 22314 22315@item show cris-version 22316Show the current CRIS version. 22317 22318@item set cris-dwarf2-cfi 22319@cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS 22320Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}. 22321Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below 22322@code{R59}. 22323 22324@item show cris-dwarf2-cfi 22325Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI. 22326 22327@item set cris-mode @var{mode} 22328@cindex CRIS mode 22329Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when 22330debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to 22331@samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}). 22332 22333@item show cris-mode 22334Show the current CRIS mode. 22335@end table 22336 22337@node Super-H 22338@subsection Renesas Super-H 22339@cindex Super-H 22340 22341For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these 22342commands: 22343 22344@table @code 22345@item set sh calling-convention @var{convention} 22346@kindex set sh calling-convention 22347Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}. 22348Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}. 22349With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling 22350convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies 22351that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function 22352is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention 22353is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used, 22354regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the 22355default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler 22356does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function. 22357 22358@item show sh calling-convention 22359@kindex show sh calling-convention 22360Show the current calling convention setting. 22361 22362@end table 22363 22364 22365@node Architectures 22366@section Architectures 22367 22368This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect 22369all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross. 22370 22371@menu 22372* AArch64:: 22373* i386:: 22374* Alpha:: 22375* MIPS:: 22376* HPPA:: HP PA architecture 22377* SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture 22378* PowerPC:: 22379* Nios II:: 22380@end menu 22381 22382@node AArch64 22383@subsection AArch64 22384@cindex AArch64 support 22385 22386When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the 22387following special commands: 22388 22389@table @code 22390@item set debug aarch64 22391@kindex set debug aarch64 22392This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging 22393messages are to be displayed. 22394 22395@item show debug aarch64 22396Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed. 22397 22398@end table 22399 22400@node i386 22401@subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues 22402 22403@table @code 22404@item set struct-convention @var{mode} 22405@kindex set struct-convention 22406@cindex struct return convention 22407@cindex struct/union returned in registers 22408Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and 22409@code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of 22410@var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the 22411default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s 22412are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a 22413@code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will 22414be returned in a register. 22415 22416@item show struct-convention 22417@kindex show struct-convention 22418Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s 22419from functions. 22420@end table 22421 22422 22423@subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX). 22424@cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX). 22425 22426Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0} 22427@footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture 22428registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values 22429which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or 22430memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's 22431complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0 22432(1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space. 22433 22434@samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw} 22435through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3} 22436display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the 22437upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the 22438@value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it 22439can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive. 22440 22441As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having 22442access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on 22443bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows: 22444 22445@smallexample 22446 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@} 22447 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64 22448@end smallexample 22449 22450This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any 22451change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its 22452counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via 22453Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to 22454the pointer. 22455 22456Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in 22457application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying 22458the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing 22459bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating 22460bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose: 22461 22462@table @code 22463@item show mpx bound @var{pointer} 22464@kindex show mpx bound 22465Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}. 22466 22467@item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound} 22468@kindex set mpx bound 22469Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table. 22470This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers 22471whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values 22472for lower and upper bounds respectively. 22473@end table 22474 22475@node Alpha 22476@subsection Alpha 22477 22478See the following section. 22479 22480@node MIPS 22481@subsection @acronym{MIPS} 22482 22483@cindex stack on Alpha 22484@cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS} 22485@cindex Alpha stack 22486@cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack 22487Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which 22488sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to 22489find the beginning of a function. 22490 22491@cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging 22492To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where 22493@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search) 22494you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these 22495commands: 22496 22497@table @code 22498@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS}) 22499@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit} 22500Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its 22501search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the 22502default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the 22503larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search 22504and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use 22505this command when debugging a stripped executable. 22506 22507@item show heuristic-fence-post 22508Display the current limit. 22509@end table 22510 22511@noindent 22512These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured 22513for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors. 22514 22515Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS} 22516programs: 22517 22518@table @code 22519@item set mips abi @var{arg} 22520@kindex set mips abi 22521@cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS} 22522Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible 22523values of @var{arg} are: 22524 22525@table @samp 22526@item auto 22527The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the 22528default). 22529@item o32 22530@item o64 22531@item n32 22532@item n64 22533@item eabi32 22534@item eabi64 22535@end table 22536 22537@item show mips abi 22538@kindex show mips abi 22539Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior. 22540 22541@item set mips compression @var{arg} 22542@kindex set mips compression 22543@cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS} 22544Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed 22545@acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the 22546inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other 22547internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to 22548when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or 22549the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses. 22550Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information 22551provided by the executable. 22552 22553Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}. 22554The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as 22555executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not 22556identified as such. 22557 22558This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across 22559debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or 22560implicitly from an executable. 22561 22562The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to 22563identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or 22564@acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations 22565are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global 22566compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting. 22567 22568@item show mips compression 22569@kindex show mips compression 22570Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by 22571@value{GDBN} to debug the inferior. 22572 22573@item set mipsfpu 22574@itemx show mipsfpu 22575@xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}. 22576 22577@item set mips mask-address @var{arg} 22578@kindex set mips mask-address 22579@cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking 22580This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit 22581@acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be 22582@samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default 22583setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value. 22584 22585@item show mips mask-address 22586@kindex show mips mask-address 22587Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or 22588not. 22589 22590@item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22591@kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22592This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that 22593transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target 22594that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr}, 22595and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}. 22596 22597@item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22598@kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs 22599Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets. 22600 22601@item set debug mips 22602@kindex set debug mips 22603This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific 22604target code in @value{GDBN}. 22605 22606@item show debug mips 22607@kindex show debug mips 22608Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages. 22609@end table 22610 22611 22612@node HPPA 22613@subsection HPPA 22614@cindex HPPA support 22615 22616When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the 22617following special commands: 22618 22619@table @code 22620@item set debug hppa 22621@kindex set debug hppa 22622This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging 22623messages are to be displayed. 22624 22625@item show debug hppa 22626Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed. 22627 22628@item maint print unwind @var{address} 22629@kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA} 22630This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the 22631given @var{address}. 22632 22633@end table 22634 22635 22636@node SPU 22637@subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture 22638@cindex Cell Broadband Engine 22639@cindex SPU 22640 22641When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture, 22642it provides the following special commands: 22643 22644@table @code 22645@item info spu event 22646@kindex info spu 22647Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask 22648and pending event status. 22649 22650@item info spu signal 22651Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending 22652signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal 22653notification channels. 22654 22655@item info spu mailbox 22656Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries, 22657in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound, 22658SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes. 22659 22660@item info spu dma 22661Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC 22662DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective 22663and local store addresses and transfer size are shown. 22664 22665@item info spu proxydma 22666Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC 22667Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective 22668and local store addresses and transfer size are shown. 22669 22670@end table 22671 22672When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application 22673on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following 22674special commands: 22675 22676@table @code 22677@item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg} 22678@kindex set spu 22679Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN} 22680will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main} 22681function. The default is @code{off}. 22682 22683@item show spu stop-on-load 22684@kindex show spu 22685Show whether to stop for new SPE threads. 22686 22687@item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg} 22688Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to 22689@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed 22690cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent 22691view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application 22692does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect. 22693 22694@item show spu auto-flush-cache 22695Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. 22696 22697@end table 22698 22699@node PowerPC 22700@subsection PowerPC 22701@cindex PowerPC architecture 22702 22703When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of 22704pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point 22705numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored 22706in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like 22707@code{f0} or @code{f2}. 22708 22709The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed 22710by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0}, 22711@code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on. 22712 22713For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit 22714wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}). 22715 22716@node Nios II 22717@subsection Nios II 22718@cindex Nios II architecture 22719 22720When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture, 22721it provides the following special commands: 22722 22723@table @code 22724 22725@item set debug nios2 22726@kindex set debug nios2 22727This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II 22728target code in @value{GDBN}. 22729 22730@item show debug nios2 22731@kindex show debug nios2 22732Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages. 22733@end table 22734 22735@node Controlling GDB 22736@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN} 22737 22738You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the 22739@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays 22740data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are 22741described here. 22742 22743@menu 22744* Prompt:: Prompt 22745* Editing:: Command editing 22746* Command History:: Command history 22747* Screen Size:: Screen size 22748* Numbers:: Numbers 22749* ABI:: Configuring the current ABI 22750* Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files 22751* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages 22752* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings 22753* Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings 22754@end menu 22755 22756@node Prompt 22757@section Prompt 22758 22759@cindex prompt 22760 22761@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string 22762called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You 22763can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For 22764instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change 22765the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell 22766which one you are talking to. 22767 22768@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the 22769prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space 22770or a prompt that does not. 22771 22772@table @code 22773@kindex set prompt 22774@item set prompt @var{newprompt} 22775Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth. 22776 22777@kindex show prompt 22778@item show prompt 22779Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}} 22780@end table 22781 22782Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have 22783prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions 22784are: 22785 22786@table @code 22787@kindex set extended-prompt 22788@item set extended-prompt @var{prompt} 22789Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions. 22790@xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for 22791substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt 22792string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt 22793is displayed. 22794 22795For example: 22796 22797@smallexample 22798set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb) 22799@end smallexample 22800 22801Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the 22802@var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information. 22803 22804@kindex show extended-prompt 22805@item show extended-prompt 22806Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of 22807the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the 22808corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed. 22809@end table 22810 22811@node Editing 22812@section Command Editing 22813@cindex readline 22814@cindex command line editing 22815 22816@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This 22817@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a 22818command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style 22819or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history 22820substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across 22821debugging sessions. 22822 22823You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the 22824command @code{set}. 22825 22826@table @code 22827@kindex set editing 22828@cindex editing 22829@item set editing 22830@itemx set editing on 22831Enable command line editing (enabled by default). 22832 22833@item set editing off 22834Disable command line editing. 22835 22836@kindex show editing 22837@item show editing 22838Show whether command line editing is enabled. 22839@end table 22840 22841@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 22842@xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}, 22843@end ifset 22844@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 22845@xref{Command Line Editing}, 22846@end ifclear 22847for more details about the Readline 22848interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are 22849encouraged to read that chapter. 22850 22851@node Command History 22852@section Command History 22853@cindex command history 22854 22855@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your 22856debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what 22857happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command 22858history facility. 22859 22860@value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline 22861package, to provide the history facility. 22862@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 22863@xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library}, 22864@end ifset 22865@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 22866@xref{Using History Interactively}, 22867@end ifclear 22868for the detailed description of the History library. 22869 22870To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of 22871the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server } 22872(@pxref{Server Prefix}). This 22873means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it 22874affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is 22875pressed on a line by itself. 22876 22877@cindex @code{server}, command prefix 22878The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value 22879history; to print a value without recording it into the value history, 22880use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command. 22881 22882Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command 22883history. 22884 22885@table @code 22886@cindex history substitution 22887@cindex history file 22888@kindex set history filename 22889@cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable 22890@item set history filename @var{fname} 22891Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}. 22892This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history 22893list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it 22894exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through 22895the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults 22896to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to 22897@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable 22898is not set. 22899 22900@cindex save command history 22901@kindex set history save 22902@item set history save 22903@itemx set history save on 22904Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the 22905@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled. 22906 22907@item set history save off 22908Stop recording command history in a file. 22909 22910@cindex history size 22911@kindex set history size 22912@cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable 22913@item set history size @var{size} 22914@itemx set history size unlimited 22915Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list. 22916This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or 22917to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE} 22918are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is 22919either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands 22920@value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited. 22921 22922@cindex remove duplicate history 22923@kindex set history remove-duplicates 22924@item set history remove-duplicates @var{count} 22925@itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited 22926Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list. 22927If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count} 22928history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current 22929entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is 22930@code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then 22931removal of duplicate history entries is disabled. 22932 22933Only history entries added during the current session are considered for 22934removal. This option is set to 0 by default. 22935 22936@end table 22937 22938History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}. 22939@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 22940@xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library}, 22941@end ifset 22942@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 22943@xref{Event Designators}, 22944@end ifclear 22945for more details. 22946 22947@cindex history expansion, turn on/off 22948Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion 22949is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the 22950@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to 22951follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with 22952a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline 22953history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings 22954@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled. 22955 22956The commands to control history expansion are: 22957 22958@table @code 22959@item set history expansion on 22960@itemx set history expansion 22961@kindex set history expansion 22962Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default. 22963 22964@item set history expansion off 22965Disable history expansion. 22966 22967@c @group 22968@kindex show history 22969@item show history 22970@itemx show history filename 22971@itemx show history save 22972@itemx show history size 22973@itemx show history expansion 22974These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters. 22975@code{show history} by itself displays all four states. 22976@c @end group 22977@end table 22978 22979@table @code 22980@kindex show commands 22981@cindex show last commands 22982@cindex display command history 22983@item show commands 22984Display the last ten commands in the command history. 22985 22986@item show commands @var{n} 22987Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}. 22988 22989@item show commands + 22990Print ten commands just after the commands last printed. 22991@end table 22992 22993@node Screen Size 22994@section Screen Size 22995@cindex size of screen 22996@cindex screen size 22997@cindex pagination 22998@cindex page size 22999@cindex pauses in output 23000 23001Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of 23002information output to the screen. To help you read all of it, 23003@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of 23004output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q} 23005to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting 23006determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being 23007printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place, 23008rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line. 23009 23010Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal 23011driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base 23012together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the 23013@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct, 23014you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set 23015width} commands: 23016 23017@table @code 23018@kindex set height 23019@kindex set width 23020@kindex show width 23021@kindex show height 23022@item set height @var{lpp} 23023@itemx set height unlimited 23024@itemx show height 23025@itemx set width @var{cpl} 23026@itemx set width unlimited 23027@itemx show width 23028These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and 23029a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show} 23030commands display the current settings. 23031 23032If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines, 23033@value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the 23034output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor 23035buffer. 23036 23037Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set 23038width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output. 23039 23040@item set pagination on 23041@itemx set pagination off 23042@kindex set pagination 23043Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning 23044pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that 23045running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode 23046Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination. 23047 23048@item show pagination 23049@kindex show pagination 23050Show the current pagination mode. 23051@end table 23052 23053@node Numbers 23054@section Numbers 23055@cindex number representation 23056@cindex entering numbers 23057 23058You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in 23059@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with 23060@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers 23061begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or 23062@samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base 2306310; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular 23064format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for 23065both input and output with the commands described below. 23066 23067@table @code 23068@kindex set input-radix 23069@item set input-radix @var{base} 23070Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices 23071for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be 23072specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for 23073example, any of 23074 23075@smallexample 23076set input-radix 012 23077set input-radix 10. 23078set input-radix 0xa 23079@end smallexample 23080 23081@noindent 23082sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10} 23083leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since 23084@samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is 23085interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16, 23086@samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't 23087change the radix. 23088 23089@kindex set output-radix 23090@item set output-radix @var{base} 23091Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices 23092for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be 23093specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix. 23094 23095@kindex show input-radix 23096@item show input-radix 23097Display the current default base for numeric input. 23098 23099@kindex show output-radix 23100@item show output-radix 23101Display the current default base for numeric display. 23102 23103@item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]} 23104@itemx show radix 23105@kindex set radix 23106@kindex show radix 23107These commands set and show the default base for both input and output 23108of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to 23109the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its 23110default value of 10. 23111 23112@end table 23113 23114@node ABI 23115@section Configuring the Current ABI 23116 23117@value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your 23118application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its 23119conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the 23120current ABI. 23121 23122@cindex OS ABI 23123@kindex set osabi 23124@kindex show osabi 23125@cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling 23126 23127One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating 23128system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation. 23129@value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use, 23130but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command. 23131One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use 23132an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does 23133not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your 23134platform provides. 23135 23136When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a 23137``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and 23138@code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library. 23139The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}. 23140 23141@table @code 23142@item show osabi 23143Show the OS ABI currently in use. 23144 23145@item set osabi 23146With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's. 23147 23148@item set osabi @var{abi} 23149Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}. 23150@end table 23151 23152@cindex float promotion 23153 23154Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a 23155function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped 23156(i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged, 23157according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped 23158(i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type 23159@code{double} and then passed. 23160 23161Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether 23162a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked 23163as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}. 23164 23165@table @code 23166@kindex set coerce-float-to-double 23167@item set coerce-float-to-double 23168@itemx set coerce-float-to-double on 23169Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed 23170to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting. 23171 23172@item set coerce-float-to-double off 23173Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped 23174functions. 23175 23176@kindex show coerce-float-to-double 23177@item show coerce-float-to-double 23178Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}. 23179@end table 23180 23181@kindex set cp-abi 23182@kindex show cp-abi 23183@value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++} 23184objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was 23185used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports 23186programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using 23187multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your 23188program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use. 23189Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions 23190before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and 23191``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may 23192use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is 23193``auto''. 23194 23195@table @code 23196@item show cp-abi 23197Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use. 23198 23199@item set cp-abi 23200With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's. 23201 23202@item set cp-abi @var{abi} 23203@itemx set cp-abi auto 23204Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection. 23205@end table 23206 23207@node Auto-loading 23208@section Automatically loading associated files 23209@cindex auto-loading 23210 23211@value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically, 23212without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature 23213@dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting 23214@value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected 23215results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted 23216sources). 23217 23218@menu 23219* Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit} 23220* libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db} 23221 23222* Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path} 23223* Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load} 23224@end menu 23225 23226There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load. 23227In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written 23228in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}. 23229 23230Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit} 23231file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path} 23232(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 23233 23234For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you 23235control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded. 23236 23237@table @code 23238@anchor{set auto-load off} 23239@kindex set auto-load off 23240@item set auto-load off 23241Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files. 23242You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option 23243(@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as: 23244@smallexample 23245$ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile} 23246@end smallexample 23247 23248Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration}) 23249and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}) 23250still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories). 23251To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the 23252@option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to 23253@code{set auto-load no}. 23254 23255@anchor{show auto-load} 23256@kindex show auto-load 23257@item show auto-load 23258Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled 23259or disabled. 23260 23261@smallexample 23262(gdb) show auto-load 23263gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on. 23264libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on. 23265local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory 23266 is on. 23267python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on. 23268safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files 23269 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load. 23270scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts 23271 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load. 23272@end smallexample 23273 23274@anchor{info auto-load} 23275@kindex info auto-load 23276@item info auto-load 23277Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or 23278not. 23279 23280@smallexample 23281(gdb) info auto-load 23282gdb-scripts: 23283Loaded Script 23284Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb 23285libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db. 23286local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been 23287 loaded. 23288python-scripts: 23289Loaded Script 23290Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py 23291@end smallexample 23292@end table 23293 23294These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading: 23295 23296@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5 23297@item @xref{set auto-load off}. 23298@tab Disable auto-loading globally. 23299@item @xref{show auto-load}. 23300@tab Show setting of all kinds of files. 23301@item @xref{info auto-load}. 23302@tab Show state of all kinds of files. 23303@item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}. 23304@tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts. 23305@item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}. 23306@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts. 23307@item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}. 23308@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts. 23309@item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}. 23310@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts. 23311@item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}. 23312@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts. 23313@item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}. 23314@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts. 23315@item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}. 23316@tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts. 23317@item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}. 23318@tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts. 23319@item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}. 23320@tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts. 23321@item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}. 23322@tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. 23323@item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}. 23324@tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. 23325@item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}. 23326@tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list. 23327@item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}. 23328@tab Control for init file in the current directory. 23329@item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}. 23330@tab Show setting of init file in the current directory. 23331@item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}. 23332@tab Show state of init file in the current directory. 23333@item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}. 23334@tab Control for thread debugging library. 23335@item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}. 23336@tab Show setting of thread debugging library. 23337@item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}. 23338@tab Show state of thread debugging library. 23339@item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}. 23340@tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading. 23341@item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}. 23342@tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading. 23343@item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}. 23344@tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading. 23345@end multitable 23346 23347@node Init File in the Current Directory 23348@subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory 23349@cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory 23350 23351By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands 23352from init file (if any) in the current working directory, 23353see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}. 23354 23355Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly 23356configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 23357 23358@table @code 23359@anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit} 23360@kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit 23361@item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off] 23362Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands 23363(@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory. 23364 23365@anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit} 23366@kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit 23367@item show auto-load local-gdbinit 23368Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the 23369current directory is enabled or disabled. 23370 23371@anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit} 23372@kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit 23373@item info auto-load local-gdbinit 23374Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the 23375current directory have been auto-loaded. 23376@end table 23377 23378@node libthread_db.so.1 file 23379@subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library 23380@cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1 23381 23382This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts. 23383 23384@value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific 23385to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}). 23386 23387The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed 23388without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system 23389libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of 23390@samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set 23391auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging 23392library. 23393 23394Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured 23395@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 23396 23397@table @code 23398@anchor{set auto-load libthread-db} 23399@kindex set auto-load libthread-db 23400@item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off] 23401Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library. 23402 23403@anchor{show auto-load libthread-db} 23404@kindex show auto-load libthread-db 23405@item show auto-load libthread-db 23406Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is 23407enabled or disabled. 23408 23409@anchor{info auto-load libthread-db} 23410@kindex info auto-load libthread-db 23411@item info auto-load libthread-db 23412Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and 23413for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it. 23414@end table 23415 23416@node Auto-loading safe path 23417@subsection Security restriction for auto-loading 23418@cindex auto-loading safe-path 23419 23420As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by 23421an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically. 23422@value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list 23423directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user. 23424Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern. 23425 23426If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not 23427get loaded: 23428 23429@smallexample 23430$ ./gdb -q ./gdb 23431Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done. 23432warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been 23433 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set 23434 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load". 23435warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been 23436 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set 23437 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load". 23438@end smallexample 23439 23440@noindent 23441To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway, 23442invoke @value{GDBN} like this: 23443 23444@smallexample 23445$ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb 23446@end smallexample 23447 23448The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands: 23449 23450@table @code 23451@anchor{set auto-load safe-path} 23452@kindex set auto-load safe-path 23453@item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]} 23454Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic 23455loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file. 23456Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match 23457directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch} 23458(@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}). 23459If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to 23460its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation. 23461 23462The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix 23463systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly 23464to the @env{PATH} environment variable. 23465 23466@anchor{show auto-load safe-path} 23467@kindex show auto-load safe-path 23468@item show auto-load safe-path 23469Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of 23470scripts. 23471 23472@anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path} 23473@kindex add-auto-load-safe-path 23474@item add-auto-load-safe-path 23475Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for 23476automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited 23477by the host platform path separator in use. 23478@end table 23479 23480This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured 23481to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir} 23482substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}. 23483The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by 23484@value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}. 23485 23486Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection, 23487corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is 23488@option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}. 23489This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the 23490system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in 23491their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated 23492init file in the current directory 23493(@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}). 23494 23495To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous 23496example, you could use one of the following ways: 23497 23498@table @asis 23499@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb} 23500Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list. 23501You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by 23502by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example). 23503 23504@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}} 23505Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single 23506@value{GDBN} session. 23507 23508@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}} 23509Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session. 23510This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come 23511from trusted sources. 23512 23513@item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path} 23514During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety. 23515This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from 23516trusted sources. 23517@end table 23518 23519On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which 23520also suppresses any such warning messages: 23521 23522@table @asis 23523@item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}} 23524You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session. 23525 23526@item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no} 23527Disable auto-loading globally for the user 23528(@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also 23529use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}). 23530@end table 23531 23532This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches 23533@value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into 23534their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the 23535entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its 23536own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is 23537recommended to be entered. 23538 23539@node Auto-loading verbose mode 23540@subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load 23541@cindex auto-loading verbose mode 23542 23543For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to 23544be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental 23545execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing 23546all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may 23547be printed. 23548 23549For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files 23550(@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which 23551may not be too obvious while setting it up. 23552 23553@smallexample 23554(gdb) set debug auto-load on 23555(gdb) file ~/src/t/true 23556auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" 23557 for objfile "/tmp/true". 23558auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt". 23559auto-load: Using directory "/usr". 23560auto-load: Using directory "/opt". 23561warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined 23562 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt". 23563@end smallexample 23564 23565@table @code 23566@anchor{set debug auto-load} 23567@kindex set debug auto-load 23568@item set debug auto-load [on|off] 23569Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded. 23570 23571@anchor{show debug auto-load} 23572@kindex show debug auto-load 23573@item show debug auto-load 23574Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned 23575on or off. 23576@end table 23577 23578@node Messages/Warnings 23579@section Optional Warnings and Messages 23580 23581@cindex verbose operation 23582@cindex optional warnings 23583By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are 23584running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose} 23585command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy 23586internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed. 23587 23588Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those 23589which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read; 23590see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}. 23591 23592@table @code 23593@kindex set verbose 23594@item set verbose on 23595Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages. 23596 23597@item set verbose off 23598Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages. 23599 23600@kindex show verbose 23601@item show verbose 23602Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off. 23603@end table 23604 23605By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an 23606object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may 23607find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading 23608Symbol Files}). 23609 23610@table @code 23611 23612@kindex set complaints 23613@item set complaints @var{limit} 23614Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of 23615unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set 23616@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number 23617to prevent complaints from being suppressed. 23618 23619@kindex show complaints 23620@item show complaints 23621Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce. 23622 23623@end table 23624 23625@anchor{confirmation requests} 23626By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a 23627lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if 23628you try to run a program which is already running: 23629 23630@smallexample 23631(@value{GDBP}) run 23632The program being debugged has been started already. 23633Start it from the beginning? (y or n) 23634@end smallexample 23635 23636If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own 23637commands, you can disable this ``feature'': 23638 23639@table @code 23640 23641@kindex set confirm 23642@cindex flinching 23643@cindex confirmation 23644@cindex stupid questions 23645@item set confirm off 23646Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with 23647the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also 23648automatically disables confirmation requests. 23649 23650@item set confirm on 23651Enables confirmation requests (the default). 23652 23653@kindex show confirm 23654@item show confirm 23655Displays state of confirmation requests. 23656 23657@end table 23658 23659@cindex command tracing 23660If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it 23661useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be 23662printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the 23663quantity denoting the call depth of each command. 23664 23665@table @code 23666@kindex set trace-commands 23667@cindex command scripts, debugging 23668@item set trace-commands on 23669Enable command tracing. 23670@item set trace-commands off 23671Disable command tracing. 23672@item show trace-commands 23673Display the current state of command tracing. 23674@end table 23675 23676@node Debugging Output 23677@section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings 23678@cindex optional debugging messages 23679 23680@value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from 23681various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of 23682interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This 23683section documents those commands. 23684 23685@table @code 23686@kindex set exec-done-display 23687@item set exec-done-display 23688Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands' 23689completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an 23690asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off. 23691@kindex show exec-done-display 23692@item show exec-done-display 23693Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion 23694notification. 23695@kindex set debug 23696@cindex ARM AArch64 23697@item set debug aarch64 23698Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64. 23699The default is off. 23700@kindex show debug 23701@item show debug aarch64 23702Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to 23703ARM AArch64. 23704@cindex gdbarch debugging info 23705@cindex architecture debugging info 23706@item set debug arch 23707Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off 23708@item show debug arch 23709Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info. 23710@item set debug aix-solib 23711@cindex AIX shared library debugging 23712Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library 23713support module. The default is off. 23714@item show debug aix-thread 23715Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages. 23716@item set debug aix-thread 23717@cindex AIX threads 23718Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread 23719module. 23720@item show debug aix-thread 23721Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display. 23722@item set debug check-physname 23723@cindex physname 23724Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF 23725debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute 23726each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two 23727different ways, depending on exactly what information is present. 23728When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names 23729both ways and display any discrepancies. 23730@item show debug check-physname 23731Show the current state of ``physname'' checking. 23732@item set debug coff-pe-read 23733@cindex COFF/PE exported symbols 23734Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE 23735exported symbols. The default is off. 23736@item show debug coff-pe-read 23737Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to 23738reading of COFF/PE exported symbols. 23739@item set debug dwarf-die 23740@cindex DWARF DIEs 23741Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in. 23742The value is the number of nesting levels to print. 23743A value of zero turns off the display. 23744@item show debug dwarf-die 23745Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging. 23746@item set debug dwarf-line 23747@cindex DWARF Line Tables 23748Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading 23749DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off). 23750A value of 1 provides basic information. 23751A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 23752@item show debug dwarf-line 23753Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging. 23754@item set debug dwarf-read 23755@cindex DWARF Reading 23756Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading 23757DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off). 23758A value of 1 provides basic information. 23759A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 23760@item show debug dwarf-read 23761Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging. 23762@item set debug displaced 23763@cindex displaced stepping debugging info 23764Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the 23765displaced stepping support. The default is off. 23766@item show debug displaced 23767Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info 23768related to displaced stepping. 23769@item set debug event 23770@cindex event debugging info 23771Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The 23772default is off. 23773@item show debug event 23774Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging 23775info. 23776@item set debug expression 23777@cindex expression debugging info 23778Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN} 23779expression parsing. The default is off. 23780@item show debug expression 23781Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about 23782@value{GDBN} expression parsing. 23783@item set debug fbsd-lwp 23784@cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages 23785Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support. 23786@item show debug fbsd-lwp 23787Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages. 23788@item set debug frame 23789@cindex frame debugging info 23790Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The 23791default is off. 23792@item show debug frame 23793Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging 23794info. 23795@item set debug gnu-nat 23796@cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages 23797Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support. 23798@item show debug gnu-nat 23799Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages. 23800@item set debug infrun 23801@cindex inferior debugging info 23802Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior. 23803The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used 23804for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior. 23805@item show debug infrun 23806Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging. 23807@item set debug jit 23808@cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages 23809Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support. 23810@item show debug jit 23811Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging. 23812@item set debug lin-lwp 23813@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages 23814@cindex Linux lightweight processes 23815Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support. 23816@item show debug lin-lwp 23817Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages. 23818@item set debug linux-namespaces 23819@cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages 23820Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support. 23821@item show debug linux-namespaces 23822Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages. 23823@item set debug mach-o 23824@cindex Mach-O symbols processing 23825Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols 23826processing. The default is off. 23827@item show debug mach-o 23828Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to 23829reading of COFF/PE exported symbols. 23830@item set debug notification 23831@cindex remote async notification debugging info 23832Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification. 23833The default is off. 23834@item show debug notification 23835Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages. 23836@item set debug observer 23837@cindex observer debugging info 23838Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This 23839includes info such as the notification of observable events. 23840@item show debug observer 23841Displays the current state of observer debugging. 23842@item set debug overload 23843@cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info 23844Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging 23845info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default 23846is off. 23847@item show debug overload 23848Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload 23849debugging info. 23850@cindex expression parser, debugging info 23851@cindex debug expression parser 23852@item set debug parser 23853Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output. 23854Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression 23855parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for 23856details. The default is off. 23857@item show debug parser 23858Show the current state of expression parser debugging. 23859@cindex packets, reporting on stdout 23860@cindex serial connections, debugging 23861@cindex debug remote protocol 23862@cindex remote protocol debugging 23863@cindex display remote packets 23864@item set debug remote 23865Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across 23866the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the 23867@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off. 23868@item show debug remote 23869Displays the state of display of remote packets. 23870@item set debug serial 23871Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The 23872default is off. 23873@item show debug serial 23874Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging 23875info. 23876@item set debug solib-frv 23877@cindex FR-V shared-library debugging 23878Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code. 23879@item show debug solib-frv 23880Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging 23881messages. 23882@item set debug symbol-lookup 23883@cindex symbol lookup 23884Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup. 23885The default is 0 (off). 23886A value of 1 provides basic information. 23887A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 23888@item show debug symbol-lookup 23889Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages. 23890@item set debug symfile 23891@cindex symbol file functions 23892Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions. 23893The default is off. @xref{Files}. 23894@item show debug symfile 23895Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages. 23896@item set debug symtab-create 23897@cindex symbol table creation 23898Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation. 23899The default is 0 (off). 23900A value of 1 provides basic information. 23901A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information. 23902@item show debug symtab-create 23903Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging. 23904@item set debug target 23905@cindex target debugging info 23906Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info 23907includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The 23908default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the 23909value of large memory transfers. 23910@item show debug target 23911Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging 23912info. 23913@item set debug timestamp 23914@cindex timestampping debugging info 23915Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info. 23916When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging 23917message. 23918@item show debug timestamp 23919Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN} 23920debugging info. 23921@item set debug varobj 23922@cindex variable object debugging info 23923Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging 23924info. The default is off. 23925@item show debug varobj 23926Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object 23927debugging info. 23928@item set debug xml 23929@cindex XML parser debugging 23930Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers. 23931@item show debug xml 23932Displays the current state of XML debugging messages. 23933@end table 23934 23935@node Other Misc Settings 23936@section Other Miscellaneous Settings 23937@cindex miscellaneous settings 23938 23939@table @code 23940@kindex set interactive-mode 23941@item set interactive-mode 23942If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started 23943in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait 23944for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at 23945the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate 23946in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries. 23947If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether 23948its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it 23949is, non-interactively otherwise. 23950 23951In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess 23952correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful 23953in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN} 23954inside a cygwin window. 23955 23956@kindex show interactive-mode 23957@item show interactive-mode 23958Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not. 23959@end table 23960 23961@node Extending GDB 23962@chapter Extending @value{GDBN} 23963@cindex extending GDB 23964 23965@value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension. 23966@value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load 23967extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the 23968user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program 23969being debugged. 23970 23971@menu 23972* Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands 23973* Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python 23974* Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile 23975* Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions 23976* Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages 23977* Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands 23978@end menu 23979 23980To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable 23981of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN} 23982can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at 23983the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension 23984are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files. 23985@xref{Command Files,, Command files}. 23986 23987You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following 23988setting: 23989 23990@table @code 23991@kindex set script-extension 23992@kindex show script-extension 23993@item set script-extension off 23994All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files. 23995 23996@item set script-extension soft 23997The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename 23998extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN} 23999evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates 24000the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File. 24001 24002@item set script-extension strict 24003The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename 24004extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the 24005language is not supported, then the evaluation fails. 24006 24007@item show script-extension 24008Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option. 24009 24010@end table 24011 24012@node Sequences 24013@section Canned Sequences of Commands 24014 24015Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint 24016Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of 24017commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command 24018files. 24019 24020@menu 24021* Define:: How to define your own commands 24022* Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands 24023* Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file 24024* Output:: Commands for controlled output 24025* Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files 24026@end menu 24027 24028@node Define 24029@subsection User-defined Commands 24030 24031@cindex user-defined command 24032@cindex arguments, to user-defined commands 24033A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to 24034which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the 24035@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments 24036separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command 24037via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example: 24038 24039@smallexample 24040define adder 24041 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2 24042end 24043@end smallexample 24044 24045@noindent 24046To execute the command use: 24047 24048@smallexample 24049adder 1 2 3 24050@end smallexample 24051 24052@noindent 24053This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of 24054its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may 24055reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior 24056functions calls. 24057 24058@cindex argument count in user-defined commands 24059@cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands) 24060In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have 24061been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10. 24062 24063@smallexample 24064define adder 24065 if $argc == 2 24066 print $arg0 + $arg1 24067 end 24068 if $argc == 3 24069 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2 24070 end 24071end 24072@end smallexample 24073 24074@table @code 24075 24076@kindex define 24077@item define @var{commandname} 24078Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command 24079by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it. 24080The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters, 24081numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined 24082prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates 24083a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command. 24084 24085The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines, 24086which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these 24087commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}. 24088 24089@kindex document 24090@kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)} 24091@item document @var{commandname} 24092Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be 24093accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be 24094defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define} 24095reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}. 24096After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command 24097@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written. 24098 24099You may use the @code{document} command again to change the 24100documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define} 24101does not change the documentation. 24102 24103@kindex dont-repeat 24104@cindex don't repeat command 24105@item dont-repeat 24106Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this 24107command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET} 24108(@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}). 24109 24110@kindex help user-defined 24111@item help user-defined 24112List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class 24113COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is 24114included (if any). 24115 24116@kindex show user 24117@item show user 24118@itemx show user @var{commandname} 24119Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but 24120not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the 24121definitions for all user-defined commands. 24122This does not work for user-defined python commands. 24123 24124@cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands 24125@kindex show max-user-call-depth 24126@kindex set max-user-call-depth 24127@item show max-user-call-depth 24128@itemx set max-user-call-depth 24129The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion 24130levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an 24131infinite recursion and aborts the command. 24132This does not apply to user-defined python commands. 24133@end table 24134 24135In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently 24136use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}. 24137 24138When user-defined commands are executed, the 24139commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command 24140stops execution of the user-defined command. 24141 24142If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed 24143without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN} 24144commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the 24145messages when used in a user-defined command. 24146 24147@node Hooks 24148@subsection User-defined Command Hooks 24149@cindex command hooks 24150@cindex hooks, for commands 24151@cindex hooks, pre-command 24152 24153@kindex hook 24154You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined 24155command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined 24156command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) 24157before that command. 24158 24159@cindex hooks, post-command 24160@kindex hookpost 24161A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed. 24162Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command 24163@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after 24164that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with 24165pre-execution hooks, for the same command. 24166 24167It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this 24168occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion. 24169 24170@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating 24171@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME! 24172 24173@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command} 24174In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining 24175(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time 24176execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run, 24177displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed. 24178 24179For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while 24180single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution, 24181you could define: 24182 24183@smallexample 24184define hook-stop 24185handle SIGALRM nopass 24186end 24187 24188define hook-run 24189handle SIGALRM pass 24190end 24191 24192define hook-continue 24193handle SIGALRM pass 24194end 24195@end smallexample 24196 24197As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo} 24198command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message, 24199you could define: 24200 24201@smallexample 24202define hook-echo 24203echo <<<--- 24204end 24205 24206define hookpost-echo 24207echo --->>>\n 24208end 24209 24210(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World 24211<<<---Hello World--->>> 24212(@value{GDBP}) 24213 24214@end smallexample 24215 24216You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but 24217not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command 24218name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}. 24219@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias 24220@c or not? 24221You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or 24222@code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@: 24223@samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}. 24224 24225If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of 24226@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt 24227(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run). 24228 24229If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you 24230get a warning from the @code{define} command. 24231 24232@node Command Files 24233@subsection Command Files 24234 24235@cindex command files 24236@cindex scripting commands 24237A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are 24238@value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may 24239also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it 24240does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the 24241terminal. 24242 24243You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source} 24244command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate 24245scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured 24246using the @code{script-extension} setting. 24247@xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}. 24248 24249@table @code 24250@kindex source 24251@cindex execute commands from a file 24252@item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename} 24253Execute the command file @var{filename}. 24254@end table 24255 24256The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially, 24257unless the order of execution is changed by one of the 24258@emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not 24259printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates 24260execution of the command file and control is returned to the console. 24261 24262@value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory. 24263If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a 24264directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path 24265(specified with the @samp{directory} command); 24266except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory 24267is not relevant to scripts. 24268 24269If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} 24270on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory. 24271The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the 24272search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript} 24273and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will 24274look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}. 24275The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path. 24276For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and 24277the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will 24278look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}. 24279For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification, 24280it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is 24281@file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN} 24282will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}. 24283 24284If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays 24285each command as it is executed. The option must be given before 24286@var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else. 24287 24288Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed 24289without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that 24290normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages 24291when called from command files. 24292 24293@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this 24294mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to 24295standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do 24296not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with 24297the next command. 24298 24299@smallexample 24300gdb < cmds > log 2>&1 24301@end smallexample 24302 24303(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example 24304will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors 24305would be directed to @file{log}. 24306 24307Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than 24308commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with 24309complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of 24310variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is 24311built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to 24312deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write 24313complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands 24314conditionally, etc. 24315 24316@table @code 24317@kindex if 24318@kindex else 24319@item if 24320@itemx else 24321This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed 24322commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an 24323expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that 24324are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero). 24325There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series 24326of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The 24327end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}. 24328 24329@kindex while 24330@item while 24331This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to 24332@code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression 24333to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per 24334line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the 24335@dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are 24336executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true. 24337 24338@kindex loop_break 24339@item loop_break 24340This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. 24341Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end} 24342line. 24343 24344@kindex loop_continue 24345@item loop_continue 24346This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands 24347in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution 24348branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates 24349the controlling expression. 24350 24351@kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)} 24352@item end 24353Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if}, 24354@code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands. 24355@end table 24356 24357 24358@node Output 24359@subsection Commands for Controlled Output 24360 24361During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal 24362@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is 24363explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section 24364describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you 24365want. 24366 24367@table @code 24368@kindex echo 24369@item echo @var{text} 24370@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence 24371@c because it is not in ANSI. 24372Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in 24373@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a 24374newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.} 24375In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed 24376by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a 24377string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and 24378trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments. 24379To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command 24380@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}. 24381 24382A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue 24383the command onto subsequent lines. For example, 24384 24385@smallexample 24386echo This is some text\n\ 24387which is continued\n\ 24388onto several lines.\n 24389@end smallexample 24390 24391produces the same output as 24392 24393@smallexample 24394echo This is some text\n 24395echo which is continued\n 24396echo onto several lines.\n 24397@end smallexample 24398 24399@kindex output 24400@item output @var{expression} 24401Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no 24402newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the 24403value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information 24404on expressions. 24405 24406@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression} 24407Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use 24408the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output 24409Formats}, for more information. 24410 24411@kindex printf 24412@item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{} 24413Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of 24414the string @var{template}. To print several values, make 24415@var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions, 24416which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as 24417specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by 24418executing the code below: 24419 24420@smallexample 24421printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}); 24422@end smallexample 24423 24424As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template} 24425are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced 24426by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be 24427evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and 24428style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then 24429printed. 24430 24431For example, you can print two values in hex like this: 24432 24433@smallexample 24434printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo 24435@end smallexample 24436 24437@code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion 24438specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%} 24439character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions: 24440 24441@itemize @bullet 24442@item 24443The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported. 24444 24445@item 24446The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or 24447width. 24448 24449@item 24450The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to 24451@code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported. 24452 24453@item 24454The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not 24455supported. 24456 24457@item 24458The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported. 24459 24460@item 24461The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported. 24462@end itemize 24463 24464@noindent 24465Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the 24466underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports 24467the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is 24468supported only if @code{long double} type is available. 24469 24470As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape 24471sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"}, 24472@samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a 24473single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not 24474supported. 24475 24476Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP 24477(@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers 24478together with a floating point specifier. 24479letters: 24480 24481@itemize @bullet 24482@item 24483@samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types. 24484 24485@item 24486@samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types. 24487 24488@item 24489@samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types. 24490@end itemize 24491 24492If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has 24493support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers 24494such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use. 24495 24496In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be 24497available and the value will be printed in the standard way. 24498 24499Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters: 24500@smallexample 24501printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl 24502@end smallexample 24503 24504@kindex eval 24505@item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{} 24506Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of 24507the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it. 24508 24509@end table 24510 24511@node Auto-loading sequences 24512@subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts 24513@cindex native script auto-loading 24514 24515When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file} 24516command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library), 24517@value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}. 24518@xref{Auto-loading extensions}. 24519 24520Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled, 24521and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed. 24522 24523@table @code 24524@anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts} 24525@kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts 24526@item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off] 24527Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts. 24528 24529@anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts} 24530@kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts 24531@item show auto-load gdb-scripts 24532Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or 24533disabled. 24534 24535@anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts} 24536@kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts 24537@cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts 24538@item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}] 24539Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN} 24540auto-loaded. 24541@end table 24542 24543If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with 24544matching names are printed. 24545 24546@c Python docs live in a separate file. 24547@include python.texi 24548 24549@c Guile docs live in a separate file. 24550@include guile.texi 24551 24552@node Auto-loading extensions 24553@section Auto-loading extensions 24554@cindex auto-loading extensions 24555 24556@value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions 24557when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file} 24558command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library): 24559@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} 24560section of modern file formats like ELF. 24561 24562@menu 24563* objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file 24564* .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 24565* Which flavor to choose?:: 24566@end menu 24567 24568The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific 24569debugging commands and features. 24570 24571Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled, 24572and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed. 24573See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language 24574for more information. 24575For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}. 24576For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}. 24577 24578Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured 24579@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24580 24581@node objfile-gdbdotext file 24582@subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file 24583@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} 24584@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} 24585@cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm} 24586 24587When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named 24588@file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below), 24589where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and 24590where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language: 24591 24592@table @code 24593@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb} 24594GDB's own command language 24595@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py} 24596Python 24597@item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm} 24598Guile 24599@end table 24600 24601@var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile} 24602is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..} 24603components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix. 24604If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a 24605script in the specified extension language. 24606 24607If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for 24608@var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below. 24609 24610Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured 24611@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24612 24613For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the 24614scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are 24615found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without 24616its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it 24617is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible 24618between Unix and MS-Windows hosts. 24619 24620@table @code 24621@anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory} 24622@kindex set auto-load scripts-directory 24623@item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]} 24624Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries 24625may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use 24626(@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS). 24627 24628Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting 24629@code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}). 24630 24631@anchor{with-auto-load-dir} 24632This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default 24633@code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN} 24634configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}. 24635 24636Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by 24637@var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any 24638reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is 24639determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and 24640@file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or 24641delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host 24642platform. 24643 24644The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix 24645systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly 24646to the @env{PATH} environment variable. 24647 24648@anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory} 24649@kindex show auto-load scripts-directory 24650@item show auto-load scripts-directory 24651Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. 24652 24653@anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory} 24654@kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory 24655@item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]} 24656Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations. 24657Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use. 24658@end table 24659 24660@value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way. 24661@value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding 24662@var{objfile} is opened. 24663So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it 24664is evaluated more than once. 24665 24666@node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section 24667@subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 24668@cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section 24669 24670For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF, 24671when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file 24672it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}. 24673If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries 24674specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that 24675specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the 24676script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}. 24677 24678The following entries are supported: 24679 24680@table @code 24681@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1 24682@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3 24683@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4 24684@item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6 24685@end table 24686 24687@subsubsection Script File Entries 24688 24689If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first 24690in the current directory and then along the source search path 24691(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}), 24692except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation 24693directory is not relevant to scripts. 24694 24695File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with, 24696for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts. 24697 24698@example 24699/* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */ 24700#define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \ 24701 asm("\ 24702.pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\ 24703.byte 1 /* Python */\n\ 24704.asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\ 24705.popsection \n\ 24706"); 24707@end example 24708 24709@noindent 24710For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}. 24711Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this: 24712 24713@example 24714DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py") 24715@end example 24716 24717The script name may include directories if desired. 24718 24719Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured 24720@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24721 24722If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library 24723using this header will get a reference to the specified script, 24724and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker 24725will remove duplicates. 24726 24727@subsubsection Script Text Entries 24728 24729Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry 24730itself instead of loading it from a file. 24731The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to 24732the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not 24733contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs. 24734The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to 24735execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among 24736all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based 24737on its name. 24738 24739Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN} 24740testsuite. 24741 24742@example 24743#include "symcat.h" 24744#include "gdb/section-scripts.h" 24745asm( 24746".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n" 24747".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n" 24748".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n" 24749".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n" 24750".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n" 24751".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ (" 24752 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n" 24753".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n" 24754".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n" 24755".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n" 24756".byte 0\n" 24757".popsection\n" 24758); 24759@end example 24760 24761Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured 24762@code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}). 24763The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file 24764containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section. 24765 24766@node Which flavor to choose? 24767@subsection Which flavor to choose? 24768 24769Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always 24770be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance. 24771 24772@noindent 24773Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way: 24774 24775@itemize @bullet 24776@item 24777Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections. 24778 24779@item 24780Ease of finding scripts for public libraries. 24781 24782Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for 24783in the source search path. 24784For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically 24785isn't a source directory in which to find the script. 24786 24787@item 24788Doesn't require source code additions. 24789@end itemize 24790 24791@noindent 24792Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way: 24793 24794@itemize @bullet 24795@item 24796Works with static linking. 24797 24798Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to 24799trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only 24800objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the 24801scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's 24802@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script. 24803 24804@item 24805Works with classes that are entirely inlined. 24806 24807Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated 24808shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to. 24809 24810@item 24811Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree. 24812 24813In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal 24814libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the 24815@file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is 24816cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the 24817@code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the 24818top of the source tree to the source search path. 24819@end itemize 24820 24821@node Multiple Extension Languages 24822@section Multiple Extension Languages 24823 24824The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state, 24825and generally do not interfere with each other. 24826There are some things to be aware of, however. 24827 24828@subsection Python comes first 24829 24830Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking 24831existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the 24832``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled 24833extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language, 24834(say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension 24835language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the 24836pretty-printed form of a value). 24837This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens 24838while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is 24839reported and any following extension languages are not tried. 24840 24841@node Aliases 24842@section Creating new spellings of existing commands 24843@cindex aliases for commands 24844 24845It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands. 24846For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has 24847a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it 24848that involves less typing. 24849 24850@value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias 24851of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous 24852abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}. 24853 24854Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions 24855of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the 24856@samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command. 24857 24858You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command. 24859 24860@table @code 24861 24862@kindex alias 24863@item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND} 24864 24865@end table 24866 24867@var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias. 24868Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and 24869underscores. 24870 24871@var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command 24872that is being aliased. 24873 24874The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation 24875of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command 24876lists displayed by the @samp{help} command. 24877 24878The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options, 24879and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash. 24880 24881Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation 24882of a command so that there is less to type. 24883Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current 24884shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command 24885and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}. 24886The following will accomplish this. 24887 24888@smallexample 24889(gdb) alias -a di = disas 24890@end smallexample 24891 24892Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands. 24893With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation 24894for it with the @samp{document} command. 24895An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command. 24896 24897Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of 24898@samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command. 24899This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part 24900of a command. 24901 24902@smallexample 24903(gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements 24904(gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements 24905(gdb) set p elms 20 24906(gdb) show p elms 24907Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200. 24908@end smallexample 24909 24910Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command, 24911and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show} 24912command, then you need to define the latter separately. 24913 24914Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and 24915@var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally. 24916 24917@smallexample 24918(gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele 24919@end smallexample 24920 24921Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word 24922alias for a more complex command. 24923This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}. 24924 24925@smallexample 24926(gdb) alias spe = set print elements 24927(gdb) spe 20 24928@end smallexample 24929 24930@node Interpreters 24931@chapter Command Interpreters 24932@cindex command interpreters 24933 24934@value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command 24935infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch 24936between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters. 24937 24938@value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console 24939interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli}) 24940and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual 24941describes both of these interfaces in great detail. 24942 24943By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter. 24944However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another 24945interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter} 24946startup options. Defined interpreters include: 24947 24948@table @code 24949@item console 24950@cindex console interpreter 24951The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often 24952used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime, 24953@value{GDBN} will use this interpreter. 24954 24955@item mi 24956@cindex mi interpreter 24957The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily 24958by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI 24959or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} 24960Interface}. 24961 24962@item mi2 24963@cindex mi2 interpreter 24964The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface. 24965 24966@item mi1 24967@cindex mi1 interpreter 24968The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3. 24969 24970@end table 24971 24972@cindex invoke another interpreter 24973 24974@kindex interpreter-exec 24975You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current 24976interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the 24977console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command: 24978 24979@smallexample 24980interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names" 24981@end smallexample 24982 24983@sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of 24984@value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater). 24985 24986Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the 24987duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter 24988permanently. 24989 24990@cindex start a new independent interpreter 24991 24992Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is 24993possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output 24994device (usually a tty). 24995 24996For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a 24997@value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal 24998emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional 24999command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that 25000terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified 25001input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN} 25002at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget, 25003while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using 25004the separate MI interpreter. 25005 25006To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the 25007@code{new-ui} command: 25008 25009@kindex new-ui 25010@cindex new user interface 25011@smallexample 25012new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty} 25013@end smallexample 25014 25015The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run. 25016This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command. 25017For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The 25018@var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the 25019interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a 25020pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example: 25021 25022@smallexample 25023(@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9 25024@end smallexample 25025 25026@noindent 25027runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}. 25028 25029@node TUI 25030@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface 25031@cindex TUI 25032@cindex Text User Interface 25033 25034@menu 25035* TUI Overview:: TUI overview 25036* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings 25037* TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode 25038* TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands 25039* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables 25040@end menu 25041 25042The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal 25043interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source 25044file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN} 25045commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only 25046on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library 25047is available. 25048 25049The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as 25050@samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}. 25051You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by 25052using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui 25053enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and 25054@ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}. 25055 25056@node TUI Overview 25057@section TUI Overview 25058 25059In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows: 25060 25061@table @emph 25062@item command 25063This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN} 25064prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still 25065managed using readline. 25066 25067@item source 25068The source window shows the source file of the program. The current 25069line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window. 25070 25071@item assembly 25072The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program. 25073 25074@item register 25075This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted 25076when their values change. 25077@end table 25078 25079The source and assembly windows show the current program position 25080by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker. 25081Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker 25082indicates the breakpoint type: 25083 25084@table @code 25085@item B 25086Breakpoint which was hit at least once. 25087 25088@item b 25089Breakpoint which was never hit. 25090 25091@item H 25092Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once. 25093 25094@item h 25095Hardware breakpoint which was never hit. 25096@end table 25097 25098The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not: 25099 25100@table @code 25101@item + 25102Breakpoint is enabled. 25103 25104@item - 25105Breakpoint is disabled. 25106@end table 25107 25108The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current 25109thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter 25110changes. 25111 25112These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command 25113window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several 25114layouts: 25115 25116@itemize @bullet 25117@item 25118source only, 25119 25120@item 25121assembly only, 25122 25123@item 25124source and assembly, 25125 25126@item 25127source and registers, or 25128 25129@item 25130assembly and registers. 25131@end itemize 25132 25133A status line above the command window shows the following information: 25134 25135@table @emph 25136@item target 25137Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target. 25138(@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 25139 25140@item process 25141Gives the current process or thread number. 25142When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}. 25143 25144@item function 25145Gives the current function name for the selected frame. 25146The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}). 25147When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter, 25148the string @code{??} is displayed. 25149 25150@item line 25151Indicates the current line number for the selected frame. 25152When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed. 25153 25154@item pc 25155Indicates the current program counter address. 25156@end table 25157 25158@node TUI Keys 25159@section TUI Key Bindings 25160@cindex TUI key bindings 25161 25162The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps 25163@ifset SYSTEM_READLINE 25164(@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}). 25165@end ifset 25166@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 25167(@pxref{Command Line Editing}). 25168@end ifclear 25169The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the 25170@value{GDBN} standard mode. 25171 25172@table @kbd 25173@kindex C-x C-a 25174@item C-x C-a 25175@kindex C-x a 25176@itemx C-x a 25177@kindex C-x A 25178@itemx C-x A 25179Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode, 25180the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using 25181its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering 25182the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows. 25183The screen is then refreshed. 25184 25185@kindex C-x 1 25186@item C-x 1 25187Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will 25188either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode 25189is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode. 25190 25191Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding. 25192 25193@kindex C-x 2 25194@item C-x 2 25195Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current 25196layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used. 25197When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the 25198previous layout and the new one. 25199 25200Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding. 25201 25202@kindex C-x o 25203@item C-x o 25204Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings 25205(like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command 25206gives the focus to the next TUI window. 25207 25208Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding. 25209 25210@kindex C-x s 25211@item C-x s 25212Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single 25213keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}). 25214@end table 25215 25216The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode: 25217 25218@table @asis 25219@kindex PgUp 25220@item @key{PgUp} 25221Scroll the active window one page up. 25222 25223@kindex PgDn 25224@item @key{PgDn} 25225Scroll the active window one page down. 25226 25227@kindex Up 25228@item @key{Up} 25229Scroll the active window one line up. 25230 25231@kindex Down 25232@item @key{Down} 25233Scroll the active window one line down. 25234 25235@kindex Left 25236@item @key{Left} 25237Scroll the active window one column left. 25238 25239@kindex Right 25240@item @key{Right} 25241Scroll the active window one column right. 25242 25243@kindex C-L 25244@item @kbd{C-L} 25245Refresh the screen. 25246@end table 25247 25248Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they 25249are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command 25250window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use 25251other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} 25252and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window. 25253 25254@node TUI Single Key Mode 25255@section TUI Single Key Mode 25256@cindex TUI single key mode 25257 25258The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several 25259frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to 25260switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used: 25261 25262@table @kbd 25263@kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25264@item c 25265continue 25266 25267@kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25268@item d 25269down 25270 25271@kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25272@item f 25273finish 25274 25275@kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25276@item n 25277next 25278 25279@kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25280@item q 25281exit the SingleKey mode. 25282 25283@kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25284@item r 25285run 25286 25287@kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25288@item s 25289step 25290 25291@kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25292@item u 25293up 25294 25295@kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25296@item v 25297info locals 25298 25299@kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)} 25300@item w 25301where 25302@end table 25303 25304Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt. 25305The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that 25306it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction 25307with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI 25308SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave 25309this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}. 25310 25311 25312@node TUI Commands 25313@section TUI-specific Commands 25314@cindex TUI commands 25315 25316The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows. 25317These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in 25318the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most 25319of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode. 25320 25321Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a 25322terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface 25323interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of 25324these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be 25325possible or desirable to enable curses window management. 25326 25327@table @code 25328@item tui enable 25329@kindex tui enable 25330Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if 25331TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session, 25332otherwise a default layout is used. 25333 25334@item tui disable 25335@kindex tui disable 25336Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter. 25337 25338@item info win 25339@kindex info win 25340List and give the size of all displayed windows. 25341 25342@item layout @var{name} 25343@kindex layout 25344Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command 25345window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which 25346additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following: 25347 25348@table @code 25349@item next 25350Display the next layout. 25351 25352@item prev 25353Display the previous layout. 25354 25355@item src 25356Display the source and command windows. 25357 25358@item asm 25359Display the assembly and command windows. 25360 25361@item split 25362Display the source, assembly, and command windows. 25363 25364@item regs 25365When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command 25366windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the 25367register, assembler, and command windows. 25368@end table 25369 25370@item focus @var{name} 25371@kindex focus 25372Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The 25373@var{name} parameter can be any of the following: 25374 25375@table @code 25376@item next 25377Make the next window active for scrolling. 25378 25379@item prev 25380Make the previous window active for scrolling. 25381 25382@item src 25383Make the source window active for scrolling. 25384 25385@item asm 25386Make the assembly window active for scrolling. 25387 25388@item regs 25389Make the register window active for scrolling. 25390 25391@item cmd 25392Make the command window active for scrolling. 25393@end table 25394 25395@item refresh 25396@kindex refresh 25397Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}. 25398 25399@item tui reg @var{group} 25400@kindex tui reg 25401Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to 25402@var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this 25403command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of 25404register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The 25405following groups are available on most targets: 25406@table @code 25407@item next 25408Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle 25409through all of the available register groups. 25410 25411@item prev 25412Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle 25413through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to 25414@var{next}. 25415 25416@item general 25417Display the general registers. 25418@item float 25419Display the floating point registers. 25420@item system 25421Display the system registers. 25422@item vector 25423Display the vector registers. 25424@item all 25425Display all registers. 25426@end table 25427 25428@item update 25429@kindex update 25430Update the source window and the current execution point. 25431 25432@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count} 25433@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count} 25434@kindex winheight 25435Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count} 25436lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts 25437decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the 25438source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the 25439disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window). 25440 25441@item tabset @var{nchars} 25442@kindex tabset 25443Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This 25444setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and 25445assembly windows. 25446@end table 25447 25448@node TUI Configuration 25449@section TUI Configuration Variables 25450@cindex TUI configuration variables 25451 25452Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows. 25453 25454@table @code 25455@item set tui border-kind @var{kind} 25456@kindex set tui border-kind 25457Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows. 25458The possible values are the following: 25459@table @code 25460@item space 25461Use a space character to draw the border. 25462 25463@item ascii 25464Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border. 25465 25466@item acs 25467Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is 25468drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them. 25469@end table 25470 25471@item set tui border-mode @var{mode} 25472@kindex set tui border-mode 25473@itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode} 25474@kindex set tui active-border-mode 25475Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows 25476or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following: 25477@table @code 25478@item normal 25479Use normal attributes to display the border. 25480 25481@item standout 25482Use standout mode. 25483 25484@item reverse 25485Use reverse video mode. 25486 25487@item half 25488Use half bright mode. 25489 25490@item half-standout 25491Use half bright and standout mode. 25492 25493@item bold 25494Use extra bright or bold mode. 25495 25496@item bold-standout 25497Use extra bright or bold and standout mode. 25498@end table 25499@end table 25500 25501@node Emacs 25502@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs 25503 25504@cindex Emacs 25505@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs 25506A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and 25507edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with 25508@value{GDBN}. 25509 25510To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the 25511executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts 25512@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly 25513created Emacs buffer. 25514@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.) 25515 25516Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two 25517things: 25518 25519@itemize @bullet 25520@item 25521All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called 25522the GUD buffer. 25523 25524This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input 25525and output done by the program you are debugging. 25526 25527This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous 25528commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output 25529in this way. 25530 25531All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting 25532with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual 25533way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a 25534stop. 25535 25536@item 25537@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs. 25538 25539Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the 25540source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the 25541left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for 25542source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session 25543and the source. 25544 25545Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as 25546usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs. 25547@end itemize 25548 25549We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses 25550a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers 25551that can control the execution and describe the state of your program. 25552@xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}. 25553 25554If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x 25555gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where 25556your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs 25557sets your current working directory to the directory associated 25558with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your 25559program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on 25560some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the 25561@value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary 25562buffer does not display the current source and line of execution. 25563 25564The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top 25565line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands 25566that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, 25567,Commands to Specify Files}. 25568 25569By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you 25570need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you 25571keep several configurations around, with different names) you can 25572customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the 25573one you want. 25574 25575In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in 25576addition to the standard Shell mode commands: 25577 25578@table @kbd 25579@item C-h m 25580Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode. 25581 25582@item C-c C-s 25583Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also 25584update the display window to show the current file and location. 25585 25586@item C-c C-n 25587Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function 25588calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window 25589to show the current file and location. 25590 25591@item C-c C-i 25592Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update 25593display window accordingly. 25594 25595@item C-c C-f 25596Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN} 25597@code{finish} command. 25598 25599@item C-c C-r 25600Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue} 25601command. 25602 25603@item C-c < 25604Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument 25605(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}), 25606like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command. 25607 25608@item C-c > 25609Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the 25610@value{GDBN} @code{down} command. 25611@end table 25612 25613In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break}) 25614tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on. 25615 25616In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a 25617separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current. 25618Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it 25619become the current frame and display the associated source in the 25620source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the 25621selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the 25622speedbar displays watch expressions. 25623 25624If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get 25625it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to 25626request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates 25627the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current 25628frame. 25629 25630The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers 25631which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit 25632the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN} 25633communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or 25634delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease 25635to correspond properly with the code. 25636 25637A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is 25638given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} 25639Emacs Manual}). 25640 25641@node GDB/MI 25642@chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface 25643 25644@unnumberedsec Function and Purpose 25645 25646@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose 25647@sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to 25648@value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the 25649@option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It 25650is specifically intended to support the development of systems which 25651use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system. 25652 25653This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written 25654in the form of a reference manual. 25655 25656Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the 25657features described below are incomplete and subject to change 25658(@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}). 25659 25660@unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology 25661 25662@cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi} 25663This chapter uses the following notation: 25664 25665@itemize @bullet 25666@item 25667@code{|} separates two alternatives. 25668 25669@item 25670@code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional: 25671it may or may not be given. 25672 25673@item 25674@code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses 25675may repeat zero or more times. 25676 25677@item 25678@code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses 25679may repeat one or more times. 25680 25681@item 25682@code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}. 25683@end itemize 25684 25685@ignore 25686@heading Dependencies 25687@end ignore 25688 25689@menu 25690* GDB/MI General Design:: 25691* GDB/MI Command Syntax:: 25692* GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI:: 25693* GDB/MI Development and Front Ends:: 25694* GDB/MI Output Records:: 25695* GDB/MI Simple Examples:: 25696* GDB/MI Command Description Format:: 25697* GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands:: 25698* GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands:: 25699* GDB/MI Program Context:: 25700* GDB/MI Thread Commands:: 25701* GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands:: 25702* GDB/MI Program Execution:: 25703* GDB/MI Stack Manipulation:: 25704* GDB/MI Variable Objects:: 25705* GDB/MI Data Manipulation:: 25706* GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands:: 25707* GDB/MI Symbol Query:: 25708* GDB/MI File Commands:: 25709@ignore 25710* GDB/MI Kod Commands:: 25711* GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands:: 25712* GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands:: 25713@end ignore 25714* GDB/MI Target Manipulation:: 25715* GDB/MI File Transfer Commands:: 25716* GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands:: 25717* GDB/MI Support Commands:: 25718* GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands:: 25719@end menu 25720 25721@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 25722@node GDB/MI General Design 25723@section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design 25724@cindex GDB/MI General Design 25725 25726Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three 25727parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands 25728and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response, 25729indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error. 25730For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the 25731requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the 25732response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed. 25733Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the 25734target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with 25735a command and reported as part of that command response. 25736 25737The important examples of notifications are: 25738@itemize @bullet 25739 25740@item 25741Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in 25742target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not 25743be feasible to include this information in response of resuming 25744commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in 25745different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event 25746happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming 25747command itself was successfully executed. 25748 25749@item 25750Console output, and status notifications. Console output 25751notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as 25752diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to 25753report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including 25754this information in command response would mean no output is produced 25755until the command is finished, which is undesirable. 25756 25757@item 25758General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on 25759the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example, 25760a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can 25761be included in command response, using notification allows for more 25762orthogonal frontend design. 25763 25764@end itemize 25765 25766There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error, 25767@value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially, 25768the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was 25769processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error, 25770we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in 25771the user interface. 25772 25773 25774@menu 25775* Context management:: 25776* Asynchronous and non-stop modes:: 25777* Thread groups:: 25778@end menu 25779 25780@node Context management 25781@subsection Context management 25782 25783@subsubsection Threads and Frames 25784 25785In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is 25786done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}). 25787Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread 25788be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame, 25789and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient, 25790because a command line user would not want to specify that information 25791explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with 25792@value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as 25793to what thread and frame are the current ones. 25794 25795In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less 25796useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information 25797itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window, 25798each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might 25799want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This 25800increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the 25801frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command 25802should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To 25803make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and 25804@samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global 25805identifier for thread and frame to operate on. 25806 25807Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select 25808a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further 25809operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the 25810current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a 25811breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is 25812hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or 25813@samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the 25814frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN} 25815communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the 25816@samp{=thread-selected} notification. 25817 25818Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so 25819frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the 25820right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The 25821simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command 25822before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need 25823to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select} 25824if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the 25825thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this 25826optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend 25827sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the 25828selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will 25829change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such 25830problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for 25831all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly 25832right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and 25833@samp{--frame} options. 25834 25835@subsubsection Language 25836 25837The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected. 25838By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used. 25839But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended 25840to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument, 25841which is the name of the language to use while executing the command. 25842For instance: 25843 25844@smallexample 25845-data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)" 25846^done,value="4" 25847(gdb) 25848@end smallexample 25849 25850The valid language names are the same names accepted by the 25851@samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto}, 25852@samp{local} or @samp{unknown}. 25853 25854@node Asynchronous and non-stop modes 25855@subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode 25856 25857On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands 25858even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous 25859command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may 25860specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the 25861@code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before 25862either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the 25863frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can 25864find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the 25865@code{-list-target-features} command. 25866 25867@table @code 25868@item -gdb-set mi-async on 25869@item -gdb-set mi-async off 25870Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode. 25871 25872When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g., 25873@code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits 25874for the program to stop before processing further commands. 25875 25876When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution 25877commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the 25878@code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing 25879MI commands even while the target is running. 25880 25881@item -gdb-show mi-async 25882Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled. 25883@end table 25884 25885Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called 25886@code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect 25887of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background 25888commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible 25889``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is 25890kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility. 25891 25892Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running, 25893many commands that access the target do not work when the target is 25894running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful 25895when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then, 25896it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads 25897are running. 25898 25899When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the 25900target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on 25901some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's 25902stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or 25903modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note 25904that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print}, 25905@code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the 25906context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a 25907stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the 25908@samp{--thread} option). 25909 25910Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is 25911highly target dependent. However, the two commands 25912@code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info}, 25913to find the state of a thread, will always work. 25914 25915@node Thread groups 25916@subsection Thread groups 25917@value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time. 25918On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several 25919hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different 25920processes running on each core. This section describes the MI 25921mechanism to support such debugging scenarios. 25922 25923The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the 25924target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that 25925accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that 25926thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce 25927neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the 25928current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature 25929that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped 25930into processes. 25931 25932To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary 25933hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a 25934@dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other 25935thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type, 25936and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new 25937command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level 25938thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is 25939debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group 25940to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain 25941the members of specific thread group. 25942 25943To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he 25944wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is 25945introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that 25946@value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the 25947@code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread 25948groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}. 25949In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only 25950after attaching to that thread group. 25951 25952Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and 25953Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special 25954type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on 25955such thread groups. 25956 25957@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 25958@node GDB/MI Command Syntax 25959@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax 25960 25961@menu 25962* GDB/MI Input Syntax:: 25963* GDB/MI Output Syntax:: 25964@end menu 25965 25966@node GDB/MI Input Syntax 25967@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax 25968 25969@cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi} 25970@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax 25971@table @code 25972@item @var{command} @expansion{} 25973@code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}} 25974 25975@item @var{cli-command} @expansion{} 25976@code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where 25977@var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command. 25978 25979@item @var{mi-command} @expansion{} 25980@code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )* 25981@code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}} 25982 25983@item @var{token} @expansion{} 25984"any sequence of digits" 25985 25986@item @var{option} @expansion{} 25987@code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]} 25988 25989@item @var{parameter} @expansion{} 25990@code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}} 25991 25992@item @var{operation} @expansion{} 25993@emph{any of the operations described in this chapter} 25994 25995@item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{} 25996@emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as 25997"-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "} 25998 25999@item @var{c-string} @expansion{} 26000@code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """} 26001 26002@item @var{nl} @expansion{} 26003@code{CR | CR-LF} 26004@end table 26005 26006@noindent 26007Notes: 26008 26009@itemize @bullet 26010@item 26011The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their 26012output is described below. 26013 26014@item 26015The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command 26016finishes. 26017 26018@item 26019Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter 26020list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be 26021followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the 26022parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using 26023@samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash). 26024@end itemize 26025 26026Pragmatics: 26027 26028@itemize @bullet 26029@item 26030We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging). 26031 26032@item 26033We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation. 26034@end itemize 26035 26036@node GDB/MI Output Syntax 26037@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax 26038 26039@cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi} 26040@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax 26041The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records 26042followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record 26043is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is 26044terminated by @samp{(gdb)}. 26045 26046If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the 26047corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same 26048@var{token}. 26049 26050@table @code 26051@item @var{output} @expansion{} 26052@code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}} 26053 26054@item @var{result-record} @expansion{} 26055@code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}} 26056 26057@item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{} 26058@code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}} 26059 26060@item @var{async-record} @expansion{} 26061@code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}} 26062 26063@item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{} 26064@code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}} 26065 26066@item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{} 26067@code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}} 26068 26069@item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{} 26070@code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}} 26071 26072@item @var{async-output} @expansion{} 26073@code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*} 26074 26075@item @var{result-class} @expansion{} 26076@code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"} 26077 26078@item @var{async-class} @expansion{} 26079@code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added 26080depending on the needs---this is still in development). 26081 26082@item @var{result} @expansion{} 26083@code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}} 26084 26085@item @var{variable} @expansion{} 26086@code{ @var{string} } 26087 26088@item @var{value} @expansion{} 26089@code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} } 26090 26091@item @var{const} @expansion{} 26092@code{@var{c-string}} 26093 26094@item @var{tuple} @expansion{} 26095@code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" } 26096 26097@item @var{list} @expansion{} 26098@code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "[" 26099@var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" } 26100 26101@item @var{stream-record} @expansion{} 26102@code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}} 26103 26104@item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{} 26105@code{"~" @var{c-string nl}} 26106 26107@item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{} 26108@code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}} 26109 26110@item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{} 26111@code{"&" @var{c-string nl}} 26112 26113@item @var{nl} @expansion{} 26114@code{CR | CR-LF} 26115 26116@item @var{token} @expansion{} 26117@emph{any sequence of digits}. 26118@end table 26119 26120@noindent 26121Notes: 26122 26123@itemize @bullet 26124@item 26125All output sequences end in a single line containing a period. 26126 26127@item 26128The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that 26129for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and 26130may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async 26131output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat 26132all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the 26133target and there should be no need to associate async output to any 26134prior command. 26135 26136@item 26137@cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26138@var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the 26139progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is 26140prefixed by @samp{+}. 26141 26142@item 26143@cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26144@var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target 26145(stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by 26146@samp{*}. 26147 26148@item 26149@cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26150@var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the 26151client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify 26152output is prefixed by @samp{=}. 26153 26154@item 26155@cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26156@var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the 26157console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console 26158output is prefixed by @samp{~}. 26159 26160@item 26161@cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26162@var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program. 26163All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}. 26164 26165@item 26166@cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26167@var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for 26168instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All 26169the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}. 26170 26171@item 26172@cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi} 26173New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing 26174@var{values}. 26175 26176 26177@end itemize 26178 26179@xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more 26180details about the various output records. 26181 26182@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26183@node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI 26184@section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI 26185 26186@cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI 26187@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI 26188 26189For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly, 26190but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands 26191that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint 26192command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as 26193@code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with 26194@samp{>}, which is not valid MI output. 26195 26196This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is 26197recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command 26198(@pxref{-interpreter-exec}). 26199 26200@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26201@node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends 26202@section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends 26203@cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development 26204 26205The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the 26206program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}. 26207 26208Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used 26209by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult 26210to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This 26211section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol 26212might change. 26213 26214Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and 26215for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a 26216list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should 26217parse MI output in a way that can handle them: 26218 26219@itemize @bullet 26220@item 26221New MI commands may be added. 26222 26223@item 26224New fields may be added to the output of any MI command. 26225 26226@item 26227The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g., 26228@code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended. 26229 26230@c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it 26231@c at your own risk. Yes, in general? 26232 26233@c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might 26234@c resolve inconsistencies. 26235@end itemize 26236 26237If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level 26238will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the 26239output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of 26240@value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the 26241responsibility of the front end to work with the new one. 26242 26243@c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI 26244@c version? 26245 26246The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front 26247end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and 26248follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and 26249@email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. 26250@cindex mailing lists 26251 26252@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26253@node GDB/MI Output Records 26254@section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records 26255 26256@menu 26257* GDB/MI Result Records:: 26258* GDB/MI Stream Records:: 26259* GDB/MI Async Records:: 26260* GDB/MI Breakpoint Information:: 26261* GDB/MI Frame Information:: 26262* GDB/MI Thread Information:: 26263* GDB/MI Ada Exception Information:: 26264@end menu 26265 26266@node GDB/MI Result Records 26267@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records 26268 26269@cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi} 26270@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records 26271In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a 26272@sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications: 26273 26274@table @code 26275@findex ^done 26276@item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ] 26277The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return 26278values. 26279 26280@item "^running" 26281@findex ^running 26282This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it 26283was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the 26284target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but 26285all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running} 26286identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine 26287which threads are resumed. 26288 26289@item "^connected" 26290@findex ^connected 26291@value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target. 26292 26293@item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ] 26294@findex ^error 26295The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains 26296the corresponding error message. 26297 26298If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error 26299code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding 26300error condition. At present, only one error code is defined: 26301 26302@table @samp 26303@item "undefined-command" 26304Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist. 26305@end table 26306 26307@item "^exit" 26308@findex ^exit 26309@value{GDBN} has terminated. 26310 26311@end table 26312 26313@node GDB/MI Stream Records 26314@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records 26315 26316@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records 26317@cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi} 26318@value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the 26319target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is 26320funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}. 26321 26322Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which 26323identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output 26324Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a 26325@code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new 26326line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline). 26327 26328@table @code 26329@item "~" @var{string-output} 26330The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the 26331CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands. 26332 26333@item "@@" @var{string-output} 26334The target output stream contains any textual output from the running 26335target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly 26336asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets. 26337 26338@item "&" @var{string-output} 26339The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s 26340internals. 26341@end table 26342 26343@node GDB/MI Async Records 26344@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records 26345 26346@cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi} 26347@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records 26348@dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of 26349additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a 26350consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of 26351target activity (e.g., target stopped). 26352 26353The following is the list of possible async records: 26354 26355@table @code 26356 26357@item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}" 26358The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global 26359thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be 26360@samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume 26361that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this 26362notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this 26363notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may 26364emit this notification several times, either for different threads, 26365because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single 26366thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting 26367it run freely. 26368 26369@item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}" 26370The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the 26371following values: 26372 26373@table @code 26374@item breakpoint-hit 26375A breakpoint was reached. 26376@item watchpoint-trigger 26377A watchpoint was triggered. 26378@item read-watchpoint-trigger 26379A read watchpoint was triggered. 26380@item access-watchpoint-trigger 26381An access watchpoint was triggered. 26382@item function-finished 26383An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished. 26384@item location-reached 26385An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished. 26386@item watchpoint-scope 26387A watchpoint has gone out of scope. 26388@item end-stepping-range 26389An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or 26390similar CLI command was accomplished. 26391@item exited-signalled 26392The inferior exited because of a signal. 26393@item exited 26394The inferior exited. 26395@item exited-normally 26396The inferior exited normally. 26397@item signal-received 26398A signal was received by the inferior. 26399@item solib-event 26400The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded. 26401This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is 26402set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is 26403in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}). 26404@item fork 26405The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork} 26406(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26407@item vfork 26408The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork} 26409(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26410@item syscall-entry 26411The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch 26412syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26413@item syscall-return 26414The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when 26415@code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26416@item exec 26417The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec} 26418(@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used. 26419@end table 26420 26421The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread 26422that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. 26423Depending on whether all-stop 26424mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either 26425stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop. 26426If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the 26427value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped} 26428field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will 26429always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see 26430several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the 26431processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent 26432if such information is not available. 26433 26434@item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}" 26435@itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}" 26436A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field 26437contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread 26438group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running 26439process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and 26440cannot be used in any way. 26441 26442@item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}" 26443A thread group became associated with a running program, 26444either because the program was just started or the thread group 26445was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the 26446@value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field 26447contains process identifier, specific to the operating system. 26448 26449@item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"] 26450A thread group is no longer associated with a running program, 26451either because the program has exited, or because it was detached 26452from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the 26453thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists 26454only when the inferior exited with some code. 26455 26456@item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}" 26457@itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}" 26458A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field 26459contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid} 26460field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to. 26461 26462@item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"] 26463Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification 26464is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or 26465@code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command 26466that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually 26467changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly 26468(via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands, 26469will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another 26470user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification. 26471 26472The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is 26473stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value. 26474 26475We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends 26476highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to 26477that thread. 26478 26479@item =library-loaded,... 26480Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This 26481notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name}, 26482@var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an 26483opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case, 26484@var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the 26485library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native 26486debugging, both those fields have the same value. The 26487@var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility 26488and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The 26489@var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread 26490group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is 26491absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present 26492thread groups. 26493 26494@item =library-unloaded,... 26495Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification 26496has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with 26497the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification. 26498The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the 26499thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is 26500absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present 26501thread groups. 26502 26503@item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum} 26504@itemx =traceframe-changed,end 26505Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is 26506@var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace 26507frame is @var{tpnum}. 26508 26509@item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial} 26510Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with 26511initial value @var{initial}. 26512 26513@item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name} 26514@itemx =tsv-deleted 26515Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all 26516trace state variables are deleted. 26517 26518@item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}] 26519Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with 26520the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of 26521trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current 26522value of trace state variable is known. 26523 26524@item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@} 26525@itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@} 26526@itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number} 26527Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted, 26528respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI 26529user. 26530 26531The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various 26532breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The 26533@var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint. 26534 26535Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a 26536command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record. 26537 26538@item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"] 26539@itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}" 26540Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an 26541inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread 26542group corresponding to the affected inferior. 26543 26544The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the 26545method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present 26546and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay} 26547for existing method and format values. 26548 26549@item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value} 26550Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is 26551changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command, 26552the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command. 26553For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param} 26554is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}. 26555 26556@item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"] 26557Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were 26558written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the 26559thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional 26560@code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds 26561executable code. 26562@end table 26563 26564@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information 26565@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information 26566 26567When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a 26568tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the 26569following fields: 26570 26571@table @code 26572@item number 26573The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location 26574of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like 26575@samp{1.2}. 26576 26577@item type 26578The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be 26579@samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible. 26580 26581@item catch-type 26582If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this 26583indicates the exact type of catchpoint. 26584 26585@item disp 26586This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that 26587the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep}, 26588meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted. 26589 26590@item enabled 26591This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the 26592value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}. 26593Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}. 26594 26595@item addr 26596The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number, 26597giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending 26598breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with 26599multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can 26600be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address. 26601 26602@item func 26603If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears. 26604If not known, this field is not present. 26605 26606@item filename 26607The name of the source file which contains this function, if known. 26608If not known, this field is not present. 26609 26610@item fullname 26611The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if 26612known. If not known, this field is not present. 26613 26614@item line 26615The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known. 26616If not known, this field is not present. 26617 26618@item at 26619If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If 26620provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed 26621by a symbol name. 26622 26623@item pending 26624If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the 26625text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user. 26626 26627@item evaluated-by 26628Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or 26629@samp{target}. 26630 26631@item thread 26632If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the 26633thread in which the breakpoint can trigger. 26634 26635@item task 26636If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this 26637field will hold the task identifier. 26638 26639@item cond 26640If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression. 26641 26642@item ignore 26643The ignore count of the breakpoint. 26644 26645@item enable 26646The enable count of the breakpoint. 26647 26648@item traceframe-usage 26649FIXME. 26650 26651@item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id 26652For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker. 26653 26654@item mask 26655For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask. 26656 26657@item pass 26658A tracepoint's pass count. 26659 26660@item original-location 26661The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user. 26662This field is optional. 26663 26664@item times 26665The number of times the breakpoint has been hit. 26666 26667@item installed 26668This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y}, 26669meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it 26670is not. 26671 26672@item what 26673Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent. 26674 26675@end table 26676 26677For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert} 26678(@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be: 26679 26680@smallexample 26681-> -break-insert main 26682<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 26683 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c", 26684 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"], 26685 times="0"@} 26686<- (gdb) 26687@end smallexample 26688 26689@node GDB/MI Frame Information 26690@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information 26691 26692Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack 26693frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following 26694fields: 26695 26696@table @code 26697@item level 26698The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of 26699zero. This field is always present. 26700 26701@item func 26702The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may 26703be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name. 26704 26705@item addr 26706The code address for the frame. This field is always present. 26707 26708@item file 26709The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code 26710address. This field may be absent. 26711 26712@item line 26713The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field 26714may be absent. 26715 26716@item from 26717The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the 26718corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent. 26719 26720@end table 26721 26722@node GDB/MI Thread Information 26723@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information 26724 26725Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it 26726uses a tuple with the following fields: 26727 26728@table @code 26729@item id 26730The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is 26731always present. 26732 26733@item target-id 26734Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present. 26735 26736@item details 26737Additional information about the thread provided by the target. 26738It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the 26739frontend. This field is optional. 26740 26741@item state 26742Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the 26743thread is presently running. This field is always present. 26744 26745@item core 26746The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the 26747thread was last seen on. This field is optional. 26748@end table 26749 26750@node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information 26751@subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information 26752 26753Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program 26754stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}), 26755@value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via 26756the @code{exception-name} field. 26757 26758@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26759@node GDB/MI Simple Examples 26760@section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction 26761@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples 26762 26763This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using 26764the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the 26765following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means 26766the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}. 26767 26768Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for 26769readability, they don't appear in the real output. 26770 26771@subheading Setting a Breakpoint 26772 26773Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed 26774information of the breakpoint. 26775 26776@smallexample 26777-> -break-insert main 26778<- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 26779 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c", 26780 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"], 26781 times="0"@} 26782<- (gdb) 26783@end smallexample 26784 26785@subheading Program Execution 26786 26787Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the 26788reason that execution stopped. 26789 26790@smallexample 26791-> -exec-run 26792<- ^running 26793<- (gdb) 26794<- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0", 26795 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main", 26796 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}], 26797 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@} 26798<- (gdb) 26799-> -exec-continue 26800<- ^running 26801<- (gdb) 26802<- *stopped,reason="exited-normally" 26803<- (gdb) 26804@end smallexample 26805 26806@subheading Quitting @value{GDBN} 26807 26808Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}. 26809 26810@smallexample 26811-> (gdb) 26812<- -gdb-exit 26813<- ^exit 26814@end smallexample 26815 26816Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might 26817take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN} 26818performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged 26819or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till 26820@value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it 26821fails to exit in reasonable time. 26822 26823@subheading A Bad Command 26824 26825Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command: 26826 26827@smallexample 26828-> -rubbish 26829<- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish" 26830<- (gdb) 26831@end smallexample 26832 26833 26834@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26835@node GDB/MI Command Description Format 26836@section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format 26837 26838The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of 26839commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section. 26840 26841@subheading Motivation 26842 26843The motivation for this collection of commands. 26844 26845@subheading Introduction 26846 26847A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole. 26848 26849@subheading Commands 26850 26851For each command in the block, the following is described: 26852 26853@subsubheading Synopsis 26854 26855@smallexample 26856 -command @var{args}@dots{} 26857@end smallexample 26858 26859@subsubheading Result 26860 26861@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26862 26863The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any. 26864 26865@subsubheading Example 26866 26867Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have 26868not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available). 26869 26870 26871@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 26872@node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands 26873@section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands 26874 26875@cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi} 26876@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands 26877This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating 26878breakpoints. 26879 26880@subheading The @code{-break-after} Command 26881@findex -break-after 26882 26883@subsubheading Synopsis 26884 26885@smallexample 26886 -break-after @var{number} @var{count} 26887@end smallexample 26888 26889The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been 26890hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of 26891the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the 26892@samp{-break-list} command below. 26893 26894@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26895 26896The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}. 26897 26898@subsubheading Example 26899 26900@smallexample 26901(gdb) 26902-break-insert main 26903^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 26904enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c", 26905fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"], 26906times="0"@} 26907(gdb) 26908-break-after 1 3 26909~ 26910^done 26911(gdb) 26912-break-list 26913^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 26914hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 26915@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 26916@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 26917@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 26918@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 26919@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 26920body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 26921addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 26922line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@} 26923(gdb) 26924@end smallexample 26925 26926@ignore 26927@subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command 26928@findex -break-catch 26929@end ignore 26930 26931@subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command 26932@findex -break-commands 26933 26934@subsubheading Synopsis 26935 26936@smallexample 26937 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ] 26938@end smallexample 26939 26940Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint 26941@var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN} 26942are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set 26943commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this 26944functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of 26945some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing. 26946 26947@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26948 26949The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}. 26950 26951@subsubheading Example 26952 26953@smallexample 26954(gdb) 26955-break-insert main 26956^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 26957enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c", 26958fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"], 26959times="0"@} 26960(gdb) 26961-break-commands 1 "print v" "continue" 26962^done 26963(gdb) 26964@end smallexample 26965 26966@subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command 26967@findex -break-condition 26968 26969@subsubheading Synopsis 26970 26971@smallexample 26972 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr} 26973@end smallexample 26974 26975Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in 26976@var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the 26977@samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list} 26978command below). 26979 26980@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 26981 26982The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}. 26983 26984@subsubheading Example 26985 26986@smallexample 26987(gdb) 26988-break-condition 1 1 26989^done 26990(gdb) 26991-break-list 26992^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 26993hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 26994@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 26995@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 26996@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 26997@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 26998@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 26999body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27000addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27001line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@} 27002(gdb) 27003@end smallexample 27004 27005@subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command 27006@findex -break-delete 27007 27008@subsubheading Synopsis 27009 27010@smallexample 27011 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 27012@end smallexample 27013 27014Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument 27015list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list. 27016 27017@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27018 27019The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}. 27020 27021@subsubheading Example 27022 27023@smallexample 27024(gdb) 27025-break-delete 1 27026^done 27027(gdb) 27028-break-list 27029^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6", 27030hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27031@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27032@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27033@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27034@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27035@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27036body=[]@} 27037(gdb) 27038@end smallexample 27039 27040@subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command 27041@findex -break-disable 27042 27043@subsubheading Synopsis 27044 27045@smallexample 27046 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 27047@end smallexample 27048 27049Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the 27050break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s). 27051 27052@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27053 27054The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}. 27055 27056@subsubheading Example 27057 27058@smallexample 27059(gdb) 27060-break-disable 2 27061^done 27062(gdb) 27063-break-list 27064^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27065hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27066@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27067@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27068@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27069@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27070@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27071body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n", 27072addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27073line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27074(gdb) 27075@end smallexample 27076 27077@subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command 27078@findex -break-enable 27079 27080@subsubheading Synopsis 27081 27082@smallexample 27083 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+ 27084@end smallexample 27085 27086Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s). 27087 27088@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27089 27090The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}. 27091 27092@subsubheading Example 27093 27094@smallexample 27095(gdb) 27096-break-enable 2 27097^done 27098(gdb) 27099-break-list 27100^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27101hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27102@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27103@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27104@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27105@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27106@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27107body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27108addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27109line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27110(gdb) 27111@end smallexample 27112 27113@subheading The @code{-break-info} Command 27114@findex -break-info 27115 27116@subsubheading Synopsis 27117 27118@smallexample 27119 -break-info @var{breakpoint} 27120@end smallexample 27121 27122@c REDUNDANT??? 27123Get information about a single breakpoint. 27124 27125The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint 27126Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the 27127table. 27128 27129@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27130 27131The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}. 27132 27133@subsubheading Example 27134N.A. 27135 27136@subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command 27137@findex -break-insert 27138@anchor{-break-insert} 27139 27140@subsubheading Synopsis 27141 27142@smallexample 27143 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ] 27144 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ] 27145 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] 27146@end smallexample 27147 27148@noindent 27149If specified, @var{location}, can be one of: 27150 27151@table @var 27152@item linespec location 27153A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}. 27154 27155@item explicit location 27156An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are 27157analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names 27158listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}. 27159 27160@table @samp 27161@item --source @var{filename} 27162The source file name of the location. This option requires the use 27163of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}. 27164 27165@item --function @var{function} 27166The name of a function or method. 27167 27168@item --label @var{label} 27169The name of a label. 27170 27171@item --line @var{lineoffset} 27172An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location. 27173@end table 27174 27175@item address location 27176An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}. 27177@end table 27178 27179@noindent 27180The possible optional parameters of this command are: 27181 27182@table @samp 27183@item -t 27184Insert a temporary breakpoint. 27185@item -h 27186Insert a hardware breakpoint. 27187@item -f 27188If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it 27189refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending 27190breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report 27191an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location} 27192cannot be parsed. 27193@item -d 27194Create a disabled breakpoint. 27195@item -a 27196Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter 27197is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created. 27198@item -c @var{condition} 27199Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27200@item -i @var{ignore-count} 27201Initialize the @var{ignore-count}. 27202@item -p @var{thread-id} 27203Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global 27204@var{thread-id}. 27205@end table 27206 27207@subsubheading Result 27208 27209@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the 27210resulting breakpoint. 27211 27212Note: this format is open to change. 27213@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result? 27214 27215@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27216 27217The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak}, 27218@samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}. 27219 27220@subsubheading Example 27221 27222@smallexample 27223(gdb) 27224-break-insert main 27225^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c", 27226fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"], 27227times="0"@} 27228(gdb) 27229-break-insert -t foo 27230^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c", 27231fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"], 27232times="0"@} 27233(gdb) 27234-break-list 27235^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27236hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27237@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27238@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27239@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27240@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27241@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27242body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27243addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c", 27244fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"], 27245times="0"@}, 27246bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y", 27247addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c", 27248fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"], 27249times="0"@}]@} 27250(gdb) 27251@c -break-insert -r foo.* 27252@c ~int foo(int, int); 27253@c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c, 27254@c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"], 27255@c times="0"@} 27256@c (gdb) 27257@end smallexample 27258 27259@subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command 27260@findex -dprintf-insert 27261 27262@subsubheading Synopsis 27263 27264@smallexample 27265 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ] 27266 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ] 27267 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ] 27268 [ @var{argument} ] 27269@end smallexample 27270 27271@noindent 27272If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for 27273the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}. 27274 27275The possible optional parameters of this command are: 27276 27277@table @samp 27278@item -t 27279Insert a temporary breakpoint. 27280@item -f 27281If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it 27282refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending 27283breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report 27284an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location} 27285cannot be parsed. 27286@item -d 27287Create a disabled breakpoint. 27288@item -c @var{condition} 27289Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27290@item -i @var{ignore-count} 27291Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count}) 27292to @var{ignore-count}. 27293@item -p @var{thread-id} 27294Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global 27295@var{thread-id}. 27296@end table 27297 27298@subsubheading Result 27299 27300@xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the 27301resulting breakpoint. 27302 27303@c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result? 27304 27305@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27306 27307The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}. 27308 27309@subsubheading Example 27310 27311@smallexample 27312(gdb) 273134-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n" 273144^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27315addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c", 27316fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"], 27317times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@}, 27318original-location="foo"@} 27319(gdb) 273205-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g 273215^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27322addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c", 27323fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"], 27324times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@}, 27325original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@} 27326(gdb) 27327@end smallexample 27328 27329@subheading The @code{-break-list} Command 27330@findex -break-list 27331 27332@subsubheading Synopsis 27333 27334@smallexample 27335 -break-list 27336@end smallexample 27337 27338Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields: 27339 27340@table @samp 27341@item Number 27342number of the breakpoint 27343@item Type 27344type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint} 27345@item Disposition 27346should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep} 27347or @samp{nokeep} 27348@item Enabled 27349is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n} 27350@item Address 27351memory location at which the breakpoint is set 27352@item What 27353logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file 27354name, line number 27355@item Thread-groups 27356list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies 27357@item Times 27358number of times the breakpoint has been hit 27359@end table 27360 27361If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable} 27362@code{body} field is an empty list. 27363 27364@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27365 27366The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}. 27367 27368@subsubheading Example 27369 27370@smallexample 27371(gdb) 27372-break-list 27373^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27374hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27375@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27376@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27377@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27378@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27379@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27380body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27381addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"], 27382times="0"@}, 27383bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27384addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c", 27385line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27386(gdb) 27387@end smallexample 27388 27389Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints: 27390 27391@smallexample 27392(gdb) 27393-break-list 27394^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6", 27395hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27396@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27397@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27398@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27399@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27400@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27401body=[]@} 27402(gdb) 27403@end smallexample 27404 27405@subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command 27406@findex -break-passcount 27407 27408@subsubheading Synopsis 27409 27410@smallexample 27411 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount} 27412@end smallexample 27413 27414Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to 27415@var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number} 27416is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI 27417command @samp{passcount}. 27418 27419@subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command 27420@findex -break-watch 27421 27422@subsubheading Synopsis 27423 27424@smallexample 27425 -break-watch [ -a | -r ] 27426@end smallexample 27427 27428Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an 27429@dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a 27430read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r} 27431option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will 27432trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without 27433either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint, 27434i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing. 27435@xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}. 27436 27437Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and 27438breakpoints inserted. 27439 27440@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27441 27442The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and 27443@samp{rwatch}. 27444 27445@subsubheading Example 27446 27447Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function: 27448 27449@smallexample 27450(gdb) 27451-break-watch x 27452^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@} 27453(gdb) 27454-exec-continue 27455^running 27456(gdb) 27457*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}, 27458value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@}, 27459frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c", 27460fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@} 27461(gdb) 27462@end smallexample 27463 27464Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop 27465the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then 27466for the watchpoint going out of scope. 27467 27468@smallexample 27469(gdb) 27470-break-watch C 27471^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@} 27472(gdb) 27473-exec-continue 27474^running 27475(gdb) 27476*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger", 27477wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@}, 27478frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 27479file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27480fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@} 27481(gdb) 27482-exec-continue 27483^running 27484(gdb) 27485*stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5", 27486frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg", 27487value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 27488file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27489fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 27490(gdb) 27491@end smallexample 27492 27493Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program 27494execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is 27495deleted. 27496 27497@smallexample 27498(gdb) 27499-break-watch C 27500^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@} 27501(gdb) 27502-break-list 27503^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27504hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27505@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27506@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27507@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27508@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27509@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27510body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27511addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 27512file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27513fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"], 27514times="1"@}, 27515bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep", 27516enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@} 27517(gdb) 27518-exec-continue 27519^running 27520(gdb) 27521*stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}, 27522value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@}, 27523frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 27524file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27525fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@} 27526(gdb) 27527-break-list 27528^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6", 27529hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27530@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27531@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27532@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27533@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27534@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27535body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27536addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 27537file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27538fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"], 27539times="1"@}, 27540bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep", 27541enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@} 27542(gdb) 27543-exec-continue 27544^running 27545^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2", 27546frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg", 27547value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 27548file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27549fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 27550(gdb) 27551-break-list 27552^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6", 27553hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@}, 27554@{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@}, 27555@{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@}, 27556@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@}, 27557@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@}, 27558@{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}], 27559body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 27560addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 27561file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 27562fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8", 27563thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@} 27564(gdb) 27565@end smallexample 27566 27567 27568@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 27569@node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands 27570@section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands 27571 27572This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating 27573catchpoints. 27574 27575@menu 27576* Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands:: 27577* Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands:: 27578@end menu 27579 27580@node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands 27581@subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints 27582 27583@subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command 27584@findex -catch-load 27585 27586@subsubheading Synopsis 27587 27588@smallexample 27589 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp} 27590@end smallexample 27591 27592Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used, 27593the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting 27594Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created 27595in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular 27596expression used to match the name of the loaded library. 27597 27598 27599@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27600 27601The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}. 27602 27603@subsubheading Example 27604 27605@smallexample 27606-catch-load -t foo.so 27607^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y", 27608what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@} 27609(gdb) 27610@end smallexample 27611 27612 27613@subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command 27614@findex -catch-unload 27615 27616@subsubheading Synopsis 27617 27618@smallexample 27619 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp} 27620@end smallexample 27621 27622Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is 27623used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting 27624Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is 27625created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular 27626expression used to match the name of the unloaded library. 27627 27628@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27629 27630The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}. 27631 27632@subsubheading Example 27633 27634@smallexample 27635-catch-unload -d bar.so 27636^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n", 27637what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@} 27638(gdb) 27639@end smallexample 27640 27641@node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands 27642@subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints 27643 27644The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints 27645that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised. 27646 27647@subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command 27648@findex -catch-assert 27649 27650@subsubheading Synopsis 27651 27652@smallexample 27653 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ] 27654@end smallexample 27655 27656Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions. 27657 27658The possible optional parameters for this command are: 27659 27660@table @samp 27661@item -c @var{condition} 27662Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27663@item -d 27664Create a disabled catchpoint. 27665@item -t 27666Create a temporary catchpoint. 27667@end table 27668 27669@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27670 27671The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}. 27672 27673@subsubheading Example 27674 27675@smallexample 27676-catch-assert 27677^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 27678enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions", 27679thread-groups=["i1"],times="0", 27680original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@} 27681(gdb) 27682@end smallexample 27683 27684@subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command 27685@findex -catch-exception 27686 27687@subsubheading Synopsis 27688 27689@smallexample 27690 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ] 27691 [ -t ] [ -u ] 27692@end smallexample 27693 27694Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised. 27695By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception 27696gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the 27697optional parameters described below, to create more selective 27698catchpoints. 27699 27700The possible optional parameters for this command are: 27701 27702@table @samp 27703@item -c @var{condition} 27704Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}. 27705@item -d 27706Create a disabled catchpoint. 27707@item -e @var{exception-name} 27708Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot 27709be used combined with @samp{-u}. 27710@item -t 27711Create a temporary catchpoint. 27712@item -u 27713Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option 27714cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}. 27715@end table 27716 27717@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27718 27719The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception} 27720and @samp{catch exception unhandled}. 27721 27722@subsubheading Example 27723 27724@smallexample 27725-catch-exception -e Program_Error 27726^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep", 27727enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874", 27728what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"], 27729times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@} 27730(gdb) 27731@end smallexample 27732 27733@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 27734@node GDB/MI Program Context 27735@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context 27736 27737@subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command 27738@findex -exec-arguments 27739 27740 27741@subsubheading Synopsis 27742 27743@smallexample 27744 -exec-arguments @var{args} 27745@end smallexample 27746 27747Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next 27748@samp{-exec-run}. 27749 27750@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27751 27752The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}. 27753 27754@subsubheading Example 27755 27756@smallexample 27757(gdb) 27758-exec-arguments -v word 27759^done 27760(gdb) 27761@end smallexample 27762 27763 27764@ignore 27765@subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command 27766@findex -exec-show-arguments 27767 27768@subsubheading Synopsis 27769 27770@smallexample 27771 -exec-show-arguments 27772@end smallexample 27773 27774Print the arguments of the program. 27775 27776@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27777 27778The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}. 27779 27780@subsubheading Example 27781N.A. 27782@end ignore 27783 27784 27785@subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command 27786@findex -environment-cd 27787 27788@subsubheading Synopsis 27789 27790@smallexample 27791 -environment-cd @var{pathdir} 27792@end smallexample 27793 27794Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory. 27795 27796@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27797 27798The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}. 27799 27800@subsubheading Example 27801 27802@smallexample 27803(gdb) 27804-environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb 27805^done 27806(gdb) 27807@end smallexample 27808 27809 27810@subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command 27811@findex -environment-directory 27812 27813@subsubheading Synopsis 27814 27815@smallexample 27816 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+ 27817@end smallexample 27818 27819Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files. 27820If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default 27821search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the 27822@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition 27823occurs as normal. 27824Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying 27825multiple directories in a single command 27826results in the directories added to the beginning of the 27827search path in the same order they were presented in the command. 27828If blanks are needed as 27829part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around 27830the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated 27831by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator 27832character must not be used 27833in any directory name. 27834If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed. 27835 27836@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27837 27838The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}. 27839 27840@subsubheading Example 27841 27842@smallexample 27843(gdb) 27844-environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb 27845^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd" 27846(gdb) 27847-environment-directory "" 27848^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd" 27849(gdb) 27850-environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src 27851^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd" 27852(gdb) 27853-environment-directory -r 27854^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd" 27855(gdb) 27856@end smallexample 27857 27858 27859@subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command 27860@findex -environment-path 27861 27862@subsubheading Synopsis 27863 27864@smallexample 27865 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+ 27866@end smallexample 27867 27868Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files. 27869If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original 27870search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are 27871supplied in addition to the 27872@samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition 27873occurs as normal. 27874Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying 27875multiple directories in a single command 27876results in the directories added to the beginning of the 27877search path in the same order they were presented in the command. 27878If blanks are needed as 27879part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around 27880the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated 27881by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator 27882character must not be used 27883in any directory name. 27884If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed. 27885 27886 27887@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27888 27889The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}. 27890 27891@subsubheading Example 27892 27893@smallexample 27894(gdb) 27895-environment-path 27896^done,path="/usr/bin" 27897(gdb) 27898-environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin 27899^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin" 27900(gdb) 27901-environment-path -r /usr/local/bin 27902^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin" 27903(gdb) 27904@end smallexample 27905 27906 27907@subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command 27908@findex -environment-pwd 27909 27910@subsubheading Synopsis 27911 27912@smallexample 27913 -environment-pwd 27914@end smallexample 27915 27916Show the current working directory. 27917 27918@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27919 27920The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}. 27921 27922@subsubheading Example 27923 27924@smallexample 27925(gdb) 27926-environment-pwd 27927^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb" 27928(gdb) 27929@end smallexample 27930 27931@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 27932@node GDB/MI Thread Commands 27933@section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands 27934 27935 27936@subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command 27937@findex -thread-info 27938 27939@subsubheading Synopsis 27940 27941@smallexample 27942 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ] 27943@end smallexample 27944 27945Reports information about either a specific thread, if the 27946@var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads. 27947@var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing 27948information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the 27949current thread. 27950 27951@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 27952 27953The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information 27954about all threads. 27955 27956@subsubheading Result 27957 27958The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are 27959defined for a given thread: 27960 27961@table @samp 27962@item current 27963This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}. 27964 27965@item id 27966The global identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread. 27967 27968@item target-id 27969The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread. 27970 27971@item details 27972Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This 27973field is optional. 27974 27975@item name 27976The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the 27977@code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if 27978@value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that 27979name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this 27980field is omitted. 27981 27982@item frame 27983The stack frame currently executing in the thread. 27984 27985@item state 27986The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following 27987values: 27988 27989@table @code 27990@item stopped 27991The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped 27992threads. 27993 27994@item running 27995The thread is running. There's no frame information for running 27996threads. 27997 27998@end table 27999 28000@item core 28001If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running, 28002then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional. 28003 28004@end table 28005 28006@subsubheading Example 28007 28008@smallexample 28009-thread-info 28010^done,threads=[ 28011@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)", 28012 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall", 28013 args=[]@},state="running"@}, 28014@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)", 28015 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo", 28016 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}], 28017 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@}, 28018 state="running"@}], 28019current-thread-id="1" 28020(gdb) 28021@end smallexample 28022 28023@subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command 28024@findex -thread-list-ids 28025 28026@subsubheading Synopsis 28027 28028@smallexample 28029 -thread-list-ids 28030@end smallexample 28031 28032Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids. 28033At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such 28034threads. 28035 28036This command is retained for historical reasons, the 28037@code{-thread-info} command should be used instead. 28038 28039@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28040 28041Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information. 28042 28043@subsubheading Example 28044 28045@smallexample 28046(gdb) 28047-thread-list-ids 28048^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@}, 28049current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3" 28050(gdb) 28051@end smallexample 28052 28053 28054@subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command 28055@findex -thread-select 28056 28057@subsubheading Synopsis 28058 28059@smallexample 28060 -thread-select @var{thread-id} 28061@end smallexample 28062 28063Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current 28064thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the 28065topmost frame for that thread. 28066 28067This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the 28068@samp{--thread} option to each command. 28069 28070@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28071 28072The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}. 28073 28074@subsubheading Example 28075 28076@smallexample 28077(gdb) 28078-exec-next 28079^running 28080(gdb) 28081*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187", 28082file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c" 28083(gdb) 28084-thread-list-ids 28085^done, 28086thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@}, 28087number-of-threads="3" 28088(gdb) 28089-thread-select 3 28090^done,new-thread-id="3", 28091frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf", 28092args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@}, 28093@{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@} 28094(gdb) 28095@end smallexample 28096 28097@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28098@node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands 28099@section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands 28100 28101@subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command 28102@findex -ada-task-info 28103 28104@subsubheading Synopsis 28105 28106@smallexample 28107 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ] 28108@end smallexample 28109 28110Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the 28111@var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks. 28112 28113@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28114 28115The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information 28116about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}). 28117 28118@subsubheading Result 28119 28120The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are 28121defined for each Ada task: 28122 28123@table @samp 28124@item current 28125This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}. 28126 28127@item id 28128The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task. 28129 28130@item task-id 28131The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task. 28132 28133@item thread-id 28134The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada 28135task. 28136 28137This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented 28138on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding 28139thread for any reason, the field is omitted. 28140 28141@item parent-id 28142This field exists only when the task was created by another task. 28143In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task. 28144 28145@item priority 28146The base priority of the task. 28147 28148@item state 28149The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the 28150possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}. 28151 28152@item name 28153The name of the task. 28154 28155@end table 28156 28157@subsubheading Example 28158 28159@smallexample 28160-ada-task-info 28161^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8", 28162hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@}, 28163@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@}, 28164@{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@}, 28165@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@}, 28166@{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@}, 28167@{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@}, 28168@{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@}, 28169@{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}], 28170body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48", 28171state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@} 28172(gdb) 28173@end smallexample 28174 28175@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28176@node GDB/MI Program Execution 28177@section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution 28178 28179These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band 28180record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes 28181asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in 28182other cases. 28183 28184@subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command 28185@findex -exec-continue 28186 28187@subsubheading Synopsis 28188 28189@smallexample 28190 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N] 28191@end smallexample 28192 28193Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue 28194to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the 28195@samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until 28196it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include 28197@itemize @bullet 28198@item 28199breakpoints or watchpoints 28200@item 28201signals or exceptions 28202@item 28203the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse}) 28204@item 28205the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used. 28206@end itemize 28207In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop 28208Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the 28209value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is 28210specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is 28211ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is 28212specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed. 28213 28214@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28215 28216The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}. 28217 28218@subsubheading Example 28219 28220@smallexample 28221-exec-continue 28222^running 28223(gdb) 28224@@Hello world 28225*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{ 28226func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c", 28227line="13"@} 28228(gdb) 28229@end smallexample 28230 28231 28232@subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command 28233@findex -exec-finish 28234 28235@subsubheading Synopsis 28236 28237@smallexample 28238 -exec-finish [--reverse] 28239@end smallexample 28240 28241Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current 28242function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function. 28243If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse 28244execution of the inferior program until the point where current 28245function was called. 28246 28247@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28248 28249The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}. 28250 28251@subsubheading Example 28252 28253Function returning @code{void}. 28254 28255@smallexample 28256-exec-finish 28257^running 28258(gdb) 28259@@hello from foo 28260*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[], 28261file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@} 28262(gdb) 28263@end smallexample 28264 28265Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal 28266@value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the 28267value itself. 28268 28269@smallexample 28270-exec-finish 28271^running 28272(gdb) 28273*stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo", 28274args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@}, 28275file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28276gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0" 28277(gdb) 28278@end smallexample 28279 28280 28281@subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command 28282@findex -exec-interrupt 28283 28284@subsubheading Synopsis 28285 28286@smallexample 28287 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N] 28288@end smallexample 28289 28290Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token 28291associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command 28292that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only 28293appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to 28294interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed. 28295 28296Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is 28297asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the 28298@samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be 28299reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification. 28300 28301In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default. 28302All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the 28303@samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} 28304option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted. 28305 28306@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28307 28308The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}. 28309 28310@subsubheading Example 28311 28312@smallexample 28313(gdb) 28314111-exec-continue 28315111^running 28316 28317(gdb) 28318222-exec-interrupt 28319222^done 28320(gdb) 28321111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt", 28322frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 28323fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@} 28324(gdb) 28325 28326(gdb) 28327-exec-interrupt 28328^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing." 28329(gdb) 28330@end smallexample 28331 28332@subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command 28333@findex -exec-jump 28334 28335@subsubheading Synopsis 28336 28337@smallexample 28338 -exec-jump @var{location} 28339@end smallexample 28340 28341Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by 28342parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the 28343different forms of @var{location}. 28344 28345@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28346 28347The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}. 28348 28349@subsubheading Example 28350 28351@smallexample 28352-exec-jump foo.c:10 28353*running,thread-id="all" 28354^running 28355@end smallexample 28356 28357 28358@subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command 28359@findex -exec-next 28360 28361@subsubheading Synopsis 28362 28363@smallexample 28364 -exec-next [--reverse] 28365@end smallexample 28366 28367Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning 28368of the next source line is reached. 28369 28370If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution 28371of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous 28372source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a 28373function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the 28374source line where the function was called. 28375 28376 28377@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28378 28379The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}. 28380 28381@subsubheading Example 28382 28383@smallexample 28384-exec-next 28385^running 28386(gdb) 28387*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c" 28388(gdb) 28389@end smallexample 28390 28391 28392@subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command 28393@findex -exec-next-instruction 28394 28395@subsubheading Synopsis 28396 28397@smallexample 28398 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse] 28399@end smallexample 28400 28401Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function 28402call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an 28403instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be 28404printed as well. 28405 28406If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution 28407of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the 28408previously executed instruction was a return from another function, 28409it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function 28410(from the current stack frame) is reached. 28411 28412@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28413 28414The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}. 28415 28416@subsubheading Example 28417 28418@smallexample 28419(gdb) 28420-exec-next-instruction 28421^running 28422 28423(gdb) 28424*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28425addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c" 28426(gdb) 28427@end smallexample 28428 28429 28430@subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command 28431@findex -exec-return 28432 28433@subsubheading Synopsis 28434 28435@smallexample 28436 -exec-return 28437@end smallexample 28438 28439Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior. 28440Displays the new current frame. 28441 28442@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28443 28444The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}. 28445 28446@subsubheading Example 28447 28448@smallexample 28449(gdb) 28450200-break-insert callee4 28451200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734", 28452file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@} 28453(gdb) 28454000-exec-run 28455000^running 28456(gdb) 28457000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1", 28458frame=@{func="callee4",args=[], 28459file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28460fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@} 28461(gdb) 28462205-break-delete 28463205^done 28464(gdb) 28465111-exec-return 28466111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3", 28467args=[@{name="strarg", 28468value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}], 28469file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28470fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@} 28471(gdb) 28472@end smallexample 28473 28474 28475@subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command 28476@findex -exec-run 28477 28478@subsubheading Synopsis 28479 28480@smallexample 28481 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ] 28482@end smallexample 28483 28484Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior 28485executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program 28486exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if 28487the program has exited exceptionally. 28488 28489When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option 28490is specified, the current inferior is started. If the 28491@samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread 28492group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started. 28493If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started. 28494 28495Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop 28496the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram, 28497following the same behavior as the @code{start} command 28498(@pxref{Starting}). 28499 28500@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28501 28502The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}. 28503 28504@subsubheading Examples 28505 28506@smallexample 28507(gdb) 28508-break-insert main 28509^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@} 28510(gdb) 28511-exec-run 28512^running 28513(gdb) 28514*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1", 28515frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c", 28516fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@} 28517(gdb) 28518@end smallexample 28519 28520@noindent 28521Program exited normally: 28522 28523@smallexample 28524(gdb) 28525-exec-run 28526^running 28527(gdb) 28528x = 55 28529*stopped,reason="exited-normally" 28530(gdb) 28531@end smallexample 28532 28533@noindent 28534Program exited exceptionally: 28535 28536@smallexample 28537(gdb) 28538-exec-run 28539^running 28540(gdb) 28541x = 55 28542*stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01" 28543(gdb) 28544@end smallexample 28545 28546Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as 28547@code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this: 28548 28549@smallexample 28550(gdb) 28551*stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT", 28552signal-meaning="Interrupt" 28553@end smallexample 28554 28555 28556@c @subheading -exec-signal 28557 28558 28559@subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command 28560@findex -exec-step 28561 28562@subsubheading Synopsis 28563 28564@smallexample 28565 -exec-step [--reverse] 28566@end smallexample 28567 28568Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning 28569of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a 28570function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called 28571function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse 28572execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the 28573previously executed source line. 28574 28575@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28576 28577The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}. 28578 28579@subsubheading Example 28580 28581Stepping into a function: 28582 28583@smallexample 28584-exec-step 28585^running 28586(gdb) 28587*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28588frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@}, 28589@{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c", 28590fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@} 28591(gdb) 28592@end smallexample 28593 28594Regular stepping: 28595 28596@smallexample 28597-exec-step 28598^running 28599(gdb) 28600*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c" 28601(gdb) 28602@end smallexample 28603 28604 28605@subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command 28606@findex -exec-step-instruction 28607 28608@subsubheading Synopsis 28609 28610@smallexample 28611 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse] 28612@end smallexample 28613 28614Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the 28615@samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the 28616inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction. 28617The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on 28618whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the 28619former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed 28620as well. 28621 28622@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28623 28624The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}. 28625 28626@subsubheading Example 28627 28628@smallexample 28629(gdb) 28630-exec-step-instruction 28631^running 28632 28633(gdb) 28634*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28635frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 28636fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@} 28637(gdb) 28638-exec-step-instruction 28639^running 28640 28641(gdb) 28642*stopped,reason="end-stepping-range", 28643frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c", 28644fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@} 28645(gdb) 28646@end smallexample 28647 28648 28649@subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command 28650@findex -exec-until 28651 28652@subsubheading Synopsis 28653 28654@smallexample 28655 -exec-until [ @var{location} ] 28656@end smallexample 28657 28658Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the 28659argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes 28660until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The 28661reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}. 28662 28663@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28664 28665The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}. 28666 28667@subsubheading Example 28668 28669@smallexample 28670(gdb) 28671-exec-until recursive2.c:6 28672^running 28673(gdb) 28674x = 55 28675*stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[], 28676file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@} 28677(gdb) 28678@end smallexample 28679 28680@ignore 28681@subheading -file-clear 28682Is this going away???? 28683@end ignore 28684 28685@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 28686@node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation 28687@section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands 28688 28689@subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command 28690@findex -enable-frame-filters 28691 28692@smallexample 28693-enable-frame-filters 28694@end smallexample 28695 28696@value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of 28697the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to 28698implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must 28699request that this functionality be enabled. 28700 28701Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled. 28702 28703Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN}, 28704this command will still succeed (and do nothing). 28705 28706@subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command 28707@findex -stack-info-frame 28708 28709@subsubheading Synopsis 28710 28711@smallexample 28712 -stack-info-frame 28713@end smallexample 28714 28715Get info on the selected frame. 28716 28717@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28718 28719The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame} 28720(without arguments). 28721 28722@subsubheading Example 28723 28724@smallexample 28725(gdb) 28726-stack-info-frame 28727^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3", 28728file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28729fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@} 28730(gdb) 28731@end smallexample 28732 28733@subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command 28734@findex -stack-info-depth 28735 28736@subsubheading Synopsis 28737 28738@smallexample 28739 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ] 28740@end smallexample 28741 28742Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth} 28743is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames. 28744 28745@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28746 28747There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. 28748 28749@subsubheading Example 28750 28751For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11: 28752 28753@smallexample 28754(gdb) 28755-stack-info-depth 28756^done,depth="12" 28757(gdb) 28758-stack-info-depth 4 28759^done,depth="4" 28760(gdb) 28761-stack-info-depth 12 28762^done,depth="12" 28763(gdb) 28764-stack-info-depth 11 28765^done,depth="11" 28766(gdb) 28767-stack-info-depth 13 28768^done,depth="12" 28769(gdb) 28770@end smallexample 28771 28772@anchor{-stack-list-arguments} 28773@subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command 28774@findex -stack-list-arguments 28775 28776@subsubheading Synopsis 28777 28778@smallexample 28779 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values} 28780 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ] 28781@end smallexample 28782 28783Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame} 28784and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and 28785@var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole 28786call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame 28787at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is 28788larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand, 28789@var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in 28790which case only existing frames will be returned. 28791 28792If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 28793the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 28794values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 28795type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 28796structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is 28797supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed. 28798 28799If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that 28800are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments 28801are still displayed, however. 28802 28803Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is 28804deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command. 28805 28806@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28807 28808@value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a 28809@samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the 28810functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}. 28811 28812@subsubheading Example 28813 28814@smallexample 28815(gdb) 28816-stack-list-frames 28817^done, 28818stack=[ 28819frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4", 28820file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28821fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}, 28822frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3", 28823file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28824fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}, 28825frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2", 28826file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28827fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@}, 28828frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1", 28829file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28830fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@}, 28831frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main", 28832file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 28833fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}] 28834(gdb) 28835-stack-list-arguments 0 28836^done, 28837stack-args=[ 28838frame=@{level="0",args=[]@}, 28839frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@}, 28840frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}, 28841frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@}, 28842frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}] 28843(gdb) 28844-stack-list-arguments 1 28845^done, 28846stack-args=[ 28847frame=@{level="0",args=[]@}, 28848frame=@{level="1", 28849 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}, 28850frame=@{level="2",args=[ 28851@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 28852@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}, 28853@{frame=@{level="3",args=[ 28854@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 28855@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}, 28856@{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@}, 28857frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}] 28858(gdb) 28859-stack-list-arguments 0 2 2 28860^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}] 28861(gdb) 28862-stack-list-arguments 1 2 2 28863^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2", 28864args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@}, 28865@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}] 28866(gdb) 28867@end smallexample 28868 28869@c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers 28870 28871 28872@anchor{-stack-list-frames} 28873@subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command 28874@findex -stack-list-frames 28875 28876@subsubheading Synopsis 28877 28878@smallexample 28879 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ] 28880@end smallexample 28881 28882List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the 28883following info: 28884 28885@table @samp 28886@item @var{level} 28887The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function. 28888@item @var{addr} 28889The @code{$pc} value for that frame. 28890@item @var{func} 28891Function name. 28892@item @var{file} 28893File name of the source file where the function lives. 28894@item @var{fullname} 28895The full file name of the source file where the function lives. 28896@item @var{line} 28897Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}. 28898@item @var{from} 28899The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given 28900if the frame's function is not known. 28901@end table 28902 28903If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the 28904whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose 28905levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments 28906are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is 28907an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of 28908frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the 28909actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be 28910returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then 28911Python frame filters will not be executed. 28912 28913@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 28914 28915The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}. 28916 28917@subsubheading Example 28918 28919Full stack backtrace: 28920 28921@smallexample 28922(gdb) 28923-stack-list-frames 28924^done,stack= 28925[frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo", 28926 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}, 28927frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28928 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28929frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28930 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28931frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28932 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28933frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28934 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28935frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28936 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28937frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28938 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28939frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28940 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28941frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28942 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28943frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28944 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28945frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28946 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28947frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main", 28948 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}] 28949(gdb) 28950@end smallexample 28951 28952Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}: 28953 28954@smallexample 28955(gdb) 28956-stack-list-frames 3 5 28957^done,stack= 28958[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28959 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28960frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28961 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}, 28962frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28963 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}] 28964(gdb) 28965@end smallexample 28966 28967Show a single frame: 28968 28969@smallexample 28970(gdb) 28971-stack-list-frames 3 3 28972^done,stack= 28973[frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo", 28974 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}] 28975(gdb) 28976@end smallexample 28977 28978 28979@subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command 28980@findex -stack-list-locals 28981@anchor{-stack-list-locals} 28982 28983@subsubheading Synopsis 28984 28985@smallexample 28986 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values} 28987@end smallexample 28988 28989Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If 28990@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 28991the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 28992values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 28993type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 28994structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately 28995display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for 28996other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in 28997more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then 28998Python frame filters will not be executed. 28999 29000If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables 29001that are not available are not listed. Partially available local 29002variables are still displayed, however. 29003 29004This command is deprecated in favor of the 29005@samp{-stack-list-variables} command. 29006 29007@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29008 29009@samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}. 29010 29011@subsubheading Example 29012 29013@smallexample 29014(gdb) 29015-stack-list-locals 0 29016^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"] 29017(gdb) 29018-stack-list-locals --all-values 29019^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@}, 29020 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}] 29021-stack-list-locals --simple-values 29022^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@}, 29023 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}] 29024(gdb) 29025@end smallexample 29026 29027@anchor{-stack-list-variables} 29028@subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command 29029@findex -stack-list-variables 29030 29031@subsubheading Synopsis 29032 29033@smallexample 29034 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values} 29035@end smallexample 29036 29037Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If 29038@var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of 29039the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their 29040values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name, 29041type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays, 29042structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is 29043supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed. 29044 29045If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables 29046and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially 29047available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however. 29048 29049@subsubheading Example 29050 29051@smallexample 29052(gdb) 29053-stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values 29054^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}] 29055(gdb) 29056@end smallexample 29057 29058 29059@subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command 29060@findex -stack-select-frame 29061 29062@subsubheading Synopsis 29063 29064@smallexample 29065 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum} 29066@end smallexample 29067 29068Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on 29069the stack. 29070 29071This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame} 29072option to every command. 29073 29074@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 29075 29076The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up}, 29077@samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}. 29078 29079@subsubheading Example 29080 29081@smallexample 29082(gdb) 29083-stack-select-frame 2 29084^done 29085(gdb) 29086@end smallexample 29087 29088@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29089@node GDB/MI Variable Objects 29090@section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects 29091 29092@ignore 29093 29094@subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi} 29095 29096For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched 29097expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code 29098used by @code{Insight}. 29099 29100The two main reasons for that are: 29101 29102@enumerate 1 29103@item 29104It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation). 29105 29106@item 29107It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is 29108now). 29109@end enumerate 29110 29111The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was 29112slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section 29113describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some 29114hints about their use. 29115 29116@emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we 29117expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at 29118least, the following operations: 29119 29120@itemize @bullet 29121@item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix} 29122@item @code{-stack-list-arguments} 29123@item @code{-stack-list-locals} 29124@item @code{-stack-select-frame} 29125@end itemize 29126 29127@end ignore 29128 29129@subheading Introduction to Variable Objects 29130 29131@cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi} 29132 29133Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and 29134changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that 29135work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for 29136simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object 29137is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the 29138frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The 29139expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex 29140expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a 29141variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object 29142operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable 29143object, or to change display format. 29144 29145Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object 29146that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has 29147a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each 29148element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have 29149children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach 29150leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable 29151objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend 29152is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no 29153child will be created. 29154 29155For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a 29156string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also 29157obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string 29158that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its 29159contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed. 29160 29161A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time 29162the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all 29163variable objects whose values has changed since the last update 29164operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must 29165be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable 29166objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a 29167real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf 29168variables that frontend has created. 29169 29170The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend 29171might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference, 29172and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is 29173relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want 29174to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not 29175visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so 29176called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never 29177implicitly updated. 29178 29179Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the 29180fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable 29181object is created, including associating identifiers to specific 29182variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating 29183variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the 29184expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current 29185frame. Consider this example: 29186 29187@smallexample 29188void do_work(...) 29189@{ 29190 struct work_state state; 29191 29192 if (...) 29193 do_work(...); 29194@} 29195@end smallexample 29196 29197If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in 29198this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable 29199object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level 29200@code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable 29201object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame. 29202 29203If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object 29204refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the 29205thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such 29206variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the 29207thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists, 29208and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame. 29209 29210The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to 29211access this functionality: 29212 29213@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6 29214@item @strong{Operation} 29215@tab @strong{Description} 29216 29217@item @code{-enable-pretty-printing} 29218@tab enable Python-based pretty-printing 29219@item @code{-var-create} 29220@tab create a variable object 29221@item @code{-var-delete} 29222@tab delete the variable object and/or its children 29223@item @code{-var-set-format} 29224@tab set the display format of this variable 29225@item @code{-var-show-format} 29226@tab show the display format of this variable 29227@item @code{-var-info-num-children} 29228@tab tells how many children this object has 29229@item @code{-var-list-children} 29230@tab return a list of the object's children 29231@item @code{-var-info-type} 29232@tab show the type of this variable object 29233@item @code{-var-info-expression} 29234@tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents 29235@item @code{-var-info-path-expression} 29236@tab print full expression that this variable object represents 29237@item @code{-var-show-attributes} 29238@tab is this variable editable? does it exist here? 29239@item @code{-var-evaluate-expression} 29240@tab get the value of this variable 29241@item @code{-var-assign} 29242@tab set the value of this variable 29243@item @code{-var-update} 29244@tab update the variable and its children 29245@item @code{-var-set-frozen} 29246@tab set frozeness attribute 29247@item @code{-var-set-update-range} 29248@tab set range of children to display on update 29249@end multitable 29250 29251In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest 29252how it can be used. 29253 29254@subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects 29255 29256@subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command 29257@findex -enable-pretty-printing 29258 29259@smallexample 29260-enable-pretty-printing 29261@end smallexample 29262 29263@value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the 29264MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to 29265implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must 29266request that this functionality be enabled. 29267 29268Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled. 29269 29270Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN}, 29271this command will still succeed (and do nothing). 29272 29273This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and 29274may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}. 29275 29276@subheading The @code{-var-create} Command 29277@findex -var-create 29278 29279@subsubheading Synopsis 29280 29281@smallexample 29282 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@} 29283 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression} 29284@end smallexample 29285 29286This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of 29287a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU 29288register. 29289 29290The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be 29291referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj 29292system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be 29293unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format. 29294The command fails if a duplicate name is found. 29295 29296The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be 29297specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current 29298frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable 29299object must be created. 29300 29301@var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not 29302begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following: 29303 29304@itemize @bullet 29305@item 29306@samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell 29307 29308@item 29309@samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD) 29310 29311@item 29312@samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name 29313@end itemize 29314 29315@cindex dynamic varobj 29316A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this 29317case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs 29318have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the 29319@code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN} 29320will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward 29321compatibility for existing clients. 29322 29323@subsubheading Result 29324 29325This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These 29326are: 29327 29328@table @samp 29329@item name 29330The name of the varobj. 29331 29332@item numchild 29333The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily 29334reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the 29335@samp{has_more} attribute. 29336 29337@item value 29338The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of 29339aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value 29340will not be interesting. 29341 29342@item type 29343The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as 29344would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object} 29345(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the 29346@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the 29347@emph{declared} one. 29348 29349@item thread-id 29350If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the 29351thread's global identifier. 29352 29353@item has_more 29354For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any 29355children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0. 29356 29357@item dynamic 29358This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 29359varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 29360then this attribute will not be present. 29361 29362@item displayhint 29363A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 29364value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 29365@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 29366@end table 29367 29368Typical output will look like this: 29369 29370@smallexample 29371 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}", 29372 has_more="@var{has_more}" 29373@end smallexample 29374 29375 29376@subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command 29377@findex -var-delete 29378 29379@subsubheading Synopsis 29380 29381@smallexample 29382 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name} 29383@end smallexample 29384 29385Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children. 29386With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children. 29387 29388Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found. 29389 29390 29391@subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command 29392@findex -var-set-format 29393 29394@subsubheading Synopsis 29395 29396@smallexample 29397 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec} 29398@end smallexample 29399 29400Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be 29401@var{format-spec}. 29402 29403@anchor{-var-set-format} 29404The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows: 29405 29406@smallexample 29407 @var{format-spec} @expansion{} 29408 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@} 29409@end smallexample 29410 29411The natural format is the default format choosen automatically 29412based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex 29413for pointers, etc.). 29414 29415The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal 29416but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit 29417hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the 29418zero-hexadecimal format. 29419 29420For a variable with children, the format is set only on the 29421variable itself, and the children are not affected. 29422 29423@subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command 29424@findex -var-show-format 29425 29426@subsubheading Synopsis 29427 29428@smallexample 29429 -var-show-format @var{name} 29430@end smallexample 29431 29432Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}. 29433 29434@smallexample 29435 @var{format} @expansion{} 29436 @var{format-spec} 29437@end smallexample 29438 29439 29440@subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command 29441@findex -var-info-num-children 29442 29443@subsubheading Synopsis 29444 29445@smallexample 29446 -var-info-num-children @var{name} 29447@end smallexample 29448 29449Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}: 29450 29451@smallexample 29452 numchild=@var{n} 29453@end smallexample 29454 29455Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj. 29456It will return the current number of children, but more children may 29457be available. 29458 29459 29460@subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command 29461@findex -var-list-children 29462 29463@subsubheading Synopsis 29464 29465@smallexample 29466 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}] 29467@end smallexample 29468@anchor{-var-list-children} 29469 29470Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and 29471create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With 29472a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or 29473@code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if 29474@var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their 29475values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and 29476value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures 29477and unions. 29478 29479@var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children 29480to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is 29481reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting 29482at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be 29483reported. 29484 29485If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to 29486@code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}. 29487For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The 29488intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any 29489update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the 29490front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and 29491then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a 29492different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just 29493the visible items. 29494 29495For each child the following results are returned: 29496 29497@table @var 29498 29499@item name 29500Name of the variable object created for this child. 29501 29502@item exp 29503The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child. 29504For example this may be the name of a structure member. 29505 29506For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an 29507expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj. 29508 29509For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to 29510designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is 29511@samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the 29512type and value are not present. 29513 29514A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying 29515pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not 29516available at all with a dynamic varobj. 29517 29518@item numchild 29519Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be 295200. 29521 29522@item type 29523The type of the child. If @samp{print object} 29524(@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the 29525@emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the 29526@emph{declared} one. 29527 29528@item value 29529If values were requested, this is the value. 29530 29531@item thread-id 29532If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the 29533thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present. 29534 29535@item frozen 29536If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1. 29537 29538@item displayhint 29539A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 29540value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 29541@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 29542 29543@item dynamic 29544This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 29545varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 29546then this attribute will not be present. 29547 29548@end table 29549 29550The result may have its own attributes: 29551 29552@table @samp 29553@item displayhint 29554A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The 29555value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's 29556@code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}. 29557 29558@item has_more 29559This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children 29560remaining after the end of the selected range. 29561@end table 29562 29563@subsubheading Example 29564 29565@smallexample 29566(gdb) 29567 -var-list-children n 29568 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp}, 29569 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}] 29570(gdb) 29571 -var-list-children --all-values n 29572 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp}, 29573 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}] 29574@end smallexample 29575 29576 29577@subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command 29578@findex -var-info-type 29579 29580@subsubheading Synopsis 29581 29582@smallexample 29583 -var-info-type @var{name} 29584@end smallexample 29585 29586Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is 29587returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the 29588@value{GDBN} CLI: 29589 29590@smallexample 29591 type=@var{typename} 29592@end smallexample 29593 29594 29595@subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command 29596@findex -var-info-expression 29597 29598@subsubheading Synopsis 29599 29600@smallexample 29601 -var-info-expression @var{name} 29602@end smallexample 29603 29604Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this 29605variable object in user interface. The string is generally 29606not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated. 29607 29608For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object 29609@code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output: 29610 29611@smallexample 29612(gdb) -var-info-expression A.1 29613^done,lang="C",exp="1" 29614@end smallexample 29615 29616@noindent 29617Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be 29618found in @ref{Supported Languages}. 29619 29620Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also 29621includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command 29622is of limited use. 29623 29624@subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command 29625@findex -var-info-path-expression 29626 29627@subsubheading Synopsis 29628 29629@smallexample 29630 -var-info-path-expression @var{name} 29631@end smallexample 29632 29633Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current 29634context and will yield the same value that a variable object has. 29635Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which 29636result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of 29637the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a 29638watchpoint from a variable object. 29639 29640This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj, 29641and will give an error when invoked on one. 29642 29643For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class 29644@code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called 29645@code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of 29646@code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable 29647@code{c}. Then, we'll get this output: 29648@smallexample 29649(gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size 29650^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size) 29651@end smallexample 29652 29653@subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command 29654@findex -var-show-attributes 29655 29656@subsubheading Synopsis 29657 29658@smallexample 29659 -var-show-attributes @var{name} 29660@end smallexample 29661 29662List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}: 29663 29664@smallexample 29665 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ] 29666@end smallexample 29667 29668@noindent 29669where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}. 29670 29671@subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command 29672@findex -var-evaluate-expression 29673 29674@subsubheading Synopsis 29675 29676@smallexample 29677 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name} 29678@end smallexample 29679 29680Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable 29681object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string 29682can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of 29683this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format} 29684(@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified, 29685the current display format will be used. The current display format 29686can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command. 29687 29688@smallexample 29689 value=@var{value} 29690@end smallexample 29691 29692Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable 29693before the value of a child variable can be evaluated. 29694 29695@subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command 29696@findex -var-assign 29697 29698@subsubheading Synopsis 29699 29700@smallexample 29701 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression} 29702@end smallexample 29703 29704Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified 29705by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's 29706value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any 29707subsequent @code{-var-update} list. 29708 29709@subsubheading Example 29710 29711@smallexample 29712(gdb) 29713-var-assign var1 3 29714^done,value="3" 29715(gdb) 29716-var-update * 29717^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}] 29718(gdb) 29719@end smallexample 29720 29721@subheading The @code{-var-update} Command 29722@findex -var-update 29723 29724@subsubheading Synopsis 29725 29726@smallexample 29727 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@} 29728@end smallexample 29729 29730Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object 29731@var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the 29732list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must 29733be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of 29734@code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the 29735@code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable 29736object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except 29737for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option 29738@var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just 29739names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same 29740as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is 29741recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the 29742number of MI commands needed on each program stop. 29743 29744With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a 29745currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any 29746diagnostic. 29747 29748If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then 29749only the selected range of children will be reported. 29750 29751@code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named 29752@samp{changelist}. 29753 29754Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding: 29755 29756@table @samp 29757@item name 29758The name of the varobj. 29759 29760@item value 29761If values were requested for this update, then this field will be 29762present and will hold the value of the varobj. 29763 29764@item in_scope 29765@anchor{-var-update} 29766This field is a string which may take one of three values: 29767 29768@table @code 29769@item "true" 29770The variable object's current value is valid. 29771 29772@item "false" 29773The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may 29774hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into 29775scope. 29776 29777@item "invalid" 29778The variable object no longer holds a valid value. 29779This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed, 29780either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file} 29781command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable 29782objects. 29783@end table 29784 29785In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should 29786be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}. 29787 29788@item type_changed 29789This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type 29790changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will 29791be @samp{false}. 29792 29793When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have 29794become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically 29795deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update 29796range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is 29797unset. 29798 29799@item new_type 29800If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will 29801hold the new type. 29802 29803@item new_num_children 29804For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the 29805type changed, this will be the new number of children. 29806 29807The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not 29808valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that 29809@value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily 29810instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of 29811children which may be available. 29812 29813The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the 29814number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to 29815detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can 29816only happen at the end of the update range). 29817 29818@item displayhint 29819The display hint, if any. 29820 29821@item has_more 29822This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children 29823available outside the varobj's update range. 29824 29825@item dynamic 29826This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the 29827varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj, 29828then this attribute will not be present. 29829 29830@item new_children 29831If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected 29832update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will 29833be listed in this attribute. 29834@end table 29835 29836@subsubheading Example 29837 29838@smallexample 29839(gdb) 29840-var-assign var1 3 29841^done,value="3" 29842(gdb) 29843-var-update --all-values var1 29844^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true", 29845type_changed="false"@}] 29846(gdb) 29847@end smallexample 29848 29849@subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command 29850@findex -var-set-frozen 29851@anchor{-var-set-frozen} 29852 29853@subsubheading Synopsis 29854 29855@smallexample 29856 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag} 29857@end smallexample 29858 29859Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The 29860@var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable 29861frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is 29862frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are 29863implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of 29864a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only 29865@code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and 29866values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is 29867implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations. 29868Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent 29869@code{-var-update} does. 29870 29871@subsubheading Example 29872 29873@smallexample 29874(gdb) 29875-var-set-frozen V 1 29876^done 29877(gdb) 29878@end smallexample 29879 29880@subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command 29881@findex -var-set-update-range 29882@anchor{-var-set-update-range} 29883 29884@subsubheading Synopsis 29885 29886@smallexample 29887 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to} 29888@end smallexample 29889 29890Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of 29891@code{-var-update}. 29892 29893@var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If 29894@var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all 29895children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from} 29896(zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported. 29897 29898@subsubheading Example 29899 29900@smallexample 29901(gdb) 29902-var-set-update-range V 1 2 29903^done 29904@end smallexample 29905 29906@subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command 29907@findex -var-set-visualizer 29908@anchor{-var-set-visualizer} 29909 29910@subsubheading Synopsis 29911 29912@smallexample 29913 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer} 29914@end smallexample 29915 29916Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}. 29917 29918@var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value 29919@samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use. 29920 29921If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression. 29922This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a 29923single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of 29924the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same 29925Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI). 29926When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the 29927pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}). 29928 29929The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to 29930select a visualizer by following the built-in process 29931(@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when 29932a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed. 29933 29934This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI 29935command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands}) 29936can be used to check this. 29937 29938@subsubheading Example 29939 29940Resetting the visualizer: 29941 29942@smallexample 29943(gdb) 29944-var-set-visualizer V None 29945^done 29946@end smallexample 29947 29948Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer: 29949 29950@smallexample 29951(gdb) 29952-var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer 29953^done 29954@end smallexample 29955 29956Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression 29957can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj: 29958 29959@smallexample 29960(gdb) 29961-var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()" 29962^done 29963@end smallexample 29964 29965@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 29966@node GDB/MI Data Manipulation 29967@section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation 29968 29969@cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi} 29970@cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation 29971This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data: 29972examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc. 29973 29974For details about what an addressable memory unit is, 29975@pxref{addressable memory unit}. 29976 29977@c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE. 29978@c @subheading -data-assign 29979@c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects. 29980@c @subsubheading GDB Command 29981@c set variable 29982@c @subsubheading Example 29983@c N.A. 29984 29985@subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command 29986@findex -data-disassemble 29987 29988@subsubheading Synopsis 29989 29990@smallexample 29991 -data-disassemble 29992 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ] 29993 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ] 29994 -- @var{mode} 29995@end smallexample 29996 29997@noindent 29998Where: 29999 30000@table @samp 30001@item @var{start-addr} 30002is the beginning address (or @code{$pc}) 30003@item @var{end-addr} 30004is the end address 30005@item @var{filename} 30006is the name of the file to disassemble 30007@item @var{linenum} 30008is the line number to disassemble around 30009@item @var{lines} 30010is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1, 30011the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is 30012specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and 30013@var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between 30014@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are 30015displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between 30016@var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr} 30017are displayed. 30018@item @var{mode} 30019is one of: 30020@itemize @bullet 30021@item 0 disassembly only 30022@item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated) 30023@item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes 30024@item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated) 30025@item 4 mixed source and disassembly 30026@item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes 30027@end itemize 30028 30029Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric'' 30030which hasn't proved useful in practice. 30031@xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between 30032@code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command. 30033@end table 30034 30035@subsubheading Result 30036 30037The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named 30038@samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode} 30039used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command. 30040 30041For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the 30042following fields: 30043 30044@table @code 30045@item address 30046The address at which this instruction was disassembled. 30047 30048@item func-name 30049The name of the function this instruction is within. 30050 30051@item offset 30052The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}. 30053 30054@item inst 30055The text disassembly for this @samp{address}. 30056 30057@item opcodes 30058This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode 30059bytes for the @samp{inst} field. 30060 30061@end table 30062 30063For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named 30064@samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields: 30065 30066@table @code 30067@item line 30068The line number within @samp{file}. 30069 30070@item file 30071The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute 30072file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command 30073used. 30074 30075@item fullname 30076Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form 30077using the source file search path 30078(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}) 30079and after resolving all the symbolic links. 30080 30081If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as 30082present in the debug information. 30083 30084@item line_asm_insn 30085This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in 30086@samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for 30087@code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address}, 30088@samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally 30089@samp{opcodes}. 30090 30091@end table 30092 30093Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not 30094manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to 30095adjust its format. 30096 30097@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30098 30099The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}. 30100 30101@subsubheading Example 30102 30103Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}: 30104 30105@smallexample 30106(gdb) 30107-data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0 30108^done, 30109asm_insns=[ 30110@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 30111inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30112@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30113inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 30114@{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12", 30115inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@}, 30116@{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16", 30117inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 30118@{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20", 30119inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}] 30120(gdb) 30121@end smallexample 30122 30123Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of 30124@code{main}. 30125 30126@smallexample 30127-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0 30128^done,asm_insns=[ 30129@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0", 30130inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}, 30131@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 30132inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30133@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30134inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}, 30135[@dots{}] 30136@{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@}, 30137@{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}] 30138(gdb) 30139@end smallexample 30140 30141Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}: 30142 30143@smallexample 30144(gdb) 30145-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0 30146^done,asm_insns=[ 30147@{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0", 30148inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}, 30149@{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4", 30150inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30151@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30152inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}] 30153(gdb) 30154@end smallexample 30155 30156Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode: 30157 30158@smallexample 30159(gdb) 30160-data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1 30161^done,asm_insns=[ 30162src_and_asm_line=@{line="31", 30163file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30164fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30165line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc", 30166func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@}, 30167src_and_asm_line=@{line="32", 30168file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30169fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c", 30170line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0", 30171func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@}, 30172@{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8", 30173inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}] 30174(gdb) 30175@end smallexample 30176 30177 30178@subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command 30179@findex -data-evaluate-expression 30180 30181@subsubheading Synopsis 30182 30183@smallexample 30184 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr} 30185@end smallexample 30186 30187Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an 30188inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously. 30189If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes. 30190 30191@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30192 30193The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and 30194@samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding 30195@samp{gdb_eval} command. 30196 30197@subsubheading Example 30198 30199In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the 30200@dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi} 30201Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its 30202output. 30203 30204@smallexample 30205211-data-evaluate-expression A 30206211^done,value="1" 30207(gdb) 30208311-data-evaluate-expression &A 30209311^done,value="0xefffeb7c" 30210(gdb) 30211411-data-evaluate-expression A+3 30212411^done,value="4" 30213(gdb) 30214511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3" 30215511^done,value="4" 30216(gdb) 30217@end smallexample 30218 30219 30220@subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command 30221@findex -data-list-changed-registers 30222 30223@subsubheading Synopsis 30224 30225@smallexample 30226 -data-list-changed-registers 30227@end smallexample 30228 30229Display a list of the registers that have changed. 30230 30231@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30232 30233@value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk} 30234has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}. 30235 30236@subsubheading Example 30237 30238On a PPC MBX board: 30239 30240@smallexample 30241(gdb) 30242-exec-continue 30243^running 30244 30245(gdb) 30246*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{ 30247func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c", 30248line="5"@} 30249(gdb) 30250-data-list-changed-registers 30251^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9", 30252"10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23", 30253"24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"] 30254(gdb) 30255@end smallexample 30256 30257 30258@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command 30259@findex -data-list-register-names 30260 30261@subsubheading Synopsis 30262 30263@smallexample 30264 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ] 30265@end smallexample 30266 30267Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments 30268are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If 30269integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the 30270names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure 30271consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may 30272include empty register names. 30273 30274@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30275 30276@value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to 30277@samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a 30278corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}. 30279 30280@subsubheading Example 30281 30282For the PPC MBX board: 30283@smallexample 30284(gdb) 30285-data-list-register-names 30286^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7", 30287"r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18", 30288"r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29", 30289"r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9", 30290"f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20", 30291"f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31", 30292"", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"] 30293(gdb) 30294-data-list-register-names 1 2 3 30295^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"] 30296(gdb) 30297@end smallexample 30298 30299@subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command 30300@findex -data-list-register-values 30301 30302@subsubheading Synopsis 30303 30304@smallexample 30305 -data-list-register-values 30306 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*] 30307@end smallexample 30308 30309Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the 30310registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed 30311by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A 30312missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the 30313registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option 30314indicates that only the available registers are to be returned. 30315 30316Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are: 30317 30318@table @code 30319@item x 30320Hexadecimal 30321@item o 30322Octal 30323@item t 30324Binary 30325@item d 30326Decimal 30327@item r 30328Raw 30329@item N 30330Natural 30331@end table 30332 30333@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30334 30335The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info 30336all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}. 30337 30338@subsubheading Example 30339 30340For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they 30341don't appear in the actual output): 30342 30343@smallexample 30344(gdb) 30345-data-list-register-values r 64 65 30346^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@}, 30347@{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}] 30348(gdb) 30349-data-list-register-values x 30350^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@}, 30351@{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@}, 30352@{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@}, 30353@{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@}, 30354@{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@}, 30355@{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@}, 30356@{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@}, 30357@{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@}, 30358@{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@}, 30359@{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@}, 30360@{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@}, 30361@{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@}, 30362@{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@}, 30363@{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@}, 30364@{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@}, 30365@{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@}, 30366@{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@}, 30367@{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@}, 30368@{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@}, 30369@{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@}, 30370@{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@}, 30371@{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@}, 30372@{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@}, 30373@{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@}, 30374@{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@}, 30375@{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@}, 30376@{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@}, 30377@{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@}, 30378@{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@}, 30379@{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@}, 30380@{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@}, 30381@{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@}, 30382@{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@}, 30383@{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@}, 30384@{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@}, 30385@{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}] 30386(gdb) 30387@end smallexample 30388 30389 30390@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command 30391@findex -data-read-memory 30392 30393This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead. 30394 30395@subsubheading Synopsis 30396 30397@smallexample 30398 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ] 30399 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size} 30400 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ] 30401@end smallexample 30402 30403@noindent 30404where: 30405 30406@table @samp 30407@item @var{address} 30408An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be 30409read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be 30410quoted using the C convention. 30411 30412@item @var{word-format} 30413The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the 30414same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats, 30415,Output Formats}). 30416 30417@item @var{word-size} 30418The size of each memory word in bytes. 30419 30420@item @var{nr-rows} 30421The number of rows in the output table. 30422 30423@item @var{nr-cols} 30424The number of columns in the output table. 30425 30426@item @var{aschar} 30427If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The 30428value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a 30429member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii} 30430characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively). 30431 30432@item @var{byte-offset} 30433An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory. 30434@end table 30435 30436This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by 30437@var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total, 30438@code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read 30439(returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number 30440of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified 30441using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned 30442in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in 30443@samp{addr}. 30444 30445The address of the next/previous row or page is available in 30446@samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and 30447@samp{prev-page}. 30448 30449@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30450 30451The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has 30452@samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command. 30453 30454@subsubheading Example 30455 30456Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by 30457@code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per 30458word. Display each word in hex. 30459 30460@smallexample 30461(gdb) 304629-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2 304639^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6", 30464next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396", 30465prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[ 30466@{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@}, 30467@{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@}, 30468@{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}] 30469(gdb) 30470@end smallexample 30471 30472Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and 30473display as a single word formatted in decimal. 30474 30475@smallexample 30476(gdb) 304775-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1 304785^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2", 30479next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e", 30480next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[ 30481@{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}] 30482(gdb) 30483@end smallexample 30484 30485Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format 30486as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x} 30487used as the non-printable character. 30488 30489@smallexample 30490(gdb) 304914-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x 304924^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32", 30493next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c", 30494next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[ 30495@{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30496@{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30497@{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30498@{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@}, 30499@{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@}, 30500@{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@}, 30501@{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@}, 30502@{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}] 30503(gdb) 30504@end smallexample 30505 30506@subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command 30507@findex -data-read-memory-bytes 30508 30509@subsubheading Synopsis 30510 30511@smallexample 30512 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ] 30513 @var{address} @var{count} 30514@end smallexample 30515 30516@noindent 30517where: 30518 30519@table @samp 30520@item @var{address} 30521An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit 30522to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be 30523quoted using the C convention. 30524 30525@item @var{count} 30526The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer 30527literal. 30528 30529@item @var{offset} 30530The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This 30531should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend 30532is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address 30533arithmetics itself. 30534 30535@end table 30536 30537This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the 30538specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory 30539map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region 30540Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining 30541regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors, 30542@value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region. 30543 30544In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not, 30545and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at 30546every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will 30547attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end 30548of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works 30549well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region 30550has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end, 30551@value{GDBN} will not read it. 30552 30553The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of 30554the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a 30555list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block 30556and has the following fields: 30557 30558@table @code 30559@item begin 30560The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal. 30561 30562@item end 30563The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal. 30564 30565@item offset 30566The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to 30567the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}. 30568 30569@item contents 30570The contents of the memory block, in hex. 30571 30572@end table 30573 30574 30575 30576@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30577 30578The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. 30579 30580@subsubheading Example 30581 30582@smallexample 30583(gdb) 30584-data-read-memory-bytes &a 10 30585^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000", 30586 end="0xbffff15e", 30587 contents="01000000020000000300"@}] 30588(gdb) 30589@end smallexample 30590 30591 30592@subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command 30593@findex -data-write-memory-bytes 30594 30595@subsubheading Synopsis 30596 30597@smallexample 30598 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} 30599 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]} 30600@end smallexample 30601 30602@noindent 30603where: 30604 30605@table @samp 30606@item @var{address} 30607An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit 30608to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should 30609be quoted using the C convention. 30610 30611@item @var{contents} 30612The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does 30613not represent an integral number of addressable memory units. 30614 30615@item @var{count} 30616Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be 30617written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length, 30618@value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills 30619@var{count} memory units. 30620 30621@end table 30622 30623@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30624 30625There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 30626 30627@subsubheading Example 30628 30629@smallexample 30630(gdb) 30631-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 30632^done 30633(gdb) 30634@end smallexample 30635 30636@smallexample 30637(gdb) 30638-data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e 30639^done 30640(gdb) 30641@end smallexample 30642 30643@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 30644@node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands 30645@section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands 30646 30647The commands defined in this section implement MI support for 30648tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}. 30649 30650@subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command 30651@findex -trace-find 30652 30653@subsubheading Synopsis 30654 30655@smallexample 30656 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}] 30657@end smallexample 30658 30659Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and 30660@var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible 30661modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}. 30662 30663@table @samp 30664 30665@item none 30666No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames. 30667 30668@item frame-number 30669An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with 30670that index. 30671 30672@item tracepoint-number 30673An integer is required as parameter. Finds next 30674trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number. 30675 30676@item pc 30677An address is required as parameter. Finds 30678next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified 30679address. 30680 30681@item pc-inside-range 30682Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace 30683frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the 30684specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range. 30685 30686@item pc-outside-range 30687Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds 30688next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside 30689the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range. 30690 30691@item line 30692Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}. 30693Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at 30694the specified location. 30695 30696@end table 30697 30698If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not 30699have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields: 30700 30701@table @samp 30702@item found 30703This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending 30704on whether a matching tracepoint was found. 30705 30706@item traceframe 30707The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff 30708the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}. 30709 30710@item tracepoint 30711The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff 30712the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}. 30713 30714@item frame 30715The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace 30716frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found. 30717@xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field. 30718 30719@end table 30720 30721@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30722 30723The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}. 30724 30725@subheading -trace-define-variable 30726@findex -trace-define-variable 30727 30728@subsubheading Synopsis 30729 30730@smallexample 30731 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ] 30732@end smallexample 30733 30734Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If 30735@var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified 30736trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start 30737with the @samp{$} character. 30738 30739@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30740 30741The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}. 30742 30743@subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command 30744@findex -trace-frame-collected 30745 30746@subsubheading Synopsis 30747 30748@smallexample 30749 -trace-frame-collected 30750 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}] 30751 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}] 30752 [--registers-format @var{regformat}] 30753 [--memory-contents] 30754@end smallexample 30755 30756This command returns the set of collected objects, register names, 30757trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions 30758that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional 30759parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways. 30760See the output description table below for more details. 30761 30762The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create 30763varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by 30764this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable, 30765which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a 30766memory range and which is a computed expression. 30767 30768For instance, if the actions were 30769@smallexample 30770collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2 30771collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40 30772@end smallexample 30773 30774@noindent 30775the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The 30776object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the 30777element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining 30778objects would be computed expressions. 30779 30780An example output would be: 30781 30782@smallexample 30783(gdb) 30784-trace-frame-collected 30785^done, 30786 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}], 30787 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@}, 30788 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@}, 30789 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@}, 30790 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@}, 30791 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}], 30792 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@}, 30793 @{number="1",value="0x0"@}, 30794 @{number="2",value="0x4"@}, 30795 ... 30796 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}], 30797 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}], 30798 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@}, 30799 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}] 30800(gdb) 30801@end smallexample 30802 30803Where: 30804 30805@table @code 30806@item explicit-variables 30807The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as 30808opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct 30809members). For each object, its name and value are printed. 30810The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value 30811field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names; 30812if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name, 30813type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for 30814arrays, structures and unions. 30815 30816@item computed-expressions 30817The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the 30818current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects 30819this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the 30820@code{explicit-variables} set. See above. 30821 30822@item registers 30823The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame. 30824For each register collected, the name and current value are returned. 30825The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format} 30826option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a 30827list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}. 30828 30829@item tvars 30830The trace state variables that have been collected at the current 30831trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and 30832current value are returned. 30833 30834@item memory 30835The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace 30836frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a 30837collected memory range and has the following fields: 30838 30839@table @code 30840@item address 30841The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal. 30842 30843@item length 30844The length of the memory range, as decimal literal. 30845 30846@item contents 30847The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present 30848if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified. 30849 30850@end table 30851 30852@end table 30853 30854@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30855 30856There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 30857 30858@subsubheading Example 30859 30860@subheading -trace-list-variables 30861@findex -trace-list-variables 30862 30863@subsubheading Synopsis 30864 30865@smallexample 30866 -trace-list-variables 30867@end smallexample 30868 30869Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the 30870table has the following fields: 30871 30872@table @samp 30873@item name 30874The name of the trace variable. This field is always present. 30875 30876@item initial 30877The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This 30878field is always present. 30879 30880@item current 30881The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit 30882signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is 30883not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is 30884presently running. 30885 30886@end table 30887 30888@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30889 30890The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}. 30891 30892@subsubheading Example 30893 30894@smallexample 30895(gdb) 30896-trace-list-variables 30897^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3", 30898hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}, 30899 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@}, 30900 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}], 30901body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@} 30902 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@} 30903(gdb) 30904@end smallexample 30905 30906@subheading -trace-save 30907@findex -trace-save 30908 30909@subsubheading Synopsis 30910 30911@smallexample 30912 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename} 30913@end smallexample 30914 30915Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the 30916@samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved 30917in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked 30918to perform the save. 30919 30920@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30921 30922The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}. 30923 30924 30925@subheading -trace-start 30926@findex -trace-start 30927 30928@subsubheading Synopsis 30929 30930@smallexample 30931 -trace-start 30932@end smallexample 30933 30934Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not 30935have any fields. 30936 30937@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 30938 30939The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}. 30940 30941@subheading -trace-status 30942@findex -trace-status 30943 30944@subsubheading Synopsis 30945 30946@smallexample 30947 -trace-status 30948@end smallexample 30949 30950Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include 30951the following fields: 30952 30953@table @samp 30954 30955@item supported 30956May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are 30957supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or 30958@samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining 30959of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be 30960started. This field is always present. 30961 30962@item running 30963May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether 30964tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present 30965if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}. 30966 30967@item stop-reason 30968Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field 30969may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The 30970value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of 30971the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means 30972the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means 30973tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected. 30974The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a 30975tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint. 30976This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}. 30977 30978@item stopping-tracepoint 30979The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is 30980present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of 30981@samp{passcount}. 30982 30983@item frames 30984@itemx frames-created 30985The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames 30986in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created 30987during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a 30988circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional. 30989 30990@item buffer-size 30991@itemx buffer-free 30992These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the 30993remaining space. These fields are optional. 30994 30995@item circular 30996The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the 30997trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if 30998necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear 30999and may fill up. 31000 31001@item disconnected 31002The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that 31003tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means 31004that the trace run will stop. 31005 31006@item trace-file 31007The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is 31008optional, and only present when examining a trace file. 31009 31010@end table 31011 31012@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31013 31014The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}. 31015 31016@subheading -trace-stop 31017@findex -trace-stop 31018 31019@subsubheading Synopsis 31020 31021@smallexample 31022 -trace-stop 31023@end smallexample 31024 31025Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same 31026fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and 31027@samp{running} fields are not output. 31028 31029@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31030 31031The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}. 31032 31033 31034@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31035@node GDB/MI Symbol Query 31036@section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands 31037 31038 31039@ignore 31040@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command 31041@findex -symbol-info-address 31042 31043@subsubheading Synopsis 31044 31045@smallexample 31046 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol} 31047@end smallexample 31048 31049Describe where @var{symbol} is stored. 31050 31051@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31052 31053The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}. 31054 31055@subsubheading Example 31056N.A. 31057 31058 31059@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command 31060@findex -symbol-info-file 31061 31062@subsubheading Synopsis 31063 31064@smallexample 31065 -symbol-info-file 31066@end smallexample 31067 31068Show the file for the symbol. 31069 31070@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31071 31072There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has 31073@samp{gdb_find_file}. 31074 31075@subsubheading Example 31076N.A. 31077 31078 31079@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command 31080@findex -symbol-info-function 31081 31082@subsubheading Synopsis 31083 31084@smallexample 31085 -symbol-info-function 31086@end smallexample 31087 31088Show which function the symbol lives in. 31089 31090@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31091 31092@samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}. 31093 31094@subsubheading Example 31095N.A. 31096 31097 31098@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command 31099@findex -symbol-info-line 31100 31101@subsubheading Synopsis 31102 31103@smallexample 31104 -symbol-info-line 31105@end smallexample 31106 31107Show the core addresses of the code for a source line. 31108 31109@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31110 31111The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}. 31112@code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands. 31113 31114@subsubheading Example 31115N.A. 31116 31117 31118@subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command 31119@findex -symbol-info-symbol 31120 31121@subsubheading Synopsis 31122 31123@smallexample 31124 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr} 31125@end smallexample 31126 31127Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}. 31128 31129@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31130 31131The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}. 31132 31133@subsubheading Example 31134N.A. 31135 31136 31137@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command 31138@findex -symbol-list-functions 31139 31140@subsubheading Synopsis 31141 31142@smallexample 31143 -symbol-list-functions 31144@end smallexample 31145 31146List the functions in the executable. 31147 31148@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31149 31150@samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and 31151@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 31152 31153@subsubheading Example 31154N.A. 31155@end ignore 31156 31157 31158@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command 31159@findex -symbol-list-lines 31160 31161@subsubheading Synopsis 31162 31163@smallexample 31164 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename} 31165@end smallexample 31166 31167Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program 31168addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in 31169ascending PC order. 31170 31171@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31172 31173There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 31174 31175@subsubheading Example 31176@smallexample 31177(gdb) 31178-symbol-list-lines basics.c 31179^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}] 31180(gdb) 31181@end smallexample 31182 31183 31184@ignore 31185@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command 31186@findex -symbol-list-types 31187 31188@subsubheading Synopsis 31189 31190@smallexample 31191 -symbol-list-types 31192@end smallexample 31193 31194List all the type names. 31195 31196@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31197 31198The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN}, 31199@samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 31200 31201@subsubheading Example 31202N.A. 31203 31204 31205@subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command 31206@findex -symbol-list-variables 31207 31208@subsubheading Synopsis 31209 31210@smallexample 31211 -symbol-list-variables 31212@end smallexample 31213 31214List all the global and static variable names. 31215 31216@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31217 31218@samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}. 31219 31220@subsubheading Example 31221N.A. 31222 31223 31224@subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command 31225@findex -symbol-locate 31226 31227@subsubheading Synopsis 31228 31229@smallexample 31230 -symbol-locate 31231@end smallexample 31232 31233@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31234 31235@samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}. 31236 31237@subsubheading Example 31238N.A. 31239 31240 31241@subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command 31242@findex -symbol-type 31243 31244@subsubheading Synopsis 31245 31246@smallexample 31247 -symbol-type @var{variable} 31248@end smallexample 31249 31250Show type of @var{variable}. 31251 31252@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31253 31254The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has 31255@samp{gdb_obj_variable}. 31256 31257@subsubheading Example 31258N.A. 31259@end ignore 31260 31261 31262@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31263@node GDB/MI File Commands 31264@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands 31265 31266This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names 31267and to read in and obtain symbol table information. 31268 31269@subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command 31270@findex -file-exec-and-symbols 31271 31272@subsubheading Synopsis 31273 31274@smallexample 31275 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file} 31276@end smallexample 31277 31278Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from 31279which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the 31280command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints 31281are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce 31282error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion 31283notification. 31284 31285@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31286 31287The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}. 31288 31289@subsubheading Example 31290 31291@smallexample 31292(gdb) 31293-file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 31294^done 31295(gdb) 31296@end smallexample 31297 31298 31299@subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command 31300@findex -file-exec-file 31301 31302@subsubheading Synopsis 31303 31304@smallexample 31305 -file-exec-file @var{file} 31306@end smallexample 31307 31308Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike 31309@samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read 31310from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information 31311about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion 31312notification. 31313 31314@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31315 31316The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}. 31317 31318@subsubheading Example 31319 31320@smallexample 31321(gdb) 31322-file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 31323^done 31324(gdb) 31325@end smallexample 31326 31327 31328@ignore 31329@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command 31330@findex -file-list-exec-sections 31331 31332@subsubheading Synopsis 31333 31334@smallexample 31335 -file-list-exec-sections 31336@end smallexample 31337 31338List the sections of the current executable file. 31339 31340@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31341 31342The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same 31343information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command 31344@samp{gdb_load_info}. 31345 31346@subsubheading Example 31347N.A. 31348@end ignore 31349 31350 31351@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command 31352@findex -file-list-exec-source-file 31353 31354@subsubheading Synopsis 31355 31356@smallexample 31357 -file-list-exec-source-file 31358@end smallexample 31359 31360List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path 31361to the current source file for the current executable. The macro 31362information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on 31363whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information. 31364 31365@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31366 31367The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source} 31368 31369@subsubheading Example 31370 31371@smallexample 31372(gdb) 31373123-file-list-exec-source-file 31374123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1" 31375(gdb) 31376@end smallexample 31377 31378 31379@subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command 31380@findex -file-list-exec-source-files 31381 31382@subsubheading Synopsis 31383 31384@smallexample 31385 -file-list-exec-source-files 31386@end smallexample 31387 31388List the source files for the current executable. 31389 31390It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file 31391name) of a source file. 31392 31393@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31394 31395The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}. 31396@code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}. 31397 31398@subsubheading Example 31399@smallexample 31400(gdb) 31401-file-list-exec-source-files 31402^done,files=[ 31403@{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@}, 31404@{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@}, 31405@{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}] 31406(gdb) 31407@end smallexample 31408 31409@ignore 31410@subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command 31411@findex -file-list-shared-libraries 31412 31413@subsubheading Synopsis 31414 31415@smallexample 31416 -file-list-shared-libraries 31417@end smallexample 31418 31419List the shared libraries in the program. 31420 31421@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31422 31423The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. 31424 31425@subsubheading Example 31426N.A. 31427 31428 31429@subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command 31430@findex -file-list-symbol-files 31431 31432@subsubheading Synopsis 31433 31434@smallexample 31435 -file-list-symbol-files 31436@end smallexample 31437 31438List symbol files. 31439 31440@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31441 31442The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it). 31443 31444@subsubheading Example 31445N.A. 31446@end ignore 31447 31448 31449@subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command 31450@findex -file-symbol-file 31451 31452@subsubheading Synopsis 31453 31454@smallexample 31455 -file-symbol-file @var{file} 31456@end smallexample 31457 31458Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When 31459used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is 31460produced, except for a completion notification. 31461 31462@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31463 31464The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}. 31465 31466@subsubheading Example 31467 31468@smallexample 31469(gdb) 31470-file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx 31471^done 31472(gdb) 31473@end smallexample 31474 31475@ignore 31476@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31477@node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands 31478@section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands 31479 31480The memory overlay commands are not implemented. 31481 31482@c @subheading -overlay-auto 31483 31484@c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state 31485 31486@c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays 31487 31488@c @subheading -overlay-map 31489 31490@c @subheading -overlay-off 31491 31492@c @subheading -overlay-on 31493 31494@c @subheading -overlay-unmap 31495 31496@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31497@node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands 31498@section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands 31499 31500Signal handling commands are not implemented. 31501 31502@c @subheading -signal-handle 31503 31504@c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions 31505 31506@c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types 31507@end ignore 31508 31509 31510@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31511@node GDB/MI Target Manipulation 31512@section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands 31513 31514 31515@subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command 31516@findex -target-attach 31517 31518@subsubheading Synopsis 31519 31520@smallexample 31521 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file} 31522@end smallexample 31523 31524Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of 31525@value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread 31526group, the id previously returned by 31527@samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used. 31528 31529@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31530 31531The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}. 31532 31533@subsubheading Example 31534@smallexample 31535(gdb) 31536-target-attach 34 31537=thread-created,id="1" 31538*stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@} 31539^done 31540(gdb) 31541@end smallexample 31542 31543@ignore 31544@subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command 31545@findex -target-compare-sections 31546 31547@subsubheading Synopsis 31548 31549@smallexample 31550 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ] 31551@end smallexample 31552 31553Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file. 31554Without the argument, all sections are compared. 31555 31556@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31557 31558The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}. 31559 31560@subsubheading Example 31561N.A. 31562@end ignore 31563 31564 31565@subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command 31566@findex -target-detach 31567 31568@subsubheading Synopsis 31569 31570@smallexample 31571 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ] 31572@end smallexample 31573 31574Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution. 31575If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either 31576the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output. 31577 31578@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31579 31580The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}. 31581 31582@subsubheading Example 31583 31584@smallexample 31585(gdb) 31586-target-detach 31587^done 31588(gdb) 31589@end smallexample 31590 31591 31592@subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command 31593@findex -target-disconnect 31594 31595@subsubheading Synopsis 31596 31597@smallexample 31598 -target-disconnect 31599@end smallexample 31600 31601Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is 31602generally not resumed. 31603 31604@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31605 31606The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}. 31607 31608@subsubheading Example 31609 31610@smallexample 31611(gdb) 31612-target-disconnect 31613^done 31614(gdb) 31615@end smallexample 31616 31617 31618@subheading The @code{-target-download} Command 31619@findex -target-download 31620 31621@subsubheading Synopsis 31622 31623@smallexample 31624 -target-download 31625@end smallexample 31626 31627Loads the executable onto the remote target. 31628It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields: 31629 31630@table @samp 31631@item section 31632The name of the section. 31633@item section-sent 31634The size of what has been sent so far for that section. 31635@item section-size 31636The size of the section. 31637@item total-sent 31638The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections). 31639@item total-size 31640The size of the overall executable to download. 31641@end table 31642 31643@noindent 31644Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , 31645@sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}). 31646 31647In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are 31648downloaded. These messages include the following fields: 31649 31650@table @samp 31651@item section 31652The name of the section. 31653@item section-size 31654The size of the section. 31655@item total-size 31656The size of the overall executable to download. 31657@end table 31658 31659@noindent 31660At the end, a summary is printed. 31661 31662@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31663 31664The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}. 31665 31666@subsubheading Example 31667 31668Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages 31669have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page. 31670 31671@smallexample 31672(gdb) 31673-target-download 31674+download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@} 31675+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668", 31676total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@} 31677+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668", 31678total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@} 31679+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668", 31680total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@} 31681+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668", 31682total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@} 31683+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668", 31684total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@} 31685+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668", 31686total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@} 31687+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668", 31688total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@} 31689+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668", 31690total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@} 31691+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668", 31692total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@} 31693+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668", 31694total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@} 31695+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668", 31696total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@} 31697+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668", 31698total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@} 31699+download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668", 31700total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@} 31701+download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@} 31702+download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@} 31703+download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@} 31704+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156", 31705total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@} 31706+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156", 31707total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@} 31708+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156", 31709total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@} 31710+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156", 31711total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@} 31712+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156", 31713total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@} 31714+download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156", 31715total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@} 31716^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586", 31717write-rate="429" 31718(gdb) 31719@end smallexample 31720 31721 31722@ignore 31723@subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command 31724@findex -target-exec-status 31725 31726@subsubheading Synopsis 31727 31728@smallexample 31729 -target-exec-status 31730@end smallexample 31731 31732Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or 31733not, for instance). 31734 31735@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31736 31737There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. 31738 31739@subsubheading Example 31740N.A. 31741 31742 31743@subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command 31744@findex -target-list-available-targets 31745 31746@subsubheading Synopsis 31747 31748@smallexample 31749 -target-list-available-targets 31750@end smallexample 31751 31752List the possible targets to connect to. 31753 31754@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31755 31756The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}. 31757 31758@subsubheading Example 31759N.A. 31760 31761 31762@subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command 31763@findex -target-list-current-targets 31764 31765@subsubheading Synopsis 31766 31767@smallexample 31768 -target-list-current-targets 31769@end smallexample 31770 31771Describe the current target. 31772 31773@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31774 31775The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among 31776other things). 31777 31778@subsubheading Example 31779N.A. 31780 31781 31782@subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command 31783@findex -target-list-parameters 31784 31785@subsubheading Synopsis 31786 31787@smallexample 31788 -target-list-parameters 31789@end smallexample 31790 31791@c ???? 31792@end ignore 31793 31794@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31795 31796No equivalent. 31797 31798@subsubheading Example 31799N.A. 31800 31801 31802@subheading The @code{-target-select} Command 31803@findex -target-select 31804 31805@subsubheading Synopsis 31806 31807@smallexample 31808 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}} 31809@end smallexample 31810 31811Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args: 31812 31813@table @samp 31814@item @var{type} 31815The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc. 31816@item @var{parameters} 31817Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, , 31818Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details. 31819@end table 31820 31821The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at 31822which the target program is, in the following form: 31823 31824@smallexample 31825^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}", 31826 args=[@var{arg list}] 31827@end smallexample 31828 31829@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31830 31831The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}. 31832 31833@subsubheading Example 31834 31835@smallexample 31836(gdb) 31837-target-select remote /dev/ttya 31838^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[] 31839(gdb) 31840@end smallexample 31841 31842@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31843@node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands 31844@section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands 31845 31846 31847@subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command 31848@findex -target-file-put 31849 31850@subsubheading Synopsis 31851 31852@smallexample 31853 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile} 31854@end smallexample 31855 31856Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running 31857@value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system. 31858 31859@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31860 31861The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}. 31862 31863@subsubheading Example 31864 31865@smallexample 31866(gdb) 31867-target-file-put localfile remotefile 31868^done 31869(gdb) 31870@end smallexample 31871 31872 31873@subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command 31874@findex -target-file-get 31875 31876@subsubheading Synopsis 31877 31878@smallexample 31879 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile} 31880@end smallexample 31881 31882Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile} 31883on the host system. 31884 31885@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31886 31887The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}. 31888 31889@subsubheading Example 31890 31891@smallexample 31892(gdb) 31893-target-file-get remotefile localfile 31894^done 31895(gdb) 31896@end smallexample 31897 31898 31899@subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command 31900@findex -target-file-delete 31901 31902@subsubheading Synopsis 31903 31904@smallexample 31905 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile} 31906@end smallexample 31907 31908Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system. 31909 31910@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31911 31912The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}. 31913 31914@subsubheading Example 31915 31916@smallexample 31917(gdb) 31918-target-file-delete remotefile 31919^done 31920(gdb) 31921@end smallexample 31922 31923 31924@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31925@node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands 31926@section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands 31927 31928@subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command 31929@findex -info-ada-exceptions 31930 31931@subsubheading Synopsis 31932 31933@smallexample 31934 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}] 31935@end smallexample 31936 31937List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged. 31938With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose 31939names match @var{regexp} are listed. 31940 31941@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 31942 31943The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}. 31944 31945@subsubheading Result 31946 31947The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are 31948defined for each exception: 31949 31950@table @samp 31951@item name 31952The name of the exception. 31953 31954@item address 31955The address of the exception. 31956 31957@end table 31958 31959@subsubheading Example 31960 31961@smallexample 31962-info-ada-exceptions aint 31963^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2", 31964hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}, 31965@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}], 31966body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@}, 31967@{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@} 31968@end smallexample 31969 31970@subheading Catching Ada Exceptions 31971 31972The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program 31973raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI 31974Catchpoint Commands}. 31975 31976 31977@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 31978@node GDB/MI Support Commands 31979@section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands 31980 31981Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi}, 31982some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger 31983about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible 31984to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features. 31985 31986@subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command 31987@cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} 31988@findex -info-gdb-mi-command 31989 31990@subsubheading Synopsis 31991 31992@smallexample 31993 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name} 31994@end smallexample 31995 31996Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}. 31997 31998Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands 31999is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input 32000Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However, 32001for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading 32002dash. 32003 32004@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32005 32006There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command. 32007 32008@subsubheading Result 32009 32010The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field: 32011 32012@table @samp 32013@item exists 32014This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists, 32015@code{"false"} otherwise. 32016 32017@end table 32018 32019@subsubheading Example 32020 32021Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist: 32022 32023@smallexample 32024-info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command 32025^done,command=@{exists="false"@} 32026@end smallexample 32027 32028@noindent 32029And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known 32030to the debugger: 32031 32032@smallexample 32033-info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines 32034^done,command=@{exists="true"@} 32035@end smallexample 32036 32037@subheading The @code{-list-features} Command 32038@findex -list-features 32039@cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list 32040 32041Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that 32042this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command, 32043or a new field in an output of some command, or even an 32044important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence 32045of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger 32046startup. 32047 32048The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an 32049available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not 32050have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names 32051is given below. 32052 32053Example output: 32054 32055@smallexample 32056(gdb) -list-features 32057^done,result=["feature1","feature2"] 32058@end smallexample 32059 32060The current list of features is: 32061 32062@ftable @samp 32063@item frozen-varobjs 32064Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well 32065as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output 32066of @code{-varobj-create}. 32067@item pending-breakpoints 32068Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} 32069command. 32070@item python 32071Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based 32072pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the 32073@samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children} 32074@item thread-info 32075Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command. 32076@item data-read-memory-bytes 32077Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the 32078@code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands. 32079@item breakpoint-notifications 32080Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the 32081CLI will be announced via async records. 32082@item ada-task-info 32083Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command. 32084@item language-option 32085Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language} 32086option (@pxref{Context management}). 32087@item info-gdb-mi-command 32088Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command. 32089@item undefined-command-error-code 32090Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result 32091records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command 32092(@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}). 32093@item exec-run-start-option 32094Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start} 32095option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}). 32096@end ftable 32097 32098@subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command 32099@findex -list-target-features 32100 32101Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the 32102target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but 32103unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the 32104features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever 32105a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select}, 32106@code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features 32107may change, and the frontend should obtain it again. 32108Example output: 32109 32110@smallexample 32111(gdb) -list-target-features 32112^done,result=["async"] 32113@end smallexample 32114 32115The current list of features is: 32116 32117@table @samp 32118@item async 32119Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command 32120execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands 32121while the target is running. 32122 32123@item reverse 32124Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution. 32125@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 32126 32127@end table 32128 32129@c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% 32130@node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands 32131@section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands 32132 32133@c @subheading -gdb-complete 32134 32135@subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command 32136@findex -gdb-exit 32137 32138@subsubheading Synopsis 32139 32140@smallexample 32141 -gdb-exit 32142@end smallexample 32143 32144Exit @value{GDBN} immediately. 32145 32146@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32147 32148Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}. 32149 32150@subsubheading Example 32151 32152@smallexample 32153(gdb) 32154-gdb-exit 32155^exit 32156@end smallexample 32157 32158 32159@ignore 32160@subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command 32161@findex -exec-abort 32162 32163@subsubheading Synopsis 32164 32165@smallexample 32166 -exec-abort 32167@end smallexample 32168 32169Kill the inferior running program. 32170 32171@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32172 32173The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}. 32174 32175@subsubheading Example 32176N.A. 32177@end ignore 32178 32179 32180@subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command 32181@findex -gdb-set 32182 32183@subsubheading Synopsis 32184 32185@smallexample 32186 -gdb-set 32187@end smallexample 32188 32189Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable. 32190@c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ????? 32191 32192@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32193 32194The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}. 32195 32196@subsubheading Example 32197 32198@smallexample 32199(gdb) 32200-gdb-set $foo=3 32201^done 32202(gdb) 32203@end smallexample 32204 32205 32206@subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command 32207@findex -gdb-show 32208 32209@subsubheading Synopsis 32210 32211@smallexample 32212 -gdb-show 32213@end smallexample 32214 32215Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable. 32216 32217@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32218 32219The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}. 32220 32221@subsubheading Example 32222 32223@smallexample 32224(gdb) 32225-gdb-show annotate 32226^done,value="0" 32227(gdb) 32228@end smallexample 32229 32230@c @subheading -gdb-source 32231 32232 32233@subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command 32234@findex -gdb-version 32235 32236@subsubheading Synopsis 32237 32238@smallexample 32239 -gdb-version 32240@end smallexample 32241 32242Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing. 32243 32244@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32245 32246The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by 32247default shows this information when you start an interactive session. 32248 32249@subsubheading Example 32250 32251@c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull 32252@c box in TeX. 32253@smallexample 32254(gdb) 32255-gdb-version 32256~GNU gdb 5.2.1 32257~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 32258~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and 32259~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under 32260~ certain conditions. 32261~Type "show copying" to see the conditions. 32262~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for 32263~ details. 32264~This GDB was configured as 32265 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi". 32266^done 32267(gdb) 32268@end smallexample 32269 32270@subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command 32271@findex -list-thread-groups 32272 32273@subheading Synopsis 32274 32275@smallexample 32276-list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ] 32277@end smallexample 32278 32279Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread 32280group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group. 32281When several thread group are passed, lists information about those 32282thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all 32283top-level thread groups. 32284 32285Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported. 32286With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups 32287available on the target. 32288 32289The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or 32290a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples 32291as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread 32292Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value, 32293each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are 32294requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups 32295are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format 32296of the @samp{group} result is described below. 32297 32298To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups 32299together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option 32300and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is 32301permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group 32302will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or 32303@samp{threads} field. 32304 32305In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with 32306the following caveats: 32307 32308@itemize @bullet 32309@item 32310When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically 32311be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain 32312anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored. 32313 32314@item 32315When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may 32316be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might 32317be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might 32318not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups. 32319The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} 32320is always an expensive operation and cache the results. 32321 32322@end itemize 32323 32324The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may 32325have the following fields: 32326 32327@table @code 32328@item id 32329Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present. 32330The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to 32331convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one. 32332 32333@item type 32334The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a 32335valid type. 32336 32337@item pid 32338The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present 32339for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists. 32340 32341@item exit-code 32342The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal. 32343This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and 32344only if the process is not running. 32345 32346@item num_children 32347The number of children this thread group has. This field may be 32348absent for an available thread group. 32349 32350@item threads 32351This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a 32352thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is 32353specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads. 32354 32355@item cores 32356This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one 32357thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if 32358such information is not available. 32359 32360@item executable 32361The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group. 32362The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process}, 32363and only if there is a corresponding executable file. 32364 32365@end table 32366 32367@subheading Example 32368 32369@smallexample 32370@value{GDBP} 32371-list-thread-groups 32372^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}] 32373-list-thread-groups 17 32374^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)", 32375 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@}, 32376@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)", 32377 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}], 32378 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]] 32379-list-thread-groups --available 32380^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}] 32381-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 32382 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2], 32383 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@}, 32384 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..] 32385-list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18 32386^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2], 32387 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@}, 32388 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...] 32389@end smallexample 32390 32391@subheading The @code{-info-os} Command 32392@findex -info-os 32393 32394@subsubheading Synopsis 32395 32396@smallexample 32397-info-os [ @var{type} ] 32398@end smallexample 32399 32400If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available 32401operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is 32402supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table 32403of data of that type. 32404 32405The types of information available depend on the target operating 32406system. 32407 32408@subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command 32409 32410The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}. 32411 32412@subsubheading Example 32413 32414When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something 32415like this: 32416 32417@smallexample 32418@value{GDBP} 32419-info-os 32420^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3", 32421hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@}, 32422 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@}, 32423 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}], 32424body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system", 32425 col2="CPUs"@}, 32426 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors", 32427 col2="File descriptors"@}, 32428 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules", 32429 col2="Kernel modules"@}, 32430 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues", 32431 col2="Message queues"@}, 32432 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes", 32433 col2="Processes"@}, 32434 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups", 32435 col2="Process groups"@}, 32436 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores", 32437 col2="Semaphores"@}, 32438 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions", 32439 col2="Shared-memory regions"@}, 32440 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets", 32441 col2="Sockets"@}, 32442 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads", 32443 col2="Threads"@}] 32444@value{GDBP} 32445-info-os processes 32446^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4", 32447hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@}, 32448 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@}, 32449 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@}, 32450 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}], 32451body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@}, 32452 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@}, 32453 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@}, 32454 ... 32455 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@}, 32456 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@} 32457(gdb) 32458@end smallexample 32459 32460(Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that 32461does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful 32462for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a 32463popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and 32464@code{info os} omits it.) 32465 32466@subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command 32467@findex -add-inferior 32468 32469@subheading Synopsis 32470 32471@smallexample 32472-add-inferior 32473@end smallexample 32474 32475Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created 32476inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may 32477be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command 32478(@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single 32479field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the 32480thread group corresponding to the new inferior. 32481 32482@subheading Example 32483 32484@smallexample 32485@value{GDBP} 32486-add-inferior 32487^done,inferior="i3" 32488@end smallexample 32489 32490@subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command 32491@findex -interpreter-exec 32492 32493@subheading Synopsis 32494 32495@smallexample 32496-interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command} 32497@end smallexample 32498@anchor{-interpreter-exec} 32499 32500Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}. 32501 32502@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32503 32504The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}. 32505 32506@subheading Example 32507 32508@smallexample 32509(gdb) 32510-interpreter-exec console "break main" 32511&"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n" 32512&"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n" 32513~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n" 32514^done 32515(gdb) 32516@end smallexample 32517 32518@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command 32519@findex -inferior-tty-set 32520 32521@subheading Synopsis 32522 32523@smallexample 32524-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 32525@end smallexample 32526 32527Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged. 32528 32529@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32530 32531The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1. 32532 32533@subheading Example 32534 32535@smallexample 32536(gdb) 32537-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 32538^done 32539(gdb) 32540@end smallexample 32541 32542@subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command 32543@findex -inferior-tty-show 32544 32545@subheading Synopsis 32546 32547@smallexample 32548-inferior-tty-show 32549@end smallexample 32550 32551Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged. 32552 32553@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32554 32555The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}. 32556 32557@subheading Example 32558 32559@smallexample 32560(gdb) 32561-inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1 32562^done 32563(gdb) 32564-inferior-tty-show 32565^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1" 32566(gdb) 32567@end smallexample 32568 32569@subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command 32570@findex -enable-timings 32571 32572@subheading Synopsis 32573 32574@smallexample 32575-enable-timings [yes | no] 32576@end smallexample 32577 32578Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI 32579command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend 32580developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is 32581equivalent to @samp{yes}. 32582 32583@subheading @value{GDBN} Command 32584 32585No equivalent. 32586 32587@subheading Example 32588 32589@smallexample 32590(gdb) 32591-enable-timings 32592^done 32593(gdb) 32594-break-insert main 32595^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y", 32596addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c", 32597fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"], 32598times="0"@}, 32599time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@} 32600(gdb) 32601-enable-timings no 32602^done 32603(gdb) 32604-exec-run 32605^running 32606(gdb) 32607*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0", 32608frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@}, 32609@{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c", 32610fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@} 32611(gdb) 32612@end smallexample 32613 32614@node Annotations 32615@chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations 32616 32617This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were 32618designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other 32619similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a 32620relatively high level. 32621 32622The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi} 32623(@pxref{GDB/MI}). 32624 32625@ignore 32626This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}. 32627@end ignore 32628 32629@menu 32630* Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax. 32631* Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state. 32632* Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input. 32633* Errors:: Annotations for error messages. 32634* Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid. 32635* Annotations for Running:: 32636 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc. 32637* Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code. 32638@end menu 32639 32640@node Annotations Overview 32641@section What is an Annotation? 32642@cindex annotations 32643 32644Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z} 32645characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional 32646information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation 32647is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional 32648information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the 32649additional information, and a newline. The additional information 32650cannot contain newline characters. 32651 32652Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z} 32653characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is 32654no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two 32655@samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the 32656annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which 32657means those three characters as output. 32658 32659The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the 32660@option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls 32661how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, 32662values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 32663is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a 32664subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable 32665for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have 32666been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation 32667Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}). 32668 32669@table @code 32670@kindex set annotate 32671@item set annotate @var{level} 32672The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of 32673annotations to the specified @var{level}. 32674 32675@item show annotate 32676@kindex show annotate 32677Show the current annotation level. 32678@end table 32679 32680This chapter describes level 3 annotations. 32681 32682A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is: 32683 32684@smallexample 32685$ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3} 32686GNU gdb 6.0 32687Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 32688GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, 32689and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it 32690under certain conditions. 32691Type "show copying" to see the conditions. 32692There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" 32693for details. 32694This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu" 32695 32696^Z^Zpre-prompt 32697(@value{GDBP}) 32698^Z^Zprompt 32699@kbd{quit} 32700 32701^Z^Zpost-prompt 32702$ 32703@end smallexample 32704 32705Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from 32706@value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z} 32707denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is 32708output from @value{GDBN}. 32709 32710@node Server Prefix 32711@section The Server Prefix 32712@cindex server prefix 32713 32714If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect 32715the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which 32716command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This 32717means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in 32718a transparent manner. 32719 32720The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into 32721the value history; to print a value without recording it into the 32722value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the 32723@code{print} command. 32724 32725Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests 32726(@pxref{confirmation requests}). 32727 32728@node Prompting 32729@section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input 32730 32731@cindex annotations for prompts 32732When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible 32733to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is 32734over, etc. 32735 32736Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each 32737input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which 32738denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain 32739annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-} 32740annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be 32741associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type 32742features the following annotations: 32743 32744@smallexample 32745^Z^Zpre-prompt 32746^Z^Zprompt 32747^Z^Zpost-prompt 32748@end smallexample 32749 32750The input types are 32751 32752@table @code 32753@findex pre-prompt annotation 32754@findex prompt annotation 32755@findex post-prompt annotation 32756@item prompt 32757When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt). 32758 32759@findex pre-commands annotation 32760@findex commands annotation 32761@findex post-commands annotation 32762@item commands 32763When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands} 32764command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input. 32765 32766@findex pre-overload-choice annotation 32767@findex overload-choice annotation 32768@findex post-overload-choice annotation 32769@item overload-choice 32770When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions. 32771 32772@findex pre-query annotation 32773@findex query annotation 32774@findex post-query annotation 32775@item query 32776When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation. 32777 32778@findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation 32779@findex prompt-for-continue annotation 32780@findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation 32781@item prompt-for-continue 32782When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't 32783expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable 32784prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the 32785presence of annotations. 32786@end table 32787 32788@node Errors 32789@section Errors 32790@cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts 32791 32792@findex quit annotation 32793@smallexample 32794^Z^Zquit 32795@end smallexample 32796 32797This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt. 32798 32799@findex error annotation 32800@smallexample 32801^Z^Zerror 32802@end smallexample 32803 32804This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error. 32805 32806Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was 32807in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a 32808@code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one 32809cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One 32810cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation 32811does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way 32812to the top level. 32813 32814@findex error-begin annotation 32815A quit or error annotation may be preceded by 32816 32817@smallexample 32818^Z^Zerror-begin 32819@end smallexample 32820 32821Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error 32822message. 32823 32824Warning messages are not yet annotated. 32825@c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(), 32826@c range_error(), and possibly other places. 32827 32828@node Invalidation 32829@section Invalidation Notices 32830 32831@cindex annotations for invalidation messages 32832The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have 32833changed. 32834 32835@table @code 32836@findex frames-invalid annotation 32837@item ^Z^Zframes-invalid 32838 32839The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may 32840have changed. 32841 32842@findex breakpoints-invalid annotation 32843@item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid 32844 32845The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or 32846deleted a breakpoint. 32847@end table 32848 32849@node Annotations for Running 32850@section Running the Program 32851@cindex annotations for running programs 32852 32853@findex starting annotation 32854@findex stopping annotation 32855When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as 32856@code{step} or @code{continue}, 32857 32858@smallexample 32859^Z^Zstarting 32860@end smallexample 32861 32862is output. When the program stops, 32863 32864@smallexample 32865^Z^Zstopped 32866@end smallexample 32867 32868is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of 32869annotations describe how the program stopped. 32870 32871@table @code 32872@findex exited annotation 32873@item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status} 32874The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for 32875successful exit, otherwise nonzero). 32876 32877@findex signalled annotation 32878@findex signal-name annotation 32879@findex signal-name-end annotation 32880@findex signal-string annotation 32881@findex signal-string-end annotation 32882@item ^Z^Zsignalled 32883The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the 32884annotation continues: 32885 32886@smallexample 32887@var{intro-text} 32888^Z^Zsignal-name 32889@var{name} 32890^Z^Zsignal-name-end 32891@var{middle-text} 32892^Z^Zsignal-string 32893@var{string} 32894^Z^Zsignal-string-end 32895@var{end-text} 32896@end smallexample 32897 32898@noindent 32899where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or 32900@code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such 32901as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments 32902@var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the 32903user's benefit and have no particular format. 32904 32905@findex signal annotation 32906@item ^Z^Zsignal 32907The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is 32908just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was 32909terminated with it. 32910 32911@findex breakpoint annotation 32912@item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number} 32913The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}. 32914 32915@findex watchpoint annotation 32916@item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number} 32917The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}. 32918@end table 32919 32920@node Source Annotations 32921@section Displaying Source 32922@cindex annotations for source display 32923 32924@findex source annotation 32925The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code: 32926 32927@smallexample 32928^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr} 32929@end smallexample 32930 32931where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source 32932file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the 32933first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position 32934within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most 32935debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line), 32936@var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the 32937line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and 32938@var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the 32939source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x} 32940followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not 32941depend on the language). 32942 32943@node JIT Interface 32944@chapter JIT Compilation Interface 32945@cindex just-in-time compilation 32946@cindex JIT compilation interface 32947 32948This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation 32949interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native 32950executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good 32951performance while maintaining platform independence. 32952 32953Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because 32954portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from 32955object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols 32956and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation, 32957@value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory 32958symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime. 32959 32960If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then 32961it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If 32962you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest 32963of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the 32964LLVM JIT. 32965 32966Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The 32967JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global 32968variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN} 32969attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to 32970find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find 32971out about additional code. 32972 32973@menu 32974* Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations 32975* Registering Code:: Steps to register code 32976* Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code 32977* Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format 32978@end menu 32979 32980@node Declarations 32981@section JIT Declarations 32982 32983These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to 32984implement the interface: 32985 32986@smallexample 32987typedef enum 32988@{ 32989 JIT_NOACTION = 0, 32990 JIT_REGISTER_FN, 32991 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN 32992@} jit_actions_t; 32993 32994struct jit_code_entry 32995@{ 32996 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry; 32997 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry; 32998 const char *symfile_addr; 32999 uint64_t symfile_size; 33000@}; 33001 33002struct jit_descriptor 33003@{ 33004 uint32_t version; 33005 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t 33006 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */ 33007 uint32_t action_flag; 33008 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry; 33009 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry; 33010@}; 33011 33012/* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */ 33013void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @}; 33014 33015/* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the 33016 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */ 33017struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @}; 33018@end smallexample 33019 33020If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any 33021modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting 33022a global mutex around modifications to these structures. 33023 33024@node Registering Code 33025@section Registering Code 33026 33027To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol: 33028 33029@itemize @bullet 33030@item 33031Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug 33032information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections. 33033 33034@item 33035Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol 33036file. 33037 33038@item 33039Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor. 33040 33041@item 33042Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry. 33043 33044@item 33045Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call 33046@code{__jit_debug_register_code}. 33047@end itemize 33048 33049When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the 33050@code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for 33051new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow 33052@value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files. 33053 33054@node Unregistering Code 33055@section Unregistering Code 33056 33057If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol: 33058 33059@itemize @bullet 33060@item 33061Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list. 33062 33063@item 33064Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry. 33065 33066@item 33067Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call 33068@code{__jit_debug_register_code}. 33069@end itemize 33070 33071If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN} 33072and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files. 33073 33074@node Custom Debug Info 33075@section Custom Debug Info 33076@cindex custom JIT debug info 33077@cindex JIT debug info reader 33078 33079Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF 33080or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the 33081debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The 33082issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info 33083format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated 33084by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing 33085such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file 33086@file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at 33087@file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion. 33088 33089The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is 33090not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at 33091runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and 33092@code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload 33093the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared 33094object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT 33095compiler. 33096 33097@menu 33098* Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly 33099* Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader 33100@end menu 33101 33102@node Using JIT Debug Info Readers 33103@subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers 33104@kindex jit-reader-load 33105@kindex jit-reader-unload 33106 33107Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load} 33108and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands. 33109 33110@table @code 33111@item jit-reader-load @var{reader} 33112Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared 33113object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In 33114the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a 33115pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX 33116system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often 33117@file{/usr/local/lib}). 33118 33119Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second 33120reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN} 33121reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading 33122the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking 33123@code{jit-reader-load}. 33124 33125@item jit-reader-unload 33126Unload the currently loaded JIT reader. 33127 33128@end table 33129 33130@node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers 33131@subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers 33132@cindex writing JIT debug info readers 33133 33134As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a 33135certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}. 33136 33137@file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions 33138required to write a reader. It is installed (along with 33139@value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is 33140the system include directory. 33141 33142Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader 33143can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro 33144@code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file. 33145 33146The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader}, 33147which is expected to be a function with the prototype 33148 33149@findex gdb_init_reader 33150@smallexample 33151extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void); 33152@end smallexample 33153 33154@cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} 33155 33156@code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback 33157functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info 33158generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames 33159(@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs 33160(@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the 33161reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this 33162 33163@smallexample 33164struct gdb_reader_funcs 33165@{ 33166 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */ 33167 int reader_version; 33168 33169 /* For use by the reader. */ 33170 void *priv_data; 33171 33172 gdb_read_debug_info *read; 33173 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind; 33174 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id; 33175 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy; 33176@}; 33177@end smallexample 33178 33179@cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} 33180@cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks} 33181 33182The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by 33183@value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are 33184passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind} 33185and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}. 33186@code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object 33187files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct 33188gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current 33189frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous 33190frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the 33191target's address space. 33192 33193@node In-Process Agent 33194@chapter In-Process Agent 33195@cindex debugging agent 33196The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine, 33197because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However, 33198as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and 33199multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more 33200and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for 33201example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's 33202timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications, 33203it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution 33204long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior. 33205If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays 33206introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the 33207code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's 33208behavior without interrupting it. 33209 33210Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce 33211some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can 33212reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The 33213@dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same 33214process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations 33215itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and 33216performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that 33217interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely, 33218because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program. 33219 33220The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions 33221(@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The 33222agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting 33223data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints. 33224 33225@anchor{Control Agent} 33226You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for 33227debugging with the following commands: 33228 33229@table @code 33230@kindex set agent on 33231@item set agent on 33232Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the 33233debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done 33234by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example, 33235if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent, 33236and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint 33237conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent. 33238 33239@kindex set agent off 33240@item set agent off 33241Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All 33242of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}. 33243 33244@kindex show agent 33245@item show agent 33246Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by 33247the in-process agent. 33248@end table 33249 33250@menu 33251* In-Process Agent Protocol:: 33252@end menu 33253 33254@node In-Process Agent Protocol 33255@section In-Process Agent Protocol 33256@cindex in-process agent protocol 33257 33258The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and 33259GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol 33260used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA. 33261In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands 33262(@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then 33263in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or 33264some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed 33265of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite 33266types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}). 33267 33268@menu 33269* IPA Protocol Objects:: 33270* IPA Protocol Commands:: 33271@end menu 33272 33273@node IPA Protocol Objects 33274@subsection IPA Protocol Objects 33275@cindex ipa protocol objects 33276 33277The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some 33278complex data types called @dfn{objects}. 33279 33280The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN} 33281or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between 33282two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle. 33283However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes: 33284 33285@enumerate 33286@item 33287word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be 33288compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one. 33289@item 33290ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or 33291GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with 33292the other one. 33293@end enumerate 33294 33295Here are the IPA Protocol Objects: 33296 33297@enumerate 33298@item 33299agent expression object. It represents an agent expression 33300(@pxref{Agent Expressions}). 33301@anchor{agent expression object} 33302@item 33303tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action 33304(@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers, 33305memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression. 33306@anchor{tracepoint action object} 33307@item 33308tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}). 33309@anchor{tracepoint object} 33310 33311@end enumerate 33312 33313The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol 33314object: 33315 33316@multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50 33317@headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description 33318@item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab 33319@item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code 33320@item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code 33321@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab 33322@item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33323@item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the 33324address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset 33325of @var{basereg} for memory collecting. 33326@item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting 33327@item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting 33328memory address for collecting. 33329@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab 33330@item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33331@item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab 33332@item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33333@item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab 33334@item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action 33335@item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object} 33336@item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab 33337@item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint 33338@item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on 33339@item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint 33340@item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint 33341@item step_count @tab 8 @tab step 33342@item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass 33343@item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions 33344@item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count 33345@item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage 33346@item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition 33347@item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size 33348@item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of 33349@ref{agent expression object} 33350@tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is 33351@ref{agent expression object} 33352@item actions @tab variable 33353@tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object} 33354@end multitable 33355 33356@node IPA Protocol Commands 33357@subsection IPA Protocol Commands 33358@cindex ipa protocol commands 33359 33360The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands 33361specification. They don't exist in real commands. 33362 33363@table @samp 33364 33365@item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} 33366Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object} 33367(@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the 33368head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine 33369in IPA finally. 33370 33371Replies: 33372@table @samp 33373@item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump} 33374@var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior. 33375The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of 33376@var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long. 33377The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry. 33378The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}. 33379@item E @var{NN} 33380for an error 33381 33382@end table 33383 33384@item close 33385Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver 33386is about to kill inferiors. 33387 33388@item qTfSTM 33389@xref{qTfSTM}. 33390@item qTsSTM 33391@xref{qTsSTM}. 33392@item qTSTMat 33393@xref{qTSTMat}. 33394@item probe_marker_at:@var{address} 33395Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}. 33396 33397Replies: 33398@table @samp 33399@item E @var{NN} 33400for an error 33401@end table 33402@item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address} 33403Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}. 33404@end table 33405 33406@node GDB Bugs 33407@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN} 33408@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN} 33409@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN} 33410 33411Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable. 33412 33413Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it 33414may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help 33415the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug 33416reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}. 33417 33418In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the 33419information that enables us to fix the bug. 33420 33421@menu 33422* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug? 33423* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs 33424@end menu 33425 33426@node Bug Criteria 33427@section Have You Found a Bug? 33428@cindex bug criteria 33429 33430If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines: 33431 33432@itemize @bullet 33433@cindex fatal signal 33434@cindex debugger crash 33435@cindex crash of debugger 33436@item 33437If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a 33438@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash. 33439 33440@cindex error on valid input 33441@item 33442If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a 33443bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be 33444somewhere in the connection to the target.) 33445 33446@cindex invalid input 33447@item 33448If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input, 33449that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of 33450``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support 33451for traditional practice''. 33452 33453@item 33454If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions 33455for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case. 33456@end itemize 33457 33458@node Bug Reporting 33459@section How to Report Bugs 33460@cindex bug reports 33461@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting 33462 33463A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products. 33464If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you 33465contact that organization first. 33466 33467You can find contact information for many support companies and 33468individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs 33469distribution. 33470@c should add a web page ref... 33471 33472@ifset BUGURL 33473@ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT 33474In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for 33475@value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using 33476@uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web 33477page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can 33478be used. 33479 33480@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to 33481@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do 33482not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive 33483@samp{bug-gdb}. 33484 33485The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which 33486serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly 33487the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the 33488newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one 33489problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail 33490path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information, 33491we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send 33492bug reports to the mailing list. 33493@end ifset 33494@ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT 33495In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for 33496@value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}. 33497@end ifclear 33498@end ifset 33499 33500The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this: 33501@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a 33502fact or leave it out, state it! 33503 33504Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the 33505problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might 33506assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter. 33507Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a 33508stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that 33509name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents 33510of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite 33511the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the 33512easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful. 33513 33514Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the 33515bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither 33516you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and 33517self-contained. 33518 33519Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a 33520bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to 33521@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report 33522bugs properly. 33523 33524To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things: 33525 33526@itemize @bullet 33527@item 33528The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start 33529with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show 33530version}. 33531 33532Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for 33533the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}. 33534 33535@item 33536The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and 33537version number. 33538 33539@item 33540The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration. 33541@value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the 33542@option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type 33543@code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt. 33544 33545@item 33546What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@: 33547``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''. 33548 33549@item 33550What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are 33551debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP 33552C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version} 33553to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for 33554those compilers. 33555 33556@item 33557The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and 33558observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee 33559you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the 33560Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient. 33561 33562If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong 33563and then we might not encounter the bug. 33564 33565@item 33566A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will 33567reproduce the bug. 33568 33569@item 33570A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is 33571incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.'' 33572 33573Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we 33574will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might 33575not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us 33576a chance to make a mistake. 33577 33578Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still 33579say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your 33580copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in 33581the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might 33582crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when 33583ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for 33584us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able 33585to draw any conclusion from our observations. 33586 33587@pindex script 33588@cindex recording a session script 33589To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program 33590such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems. 33591Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then 33592include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report. 33593 33594Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN} 33595inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file. 33596 33597@item 33598If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context 33599diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to 33600it by context, not by line number. 33601 33602The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your 33603sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us. 33604 33605@end itemize 33606 33607Here are some things that are not necessary: 33608 33609@itemize @bullet 33610@item 33611A description of the envelope of the bug. 33612 33613Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating 33614which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which 33615changes will not affect it. 33616 33617This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we 33618will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger 33619with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples. 33620We recommend that you save your time for something else. 33621 33622Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead} 33623of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the 33624output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take 33625less time, and so on. 33626 33627However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this, 33628report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used. 33629 33630@item 33631A patch for the bug. 33632 33633A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit 33634the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that 33635a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide 33636to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all. 33637 33638Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to 33639construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path 33640through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able 33641to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed. 33642 33643And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your 33644patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will 33645help us to understand. 33646 33647@item 33648A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on. 33649 33650Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such 33651things without first using the debugger to find the facts. 33652@end itemize 33653 33654@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code 33655@c and consists of the two following files: 33656@c rluser.texi 33657@c hsuser.texi 33658@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory, 33659@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX. 33660@ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE 33661@include rluser.texi 33662@include hsuser.texi 33663@end ifclear 33664 33665@node In Memoriam 33666@appendix In Memoriam 33667 33668The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time 33669contributors: 33670 33671@table @code 33672@item Fred Fish 33673Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and 33674to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in 33675the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project. 33676 33677@item Michael Snyder 33678Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project, 33679with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition 33680to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind 33681adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}. 33682@end table 33683 33684Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also 33685enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them. 33686 33687@node Formatting Documentation 33688@appendix Formatting Documentation 33689 33690@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card 33691@cindex reference card 33692The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready 33693for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb} 33694subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In 33695@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN} 33696release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer, 33697you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}. 33698 33699The release also includes the source for the reference card. You 33700can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing: 33701 33702@smallexample 33703make refcard.dvi 33704@end smallexample 33705 33706The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape} 33707mode on US ``letter'' size paper; 33708that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches 33709high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to 33710your @sc{dvi} output program. 33711 33712@cindex documentation 33713 33714All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable 33715distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is 33716a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both 33717on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info 33718formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation 33719and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version. 33720 33721@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info 33722version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info 33723file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to 33724subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If 33725necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor; 33726but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu} 33727Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the 33728@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution. 33729 33730If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the 33731Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or 33732@code{makeinfo}. 33733 33734If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level 33735@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of 33736version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing: 33737 33738@smallexample 33739cd gdb 33740make gdb.info 33741@end smallexample 33742 33743If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{}, 33744a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the 33745Texinfo definitions file. 33746 33747@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but 33748produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset 33749document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system 33750has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise 33751command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another 33752(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may 33753require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension. 33754 33755@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called 33756@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document 33757written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or 33758typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB 33759and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo} 33760directory. 33761 33762If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can 33763typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb} 33764subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to 33765@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type: 33766 33767@smallexample 33768make gdb.dvi 33769@end smallexample 33770 33771Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program. 33772 33773@node Installing GDB 33774@appendix Installing @value{GDBN} 33775@cindex installation 33776 33777@menu 33778* Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN} 33779* Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script 33780* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory 33781* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets 33782* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure 33783* System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file 33784@end menu 33785 33786@node Requirements 33787@section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN} 33788@cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for 33789 33790Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available. 33791Other packages will be used only if they are found. 33792 33793@heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN} 33794@table @asis 33795@item ISO C90 compiler 33796@value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any 33797working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC. 33798 33799@end table 33800 33801@heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN} 33802@table @asis 33803@item Expat 33804@anchor{Expat} 33805@value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be 33806included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you 33807can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}. 33808The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several 33809standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can 33810use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location. 33811 33812Expat is used for: 33813 33814@itemize @bullet 33815@item 33816Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format}) 33817@item 33818Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) 33819@item 33820Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format}, 33821or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}) 33822@item 33823MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries}) 33824@item 33825Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format}) 33826@item 33827Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format}, 33828@pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}) 33829@end itemize 33830 33831@item zlib 33832@cindex compressed debug sections 33833@value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read 33834compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable 33835of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN} 33836is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug 33837information in such binaries. 33838 33839The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system 33840distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from 33841@url{http://zlib.net}. 33842 33843@item iconv 33844@value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character 33845Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are 33846on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some 33847other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}. 33848 33849If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed 33850in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it. 33851This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the 33852directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. 33853 33854On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you 33855have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the 33856@option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure. 33857 33858@value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will 33859arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears 33860in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and 33861if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv} 33862implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used 33863by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU 33864Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the 33865Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}. 33866@end table 33867 33868@node Running Configure 33869@section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script 33870@cindex configuring @value{GDBN} 33871@value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process 33872of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to 33873build the @code{gdb} program. 33874@iftex 33875@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with. 33876@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN}, 33877look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the 33878installation procedures since publishing this manual.} 33879@end iftex 33880 33881The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for 33882@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by 33883appending the version number to @samp{gdb}. 33884 33885For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the 33886@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains: 33887 33888@table @code 33889@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)} 33890script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries 33891 33892@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb 33893the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself 33894 33895@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd 33896source for the Binary File Descriptor library 33897 33898@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include 33899@sc{gnu} include files 33900 33901@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty 33902source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library 33903 33904@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes 33905source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers 33906 33907@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline 33908source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface 33909 33910@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob 33911source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine 33912 33913@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc 33914source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package 33915@end table 33916 33917The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure} 33918from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in 33919this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. 33920 33921First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory 33922if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the 33923identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an 33924argument. 33925 33926For example: 33927 33928@smallexample 33929cd gdb-@value{GDBVN} 33930./configure @var{host} 33931make 33932@end smallexample 33933 33934@noindent 33935where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or 33936@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run. 33937(You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the 33938correct value by examining your system.) 33939 33940Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the 33941@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty} 33942libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the 33943binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories. 33944 33945@need 750 33946@file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your 33947system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different 33948shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly: 33949 33950@smallexample 33951sh configure @var{host} 33952@end smallexample 33953 33954If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source 33955directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the 33956@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, 33957@file{configure} 33958creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless 33959you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option). 33960 33961You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the 33962source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run 33963@file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only 33964that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular, 33965if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory 33966of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the 33967configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling 33968directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors 33969about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}. 33970 33971You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths. 33972However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by 33973the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember 33974that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to 33975let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable. 33976 33977@node Separate Objdir 33978@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory 33979 33980If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines, 33981you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of 33982host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by 33983allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory, 33984rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program 33985handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running 33986@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb} 33987program specified there. 33988 33989To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure} 33990with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source. 33991(You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure} 33992itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure} 33993would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out 33994the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.) 33995 33996For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a 33997separate directory for a Sun 4 like this: 33998 33999@smallexample 34000@group 34001cd gdb-@value{GDBVN} 34002mkdir ../gdb-sun4 34003cd ../gdb-sun4 34004../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4 34005make 34006@end group 34007@end smallexample 34008 34009When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source 34010directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure 34011(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In 34012the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the 34013directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in 34014@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}. 34015 34016Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one 34017instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks 34018like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only 34019one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to 34020build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}. 34021 34022One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate 34023directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where 34024@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging 34025programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}). 34026You specify a cross-debugging target by 34027giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}. 34028 34029When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run 34030it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you 34031called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories). 34032 34033The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source 34034directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source 34035directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured 34036directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you 34037will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB. 34038 34039When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate 34040directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example, 34041if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere 34042with each other. 34043 34044@node Config Names 34045@section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets 34046 34047The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure} 34048script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined 34049aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces 34050of information in the following pattern: 34051 34052@smallexample 34053@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os} 34054@end smallexample 34055 34056For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument, 34057or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}} 34058option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}. 34059 34060The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide 34061any query facility to list all supported host and target names or 34062aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script 34063@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the 34064script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on 34065abbreviations---for example: 34066 34067@smallexample 34068% sh config.sub i386-linux 34069i386-pc-linux-gnu 34070% sh config.sub alpha-linux 34071alpha-unknown-linux-gnu 34072% sh config.sub hp9k700 34073hppa1.1-hp-hpux 34074% sh config.sub sun4 34075sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1 34076% sh config.sub sun3 34077m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1 34078% sh config.sub i986v 34079Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized 34080@end smallexample 34081 34082@noindent 34083@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source 34084directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}). 34085 34086@node Configure Options 34087@section @file{configure} Options 34088 34089Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that 34090are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has 34091several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure 34092Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}. 34093 34094@smallexample 34095configure @r{[}--help@r{]} 34096 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]} 34097 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]} 34098 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]} 34099 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]} 34100 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]} 34101 @var{host} 34102@end smallexample 34103 34104@noindent 34105You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than 34106@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use 34107@samp{--}. 34108 34109@table @code 34110@item --help 34111Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}. 34112 34113@item --prefix=@var{dir} 34114Configure the source to install programs and files under directory 34115@file{@var{dir}}. 34116 34117@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir} 34118Configure the source to install programs under directory 34119@file{@var{dir}}. 34120 34121@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation: 34122@need 2000 34123@item --srcdir=@var{dirname} 34124@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another 34125@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@* 34126Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the 34127@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to 34128build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate 34129directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in 34130the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the 34131directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under 34132the working directory in parallel to the source directories below 34133@var{dirname}. 34134 34135@item --norecursion 34136Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not 34137propagate configuration to subdirectories. 34138 34139@item --target=@var{target} 34140Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified 34141@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug 34142programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself. 34143 34144There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets. 34145 34146@item @var{host} @dots{} 34147Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}. 34148 34149There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts. 34150@end table 34151 34152There are many other options available as well, but they are generally 34153needed for special purposes only. 34154 34155@node System-wide configuration 34156@section System-wide configuration and settings 34157@cindex system-wide init file 34158 34159@value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file; 34160this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What 34161@value{GDBN} does during startup}). 34162 34163Here is the corresponding configure option: 34164 34165@table @code 34166@item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file} 34167Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is 34168@var{file}. 34169@end table 34170 34171If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix}, 34172it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases: 34173 34174@itemize @bullet 34175@item 34176If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix}, 34177it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options 34178are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit}; 34179if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system 34180init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of 34181@file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}. 34182 34183@item 34184By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix, 34185it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with 34186@option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit}, 34187then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit}, 34188wherever @value{GDBN} is installed. 34189@end itemize 34190 34191If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the 34192@option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the 34193data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure 34194time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the 34195system-wide init file in the directory specified by the 34196@option{--data-directory} command-line option. 34197Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN} 34198initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has 34199started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be 34200reread. 34201 34202@menu 34203* System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts 34204@end menu 34205 34206@node System-wide Configuration Scripts 34207@subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts 34208@cindex system-wide configuration scripts 34209 34210The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory 34211(as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains 34212a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To 34213automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be 34214configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user 34215should be able to source them by hand as needed. 34216 34217The following scripts are currently available: 34218@itemize @bullet 34219 34220@item @file{elinos.py} 34221@pindex elinos.py 34222@cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script 34223This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target. 34224It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard 34225ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system 34226shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} 34227and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately. 34228 34229@item @file{wrs-linux.py} 34230@pindex wrs-linux.py 34231@cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script 34232This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running 34233Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to 34234the host-side sysroot used by the target system. 34235 34236@end itemize 34237 34238@node Maintenance Commands 34239@appendix Maintenance Commands 34240@cindex maintenance commands 34241@cindex internal commands 34242 34243In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN} 34244includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers, 34245that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are 34246provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging 34247messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.) 34248 34249@table @code 34250@kindex maint agent 34251@kindex maint agent-eval 34252@item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression} 34253@itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression} 34254Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes. 34255This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism 34256(@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an 34257expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while 34258@samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly 34259to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa + 34260globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each 34261of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding 34262the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the 34263addition and return the sum. 34264If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}. 34265If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address. 34266 34267@kindex maint agent-printf 34268@item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},... 34269Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions 34270into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list. 34271This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic 34272printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}). 34273 34274@kindex maint info breakpoints 34275@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints 34276Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the 34277breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for 34278internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative 34279breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint 34280is shown: 34281 34282@table @code 34283@item breakpoint 34284Normal, explicitly set breakpoint. 34285 34286@item watchpoint 34287Normal, explicitly set watchpoint. 34288 34289@item longjmp 34290Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through 34291@code{longjmp} calls. 34292 34293@item longjmp resume 34294Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}. 34295 34296@item until 34297Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command. 34298 34299@item finish 34300Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command. 34301 34302@item shlib events 34303Shared library events. 34304 34305@end table 34306 34307@kindex maint info btrace 34308@item maint info btrace 34309Pint information about raw branch tracing data. 34310 34311@kindex maint btrace packet-history 34312@item maint btrace packet-history 34313Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the 34314execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the 34315information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace 34316recording format. 34317 34318@table @code 34319@item bts 34320For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential 34321code. For each block, the following information is printed: 34322 34323@table @asis 34324@item Block number 34325Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero. 34326@item Lowest @samp{PC} 34327@item Highest @samp{PC} 34328@end table 34329 34330@item pt 34331For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of 34332Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following 34333information is printed: 34334 34335@table @asis 34336@item Packet number 34337Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero. 34338@item Trace offset 34339The packet's offset in the trace stream. 34340@item Packet opcode and payload 34341@end table 34342@end table 34343 34344@kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history 34345@item maint btrace clear-packet-history 34346Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace 34347packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when 34348needed. 34349 34350@kindex maint btrace clear 34351@item maint btrace clear 34352Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the 34353branch trace will be recomputed when needed. 34354 34355This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace 34356buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace 34357available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace 34358buffer. 34359 34360@kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad 34361@item maint set btrace pt skip-pad 34362@kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad 34363@item maint show btrace pt skip-pad 34364Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the 34365packet history. 34366 34367@kindex set displaced-stepping 34368@kindex show displaced-stepping 34369@cindex displaced stepping support 34370@cindex out-of-line single-stepping 34371@item set displaced-stepping 34372@itemx show displaced-stepping 34373Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping} 34374if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step 34375over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing 34376an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the 34377breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping. 34378 34379@table @code 34380@item set displaced-stepping on 34381If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use 34382displaced stepping to step over breakpoints. 34383 34384@item set displaced-stepping off 34385@value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints, 34386even if such is supported by the target architecture. 34387 34388@cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping} 34389@item set displaced-stepping auto 34390This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping 34391only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target 34392architecture supports displaced stepping. 34393@end table 34394 34395@kindex maint check-psymtabs 34396@item maint check-psymtabs 34397Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs. 34398Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other. 34399 34400@kindex maint check-symtabs 34401@item maint check-symtabs 34402Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs. 34403 34404@kindex maint expand-symtabs 34405@item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}] 34406Expand symbol tables. 34407If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file 34408names matching @var{regexp}. 34409 34410@kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes 34411@kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes 34412@cindex demangler crashes 34413@item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off] 34414@itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes 34415Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the 34416symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes. 34417If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created, 34418the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the 34419option to terminate the current session. 34420 34421@kindex maint cplus first_component 34422@item maint cplus first_component @var{name} 34423Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}. 34424 34425@kindex maint cplus namespace 34426@item maint cplus namespace 34427Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces. 34428 34429@kindex maint deprecate 34430@kindex maint undeprecate 34431@cindex deprecated commands 34432@item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]} 34433@itemx maint undeprecate @var{command} 34434Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands 34435cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional 34436argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in 34437favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention 34438the replacement as part of the warning. 34439 34440@kindex maint dump-me 34441@item maint dump-me 34442@cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN} 34443Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core. 34444This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program 34445with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal. 34446 34447@kindex maint internal-error 34448@kindex maint internal-warning 34449@kindex maint demangler-warning 34450@cindex demangler crashes 34451@item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 34452@itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 34453@itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]} 34454 34455Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}, 34456@code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave 34457as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to 34458reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the 34459opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error} 34460and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current 34461@value{GDBN} session. 34462 34463These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is 34464used as the text of the error or warning message. 34465 34466Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}: 34467 34468@smallexample 34469(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2} 34470@dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2 34471A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further 34472debugging may prove unreliable. 34473Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n} 34474Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n} 34475(@value{GDBP}) 34476@end smallexample 34477 34478@cindex @value{GDBN} internal error 34479@cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior 34480@cindex demangler crashes 34481 34482@kindex maint set internal-error 34483@kindex maint show internal-error 34484@kindex maint set internal-warning 34485@kindex maint show internal-warning 34486@kindex maint set demangler-warning 34487@kindex maint show demangler-warning 34488@item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 34489@itemx maint show internal-error @var{action} 34490@itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 34491@itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action} 34492@itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no] 34493@itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action} 34494When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it 34495gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a 34496core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you 34497override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action}, 34498described in the table below. 34499 34500@table @samp 34501@item quit 34502You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no) 34503quit. The default is to ask the user what to do. 34504 34505@item corefile 34506You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no) 34507create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note 34508that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}: 34509demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be 34510disabled. 34511@end table 34512 34513@kindex maint packet 34514@item maint packet @var{text} 34515If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol, 34516then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and 34517displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial 34518@samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the 34519checksum. 34520 34521@kindex maint print architecture 34522@item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34523Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument 34524@var{file} names the file where the output goes. 34525 34526@kindex maint print c-tdesc 34527@item maint print c-tdesc 34528Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as 34529a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN} 34530when an XML parser is not available to parse the description. 34531 34532@kindex maint print dummy-frames 34533@item maint print dummy-frames 34534Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack. 34535 34536@smallexample 34537(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add} 34538@dots{} 34539(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)} 34540Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{} 3454158 return (a + b); 34542The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB. 34543@dots{} 34544(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames} 345450xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353 34546(@value{GDBP}) 34547@end smallexample 34548 34549Takes an optional file parameter. 34550 34551@kindex maint print registers 34552@kindex maint print raw-registers 34553@kindex maint print cooked-registers 34554@kindex maint print register-groups 34555@kindex maint print remote-registers 34556@item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34557@itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34558@itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34559@itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34560@itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34561Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures. 34562 34563The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of 34564the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print 34565cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers, 34566including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible 34567to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the 34568groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint 34569print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers 34570and offsets in the `G' packets. 34571 34572These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to 34573write the information. 34574 34575@kindex maint print reggroups 34576@item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]} 34577Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The 34578optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the 34579information. 34580 34581The register groups info looks like this: 34582 34583@smallexample 34584(@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups} 34585 Group Type 34586 general user 34587 float user 34588 all user 34589 vector user 34590 system user 34591 save internal 34592 restore internal 34593@end smallexample 34594 34595@kindex flushregs 34596@item flushregs 34597This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache. 34598 34599@kindex maint print objfiles 34600@cindex info for known object files 34601@item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]} 34602Print a dump of all known object files. 34603If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names 34604match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name, 34605address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs. 34606 34607@kindex maint print user-registers 34608@cindex user registers 34609@item maint print user-registers 34610List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers 34611typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They 34612include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc}, 34613@code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User 34614registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical 34615register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info 34616registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands. 34617 34618@kindex maint print section-scripts 34619@cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts 34620@item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}] 34621Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section. 34622If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files 34623matching @var{regexp}. 34624For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile, 34625and the full path if known. 34626@xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}. 34627 34628@kindex maint print statistics 34629@cindex bcache statistics 34630@item maint print statistics 34631This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data 34632about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache}) 34633statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number 34634of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types 34635defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables, 34636the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory 34637used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts, 34638sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max, 34639average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and 34640savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain 34641lengths. 34642 34643@kindex maint print target-stack 34644@cindex target stack description 34645@item maint print target-stack 34646A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular 34647kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata}, 34648so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request. 34649In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets 34650until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular 34651address. 34652 34653This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on 34654the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one. 34655 34656@kindex maint print type 34657@cindex type chain of a data type 34658@item maint print type @var{expr} 34659Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument 34660can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of 34661that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is 34662a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s 34663data structures, including its flags and contained types. 34664 34665@kindex maint selftest 34666@cindex self tests 34667Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will 34668print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed. 34669 34670@kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble 34671@kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble 34672@item maint set dwarf always-disassemble 34673@item maint show dwarf always-disassemble 34674Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging 34675information. 34676 34677The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to 34678describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When 34679@code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location 34680expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are 34681too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will 34682always see the disassembly form. 34683 34684Here is an example of the resulting disassembly: 34685 34686@smallexample 34687(gdb) info addr argc 34688Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression: 34689 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0 34690@end smallexample 34691 34692For more information on these expressions, see 34693@uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}. 34694 34695@kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age 34696@kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age 34697@item maint set dwarf max-cache-age 34698@itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age 34699Control the DWARF compilation unit cache. 34700 34701@cindex DWARF compilation units cache 34702In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those 34703produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 34704reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units. 34705This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the 34706cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached 34707compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total 34708memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will 34709slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption. 34710 34711@kindex maint set profile 34712@kindex maint show profile 34713@cindex profiling GDB 34714@item maint set profile 34715@itemx maint show profile 34716Control profiling of @value{GDBN}. 34717 34718Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile} 34719command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin 34720collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or 34721exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that 34722if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file 34723(often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling 34724data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location. 34725 34726Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be 34727compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option. 34728 34729@kindex maint set show-debug-regs 34730@kindex maint show show-debug-regs 34731@cindex hardware debug registers 34732@item maint set show-debug-regs 34733@itemx maint show show-debug-regs 34734Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug 34735registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If 34736enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or 34737removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior 34738triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint. 34739 34740@kindex maint set show-all-tib 34741@kindex maint show show-all-tib 34742@item maint set show-all-tib 34743@itemx maint show show-all-tib 34744Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting 34745at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block} 34746command. 34747 34748@kindex maint set target-async 34749@kindex maint show target-async 34750@item maint set target-async 34751@itemx maint show target-async 34752This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or 34753asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the 34754default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed 34755to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode. 34756 34757@kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto] 34758@kindex maint show target-non-stop 34759@item maint set target-non-stop 34760@itemx maint show target-non-stop 34761 34762This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop 34763mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop 34764Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled 34765if supported by the target. 34766 34767@table @code 34768@item maint set target-non-stop auto 34769This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in 34770non-stop mode if the target supports it. 34771 34772@item maint set target-non-stop on 34773@value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target 34774does not indicate support. 34775 34776@item maint set target-non-stop off 34777@value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the 34778target supports it. 34779@end table 34780 34781@kindex maint set per-command 34782@kindex maint show per-command 34783@item maint set per-command 34784@itemx maint show per-command 34785@cindex resources used by commands 34786 34787@value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command. 34788This is useful in debugging performance problems. 34789 34790@table @code 34791@item maint set per-command space [on|off] 34792@itemx maint show per-command space 34793Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command. 34794If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command 34795took, following the command's own output. 34796This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the 34797@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}). 34798 34799@item maint set per-command time [on|off] 34800@itemx maint show per-command time 34801Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN} 34802for each command. 34803If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it 34804took to execute each command, following the command's own output. 34805Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed. 34806Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is 34807CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency. 34808Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include 34809the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently 34810to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was 34811spent by the program been debugged. 34812This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the 34813@option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}). 34814 34815@item maint set per-command symtab [on|off] 34816@itemx maint show per-command symtab 34817Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics 34818for each command. 34819If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information: 34820 34821@enumerate a 34822@item 34823number of symbol tables 34824@item 34825number of primary symbol tables 34826@item 34827number of blocks in the blockvector 34828@end enumerate 34829@end table 34830 34831@kindex maint space 34832@cindex memory used by commands 34833@item maint space @var{value} 34834An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}. 34835A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it. 34836 34837@kindex maint time 34838@cindex time of command execution 34839@item maint time @var{value} 34840An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}. 34841A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it. 34842 34843@kindex maint translate-address 34844@item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr} 34845Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address 34846@var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found, 34847@value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from 34848the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to 34849the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this 34850command also allows to find symbols in other sections. 34851 34852If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found 34853is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of 34854executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well. 34855 34856@end table 34857 34858The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of 34859@value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite. 34860 34861@table @code 34862@item set watchdog @var{nsec} 34863@kindex set watchdog 34864@cindex watchdog timer 34865@cindex timeout for commands 34866Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the 34867target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN} 34868reports and error and the command is aborted. 34869 34870@item show watchdog 34871Show the current setting of the target wait timeout. 34872@end table 34873 34874@node Remote Protocol 34875@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol 34876 34877@menu 34878* Overview:: 34879* Packets:: 34880* Stop Reply Packets:: 34881* General Query Packets:: 34882* Architecture-Specific Protocol Details:: 34883* Tracepoint Packets:: 34884* Host I/O Packets:: 34885* Interrupts:: 34886* Notification Packets:: 34887* Remote Non-Stop:: 34888* Packet Acknowledgment:: 34889* Examples:: 34890* File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension:: 34891* Library List Format:: 34892* Library List Format for SVR4 Targets:: 34893* Memory Map Format:: 34894* Thread List Format:: 34895* Traceframe Info Format:: 34896* Branch Trace Format:: 34897* Branch Trace Configuration Format:: 34898@end menu 34899 34900@node Overview 34901@section Overview 34902 34903There may be occasions when you need to know something about the 34904protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target 34905machine, you might want your program to do something special if it 34906recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}. 34907 34908In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate 34909transmitted and received data, respectively. 34910 34911@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial 34912@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote 34913@cindex remote serial protocol 34914All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments 34915and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a 34916@var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character 34917@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character 34918@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}: 34919 34920@smallexample 34921@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 34922@end smallexample 34923@noindent 34924 34925@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote 34926@noindent 34927The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all 34928characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an 34929eight bit unsigned checksum). 34930 34931Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol 34932specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}: 34933 34934@smallexample 34935@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 34936@end smallexample 34937 34938@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote 34939@noindent 34940That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN} 34941has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added 34942since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}. 34943 34944When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first 34945response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate 34946the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request 34947retransmission): 34948 34949@smallexample 34950-> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum} 34951<- @code{+} 34952@end smallexample 34953@noindent 34954 34955The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled 34956once a connection is established. 34957@xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details. 34958 34959The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the 34960debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In 34961the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent 34962when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all 34963threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode 34964behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop 34965execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details. 34966 34967@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the 34968exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional 34969exceptions). 34970 34971@cindex remote protocol, field separator 34972Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or 34973@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in 34974@sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed. 34975 34976Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character 34977@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it 34978would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}). 34979 34980@cindex remote protocol, binary data 34981@anchor{Binary Data} 34982Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal 34983digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote 34984protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean. 34985Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean 34986connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive 34987binary data. 34988 34989The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}}) 34990as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape 34991character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}. 34992For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two 34993bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}), 34994@code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii} 34995@samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub 34996must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it 34997is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence 34998(described next). 34999 35000Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. 35001Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one 35002instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a 35003repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid 35004binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as 35005@code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this 35006produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii} 35007code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length 35008encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example, 35009@samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character 35010after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 = 350113}} more times. 35012 35013The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value 35014greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or 35015seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only 35016five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as 35017@samp{0*"00}. 35018 35019The error response returned for some packets includes a two character 35020error number. That number is not well defined. 35021 35022@cindex empty response, for unsupported packets 35023For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response 35024(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the 35025protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based 35026on that response. 35027 35028At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G} 35029commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands 35030for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets 35031can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s} 35032(step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should 35033support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional. 35034 35035@node Packets 35036@section Packets 35037 35038The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined 35039@var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}. 35040@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File 35041I/O extension of the remote protocol. 35042 35043Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall 35044syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We 35045include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not 35046part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to 35047separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo 35048@var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII 35049bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a 35050@var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the 35051@samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the 35052@var{baz}. 35053 35054@cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol 35055@anchor{thread-id syntax} 35056Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify 35057a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific 35058interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id} 35059can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to 35060pick any thread. 35061 35062In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in 35063which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both 35064process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}. 35065The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the 35066format described above: a positive number with target-specific 35067interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1} 35068to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to 35069indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as 35070@samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an 35071error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as 35072@samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used 35073for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process 35074ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}. 35075 35076The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both 35077@value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess} 35078feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for 35079more information. 35080 35081Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case 35082letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use. 35083 35084Here are the packet descriptions. 35085 35086@table @samp 35087 35088@item ! 35089@cindex @samp{!} packet 35090@anchor{extended mode} 35091Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made 35092persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being 35093debugged. 35094 35095Reply: 35096@table @samp 35097@item OK 35098The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode. 35099@end table 35100 35101@item ? 35102@cindex @samp{?} packet 35103@anchor{? packet} 35104Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for 35105step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the 35106target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}. 35107 35108Reply: 35109@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35110 35111@item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{} 35112@cindex @samp{A} packet 35113Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen} 35114specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream 35115@var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details. 35116 35117Reply: 35118@table @samp 35119@item OK 35120The arguments were set. 35121@item E @var{NN} 35122An error occurred. 35123@end table 35124 35125@item b @var{baud} 35126@cindex @samp{b} packet 35127(Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.) 35128Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. 35129 35130JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's 35131received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are 35132problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.} 35133 35134Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get 35135it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send 35136some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the 35137switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point 35138of view, nothing actually happened.} 35139 35140@item B @var{addr},@var{mode} 35141@cindex @samp{B} packet 35142Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a 35143breakpoint at @var{addr}. 35144 35145Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead 35146(@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}). 35147 35148@cindex @samp{bc} packet 35149@anchor{bc} 35150@item bc 35151Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter. 35152@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 35153 35154Reply: 35155@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35156 35157@cindex @samp{bs} packet 35158@anchor{bs} 35159@item bs 35160Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter. 35161@xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information. 35162 35163Reply: 35164@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35165 35166@item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]} 35167@cindex @samp{c} packet 35168Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr} 35169is omitted, resume at current address. 35170 35171This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35172packet}. 35173 35174Reply: 35175@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35176 35177@item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]} 35178@cindex @samp{C} packet 35179Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If 35180@samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address. 35181 35182This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35183packet}. 35184 35185Reply: 35186@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35187 35188@item d 35189@cindex @samp{d} packet 35190Toggle debug flag. 35191 35192Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet 35193(@pxref{General Query Packets}). 35194 35195@item D 35196@itemx D;@var{pid} 35197@cindex @samp{D} packet 35198The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the 35199remote system. It is sent to the remote target 35200before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command. 35201 35202The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess 35203protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to 35204detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a 35205big-endian hex string. 35206 35207Reply: 35208@table @samp 35209@item OK 35210for success 35211@item E @var{NN} 35212for an error 35213@end table 35214 35215@item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX} 35216@cindex @samp{F} packet 35217A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target. 35218This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O 35219Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification. 35220 35221@item g 35222@anchor{read registers packet} 35223@cindex @samp{g} packet 35224Read general registers. 35225 35226Reply: 35227@table @samp 35228@item @var{XX@dots{}} 35229Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes 35230with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of 35231each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are 35232determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions 35233@code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The 35234specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below. 35235 35236When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected 35237Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of 35238literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate 35239that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value 35240is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of 352414 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that 35242registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3 35243have been collected, and both have zero value: 35244 35245@smallexample 35246-> @code{g} 35247<- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000} 35248@end smallexample 35249 35250@item E @var{NN} 35251for an error. 35252@end table 35253 35254@item G @var{XX@dots{}} 35255@cindex @samp{G} packet 35256Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a 35257description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data. 35258 35259Reply: 35260@table @samp 35261@item OK 35262for success 35263@item E @var{NN} 35264for an error 35265@end table 35266 35267@item H @var{op} @var{thread-id} 35268@cindex @samp{H} packet 35269Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g}, 35270@samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op} 35271should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this 35272is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better 35273option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator 35274@var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in 35275@ref{thread-id syntax}. 35276 35277Reply: 35278@table @samp 35279@item OK 35280for success 35281@item E @var{NN} 35282for an error 35283@end table 35284 35285@c FIXME: JTC: 35286@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a 35287@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed 35288@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the 35289@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be 35290@c described. For example: 35291@c 35292@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is 35293@c selected, returns the register block from that thread; 35294@c otherwise returns current registers. 35295@c 35296@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is 35297@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of 35298@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers. 35299 35300@item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]} 35301@anchor{cycle step packet} 35302@cindex @samp{i} packet 35303Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is 35304present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle 35305step starting at that address. 35306 35307@item I 35308@cindex @samp{I} packet 35309Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle 35310step packet}. 35311 35312@item k 35313@cindex @samp{k} packet 35314Kill request. 35315 35316The exact effect of this packet is not specified. 35317 35318For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target 35319system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply. 35320 35321For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible. 35322 35323A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all 35324that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use 35325the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}). 35326 35327If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to 35328@samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet 35329acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful. 35330 35331If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does 35332not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN} 35333probes the target state as if a new connection was opened 35334(@pxref{? packet}). 35335 35336@item m @var{addr},@var{length} 35337@cindex @samp{m} packet 35338Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr} 35339(@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to 35340any particular boundary. 35341 35342The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering 35343data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned 35344and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to 35345use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be 35346suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices. 35347@cindex alignment of remote memory accesses 35348@cindex size of remote memory accesses 35349@cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses 35350 35351Reply: 35352@table @samp 35353@item @var{XX@dots{}} 35354Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number. 35355The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the 35356server was able to read only part of the region of memory. 35357@item E @var{NN} 35358@var{NN} is errno 35359@end table 35360 35361@item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}} 35362@cindex @samp{M} packet 35363Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr} 35364(@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each 35365byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number. 35366 35367Reply: 35368@table @samp 35369@item OK 35370for success 35371@item E @var{NN} 35372for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was 35373written). 35374@end table 35375 35376@item p @var{n} 35377@cindex @samp{p} packet 35378Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex. 35379@xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned 35380register value is encoded. 35381 35382Reply: 35383@table @samp 35384@item @var{XX@dots{}} 35385the register's value 35386@item E @var{NN} 35387for an error 35388@item @w{} 35389Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}. 35390@end table 35391 35392@item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}} 35393@anchor{write register packet} 35394@cindex @samp{P} packet 35395Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register 35396number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex 35397digits for each byte in the register (target byte order). 35398 35399Reply: 35400@table @samp 35401@item OK 35402for success 35403@item E @var{NN} 35404for an error 35405@end table 35406 35407@item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{} 35408@itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{} 35409@cindex @samp{q} packet 35410@cindex @samp{Q} packet 35411General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are 35412described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}. 35413 35414@item r 35415@cindex @samp{r} packet 35416Reset the entire system. 35417 35418Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead. 35419 35420@item R @var{XX} 35421@cindex @samp{R} packet 35422Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored. 35423This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 35424 35425The @samp{R} packet has no reply. 35426 35427@item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]} 35428@cindex @samp{s} packet 35429Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If 35430@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address. 35431 35432This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35433packet}. 35434 35435Reply: 35436@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35437 35438@item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]} 35439@anchor{step with signal packet} 35440@cindex @samp{S} packet 35441Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but 35442requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution. 35443 35444This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont 35445packet}. 35446 35447Reply: 35448@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35449 35450@item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM} 35451@cindex @samp{t} packet 35452Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern 35453@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long. 35454There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}. 35455 35456@item T @var{thread-id} 35457@cindex @samp{T} packet 35458Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}. 35459 35460Reply: 35461@table @samp 35462@item OK 35463thread is still alive 35464@item E @var{NN} 35465thread is dead 35466@end table 35467 35468@item v 35469Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name, 35470up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet). 35471 35472@item vAttach;@var{pid} 35473@cindex @samp{vAttach} packet 35474Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}. 35475The process ID is a 35476hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all 35477threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be 35478attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target. 35479 35480@c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the 35481@c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After 35482@c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC. 35483@c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the 35484@c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you 35485@c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not 35486@c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either 35487@c stopping or restarting threads. 35488 35489This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 35490 35491Reply: 35492@table @samp 35493@item E @var{nn} 35494for an error 35495@item @r{Any stop packet} 35496for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) 35497@item OK 35498for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) 35499@end table 35500 35501@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{} 35502@cindex @samp{vCont} packet 35503@anchor{vCont packet} 35504Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread. 35505If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any 35506threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is 35507specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and 35508in their current state in non-stop mode. 35509Specifying multiple 35510default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error. 35511Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. 35512 35513Currently supported actions are: 35514 35515@table @samp 35516@item c 35517Continue. 35518@item C @var{sig} 35519Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits. 35520@item s 35521Step. 35522@item S @var{sig} 35523Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits. 35524@item t 35525Stop. 35526@item r @var{start},@var{end} 35527Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at 35528addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive). 35529The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out 35530of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting 35531a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}. 35532 35533If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action 35534becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words, 35535single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction 35536jumps to @var{start}). 35537 35538(A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within 35539the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet 35540in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.) 35541 35542@end table 35543 35544The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the 35545@samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is 35546not supported in @samp{vCont}. 35547 35548The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode 35549(@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise. 35550A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped. 35551When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action, 35552the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with 35553signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal 35554as an implementation detail. 35555 35556The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for 35557multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in 35558this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads 35559in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the 35560@var{thread-id}. 35561 35562Reply: 35563@xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications. 35564 35565@item vCont? 35566@cindex @samp{vCont?} packet 35567Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet. 35568 35569Reply: 35570@table @samp 35571@item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]} 35572The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported 35573command in the @samp{vCont} packet. 35574@item @w{} 35575The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported. 35576@end table 35577 35578@anchor{vCtrlC packet} 35579@item vCtrlC 35580@cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet 35581Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote 35582terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C} 35583(@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode 35584while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode. 35585@xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop 35586variant. 35587 35588Reply: 35589@table @samp 35590@item E @var{nn} 35591for an error 35592@item OK 35593for success 35594@end table 35595 35596@item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{} 35597@cindex @samp{vFile} packet 35598Perform a file operation on the target system. For details, 35599see @ref{Host I/O Packets}. 35600 35601@item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length} 35602@cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet 35603Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at 35604@var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but 35605its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the 35606flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map 35607Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations 35608together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the 35609stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone} 35610packet is received. 35611 35612Reply: 35613@table @samp 35614@item OK 35615for success 35616@item E @var{NN} 35617for an error 35618@end table 35619 35620@item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}} 35621@cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet 35622Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data 35623is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X} 35624packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by 35625@samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must 35626not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses 35627(although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already 35628have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between 35629@samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was 35630neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other 35631target-specific method, the results are unpredictable. 35632 35633 35634Reply: 35635@table @samp 35636@item OK 35637for success 35638@item E.memtype 35639for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory 35640@item E @var{NN} 35641for an error 35642@end table 35643 35644@item vFlashDone 35645@cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet 35646Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished. 35647The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of 35648@samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a 35649@samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected 35650regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone} 35651request is completed. 35652 35653@item vKill;@var{pid} 35654@cindex @samp{vKill} packet 35655@anchor{vKill packet} 35656Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a 35657hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in 35658preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are 35659supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}. 35660 35661Reply: 35662@table @samp 35663@item E @var{nn} 35664for an error 35665@item OK 35666for success 35667@end table 35668 35669@item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{} 35670@cindex @samp{vRun} packet 35671Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its 35672command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If 35673@var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program 35674(e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped 35675state. 35676 35677@c FIXME: What about non-stop mode? 35678 35679This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 35680 35681Reply: 35682@table @samp 35683@item E @var{nn} 35684for an error 35685@item @r{Any stop packet} 35686for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) 35687@end table 35688 35689@item vStopped 35690@cindex @samp{vStopped} packet 35691@xref{Notification Packets}. 35692 35693@item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}} 35694@anchor{X packet} 35695@cindex @samp{X} packet 35696Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary. 35697Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory 35698units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit}); 35699@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}). 35700 35701Reply: 35702@table @samp 35703@item OK 35704for success 35705@item E @var{NN} 35706for an error 35707@end table 35708 35709@item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind} 35710@itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind} 35711@anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet} 35712@cindex @samp{z} packet 35713@cindex @samp{Z} packets 35714Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or 35715watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}. 35716 35717Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented 35718separately. 35719 35720@emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string 35721for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A 35722remote target shall support either both or neither of a given 35723@samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To 35724avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should 35725be implemented in an idempotent way.} 35726 35727@item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35728@itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]} 35729@cindex @samp{z0} packet 35730@cindex @samp{Z0} packet 35731Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address 35732@var{addr} of type @var{kind}. 35733 35734A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at 35735@var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The 35736@var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of 35737the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} 35738and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some 35739architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}; 35740@var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode 35741form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the 35742conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if 35743the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}. 35744 35745See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}) 35746for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}. 35747 35748The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions, 35749concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form: 35750 35751@table @samp 35752 35753@item X @var{len},@var{expr} 35754@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the 35755actual conditional expression in bytecode form. 35756 35757@end table 35758 35759The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be 35760run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}. 35761The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is 35762nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands 35763continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. 35764Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no 35765separators. Each expression has the following form: 35766 35767@table @samp 35768 35769@item X @var{len},@var{expr} 35770@var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the 35771actual conditional expression in bytecode form. 35772 35773@end table 35774 35775see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}. 35776 35777@emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move 35778code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing 35779overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a 35780target, is not defined.} 35781 35782Reply: 35783@table @samp 35784@item OK 35785success 35786@item @w{} 35787not supported 35788@item E @var{NN} 35789for an error 35790@end table 35791 35792@item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35793@itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]} 35794@cindex @samp{z1} packet 35795@cindex @samp{Z1} packet 35796Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at 35797address @var{addr}. 35798 35799A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not 35800dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind} 35801and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets. 35802 35803@emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code 35804movement.} 35805 35806Reply: 35807@table @samp 35808@item OK 35809success 35810@item @w{} 35811not supported 35812@item E @var{NN} 35813for an error 35814@end table 35815 35816@item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35817@itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35818@cindex @samp{z2} packet 35819@cindex @samp{Z2} packet 35820Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}. 35821The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}. 35822 35823Reply: 35824@table @samp 35825@item OK 35826success 35827@item @w{} 35828not supported 35829@item E @var{NN} 35830for an error 35831@end table 35832 35833@item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35834@itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35835@cindex @samp{z3} packet 35836@cindex @samp{Z3} packet 35837Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}. 35838The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}. 35839 35840Reply: 35841@table @samp 35842@item OK 35843success 35844@item @w{} 35845not supported 35846@item E @var{NN} 35847for an error 35848@end table 35849 35850@item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35851@itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind} 35852@cindex @samp{z4} packet 35853@cindex @samp{Z4} packet 35854Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}. 35855The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}. 35856 35857Reply: 35858@table @samp 35859@item OK 35860success 35861@item @w{} 35862not supported 35863@item E @var{NN} 35864for an error 35865@end table 35866 35867@end table 35868 35869@node Stop Reply Packets 35870@section Stop Reply Packets 35871@cindex stop reply packets 35872 35873The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont}, 35874@samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can 35875receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?} 35876and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned 35877when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal 35878number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the 35879@value{GDBN} source code. 35880 35881As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the 35882reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's 35883syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its 35884components. 35885 35886@table @samp 35887 35888@item S @var{AA} 35889The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal 35890number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no 35891@var{n}:@var{r} pairs. 35892 35893@item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{} 35894@cindex @samp{T} packet reply 35895The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal 35896number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the 35897@samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers 35898and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing 35899round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported 35900this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows: 35901 35902@itemize @bullet 35903@item 35904If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the 35905corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a 35906series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a 35907two-digit hex number. 35908 35909@item 35910If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of 35911the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}. 35912 35913@item 35914If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of 35915the core on which the stop event was detected. 35916 35917@item 35918If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more 35919specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop 35920reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap 35921signal. At most one stop reason should be present. 35922 35923@item 35924Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair 35925and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the 35926future. 35927@end itemize 35928 35929The currently defined stop reasons are: 35930 35931@table @samp 35932@item watch 35933@itemx rwatch 35934@itemx awatch 35935The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in 35936hex. 35937 35938@item syscall_entry 35939@itemx syscall_return 35940The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the 35941syscall number, in hex. 35942 35943@cindex shared library events, remote reply 35944@item library 35945The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed. 35946@value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new 35947list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored. 35948 35949@cindex replay log events, remote reply 35950@item replaylog 35951The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying 35952logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the 35953beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r} 35954will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution}, 35955for more information. 35956 35957@item swbreak 35958@anchor{swbreak stop reason} 35959The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed, 35960irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the 35961breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r} 35962part must be left empty. 35963 35964On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a 35965breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the 35966breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is 35967responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint 35968address. 35969 35970This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 35971did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 35972appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 35973remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 35974indicating support. 35975 35976This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation. 35977 35978@item hwbreak 35979The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint. 35980The @var{r} part must be left empty. 35981 35982The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above 35983apply. 35984 35985@cindex fork events, remote reply 35986@item fork 35987The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r} 35988is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to 35989@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id} 35990field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support 35991fork events. 35992 35993This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 35994did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 35995appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 35996remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 35997indicating support. 35998 35999@cindex vfork events, remote reply 36000@item vfork 36001The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r} 36002is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to 36003@ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id} 36004field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support 36005vfork events. 36006 36007This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36008did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36009appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36010remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36011indicating support. 36012 36013@cindex vforkdone events, remote reply 36014@item vforkdone 36015The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork 36016has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the 36017address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer 36018shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only 36019applicable to targets that support vforkdone events. 36020 36021This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36022did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36023appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36024remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36025indicating support. 36026 36027@cindex exec events, remote reply 36028@item exec 36029The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r} 36030is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex. 36031This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events. 36032 36033This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions 36034did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an 36035appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The 36036remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature 36037indicating support. 36038 36039@cindex thread create event, remote reply 36040@anchor{thread create event} 36041@item create 36042The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread 36043is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet 36044(@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default; 36045@value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See 36046also the @samp{w} (@ref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. 36047 36048@end table 36049 36050@item W @var{AA} 36051@itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid} 36052The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only 36053applicable to certain targets. 36054 36055The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited 36056process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for 36057multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}. 36058The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string. 36059 36060@item X @var{AA} 36061@itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid} 36062The process terminated with signal @var{AA}. 36063 36064The second form of the response, including the process ID of the 36065terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported 36066support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess 36067extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string. 36068 36069@anchor{thread exit event} 36070@cindex thread exit event, remote reply 36071@item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid} 36072 36073The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response 36074should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the 36075@ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above. 36076 36077@item N 36078There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even 36079though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For 36080example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread 360812. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which 36082subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still 36083alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually 36084executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client 36085that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be 36086sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it. 36087@value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate 36088@samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must 36089also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating 36090support. 36091 36092@item O @var{XX}@dots{} 36093@samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be 36094written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time 36095while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait 36096for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode. 36097 36098@item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{} 36099@var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should 36100be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the 36101correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}. 36102@xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented 36103system calls. 36104 36105@samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for 36106this very system call. 36107 36108The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to 36109call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies 36110with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next 36111reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} 36112or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote 36113Protocol Extension}, for more details. 36114 36115@end table 36116 36117@node General Query Packets 36118@section General Query Packets 36119@cindex remote query requests 36120 36121Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets}; 36122packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General 36123query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and 36124sending information to and from the stub. 36125 36126The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name 36127indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example, 36128@value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol 36129definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some 36130conventions: 36131 36132@itemize @bullet 36133@item 36134The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons. 36135@item 36136Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case 36137letter. 36138@item 36139The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in 36140lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at 36141the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying 36142foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars). 36143@end itemize 36144 36145The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any 36146parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be 36147separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the 36148full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet, 36149in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin 36150with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL} 36151packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator 36152for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that 36153are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some 36154existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the 36155packet.}. 36156 36157Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here 36158has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an 36159explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the 36160templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No 36161@value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components. 36162 36163Here are the currently defined query and set packets: 36164 36165@table @samp 36166 36167@item QAgent:1 36168@itemx QAgent:0 36169Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations 36170delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}). 36171 36172@item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{} 36173@cindex @samp{QAllow} packet 36174Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the 36175target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value 36176pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg}, 36177@samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace}, 36178@samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0, 36179indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1, 36180indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its 36181own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to 36182insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.) 36183 36184@item qC 36185@cindex current thread, remote request 36186@cindex @samp{qC} packet 36187Return the current thread ID. 36188 36189Reply: 36190@table @samp 36191@item QC @var{thread-id} 36192Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in 36193@ref{thread-id syntax}. 36194@item @r{(anything else)} 36195Any other reply implies the old thread ID. 36196@end table 36197 36198@item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length} 36199@cindex CRC of memory block, remote request 36200@cindex @samp{qCRC} packet 36201@anchor{qCRC packet} 36202Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in 36203IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most 36204significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code 36205@code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC. 36206 36207@emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug 36208files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate 36209Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating 36210separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least} 36211significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to 36212detect trailing zeros. 36213 36214Reply: 36215@table @samp 36216@item E @var{NN} 36217An error (such as memory fault) 36218@item C @var{crc32} 36219The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}. 36220@end table 36221 36222@item QDisableRandomization:@var{value} 36223@cindex disable address space randomization, remote request 36224@cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet 36225Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space 36226of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature 36227to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic 36228debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value} 36229of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for 36230processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet 36231with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space 36232randomization. 36233 36234This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}). 36235 36236Reply: 36237@table @samp 36238@item OK 36239The request succeeded. 36240 36241@item E @var{nn} 36242An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36243 36244@item @w{} 36245An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported 36246by the stub. 36247@end table 36248 36249This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36250by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36251This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling 36252address space randomization. 36253 36254@item qfThreadInfo 36255@itemx qsThreadInfo 36256@cindex list active threads, remote request 36257@cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet 36258@cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet 36259Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there 36260may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query 36261works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to 36262obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will 36263be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the 36264sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query. 36265 36266NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below). 36267 36268Reply: 36269@table @samp 36270@item m @var{thread-id} 36271A single thread ID 36272@item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{} 36273a comma-separated list of thread IDs 36274@item l 36275(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list. 36276@end table 36277 36278In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or 36279more thread IDs, separated by commas. 36280@value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread 36281ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds 36282with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}). 36283Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id} 36284fields. 36285 36286@emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the 36287initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID 36288mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent 36289message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in 36290the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.} 36291 36292@item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm} 36293@cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request 36294@cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet 36295Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified 36296by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}. 36297 36298@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the 36299thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}. 36300 36301@var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the 36302thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug 36303information associated with the variable.) 36304 36305@var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the 36306load module associated with the thread local storage. For example, 36307a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared 36308object associated with the thread local storage under consideration. 36309Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module 36310differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary. 36311 36312Reply: 36313@table @samp 36314@item @var{XX}@dots{} 36315Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread 36316local storage requested. 36317 36318@item E @var{nn} 36319An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36320 36321@item @w{} 36322An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub. 36323@end table 36324 36325@item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id} 36326@cindex get thread information block address 36327@cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet 36328Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block. 36329 36330@var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread. 36331 36332Reply: 36333@table @samp 36334@item @var{XX}@dots{} 36335Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the 36336thread information block. 36337 36338@item E @var{nn} 36339An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the 36340address could not be retrieved. 36341 36342@item @w{} 36343An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub. 36344@end table 36345 36346@item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread} 36347Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex 36348digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a 36349subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum 36350number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread} 36351(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is 36352returned in the response as @var{argthread}. 36353 36354Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above). 36355 36356Reply: 36357@table @samp 36358@item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{} 36359Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being 36360returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads 36361and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex 36362digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{} 36363is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex 36364digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}. 36365@end table 36366 36367@item qOffsets 36368@cindex section offsets, remote request 36369@cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet 36370Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded 36371image. 36372 36373Reply: 36374@table @samp 36375@item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]} 36376Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address. 36377Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address. 36378If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf} 36379@samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire 36380segments by the supplied offsets. 36381 36382@emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response, 36383@value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset 36384to the @code{Bss} section.} 36385 36386@item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]} 36387Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally 36388contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If 36389@samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which 36390conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of 36391@var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file 36392does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least 36393as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are 36394kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment. 36395@end table 36396 36397@item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id} 36398@cindex thread information, remote request 36399@cindex @samp{qP} packet 36400Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex 36401encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID 36402(@pxref{thread-id syntax}). 36403 36404Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead 36405(see below). 36406 36407Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}. 36408 36409@item QNonStop:1 36410@itemx QNonStop:0 36411@cindex non-stop mode, remote request 36412@cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet 36413@anchor{QNonStop} 36414Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode. 36415@xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information. 36416 36417Reply: 36418@table @samp 36419@item OK 36420The request succeeded. 36421 36422@item E @var{nn} 36423An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36424 36425@item @w{} 36426An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by 36427the stub. 36428@end table 36429 36430This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36431by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36432Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command; 36433@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}. 36434 36435@item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{} 36436@itemx QCatchSyscalls:0 36437@cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request 36438@cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet 36439@anchor{QCatchSyscalls} 36440Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0}) 36441catching syscalls from the inferior process. 36442 36443For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded 36444in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno} 36445is listed, every system call should be reported. 36446 36447Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will 36448still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding 36449@code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only 36450report the requested syscalls. 36451 36452Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier 36453@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list. 36454 36455If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is 36456kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall 36457numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the 36458client should send a new packet with the new syscall list. 36459 36460Reply: 36461@table @samp 36462@item OK 36463The request succeeded. 36464 36465@item E @var{nn} 36466An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits. 36467 36468@item @w{} 36469An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by 36470the stub. 36471@end table 36472 36473Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls} 36474command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}). 36475This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36476by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36477 36478@item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{} 36479@cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request 36480@cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet 36481@anchor{QPassSignals} 36482Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process. 36483Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies 36484(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be 36485strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop 36486the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be 36487reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not 36488combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the 36489new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle 36490@var{signal} nostop noprint pass}. 36491 36492Reply: 36493@table @samp 36494@item OK 36495The request succeeded. 36496 36497@item E @var{nn} 36498An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36499 36500@item @w{} 36501An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by 36502the stub. 36503@end table 36504 36505Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals} 36506command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}). 36507This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36508by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36509 36510@item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{} 36511@cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request 36512@cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet 36513@anchor{QProgramSignals} 36514Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process. 36515Others should be silently discarded. 36516 36517In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a 36518signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One 36519example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have 36520stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to 36521@value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified 36522by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending 36523signals. 36524 36525This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a 36526resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}). 36527 36528Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies 36529(@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be 36530strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple 36531@samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier 36532@samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list. 36533 36534Reply: 36535@table @samp 36536@item OK 36537The request succeeded. 36538 36539@item E @var{nn} 36540An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36541 36542@item @w{} 36543An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported 36544by the stub. 36545@end table 36546 36547Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals} 36548command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}). 36549This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 36550by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 36551 36552@anchor{QThreadEvents} 36553@item QThreadEvents:1 36554@itemx QThreadEvents:0 36555@cindex thread create/exit events, remote request 36556@cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet 36557 36558Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0}) 36559reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create 36560event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in 36561non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and 36562synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without 36563exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang 36564forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that 36565same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the 36566stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in 36567its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36568 36569Reply: 36570@table @samp 36571@item OK 36572The request succeeded. 36573 36574@item E @var{nn} 36575An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 36576 36577@item @w{} 36578An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by 36579the stub. 36580@end table 36581 36582Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events} 36583command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}). 36584 36585@item qRcmd,@var{command} 36586@cindex execute remote command, remote request 36587@cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet 36588@var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for 36589execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output 36590string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond 36591with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output 36592packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a 36593stubs's interpreter may have security implications}. 36594 36595Reply: 36596@table @samp 36597@item OK 36598A command response with no output. 36599@item @var{OUTPUT} 36600A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}. 36601@item E @var{NN} 36602Indicate a badly formed request. 36603@item @w{} 36604An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized. 36605@end table 36606 36607(Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the 36608command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming 36609conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new 36610packets.) 36611 36612@item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern} 36613@cindex searching memory, in remote debugging 36614@ifnotinfo 36615@cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet 36616@end ifnotinfo 36617@cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet 36618@anchor{qSearch memory} 36619Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}. 36620Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex; 36621@var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded. 36622 36623Reply: 36624@table @samp 36625@item 0 36626The pattern was not found. 36627@item 1,address 36628The pattern was found at @var{address}. 36629@item E @var{NN} 36630A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory. 36631@item @w{} 36632An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized. 36633@end table 36634 36635@item QStartNoAckMode 36636@cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet 36637@anchor{QStartNoAckMode} 36638Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-} 36639protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}). 36640 36641Reply: 36642@table @samp 36643@item OK 36644The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode. 36645@value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse, 36646but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further 36647@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection. 36648@item @w{} 36649An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode. 36650@end table 36651 36652@item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]} 36653@cindex supported packets, remote query 36654@cindex features of the remote protocol 36655@cindex @samp{qSupported} packet 36656@anchor{qSupported} 36657Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and 36658query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows 36659@value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others' 36660features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes 36661at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger 36662packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on 36663high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not 36664be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or 36665stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be 36666automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be 36667reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default 36668unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it 36669helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new 36670versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets. 36671 36672Reply: 36673@table @samp 36674@item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{} 36675The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature}, 36676depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the 36677possible forms). 36678@item @w{} 36679An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized, 36680or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}. 36681@end table 36682 36683The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the 36684@samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response) 36685are: 36686 36687@table @samp 36688@item @var{name}=@var{value} 36689The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated 36690with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends 36691on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon. 36692@item @var{name}+ 36693The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not 36694need an associated value. 36695@item @var{name}- 36696The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported. 36697@item @var{name}? 36698The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and 36699@value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is 36700needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications, 36701but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses. 36702@end table 36703 36704Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the 36705supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous 36706request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known 36707state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with 36708a different version of @value{GDBN}. 36709 36710The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN}) 36711are defined: 36712 36713@table @samp 36714@item multiprocess 36715This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess 36716extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36717extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36718including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36719@xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details. 36720 36721@item xmlRegisters 36722This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target 36723description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target 36724specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register 36725description. 36726 36727@item qRelocInsn 36728This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the 36729@samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate 36730instruction reply packet}). 36731 36732@item swbreak 36733This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop 36734reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details. 36735 36736@item hwbreak 36737This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop 36738reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details. 36739 36740@item fork-events 36741This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event 36742extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36743extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36744including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36745 36746@item vfork-events 36747This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event 36748extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36749extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36750including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36751 36752@item exec-events 36753This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event 36754extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such 36755extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by 36756including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply. 36757 36758@item vContSupported 36759This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the 36760supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet. 36761@end table 36762 36763Stubs should ignore any unknown values for 36764@var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported} 36765packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier 36766versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values 36767for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take 36768advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible 36769improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is 36770an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent 36771of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN} 36772describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with 36773all the features it supports. 36774 36775Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature 36776responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms. 36777 36778Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature 36779should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features 36780require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=} 36781form response. 36782 36783Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if 36784@samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned 36785in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a 36786stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults. 36787 36788Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing 36789mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal 36790architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information 36791about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in 36792stubs which may be configured for multiple targets. 36793 36794These are the currently defined stub features and their properties: 36795 36796@multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2 36797@c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require 36798@c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem. 36799@item Feature Name 36800@tab Value Required 36801@tab Default 36802@tab Probe Allowed 36803 36804@item @samp{PacketSize} 36805@tab Yes 36806@tab @samp{-} 36807@tab No 36808 36809@item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} 36810@tab No 36811@tab @samp{-} 36812@tab Yes 36813 36814@item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read} 36815@tab No 36816@tab @samp{-} 36817@tab Yes 36818 36819@item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read} 36820@tab No 36821@tab @samp{-} 36822@tab Yes 36823 36824@item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} 36825@tab No 36826@tab @samp{-} 36827@tab Yes 36828 36829@item @samp{qXfer:features:read} 36830@tab No 36831@tab @samp{-} 36832@tab Yes 36833 36834@item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} 36835@tab No 36836@tab @samp{-} 36837@tab Yes 36838 36839@item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} 36840@tab No 36841@tab @samp{-} 36842@tab Yes 36843 36844@item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read} 36845@tab No 36846@tab @samp{-} 36847@tab No 36848 36849@item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} 36850@tab No 36851@tab @samp{-} 36852@tab Yes 36853 36854@item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} 36855@tab No 36856@tab @samp{-} 36857@tab Yes 36858 36859@item @samp{qXfer:spu:read} 36860@tab No 36861@tab @samp{-} 36862@tab Yes 36863 36864@item @samp{qXfer:spu:write} 36865@tab No 36866@tab @samp{-} 36867@tab Yes 36868 36869@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} 36870@tab No 36871@tab @samp{-} 36872@tab Yes 36873 36874@item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} 36875@tab No 36876@tab @samp{-} 36877@tab Yes 36878 36879@item @samp{qXfer:threads:read} 36880@tab No 36881@tab @samp{-} 36882@tab Yes 36883 36884@item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 36885@tab No 36886@tab @samp{-} 36887@tab Yes 36888 36889@item @samp{qXfer:uib:read} 36890@tab No 36891@tab @samp{-} 36892@tab Yes 36893 36894@item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read} 36895@tab No 36896@tab @samp{-} 36897@tab Yes 36898 36899@item @samp{Qbtrace:off} 36900@tab Yes 36901@tab @samp{-} 36902@tab Yes 36903 36904@item @samp{Qbtrace:bts} 36905@tab Yes 36906@tab @samp{-} 36907@tab Yes 36908 36909@item @samp{Qbtrace:pt} 36910@tab Yes 36911@tab @samp{-} 36912@tab Yes 36913 36914@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} 36915@tab Yes 36916@tab @samp{-} 36917@tab Yes 36918 36919@item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} 36920@tab Yes 36921@tab @samp{-} 36922@tab Yes 36923 36924@item @samp{QNonStop} 36925@tab No 36926@tab @samp{-} 36927@tab Yes 36928 36929@item @samp{QCatchSyscalls} 36930@tab No 36931@tab @samp{-} 36932@tab Yes 36933 36934@item @samp{QPassSignals} 36935@tab No 36936@tab @samp{-} 36937@tab Yes 36938 36939@item @samp{QStartNoAckMode} 36940@tab No 36941@tab @samp{-} 36942@tab Yes 36943 36944@item @samp{multiprocess} 36945@tab No 36946@tab @samp{-} 36947@tab No 36948 36949@item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints} 36950@tab No 36951@tab @samp{-} 36952@tab No 36953 36954@item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints} 36955@tab No 36956@tab @samp{-} 36957@tab No 36958 36959@item @samp{ReverseContinue} 36960@tab No 36961@tab @samp{-} 36962@tab No 36963 36964@item @samp{ReverseStep} 36965@tab No 36966@tab @samp{-} 36967@tab No 36968 36969@item @samp{TracepointSource} 36970@tab No 36971@tab @samp{-} 36972@tab No 36973 36974@item @samp{QAgent} 36975@tab No 36976@tab @samp{-} 36977@tab No 36978 36979@item @samp{QAllow} 36980@tab No 36981@tab @samp{-} 36982@tab No 36983 36984@item @samp{QDisableRandomization} 36985@tab No 36986@tab @samp{-} 36987@tab No 36988 36989@item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints} 36990@tab No 36991@tab @samp{-} 36992@tab No 36993 36994@item @samp{QTBuffer:size} 36995@tab No 36996@tab @samp{-} 36997@tab No 36998 36999@item @samp{tracenz} 37000@tab No 37001@tab @samp{-} 37002@tab No 37003 37004@item @samp{BreakpointCommands} 37005@tab No 37006@tab @samp{-} 37007@tab No 37008 37009@item @samp{swbreak} 37010@tab No 37011@tab @samp{-} 37012@tab No 37013 37014@item @samp{hwbreak} 37015@tab No 37016@tab @samp{-} 37017@tab No 37018 37019@item @samp{fork-events} 37020@tab No 37021@tab @samp{-} 37022@tab No 37023 37024@item @samp{vfork-events} 37025@tab No 37026@tab @samp{-} 37027@tab No 37028 37029@item @samp{exec-events} 37030@tab No 37031@tab @samp{-} 37032@tab No 37033 37034@item @samp{QThreadEvents} 37035@tab No 37036@tab @samp{-} 37037@tab No 37038 37039@item @samp{no-resumed} 37040@tab No 37041@tab @samp{-} 37042@tab No 37043 37044@end multitable 37045 37046These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail: 37047 37048@table @samp 37049@cindex packet size, remote protocol 37050@item PacketSize=@var{bytes} 37051The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in 37052length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk 37053transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the 37054data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum. 37055There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub 37056stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra 37057byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported, 37058@value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response. 37059 37060@item qXfer:auxv:read 37061The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet 37062(@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}). 37063 37064@item qXfer:btrace:read 37065The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read} 37066packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}). 37067 37068@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read 37069The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read} 37070packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}). 37071 37072@item qXfer:exec-file:read 37073The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet 37074(@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}). 37075 37076@item qXfer:features:read 37077The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet 37078(@pxref{qXfer target description read}). 37079 37080@item qXfer:libraries:read 37081The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet 37082(@pxref{qXfer library list read}). 37083 37084@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read 37085The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet 37086(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}). 37087 37088@item augmented-libraries-svr4-read 37089The remote stub understands the augmented form of the 37090@samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet 37091(@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}). 37092 37093@item qXfer:memory-map:read 37094The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet 37095(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}). 37096 37097@item qXfer:sdata:read 37098The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet 37099(@pxref{qXfer sdata read}). 37100 37101@item qXfer:spu:read 37102The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet 37103(@pxref{qXfer spu read}). 37104 37105@item qXfer:spu:write 37106The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet 37107(@pxref{qXfer spu write}). 37108 37109@item qXfer:siginfo:read 37110The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet 37111(@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}). 37112 37113@item qXfer:siginfo:write 37114The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet 37115(@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}). 37116 37117@item qXfer:threads:read 37118The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet 37119(@pxref{qXfer threads read}). 37120 37121@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read 37122The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 37123packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}). 37124 37125@item qXfer:uib:read 37126The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read} 37127packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}). 37128 37129@item qXfer:fdpic:read 37130The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read} 37131packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}). 37132 37133@item QNonStop 37134The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet 37135(@pxref{QNonStop}). 37136 37137@item QCatchSyscalls 37138The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet 37139(@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}). 37140 37141@item QPassSignals 37142The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet 37143(@pxref{QPassSignals}). 37144 37145@item QStartNoAckMode 37146The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and 37147prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}. 37148 37149@item multiprocess 37150@anchor{multiprocess extensions} 37151@cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol 37152The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote 37153protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of 37154thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and 37155add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X} 37156replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the 37157syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports 37158debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use 37159multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also 37160indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request. 37161 37162@item qXfer:osdata:read 37163The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet 37164((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}). 37165 37166@item ConditionalBreakpoints 37167The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions 37168defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers 37169when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}). 37170 37171@item ConditionalTracepoints 37172The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined 37173for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}). 37174 37175@item ReverseContinue 37176The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet 37177(@pxref{bc}). 37178 37179@item ReverseStep 37180The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet 37181(@pxref{bs}). 37182 37183@item TracepointSource 37184The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies 37185the source form of tracepoint definitions. 37186 37187@item QAgent 37188The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet. 37189 37190@item QAllow 37191The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet. 37192 37193@item QDisableRandomization 37194The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet. 37195 37196@item StaticTracepoint 37197@cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol 37198The remote stub supports static tracepoints. 37199 37200@item InstallInTrace 37201@anchor{install tracepoint in tracing} 37202The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing. 37203 37204@item EnableDisableTracepoints 37205The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and 37206@samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints 37207to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running. 37208 37209@item QTBuffer:size 37210The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size}) 37211packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer. 37212 37213@item tracenz 37214@cindex string tracing, in remote protocol 37215The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings. 37216See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode. 37217 37218@item BreakpointCommands 37219@cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol 37220The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself, 37221rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}. 37222 37223@item Qbtrace:off 37224The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet. 37225 37226@item Qbtrace:bts 37227The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet. 37228 37229@item Qbtrace:pt 37230The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet. 37231 37232@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size 37233The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet. 37234 37235@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size 37236The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet. 37237 37238@item swbreak 37239The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory 37240breakpoints. 37241 37242@item hwbreak 37243The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware 37244breakpoints. 37245 37246@item fork-events 37247The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events. 37248 37249@item vfork-events 37250The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events 37251and vforkdone events. 37252 37253@item exec-events 37254The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events. 37255 37256@item vContSupported 37257The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to 37258@samp{vCont?} packet. 37259 37260@item QThreadEvents 37261The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet. 37262 37263@item no-resumed 37264The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply. 37265 37266@end table 37267 37268@item qSymbol:: 37269@cindex symbol lookup, remote request 37270@cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet 37271Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup 37272requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols. 37273 37274Reply: 37275@table @samp 37276@item OK 37277The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols. 37278@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name} 37279The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded). 37280@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the 37281@samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described 37282below. 37283@end table 37284 37285@item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} 37286Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}. 37287 37288@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the 37289target has previously requested. 37290 37291@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If 37292@value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field 37293will be empty. 37294 37295Reply: 37296@table @samp 37297@item OK 37298The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols. 37299@item qSymbol:@var{sym_name} 37300The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex 37301encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols 37302(if available), until the target ceases to request them. 37303@end table 37304 37305@item qTBuffer 37306@itemx QTBuffer 37307@itemx QTDisconnected 37308@itemx QTDP 37309@itemx QTDPsrc 37310@itemx QTDV 37311@itemx qTfP 37312@itemx qTfV 37313@itemx QTFrame 37314@itemx qTMinFTPILen 37315 37316@xref{Tracepoint Packets}. 37317 37318@item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id} 37319@cindex thread attributes info, remote request 37320@cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet 37321Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread 37322attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax}, 37323for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This 37324string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting 37325for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is 37326displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some 37327examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or 37328@samp{Blocked on Mutex}. 37329 37330Reply: 37331@table @samp 37332@item @var{XX}@dots{} 37333Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, 37334comprising the printable string containing the extra information about 37335the thread's attributes. 37336@end table 37337 37338(Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from 37339the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming 37340conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new 37341packets.) 37342 37343@item QTNotes 37344@itemx qTP 37345@itemx QTSave 37346@itemx qTsP 37347@itemx qTsV 37348@itemx QTStart 37349@itemx QTStop 37350@itemx QTEnable 37351@itemx QTDisable 37352@itemx QTinit 37353@itemx QTro 37354@itemx qTStatus 37355@itemx qTV 37356@itemx qTfSTM 37357@itemx qTsSTM 37358@itemx qTSTMat 37359@xref{Tracepoint Packets}. 37360 37361@item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37362@cindex read special object, remote request 37363@cindex @samp{qXfer} packet 37364@anchor{qXfer read} 37365Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area 37366identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes 37367starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and 37368encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply 37369additional details about what data to access. 37370 37371Reply: 37372@table @samp 37373@item m @var{data} 37374Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the 37375target. There may be more data at a higher address (although 37376it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid 37377block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read). 37378It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the 37379request. 37380 37381@item l @var{data} 37382Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target. 37383There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to 37384have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request. 37385 37386@item l 37387The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data. 37388There is no more data to be read. 37389 37390@item E00 37391The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid. 37392 37393@item E @var{nn} 37394The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data. 37395The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value. 37396 37397@item @w{} 37398An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by 37399the stub, or that the object does not support reading. 37400@end table 37401 37402Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the 37403@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply 37404formats, listed above. 37405 37406@table @samp 37407@item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37408@anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read} 37409Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information, 37410auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty. 37411 37412This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37413by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37414 37415@item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37416@anchor{qXfer btrace read} 37417 37418Return a description of the current branch trace. 37419@xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} 37420packet may have one of the following values: 37421 37422@table @code 37423@item all 37424Returns all available branch trace. 37425 37426@item new 37427Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since 37428the last read request. 37429 37430@item delta 37431Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new 37432block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source 37433location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is 37434used to stitch traces together. 37435 37436If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow. 37437@end table 37438 37439This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it 37440by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37441 37442@item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37443@anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read} 37444 37445Return a description of the current branch trace configuration. 37446@xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}. 37447 37448This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it 37449by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37450 37451@item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37452@anchor{qXfer executable filename read} 37453Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create 37454a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the 37455numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal 37456number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the 37457filename corresponding to the currently executing process. 37458 37459This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37460by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37461 37462@item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37463@anchor{qXfer target description read} 37464Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The 37465annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is 37466always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex. 37467 37468This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37469by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37470 37471@item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37472@anchor{qXfer library list read} 37473Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}. 37474The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 37475(@pxref{qXfer read}). 37476 37477Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do 37478not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where 37479the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries. 37480 37481This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37482by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37483 37484@item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37485@anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read} 37486Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4 37487platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part 37488of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote 37489stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet 37490by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37491(@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}). 37492 37493This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets. 37494@value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise. 37495 37496This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37497by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37498 37499If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this 37500packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may 37501contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}} 37502arguments. The currently supported arguments are: 37503 37504@table @code 37505@item start=@var{address} 37506A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct 37507link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero 37508then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be 37509chosen as the starting point. 37510 37511@item prev=@var{address} 37512A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct 37513link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map} 37514specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then 37515the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map} 37516exists prior to the starting point. 37517 37518@end table 37519 37520Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently 37521ignored. 37522 37523@item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37524@anchor{qXfer memory map read} 37525Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The 37526annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 37527(@pxref{qXfer read}). 37528 37529This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37530by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37531 37532@item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37533@anchor{qXfer sdata read} 37534 37535Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker 37536information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must 37537be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint 37538Action Lists}. 37539 37540This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37541by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37542(@pxref{qSupported}). 37543 37544@item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37545@anchor{qXfer siginfo read} 37546Read contents of the extra signal information on the target 37547system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be 37548empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). 37549 37550This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37551by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37552(@pxref{qSupported}). 37553 37554@item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37555@anchor{qXfer spu read} 37556Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The 37557annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form 37558@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID 37559in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file 37560in that context to be accessed. 37561 37562This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37563by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37564(@pxref{qSupported}). 37565 37566@item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37567@anchor{qXfer threads read} 37568Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The 37569annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty 37570(@pxref{qXfer read}). 37571 37572This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37573by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37574 37575@item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37576@anchor{qXfer traceframe info read} 37577 37578Return a description of the current traceframe's contents. 37579@xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic 37580@samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). 37581 37582This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37583by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37584 37585@item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37586@anchor{qXfer unwind info block} 37587 37588Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used 37589on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information. 37590 37591This packet is not probed by default. 37592 37593@item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length} 37594@anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read} 37595Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The 37596annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap}, 37597executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read. 37598 37599This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37600by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37601 37602@item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length} 37603@anchor{qXfer osdata read} 37604Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}. 37605@xref{Operating System Information}. 37606 37607@end table 37608 37609@item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 37610@cindex write data into object, remote request 37611@anchor{qXfer write} 37612Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area 37613identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes 37614into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be 37615written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex} 37616is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data 37617to access. 37618 37619Reply: 37620@table @samp 37621@item @var{nn} 37622@var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written. 37623This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request. 37624 37625@item E00 37626The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid. 37627 37628@item E @var{nn} 37629The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data. 37630The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value. 37631 37632@item @w{} 37633An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not 37634recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing. 37635@end table 37636 37637Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the 37638@samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply 37639formats, listed above. 37640 37641@table @samp 37642@item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 37643@anchor{qXfer siginfo write} 37644Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system. 37645The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be 37646empty (@pxref{qXfer write}). 37647 37648This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37649by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response 37650(@pxref{qSupported}). 37651 37652@item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{} 37653@anchor{qXfer spu write} 37654Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The 37655annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form 37656@file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID 37657in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file 37658in that context to be accessed. 37659 37660This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it, 37661by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 37662@end table 37663 37664@item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{} 37665Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does 37666not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for 37667@var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub 37668must respond with an empty packet. 37669 37670@item qAttached:@var{pid} 37671@cindex query attached, remote request 37672@cindex @samp{qAttached} packet 37673Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an 37674existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess 37675protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), 37676@var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target 37677process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and 37678the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}. 37679 37680This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process 37681should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with 37682the @code{quit} command. 37683 37684Reply: 37685@table @samp 37686@item 1 37687The remote server attached to an existing process. 37688@item 0 37689The remote server created a new process. 37690@item E @var{NN} 37691A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37692@end table 37693 37694@item Qbtrace:bts 37695Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store. 37696 37697Reply: 37698@table @samp 37699@item OK 37700Branch tracing has been enabled. 37701@item E.errtext 37702A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37703@end table 37704 37705@item Qbtrace:pt 37706Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace. 37707 37708Reply: 37709@table @samp 37710@item OK 37711Branch tracing has been enabled. 37712@item E.errtext 37713A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37714@end table 37715 37716@item Qbtrace:off 37717Disable branch tracing for the current thread. 37718 37719Reply: 37720@table @samp 37721@item OK 37722Branch tracing has been disabled. 37723@item E.errtext 37724A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37725@end table 37726 37727@item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value} 37728Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the 37729btrace recording method in bts format. 37730 37731Reply: 37732@table @samp 37733@item OK 37734The ring buffer size has been set. 37735@item E.errtext 37736A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37737@end table 37738 37739@item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value} 37740Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the 37741btrace recording method in pt format. 37742 37743Reply: 37744@table @samp 37745@item OK 37746The ring buffer size has been set. 37747@item E.errtext 37748A badly formed request or an error was encountered. 37749@end table 37750 37751@end table 37752 37753@node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details 37754@section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details 37755 37756This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific 37757target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for 37758details of XML target descriptions for each architecture. 37759 37760@menu 37761* ARM-Specific Protocol Details:: 37762* MIPS-Specific Protocol Details:: 37763@end menu 37764 37765@node ARM-Specific Protocol Details 37766@subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details 37767 37768@menu 37769* ARM Breakpoint Kinds:: 37770@end menu 37771 37772@node ARM Breakpoint Kinds 37773@subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds 37774@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM} 37775 37776These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets. 37777 37778@table @r 37779 37780@item 2 3778116-bit Thumb mode breakpoint. 37782 37783@item 3 3778432-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint. 37785 37786@item 4 3778732-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint. 37788 37789@end table 37790 37791@node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details 37792@subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details 37793 37794@menu 37795* MIPS Register packet Format:: 37796* MIPS Breakpoint Kinds:: 37797@end menu 37798 37799@node MIPS Register packet Format 37800@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format 37801@cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS} 37802 37803The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined. 37804In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as 37805sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) 37806to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target 37807byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred 37808most-significant -- least-significant. 37809 37810@table @r 37811 37812@item MIPS32 37813All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order: 3781432 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point 37815registers; fsr; fir; fp. 37816 37817@item MIPS64 37818All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including 37819thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same 37820as @code{MIPS32}. 37821 37822@end table 37823 37824@node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds 37825@subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds 37826@cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS} 37827 37828These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets. 37829 37830@table @r 37831 37832@item 2 3783316-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint. 37834 37835@item 3 3783616-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint. 37837 37838@item 4 3783932-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint. 37840 37841@item 5 3784232-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint. 37843 37844@end table 37845 37846@node Tracepoint Packets 37847@section Tracepoint Packets 37848@cindex tracepoint packets 37849@cindex packets, tracepoint 37850 37851Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement 37852tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}). 37853 37854@table @samp 37855 37856@item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]} 37857@cindex @samp{QTDP} packet 37858Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena} 37859is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then 37860the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step 37861count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present, 37862then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is 37863the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room 37864for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a 37865tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed 37866by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action 37867encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present, 37868further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's 37869actions. 37870 37871Replies: 37872@table @samp 37873@item OK 37874The packet was understood and carried out. 37875@item qRelocInsn 37876@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}. 37877@item @w{} 37878The packet was not recognized. 37879@end table 37880 37881@item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]} 37882Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and 37883@var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for 37884this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after 37885another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the 37886trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow, 37887specifying more actions for this tracepoint. 37888 37889In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one 37890can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet 37891is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping'' 37892actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those 37893taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an 37894@samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary 37895tracepoint actions. 37896 37897The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of 37898actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the 37899following forms: 37900 37901@table @samp 37902 37903@item R @var{mask} 37904Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}, 37905a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number 37906@var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered 37907zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may 37908not fit in a 32-bit word. 37909 37910@item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len} 37911Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register 37912number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is 37913@samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the 37914address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg}, 37915@var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal 37916values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case). 37917 37918@item X @var{len},@var{expr} 37919Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as 37920it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in 37921@ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a 37922two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes 37923in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the 37924packet). 37925 37926@end table 37927 37928Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP} 37929packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet 37930length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R} 37931action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X} 37932actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions 37933must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The 37934``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a 37935separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.) 37936 37937Replies: 37938@table @samp 37939@item OK 37940The packet was understood and carried out. 37941@item qRelocInsn 37942@xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}. 37943@item @w{} 37944The packet was not recognized. 37945@end table 37946 37947@item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes} 37948@cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet 37949Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}. 37950This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints 37951originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type} 37952is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the 37953tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while 37954@var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal. 37955 37956@var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source 37957string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string. 37958This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will 37959fit in a single packet. 37960@c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated 37961@c tracepoint descriptions section. 37962 37963The available string types are @samp{at} for the location, 37964@samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command. 37965@value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action 37966list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list. 37967 37968The target does not need to do anything with source strings except 37969report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP} 37970query packets. 37971 37972Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it 37973if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General 37974Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files 37975much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the 37976tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to 37977the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy 37978could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not 37979be found. 37980 37981@item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name} 37982@cindex define trace state variable, remote request 37983@cindex @samp{QTDV} packet 37984Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial 37985value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n} 37986and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has 37987the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the 37988target should simply create the trace state variables as they are 37989mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one) 37990if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin. 37991@value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or 37992@samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the 37993hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state 37994variable. 37995 37996@item QTFrame:@var{n} 37997@cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet 37998Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the 37999register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent 38000request packets from @value{GDBN}. 38001 38002A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the 38003requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated 38004without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has 38005one of the following forms: 38006 38007@table @samp 38008@item F @var{f} 38009The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer; 38010@var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there 38011was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet. 38012 38013@item T @var{t} 38014The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t}; 38015@var{t} is a hexadecimal number. 38016 38017@end table 38018 38019@item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr} 38020Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 38021currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr}; 38022@var{addr} is a hexadecimal number. 38023 38024@item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t} 38025Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 38026currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t} 38027is a hexadecimal number. 38028 38029@item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end} 38030Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the 38031currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive) 38032and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal 38033numbers. 38034 38035@item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end} 38036Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first 38037frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive). 38038 38039@item qTMinFTPILen 38040@cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet 38041This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast 38042tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on 38043the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but 38044it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in 38045the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that 38046system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to 38047arrange for that. 38048 38049Replies: 38050 38051@table @samp 38052@item 0 38053The minimum instruction length is currently unknown. 38054@item @var{length} 38055The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length} 38056is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply 38057of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction 38058regardless of size. 38059@item E 38060An error has occurred. 38061@item @w{} 38062An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub. 38063@end table 38064 38065@item QTStart 38066@cindex @samp{QTStart} packet 38067Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from 38068tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the 38069@samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate 38070instruction reply packet}). 38071 38072@item QTStop 38073@cindex @samp{QTStop} packet 38074End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames. 38075 38076@item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr} 38077@anchor{QTEnable} 38078@cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet 38079Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint 38080experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection 38081of data from it will resume. 38082 38083@item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr} 38084@anchor{QTDisable} 38085@cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet 38086Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint 38087experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless 38088@samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued. 38089 38090@item QTinit 38091@cindex @samp{QTinit} packet 38092Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer. 38093 38094@item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{} 38095@cindex @samp{QTro} packet 38096Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub 38097will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents, 38098if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit. 38099 38100@value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those 38101containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should 38102still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so 38103there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents. 38104 38105@item QTDisconnected:@var{value} 38106@cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet 38107Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN} 38108disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to 38109continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if 38110@value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture. 38111 38112@item qTStatus 38113@cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet 38114Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now. 38115 38116The reply has the form: 38117 38118@table @samp 38119 38120@item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{} 38121@var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently 38122running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated 38123optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status. 38124 38125@end table 38126 38127If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several 38128explanations as one of the optional fields: 38129 38130@table @samp 38131 38132@item tnotrun:0 38133No trace has been run yet. 38134 38135@item tstop[:@var{text}]:0 38136The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional 38137@var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the 38138stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was 38139stopped manually). It is hex-encoded. 38140 38141@item tfull:0 38142The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up. 38143 38144@item tdisconnected:0 38145The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target. 38146 38147@item tpasscount:@var{tpnum} 38148The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count. 38149 38150@item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum} 38151The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The 38152string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error 38153(for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it 38154is hex encoded. 38155 38156@item tunknown:0 38157The trace stopped for some other reason. 38158 38159@end table 38160 38161Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information. 38162Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring 38163the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these 38164numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped 38165trace. 38166 38167@table @samp 38168 38169@item tframes:@var{n} 38170The number of trace frames in the buffer. 38171 38172@item tcreated:@var{n} 38173The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may 38174be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular. 38175 38176@item tsize:@var{n} 38177The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes. 38178 38179@item tfree:@var{n} 38180The number of bytes still unused in the buffer. 38181 38182@item circular:@var{n} 38183The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the 38184trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if 38185necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear 38186and may fill up. 38187 38188@item disconn:@var{n} 38189The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that 38190tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means 38191that the trace run will stop. 38192 38193@end table 38194 38195@item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr} 38196@cindex tracepoint status, remote request 38197@cindex @samp{qTP} packet 38198Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at 38199address @var{addr}. 38200 38201Replies: 38202@table @samp 38203@item V@var{hits}:@var{usage} 38204The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace 38205run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that 38206@code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the 38207steps' space consumption is added into the usage number. 38208 38209@end table 38210 38211@item qTV:@var{var} 38212@cindex trace state variable value, remote request 38213@cindex @samp{qTV} packet 38214Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}. 38215 38216Replies: 38217@table @samp 38218@item V@var{value} 38219The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current 38220value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a 38221saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the 38222user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in 38223different reply values, such as when requesting values while the 38224program is running. 38225 38226@item U 38227The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example, 38228if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable 38229was not collected. 38230@end table 38231 38232@item qTfP 38233@cindex @samp{qTfP} packet 38234@itemx qTsP 38235@cindex @samp{qTsP} packet 38236These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by 38237the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece 38238of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies 38239to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets 38240that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax) 38241 38242@item qTfV 38243@cindex @samp{qTfV} packet 38244@itemx qTsV 38245@cindex @samp{qTsV} packet 38246These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the 38247target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data, 38248and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to 38249these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define 38250trace state variables. 38251 38252@item qTfSTM 38253@itemx qTsSTM 38254@anchor{qTfSTM} 38255@anchor{qTsSTM} 38256@cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet 38257@cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet 38258These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist 38259in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the 38260first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional 38261pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form: 38262 38263Reply: 38264@table @samp 38265@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra} 38266A single marker 38267@item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{} 38268a comma-separated list of markers 38269@item l 38270(lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list. 38271@item E @var{nn} 38272An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits. 38273@item @w{} 38274An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the 38275stub. 38276@end table 38277 38278The @var{address} is encoded in hex; 38279@var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex. 38280 38281In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or 38282more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each 38283reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the 38284query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for 38285@dfn{last}). 38286 38287@item qTSTMat:@var{address} 38288@anchor{qTSTMat} 38289@cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet 38290This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the 38291target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the 38292syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static 38293tracepoint markers. 38294 38295@item QTSave:@var{filename} 38296@cindex @samp{QTSave} packet 38297This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name 38298@var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded 38299as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs 38300absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target. 38301 38302@item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len} 38303@cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet 38304Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer, 38305starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were 38306a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format. 38307The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver 38308in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for. 38309A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are 38310available. 38311 38312@item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value} 38313This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if 38314@var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0. 38315 38316@item QTBuffer:size:@var{size} 38317@anchor{QTBuffer-size} 38318@cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet 38319This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size 38320@var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to 38321use whatever size it prefers. 38322 38323@item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{} 38324@cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet 38325This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable 38326types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the 38327@var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded. 38328 38329@end table 38330 38331@subsection Relocate instruction reply packet 38332When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to 38333relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a 38334different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is 38335enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the 38336return address on the stack, and relative branches or other 38337PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect 38338of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if 38339it had executed in the original location. 38340 38341In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also 38342respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request 38343packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle 38344this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its 38345documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above 38346descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The 38347format of the request is: 38348 38349@table @samp 38350@item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to} 38351 38352This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from} 38353to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the 38354instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at 38355@var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target 38356memory starting at @var{to}. 38357@end table 38358 38359Replies: 38360@table @samp 38361@item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size} 38362Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is 38363the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence. 38364@item E @var{NN} 38365A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while 38366relocating the instruction. 38367@end table 38368 38369@node Host I/O Packets 38370@section Host I/O Packets 38371@cindex Host I/O, remote protocol 38372@cindex file transfer, remote protocol 38373 38374The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O 38375operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is 38376used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own 38377filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure 38378layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the 38379Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated 38380protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers. 38381Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the 38382target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol 38383Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol. 38384 38385The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with 38386its arguments. They have this format: 38387 38388@table @samp 38389 38390@item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{} 38391@var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target 38392should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking 38393for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on 38394the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative 38395numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not 38396used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of 38397hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a 38398buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}). 38399 38400@end table 38401 38402The valid responses to Host I/O packets are: 38403 38404@table @samp 38405 38406@item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}] 38407@var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually 38408non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured, 38409@var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a 38410value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For 38411operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a 38412binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the 38413normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet 38414documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and 38415@var{attachment}. 38416 38417@item @w{} 38418An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized. 38419 38420@end table 38421 38422These are the supported Host I/O operations: 38423 38424@table @samp 38425@item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode} 38426Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or 38427return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string, 38428@var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags 38429(@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask 38430of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}). 38431@xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values. 38432 38433@item vFile:close: @var{fd} 38434Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or 38435-1 if an error occurs. 38436 38437@item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset} 38438Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to 38439@var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset} 38440relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes; 38441common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file 38442condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be 38443returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if 38444@var{count} was zero. 38445 38446The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success. 38447If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary 38448attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the 38449number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if 38450some characters were escaped. 38451 38452@item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data} 38453Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding 38454to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the 38455file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no 38456separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the 38457packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written, 38458which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an 38459error occurred. 38460 38461@item vFile:fstat: @var{fd} 38462Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. 38463On success the information is returned as a binary attachment 38464and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes. 38465If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the 38466returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}. 38467 38468@item vFile:unlink: @var{filename} 38469Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0, 38470or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string. 38471 38472@item vFile:readlink: @var{filename} 38473Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return 38474the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs. 38475 38476The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success. 38477If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary 38478attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the 38479number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if 38480some characters were escaped. 38481 38482@item vFile:setfs: @var{pid} 38483Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with 38484@var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for 38485@value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where 38486the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the 38487inferior(s). 38488 38489If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process 38490@var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by 38491the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs. 38492If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem 38493remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:} 38494operation. 38495 38496@end table 38497 38498@node Interrupts 38499@section Interrupts 38500@cindex interrupts (remote protocol) 38501@anchor{interrupting remote targets} 38502 38503In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running, 38504@value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, 38505@code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which 38506is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}. 38507 38508The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport 38509mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not 38510currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network 38511interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the 38512@code{telnet} BREAK sequence. 38513 38514@samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all 38515transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte 38516@code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in 38517the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is 38518transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data 38519and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet 38520(@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped 38521@code{0x03} as part of its packet. 38522 38523@code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g. 38524When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port, 38525it stops execution and connects to gdb. 38526 38527In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous 38528(@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote 38529command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that 38530reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC 38531packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte 38532@code{0x03}. 38533 38534Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the 38535precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is 38536implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple 38537threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all 38538currently-executing threads and processes. 38539If the stub is successful at interrupting the 38540running program, it should send one of the stop 38541reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result 38542of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply 38543for each stopped thread in non-stop mode. 38544Interrupts received while the 38545program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when 38546it is resumed next time. 38547 38548@node Notification Packets 38549@section Notification Packets 38550@cindex notification packets 38551@cindex packets, notification 38552 38553The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications}, 38554packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub 38555may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at 38556present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information 38557without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so 38558are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss 38559is not a problem. 38560 38561A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} # 38562@var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification, 38563and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted 38564as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data} 38565never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon 38566receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-} 38567to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption. 38568 38569Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no 38570colon characters, followed by a colon character. 38571 38572Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and 38573notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart 38574timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or 38575not they understand it. 38576 38577Senders should only send the notifications described here when this 38578protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the 38579future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in 38580new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer 38581recipients. 38582 38583(Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see 38584the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may 38585transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There 38586are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we 38587assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.) 38588 38589Each notification is comprised of three parts: 38590@table @samp 38591@item @var{name}:@var{event} 38592The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the 38593exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event} 38594carrying the specific information about the notification, and 38595@var{name} specifying the name of the notification. 38596@item @var{ack} 38597The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to 38598acknowledge the exchange and request the event. 38599@end table 38600 38601The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to 38602@value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub. 38603 38604The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event} 38605at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when 38606appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN} 38607acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if 38608additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the 38609previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later 38610synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from 38611@value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable, 38612the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes 38613@value{GDBN} may not have received it. 38614 38615Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not 38616otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is 38617expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a 38618@samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent. 38619Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from 38620the stub so there is no ambiguity. 38621 38622After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by 38623sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the 38624stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as 38625@value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the 38626stub first, which the stub should process normally. 38627 38628Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued 38629events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a 38630normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack} 38631packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send 38632other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process 38633normally. 38634 38635If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional 38636@var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response. 38637At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification 38638and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN} 38639won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is 38640received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send 38641a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and 38642the process shall be repeated. 38643 38644The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the 38645following example: 38646@smallexample 38647<- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;} 38648@code{...} 38649-> @code{vStopped} 38650<- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;} 38651-> @code{vStopped} 38652<- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;} 38653-> @code{vStopped} 38654<- @code{OK} 38655@end smallexample 38656 38657The following notifications are defined: 38658@multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38 38659 38660@item Notification 38661@tab Ack 38662@tab Event 38663@tab Description 38664 38665@item Stop 38666@tab vStopped 38667@tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as 38668described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, 38669for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by 38670@value{GDBN}. 38671@tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode. 38672 38673@end multitable 38674 38675@node Remote Non-Stop 38676@section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode 38677 38678@value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of 38679multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub 38680supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including 38681@samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}). 38682 38683@value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when 38684establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode 38685does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets 38686must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering 38687all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to 38688probe the target state after a mode change. 38689 38690In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that 38691would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the 38692asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to 38693inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads 38694in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop 38695mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is, 38696when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion 38697of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the 38698affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue 38699to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running 38700threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run. 38701 38702In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as 38703follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped} 38704sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new 38705sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not 38706it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first 38707stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and 38708subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets 38709using the mechanism described above. The target must not send 38710asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete. 38711If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet, 38712or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond 38713@samp{OK}. 38714 38715If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the 38716@samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and 38717the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported 38718(@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous 38719nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint 38720and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the 38721breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to 38722this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was 38723caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as 38724opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user. 38725Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible 38726for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if 38727necessary, such as on the x86 architecture. 38728 38729@node Packet Acknowledgment 38730@section Packet Acknowledgment 38731 38732@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote 38733@cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote 38734By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet, 38735the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate 38736the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission). 38737This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over 38738unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line. 38739 38740In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or 38741TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant. 38742It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication 38743overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the 38744@samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}. 38745 38746When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or 38747expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet 38748and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in 38749@ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver. 38750 38751If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in 38752no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} 38753by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported}; 38754@pxref{qSupported}. 38755If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been 38756disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command 38757(@pxref{Remote Configuration}), 38758@value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub. 38759Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments. 38760@value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK} 38761response, which can be safely ignored by the stub. 38762 38763Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation 38764between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made; 38765it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current 38766connection. 38767Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a 38768new connection is established, 38769there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments 38770for the current connection, once disabled. 38771 38772@node Examples 38773@section Examples 38774 38775Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart 38776does not get any direct output: 38777 38778@smallexample 38779-> @code{R00} 38780<- @code{+} 38781@emph{target restarts} 38782-> @code{?} 38783<- @code{+} 38784<- @code{T001:1234123412341234} 38785-> @code{+} 38786@end smallexample 38787 38788Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction: 38789 38790@smallexample 38791-> @code{G1445@dots{}} 38792<- @code{+} 38793-> @code{s} 38794<- @code{+} 38795@emph{time passes} 38796<- @code{T001:1234123412341234} 38797-> @code{+} 38798-> @code{g} 38799<- @code{+} 38800<- @code{1455@dots{}} 38801-> @code{+} 38802@end smallexample 38803 38804@node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension 38805@section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension 38806@cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension 38807 38808@menu 38809* File-I/O Overview:: 38810* Protocol Basics:: 38811* The F Request Packet:: 38812* The F Reply Packet:: 38813* The Ctrl-C Message:: 38814* Console I/O:: 38815* List of Supported Calls:: 38816* Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes:: 38817* Constants:: 38818* File-I/O Examples:: 38819@end menu 38820 38821@node File-I/O Overview 38822@subsection File-I/O Overview 38823@cindex file-i/o overview 38824 38825The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the 38826target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various 38827system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a 38828remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed 38829actions and returns a response packet to the target system. 38830This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems. 38831 38832The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems. 38833It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both 38834@value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for 38835translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal 38836protocol representations when data is transmitted. 38837 38838The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when 38839@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} 38840or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call, 38841the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's 38842memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On 38843the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt 38844(@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}. 38845 38846The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish 38847the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means, 38848after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the 38849previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step 38850request from @value{GDBN} is required. 38851 38852@smallexample 38853(@value{GDBP}) continue 38854 <- target requests 'system call X' 38855 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call 38856 -> @value{GDBN} returns result 38857 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target 38858 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet 38859@end smallexample 38860 38861The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on 38862the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes, 38863named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host 38864system are not supported by this protocol. 38865 38866File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode. 38867 38868@node Protocol Basics 38869@subsection Protocol Basics 38870@cindex protocol basics, file-i/o 38871 38872The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well 38873as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when 38874@value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target, 38875the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result 38876of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet. 38877This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN} 38878to call the appropriate host system call: 38879 38880@itemize @bullet 38881@item 38882A unique identifier for the requested system call. 38883 38884@item 38885All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses 38886in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as 38887pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are. 38888Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation. 38889 38890@end itemize 38891 38892At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions. 38893 38894@itemize @bullet 38895@item 38896If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a 38897system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a 38898standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be 38899expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m} 38900packet. 38901 38902@item 38903@value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host 38904representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types. 38905 38906@item 38907@value{GDBN} calls the system call. 38908 38909@item 38910It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation. 38911 38912@item 38913If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified 38914by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the 38915target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected 38916by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X} 38917packet. 38918 38919@end itemize 38920 38921Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all 38922necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains 38923 38924@itemize @bullet 38925@item 38926Return value. 38927 38928@item 38929@code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call. 38930 38931@item 38932``Ctrl-C'' flag. 38933 38934@end itemize 38935 38936After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues 38937the latest continue or step action. 38938 38939@node The F Request Packet 38940@subsection The @code{F} Request Packet 38941@cindex file-i/o request packet 38942@cindex @code{F} request packet 38943 38944The @code{F} request packet has the following format: 38945 38946@table @samp 38947@item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}} 38948 38949@var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called. 38950This is just the name of the function. 38951 38952@var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call. 38953Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case 38954of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound 38955datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case 38956of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a 38957comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII 38958string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash. 38959 38960@end table 38961 38962 38963 38964@node The F Reply Packet 38965@subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet 38966@cindex file-i/o reply packet 38967@cindex @code{F} reply packet 38968 38969The @code{F} reply packet has the following format: 38970 38971@table @samp 38972 38973@item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment} 38974 38975@var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value. 38976 38977@var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific 38978representation. 38979This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful. 38980 38981@var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this 38982case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful. 38983The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}: 38984 38985@smallexample 38986F0,0,C 38987@end smallexample 38988 38989@noindent 38990or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed: 38991 38992@smallexample 38993F-1,4,C 38994@end smallexample 38995 38996@noindent 38997assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}. 38998 38999@end table 39000 39001 39002@node The Ctrl-C Message 39003@subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message 39004@cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol 39005 39006If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN} 39007reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}), 39008the target should behave as if it had 39009gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call 39010interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop 39011(as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02} 39012packet. 39013 39014It's important for the target to know in which 39015state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases: 39016 39017@itemize @bullet 39018@item 39019The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet. 39020 39021@item 39022The system call on the host has been finished. 39023 39024@end itemize 39025 39026These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the 39027returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system 39028call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling 39029on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the 39030system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave 39031as if the break message arrived right after the system call. 39032 39033@value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called 39034yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as 39035@code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished 39036before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by 39037@value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary. 39038The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened 39039or the full action has been completed. 39040 39041@node Console I/O 39042@subsection Console I/O 39043@cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o 39044 39045By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file 39046descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output 39047on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation 39048(@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled 39049by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor 390500 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following 39051conditions is met: 39052 39053@itemize @bullet 39054@item 39055The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the 39056@code{read} 39057system call is treated as finished. 39058 39059@item 39060The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing 39061newline. 39062 39063@item 39064The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing 39065character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input. 39066 39067@end itemize 39068 39069If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to 39070the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until 39071either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging 39072is stopped at the user's request. 39073 39074 39075@node List of Supported Calls 39076@subsection List of Supported Calls 39077@cindex list of supported file-i/o calls 39078 39079@menu 39080* open:: 39081* close:: 39082* read:: 39083* write:: 39084* lseek:: 39085* rename:: 39086* unlink:: 39087* stat/fstat:: 39088* gettimeofday:: 39089* isatty:: 39090* system:: 39091@end menu 39092 39093@node open 39094@unnumberedsubsubsec open 39095@cindex open, file-i/o system call 39096 39097@table @asis 39098@item Synopsis: 39099@smallexample 39100int open(const char *pathname, int flags); 39101int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode); 39102@end smallexample 39103 39104@item Request: 39105@samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}} 39106 39107@noindent 39108@var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values: 39109 39110@table @code 39111@item O_CREAT 39112If the file does not exist it will be created. The host 39113rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps 39114are concerned. 39115 39116@item O_EXCL 39117When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is 39118an error and open() fails. 39119 39120@item O_TRUNC 39121If the file already exists and the open mode allows 39122writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be 39123truncated to zero length. 39124 39125@item O_APPEND 39126The file is opened in append mode. 39127 39128@item O_RDONLY 39129The file is opened for reading only. 39130 39131@item O_WRONLY 39132The file is opened for writing only. 39133 39134@item O_RDWR 39135The file is opened for reading and writing. 39136@end table 39137 39138@noindent 39139Other bits are silently ignored. 39140 39141 39142@noindent 39143@var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values: 39144 39145@table @code 39146@item S_IRUSR 39147User has read permission. 39148 39149@item S_IWUSR 39150User has write permission. 39151 39152@item S_IRGRP 39153Group has read permission. 39154 39155@item S_IWGRP 39156Group has write permission. 39157 39158@item S_IROTH 39159Others have read permission. 39160 39161@item S_IWOTH 39162Others have write permission. 39163@end table 39164 39165@noindent 39166Other bits are silently ignored. 39167 39168 39169@item Return value: 39170@code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error 39171occurred. 39172 39173@item Errors: 39174 39175@table @code 39176@item EEXIST 39177@var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used. 39178 39179@item EISDIR 39180@var{pathname} refers to a directory. 39181 39182@item EACCES 39183The requested access is not allowed. 39184 39185@item ENAMETOOLONG 39186@var{pathname} was too long. 39187 39188@item ENOENT 39189A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist. 39190 39191@item ENODEV 39192@var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket. 39193 39194@item EROFS 39195@var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and 39196write access was requested. 39197 39198@item EFAULT 39199@var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value. 39200 39201@item ENOSPC 39202No space on device to create the file. 39203 39204@item EMFILE 39205The process already has the maximum number of files open. 39206 39207@item ENFILE 39208The limit on the total number of files open on the system 39209has been reached. 39210 39211@item EINTR 39212The call was interrupted by the user. 39213@end table 39214 39215@end table 39216 39217@node close 39218@unnumberedsubsubsec close 39219@cindex close, file-i/o system call 39220 39221@table @asis 39222@item Synopsis: 39223@smallexample 39224int close(int fd); 39225@end smallexample 39226 39227@item Request: 39228@samp{Fclose,@var{fd}} 39229 39230@item Return value: 39231@code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred. 39232 39233@item Errors: 39234 39235@table @code 39236@item EBADF 39237@var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor. 39238 39239@item EINTR 39240The call was interrupted by the user. 39241@end table 39242 39243@end table 39244 39245@node read 39246@unnumberedsubsubsec read 39247@cindex read, file-i/o system call 39248 39249@table @asis 39250@item Synopsis: 39251@smallexample 39252int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count); 39253@end smallexample 39254 39255@item Request: 39256@samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}} 39257 39258@item Return value: 39259On success, the number of bytes read is returned. 39260Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read 39261returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned. 39262 39263@item Errors: 39264 39265@table @code 39266@item EBADF 39267@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for 39268reading. 39269 39270@item EFAULT 39271@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39272 39273@item EINTR 39274The call was interrupted by the user. 39275@end table 39276 39277@end table 39278 39279@node write 39280@unnumberedsubsubsec write 39281@cindex write, file-i/o system call 39282 39283@table @asis 39284@item Synopsis: 39285@smallexample 39286int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count); 39287@end smallexample 39288 39289@item Request: 39290@samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}} 39291 39292@item Return value: 39293On success, the number of bytes written are returned. 39294Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1 39295is returned. 39296 39297@item Errors: 39298 39299@table @code 39300@item EBADF 39301@var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for 39302writing. 39303 39304@item EFAULT 39305@var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39306 39307@item EFBIG 39308An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the 39309host-specific maximum file size allowed. 39310 39311@item ENOSPC 39312No space on device to write the data. 39313 39314@item EINTR 39315The call was interrupted by the user. 39316@end table 39317 39318@end table 39319 39320@node lseek 39321@unnumberedsubsubsec lseek 39322@cindex lseek, file-i/o system call 39323 39324@table @asis 39325@item Synopsis: 39326@smallexample 39327long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag); 39328@end smallexample 39329 39330@item Request: 39331@samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}} 39332 39333@var{flag} is one of: 39334 39335@table @code 39336@item SEEK_SET 39337The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes. 39338 39339@item SEEK_CUR 39340The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset} 39341bytes. 39342 39343@item SEEK_END 39344The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset} 39345bytes. 39346@end table 39347 39348@item Return value: 39349On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from 39350the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a 39351value of -1 is returned. 39352 39353@item Errors: 39354 39355@table @code 39356@item EBADF 39357@var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor. 39358 39359@item ESPIPE 39360@var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console. 39361 39362@item EINVAL 39363@var{flag} is not a proper value. 39364 39365@item EINTR 39366The call was interrupted by the user. 39367@end table 39368 39369@end table 39370 39371@node rename 39372@unnumberedsubsubsec rename 39373@cindex rename, file-i/o system call 39374 39375@table @asis 39376@item Synopsis: 39377@smallexample 39378int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath); 39379@end smallexample 39380 39381@item Request: 39382@samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}} 39383 39384@item Return value: 39385On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 39386 39387@item Errors: 39388 39389@table @code 39390@item EISDIR 39391@var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a 39392directory. 39393 39394@item EEXIST 39395@var{newpath} is a non-empty directory. 39396 39397@item EBUSY 39398@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some 39399process. 39400 39401@item EINVAL 39402An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory 39403of itself. 39404 39405@item ENOTDIR 39406A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new 39407path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory 39408and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory. 39409 39410@item EFAULT 39411@var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values. 39412 39413@item EACCES 39414No access to the file or the path of the file. 39415 39416@item ENAMETOOLONG 39417 39418@var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long. 39419 39420@item ENOENT 39421A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist. 39422 39423@item EROFS 39424The file is on a read-only filesystem. 39425 39426@item ENOSPC 39427The device containing the file has no room for the new 39428directory entry. 39429 39430@item EINTR 39431The call was interrupted by the user. 39432@end table 39433 39434@end table 39435 39436@node unlink 39437@unnumberedsubsubsec unlink 39438@cindex unlink, file-i/o system call 39439 39440@table @asis 39441@item Synopsis: 39442@smallexample 39443int unlink(const char *pathname); 39444@end smallexample 39445 39446@item Request: 39447@samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}} 39448 39449@item Return value: 39450On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 39451 39452@item Errors: 39453 39454@table @code 39455@item EACCES 39456No access to the file or the path of the file. 39457 39458@item EPERM 39459The system does not allow unlinking of directories. 39460 39461@item EBUSY 39462The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's 39463being used by another process. 39464 39465@item EFAULT 39466@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39467 39468@item ENAMETOOLONG 39469@var{pathname} was too long. 39470 39471@item ENOENT 39472A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist. 39473 39474@item ENOTDIR 39475A component of the path is not a directory. 39476 39477@item EROFS 39478The file is on a read-only filesystem. 39479 39480@item EINTR 39481The call was interrupted by the user. 39482@end table 39483 39484@end table 39485 39486@node stat/fstat 39487@unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat 39488@cindex fstat, file-i/o system call 39489@cindex stat, file-i/o system call 39490 39491@table @asis 39492@item Synopsis: 39493@smallexample 39494int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf); 39495int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf); 39496@end smallexample 39497 39498@item Request: 39499@samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@* 39500@samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}} 39501 39502@item Return value: 39503On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned. 39504 39505@item Errors: 39506 39507@table @code 39508@item EBADF 39509@var{fd} is not a valid open file. 39510 39511@item ENOENT 39512A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the 39513path is an empty string. 39514 39515@item ENOTDIR 39516A component of the path is not a directory. 39517 39518@item EFAULT 39519@var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39520 39521@item EACCES 39522No access to the file or the path of the file. 39523 39524@item ENAMETOOLONG 39525@var{pathname} was too long. 39526 39527@item EINTR 39528The call was interrupted by the user. 39529@end table 39530 39531@end table 39532 39533@node gettimeofday 39534@unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday 39535@cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call 39536 39537@table @asis 39538@item Synopsis: 39539@smallexample 39540int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz); 39541@end smallexample 39542 39543@item Request: 39544@samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}} 39545 39546@item Return value: 39547On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise. 39548 39549@item Errors: 39550 39551@table @code 39552@item EINVAL 39553@var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer. 39554 39555@item EFAULT 39556@var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value. 39557@end table 39558 39559@end table 39560 39561@node isatty 39562@unnumberedsubsubsec isatty 39563@cindex isatty, file-i/o system call 39564 39565@table @asis 39566@item Synopsis: 39567@smallexample 39568int isatty(int fd); 39569@end smallexample 39570 39571@item Request: 39572@samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}} 39573 39574@item Return value: 39575Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. 39576 39577@item Errors: 39578 39579@table @code 39580@item EINTR 39581The call was interrupted by the user. 39582@end table 39583 39584@end table 39585 39586Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns 395871 to the target if the file descriptor is attached 39588to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls 39589would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than 39590needed. 39591 39592 39593@node system 39594@unnumberedsubsubsec system 39595@cindex system, file-i/o system call 39596 39597@table @asis 39598@item Synopsis: 39599@smallexample 39600int system(const char *command); 39601@end smallexample 39602 39603@item Request: 39604@samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}} 39605 39606@item Return value: 39607If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is 39608available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available. 39609For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the 39610return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the 39611command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system} 39612return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case 39613@file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned. 39614 39615@item Errors: 39616 39617@table @code 39618@item EINTR 39619The call was interrupted by the user. 39620@end table 39621 39622@end table 39623 39624@value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls 39625to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on 39626the host is simplified before it's returned 39627to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process 39628is discarded, and the return value consists 39629entirely of the exit status of the called command. 39630 39631Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused 39632by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the 39633@code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command. 39634 39635@table @code 39636@item set remote system-call-allowed 39637@kindex set remote system-call-allowed 39638Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O 39639protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled). 39640 39641@item show remote system-call-allowed 39642@kindex show remote system-call-allowed 39643Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O 39644protocol. 39645@end table 39646 39647@node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes 39648@subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes 39649@cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol 39650 39651@menu 39652* Integral Datatypes:: 39653* Pointer Values:: 39654* Memory Transfer:: 39655* struct stat:: 39656* struct timeval:: 39657@end menu 39658 39659@node Integral Datatypes 39660@unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes 39661@cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol 39662 39663The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int}, 39664@code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long}, 39665@code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}. 39666 39667@code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are 39668implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol. 39669 39670@code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types. 39671 39672@xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those 39673in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target. 39674 39675@code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch. 39676 39677All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a 39678structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian 39679byte order. 39680 39681@node Pointer Values 39682@unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values 39683@cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol 39684 39685Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception 39686is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't 39687transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings 39688are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@: 39689 39690@smallexample 39691@code{1aaf/12} 39692@end smallexample 39693 39694@noindent 39695which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf. 39696The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including 39697the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"} 39698at address 0x123456 is transmitted as 39699 39700@smallexample 39701@code{123456/d} 39702@end smallexample 39703 39704@node Memory Transfer 39705@unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer 39706@cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol 39707 39708Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for 39709example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format 39710with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to 39711this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F} 39712packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before 39713it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured 39714data should point to the already-coerced data at any time. 39715 39716 39717@node struct stat 39718@unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat 39719@cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol 39720 39721The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN} 39722is defined as follows: 39723 39724@smallexample 39725struct stat @{ 39726 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */ 39727 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */ 39728 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */ 39729 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */ 39730 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */ 39731 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */ 39732 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */ 39733 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */ 39734 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */ 39735 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */ 39736 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */ 39737 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */ 39738 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */ 39739@}; 39740@end smallexample 39741 39742The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the 39743appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this 39744structure is of size 64 bytes. 39745 39746The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or 39747range of values. 39748 39749@table @code 39750 39751@item st_dev 39752A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console. 39753 39754@item st_ino 39755No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged. 39756 39757@item st_mode 39758Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other 39759bits have currently no meaning for the target. 39760 39761@item st_uid 39762@itemx st_gid 39763@itemx st_rdev 39764No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged. 39765 39766@item st_atime 39767@itemx st_mtime 39768@itemx st_ctime 39769These values have a host and file system dependent 39770accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not 39771support exact timing values. 39772@end table 39773 39774The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is 39775responsible for coercing it to the target representation before 39776continuing. 39777 39778Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol 39779representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually 39780get truncated on the target. 39781 39782@node struct timeval 39783@unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval 39784@cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol 39785 39786The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol 39787is defined as follows: 39788 39789@smallexample 39790struct timeval @{ 39791 time_t tv_sec; /* second */ 39792 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */ 39793@}; 39794@end smallexample 39795 39796The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the 39797appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this 39798structure is of size 8 bytes. 39799 39800@node Constants 39801@subsection Constants 39802@cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol 39803 39804The following values are used for the constants inside of the 39805protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these 39806values before and after the call as needed. 39807 39808@menu 39809* Open Flags:: 39810* mode_t Values:: 39811* Errno Values:: 39812* Lseek Flags:: 39813* Limits:: 39814@end menu 39815 39816@node Open Flags 39817@unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags 39818@cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol 39819 39820All values are given in hexadecimal representation. 39821 39822@smallexample 39823 O_RDONLY 0x0 39824 O_WRONLY 0x1 39825 O_RDWR 0x2 39826 O_APPEND 0x8 39827 O_CREAT 0x200 39828 O_TRUNC 0x400 39829 O_EXCL 0x800 39830@end smallexample 39831 39832@node mode_t Values 39833@unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values 39834@cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol 39835 39836All values are given in octal representation. 39837 39838@smallexample 39839 S_IFREG 0100000 39840 S_IFDIR 040000 39841 S_IRUSR 0400 39842 S_IWUSR 0200 39843 S_IXUSR 0100 39844 S_IRGRP 040 39845 S_IWGRP 020 39846 S_IXGRP 010 39847 S_IROTH 04 39848 S_IWOTH 02 39849 S_IXOTH 01 39850@end smallexample 39851 39852@node Errno Values 39853@unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values 39854@cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol 39855 39856All values are given in decimal representation. 39857 39858@smallexample 39859 EPERM 1 39860 ENOENT 2 39861 EINTR 4 39862 EBADF 9 39863 EACCES 13 39864 EFAULT 14 39865 EBUSY 16 39866 EEXIST 17 39867 ENODEV 19 39868 ENOTDIR 20 39869 EISDIR 21 39870 EINVAL 22 39871 ENFILE 23 39872 EMFILE 24 39873 EFBIG 27 39874 ENOSPC 28 39875 ESPIPE 29 39876 EROFS 30 39877 ENAMETOOLONG 91 39878 EUNKNOWN 9999 39879@end smallexample 39880 39881 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns 39882 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers. 39883 39884@node Lseek Flags 39885@unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags 39886@cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol 39887 39888@smallexample 39889 SEEK_SET 0 39890 SEEK_CUR 1 39891 SEEK_END 2 39892@end smallexample 39893 39894@node Limits 39895@unnumberedsubsubsec Limits 39896@cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol 39897 39898All values are given in decimal representation. 39899 39900@smallexample 39901 INT_MIN -2147483648 39902 INT_MAX 2147483647 39903 UINT_MAX 4294967295 39904 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808 39905 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807 39906 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615 39907@end smallexample 39908 39909@node File-I/O Examples 39910@subsection File-I/O Examples 39911@cindex file-i/o examples 39912 39913Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target 39914address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written: 39915 39916@smallexample 39917<- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6} 39918@emph{request memory read from target} 39919-> @code{m1234,6} 39920<- XXXXXX 39921@emph{return "6 bytes written"} 39922-> @code{F6} 39923@end smallexample 39924 39925Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target 39926address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read: 39927 39928@smallexample 39929<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 39930@emph{request memory write to target} 39931-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX} 39932@emph{return "6 bytes read"} 39933-> @code{F6} 39934@end smallexample 39935 39936Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid 39937file descriptor (@code{EBADF}): 39938 39939@smallexample 39940<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 39941-> @code{F-1,9} 39942@end smallexample 39943 39944Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on 39945host is called: 39946 39947@smallexample 39948<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 39949-> @code{F-1,4,C} 39950<- @code{T02} 39951@end smallexample 39952 39953Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on 39954host is called: 39955 39956@smallexample 39957<- @code{Fread,3,1234,6} 39958-> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX} 39959<- @code{T02} 39960@end smallexample 39961 39962@node Library List Format 39963@section Library List Format 39964@cindex library list format, remote protocol 39965 39966On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the 39967same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case, 39968@value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory 39969operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other 39970platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries. 39971@value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries 39972through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} 39973packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub 39974queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries 39975are loaded. 39976 39977The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which 39978lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an 39979associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses, 39980which report where the library was loaded in memory. 39981 39982For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the 39983library should have a list of segments. If the target supports 39984dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element 39985should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or 39986section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not 39987depend on the library's link-time base addresses. 39988 39989@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 39990library lists. @xref{Expat}. 39991 39992A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single 39993offset, looks like this: 39994 39995@smallexample 39996<library-list> 39997 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6"> 39998 <segment address="0x10000000"/> 39999 </library> 40000</library-list> 40001@end smallexample 40002 40003Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three 40004allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this: 40005 40006@smallexample 40007<library-list> 40008 <library name="sharedlib.o"> 40009 <section address="0x10000000"/> 40010 <section address="0x20000000"/> 40011 <section address="0x30000000"/> 40012 </library> 40013</library-list> 40014@end smallexample 40015 40016The format of a library list is described by this DTD: 40017 40018@smallexample 40019<!-- library-list: Root element with versioning --> 40020<!ELEMENT library-list (library)*> 40021<!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40022<!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)> 40023<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED> 40024<!ELEMENT segment EMPTY> 40025<!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED> 40026<!ELEMENT section EMPTY> 40027<!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED> 40028@end smallexample 40029 40030In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a 40031single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or 40032section for each library. 40033 40034@node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets 40035@section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets 40036@cindex library list format, remote protocol 40037 40038On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader 40039(e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of 40040shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is 40041more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol. 40042 40043The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists 40044loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4 40045target, the following parameters are reported: 40046 40047@itemize @minus 40048@item 40049@code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of 40050@code{struct link_map}. 40051@item 40052@code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS 40053(Thread Local Storage) access. 40054@item 40055@code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of 40056@code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute 40057memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against 40058address the file was prelinked to during the library load. 40059@item 40060@code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment 40061@end itemize 40062 40063Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of 40064@code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used 40065for TLS access and its presence is optional. 40066 40067@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40068SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}. 40069 40070A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink), 40071looks like this: 40072 40073@smallexample 40074<library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8"> 40075 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000" 40076 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/> 40077 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000" 40078 l_ld="0x152350"/> 40079</library-list-svr> 40080@end smallexample 40081 40082The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD: 40083 40084@smallexample 40085<!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning --> 40086<!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*> 40087<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40088<!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED> 40089<!ELEMENT library EMPTY> 40090<!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED> 40091<!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED> 40092<!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED> 40093<!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED> 40094@end smallexample 40095 40096@node Memory Map Format 40097@section Memory Map Format 40098@cindex memory map format 40099 40100To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a 40101memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the 40102memory map. 40103 40104The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} 40105(@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that 40106lists memory regions. 40107 40108@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40109memory maps. @xref{Expat}. 40110 40111The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 40112 40113@smallexample 40114<?xml version="1.0"?> 40115<!DOCTYPE memory-map 40116 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN" 40117 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd"> 40118<memory-map> 40119 region... 40120</memory-map> 40121@end smallexample 40122 40123Each region can be either: 40124 40125@itemize 40126 40127@item 40128A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length} 40129bytes from there: 40130 40131@smallexample 40132<memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 40133@end smallexample 40134 40135 40136@item 40137A region of read-only memory: 40138 40139@smallexample 40140<memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 40141@end smallexample 40142 40143 40144@item 40145A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize} 40146bytes in length: 40147 40148@smallexample 40149<memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"> 40150 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property> 40151</memory> 40152@end smallexample 40153 40154@end itemize 40155 40156Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered 40157by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X} 40158packets to write to addresses in such ranges. 40159 40160The formal DTD for memory map format is given below: 40161 40162@smallexample 40163<!-- ................................................... --> 40164<!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ --> 40165<!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. --> 40166<!-- .................................... .............. --> 40167<!-- memory-map.dtd --> 40168<!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning --> 40169<!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)> 40170<!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0"> 40171<!ELEMENT memory (property)> 40172<!-- memory: Specifies a memory region, 40173 and its type, or device. --> 40174<!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED 40175 start CDATA #REQUIRED 40176 length CDATA #REQUIRED 40177 device CDATA #IMPLIED> 40178<!-- property: Generic attribute tag --> 40179<!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*> 40180<!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED> 40181@end smallexample 40182 40183@node Thread List Format 40184@section Thread List Format 40185@cindex thread list format 40186 40187To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes, 40188@value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet 40189(@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with 40190the following structure: 40191 40192@smallexample 40193<?xml version="1.0"?> 40194<threads> 40195 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name"> 40196 ... description ... 40197 </thread> 40198</threads> 40199@end smallexample 40200 40201Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that 40202identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The 40203@samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core 40204the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if 40205present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content 40206of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable 40207auxiliary information. 40208 40209@node Traceframe Info Format 40210@section Traceframe Info Format 40211@cindex traceframe info format 40212 40213To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when 40214inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of 40215memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been 40216collected in a traceframe. 40217 40218This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read} 40219(@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document. 40220 40221@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40222traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}. 40223 40224The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 40225 40226@smallexample 40227<?xml version="1.0"?> 40228<!DOCTYPE traceframe-info 40229 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN" 40230 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd"> 40231<traceframe-info> 40232 block... 40233</traceframe-info> 40234@end smallexample 40235 40236Each traceframe block can be either: 40237 40238@itemize 40239 40240@item 40241A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for 40242@var{length} bytes from there: 40243 40244@smallexample 40245<memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/> 40246@end smallexample 40247 40248@item 40249A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been 40250collected: 40251 40252@smallexample 40253<tvar id="@var{number}"/> 40254@end smallexample 40255 40256@end itemize 40257 40258The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below: 40259 40260@smallexample 40261<!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* > 40262<!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40263 40264<!ELEMENT memory EMPTY> 40265<!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED 40266 length CDATA #REQUIRED> 40267<!ELEMENT tvar> 40268<!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED> 40269@end smallexample 40270 40271@node Branch Trace Format 40272@section Branch Trace Format 40273@cindex branch trace format 40274 40275In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread, 40276@value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is 40277represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via 40278branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially. 40279 40280This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read} 40281(@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document. 40282 40283@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40284traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}. 40285 40286The top-level structure of the document is shown below: 40287 40288@smallexample 40289<?xml version="1.0"?> 40290<!DOCTYPE btrace 40291 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN" 40292 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd"> 40293<btrace> 40294 block... 40295</btrace> 40296@end smallexample 40297 40298@itemize 40299 40300@item 40301A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin} 40302and ending at @var{end}: 40303 40304@smallexample 40305<block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/> 40306@end smallexample 40307 40308@end itemize 40309 40310The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below: 40311 40312@smallexample 40313<!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) > 40314<!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40315 40316<!ELEMENT block EMPTY> 40317<!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED 40318 end CDATA #REQUIRED> 40319 40320<!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)> 40321 40322<!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)> 40323 40324<!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY> 40325<!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED 40326 family CDATA #REQUIRED 40327 model CDATA #REQUIRED 40328 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED> 40329 40330<!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)> 40331@end smallexample 40332 40333@node Branch Trace Configuration Format 40334@section Branch Trace Configuration Format 40335@cindex branch trace configuration format 40336 40337For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace 40338configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read} 40339(@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet. 40340 40341The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration 40342settings for that format. The following information is described: 40343 40344@table @code 40345@item bts 40346This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format. 40347@table @code 40348@item size 40349The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes. 40350@end table 40351@item pt 40352This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel 40353PT}) format. 40354@table @code 40355@item size 40356The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes. 40357@end table 40358@end table 40359 40360@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40361branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}. 40362 40363The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below: 40364 40365@smallexample 40366<!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)> 40367<!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0"> 40368 40369<!ELEMENT bts EMPTY> 40370<!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED> 40371 40372<!ELEMENT pt EMPTY> 40373<!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED> 40374@end smallexample 40375 40376@include agentexpr.texi 40377 40378@node Target Descriptions 40379@appendix Target Descriptions 40380@cindex target descriptions 40381 40382One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems 40383is that there are so many minor variants of each processor 40384architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with 40385a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example --- 40386and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some 40387architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of 40388vendors. This leads to a number of problems: 40389 40390@itemize @bullet 40391@item 40392With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for 40393the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes. 40394@item 40395Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited 40396audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every 40397variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree. 40398@item 40399When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system 40400at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the 40401@command{set architecture} command can be error-prone. 40402@end itemize 40403 40404To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a 40405target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to 40406actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support 40407processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the 40408descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them. 40409 40410@value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML 40411target descriptions. @xref{Expat}. 40412 40413@menu 40414* Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target. 40415* Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description. 40416* Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target 40417 descriptions. 40418* Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types. 40419* Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about. 40420@end menu 40421 40422@node Retrieving Descriptions 40423@section Retrieving Descriptions 40424 40425Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or 40426specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the 40427description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote 40428protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets, 40429qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be 40430@samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an 40431XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description 40432Format}. 40433 40434Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description. 40435If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to 40436specify a file are: 40437 40438@table @code 40439@cindex set tdesc filename 40440@item set tdesc filename @var{path} 40441Read the target description from @var{path}. 40442 40443@cindex unset tdesc filename 40444@item unset tdesc filename 40445Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN} 40446will use the description supplied by the current target. 40447 40448@cindex show tdesc filename 40449@item show tdesc filename 40450Show the filename to read for a target description, if any. 40451@end table 40452 40453 40454@node Target Description Format 40455@section Target Description Format 40456@cindex target descriptions, XML format 40457 40458A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML} 40459document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in 40460the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This 40461means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to 40462check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid. 40463However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for 40464their targets, we also describe the grammar here. 40465 40466Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target 40467and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register 40468sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target. 40469@value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your 40470target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target. 40471 40472Here is a simple target description: 40473 40474@smallexample 40475<target version="1.0"> 40476 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture> 40477</target> 40478@end smallexample 40479 40480@noindent 40481This minimal description only says that the target uses 40482the x86-64 architecture. 40483 40484A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking 40485optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements 40486are explained further below. 40487 40488@smallexample 40489<?xml version="1.0"?> 40490<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd"> 40491<target version="1.0"> 40492 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]} 40493 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]} 40494 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]} 40495 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]} 40496</target> 40497@end smallexample 40498 40499@noindent 40500The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line 40501breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version 40502declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted 40503(@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be 40504useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for 40505@samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend 40506including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible 40507revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report 40508the version mismatch. 40509 40510@subsection Inclusion 40511@cindex target descriptions, inclusion 40512@cindex XInclude 40513@ifnotinfo 40514@cindex <xi:include> 40515@end ifnotinfo 40516 40517It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into 40518several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to 40519share files between different possible target descriptions. You can 40520divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of 40521the target description with an inclusion directive of the form: 40522 40523@smallexample 40524<xi:include href="@var{document}"/> 40525@end smallexample 40526 40527@noindent 40528When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve 40529the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with 40530the contents of that document. If the current description was read 40531using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document; 40532@var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the 40533current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for 40534@var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the 40535original description. 40536 40537@subsection Architecture 40538@cindex <architecture> 40539 40540An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form: 40541 40542@smallexample 40543 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture> 40544@end smallexample 40545 40546@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by 40547@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 40548 40549@subsection OS ABI 40550@cindex @code{<osabi>} 40551 40552This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0. 40553Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it. 40554 40555An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form: 40556 40557@smallexample 40558 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi> 40559@end smallexample 40560 40561@var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by 40562@w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}). 40563 40564@subsection Compatible Architecture 40565@cindex @code{<compatible>} 40566 40567This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0. 40568Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it. 40569 40570A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form: 40571 40572@smallexample 40573 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible> 40574@end smallexample 40575 40576@var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by 40577@code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}). 40578 40579A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target 40580is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture 40581given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the 40582Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common} 40583or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries 40584in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this 40585capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows: 40586 40587@smallexample 40588 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture> 40589 <compatible>spu</compatible> 40590@end smallexample 40591 40592@subsection Features 40593@cindex <feature> 40594 40595Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target 40596system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU 40597registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element 40598has this form: 40599 40600@smallexample 40601<feature name="@var{name}"> 40602 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]} 40603 @var{reg}@dots{} 40604</feature> 40605@end smallexample 40606 40607@noindent 40608Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name 40609of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special 40610knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature 40611should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}. 40612 40613@subsection Types 40614 40615Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must 40616interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer, 40617but other types can be requested by name in the register description. 40618Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined 40619Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite 40620and enum types. 40621 40622Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives 40623a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type. 40624Types must be defined before they are used. 40625 40626@cindex <vector> 40627Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays 40628of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements, 40629specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements, 40630@var{count}: 40631 40632@smallexample 40633<vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/> 40634@end smallexample 40635 40636@cindex <union> 40637If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it 40638with a union type containing the useful representations. The 40639@samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements, 40640each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}: 40641 40642@smallexample 40643<union id="@var{id}"> 40644 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/> 40645 @dots{} 40646</union> 40647@end smallexample 40648 40649@cindex <struct> 40650@cindex <flags> 40651If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define 40652it with either a structure type or a flags type. 40653A flags type may only contain bitfields. 40654A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields. 40655If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be 40656specified. 40657 40658Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}. 40659 40660@smallexample 40661<struct id="@var{id}"> 40662 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/> 40663 @dots{} 40664</struct> 40665@end smallexample 40666 40667Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required. 40668No implicit padding is added. 40669 40670Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}. 40671 40672@smallexample 40673<struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 40674 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/> 40675 @dots{} 40676</struct> 40677@end smallexample 40678 40679@smallexample 40680<flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 40681 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/> 40682 @dots{} 40683</flags> 40684@end smallexample 40685 40686The @var{name} value is required. 40687Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""}, 40688in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed. 40689Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional. 40690 40691The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type} 40692is optional. 40693The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end}, 40694and zero represents the least significant bit. 40695 40696The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields, 40697and an unsigned integer otherwise. 40698 40699Which to choose? Structures or flags? 40700 40701Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over 40702defining them with @samp{struct}: 40703 40704@itemize @bullet 40705@item 40706Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers. 40707@item 40708They are printed in a more readable fashion. 40709@end itemize 40710 40711Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over 40712defining them with @samp{flags}: 40713 40714@itemize @bullet 40715@item 40716One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}. 40717 40718@smallexample 40719(gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3 40720$1 = 42 40721@end smallexample 40722 40723@end itemize 40724 40725@subsection Registers 40726@cindex <reg> 40727 40728Each register is represented as an element with this form: 40729 40730@smallexample 40731<reg name="@var{name}" 40732 bitsize="@var{size}" 40733 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]} 40734 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]} 40735 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]} 40736 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/> 40737@end smallexample 40738 40739@noindent 40740The components are as follows: 40741 40742@table @var 40743 40744@item name 40745The register's name; it must be unique within the target description. 40746 40747@item bitsize 40748The register's size, in bits. 40749 40750@item regnum 40751The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater 40752than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in 40753a preceding feature); the first register in the target description 40754defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write 40755the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P} 40756packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets 40757in order of increasing register number. 40758 40759@item save-restore 40760Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function 40761calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is 40762@code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for 40763some system control registers; this is not related to the target's 40764ABI. 40765 40766@item type 40767The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type 40768defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int} 40769and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size 40770for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the 40771architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for 40772@var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}. 40773 40774@item group 40775The register group to which this register belongs. It must 40776be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no 40777@var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register 40778in @code{info registers}. 40779 40780@end table 40781 40782@node Predefined Target Types 40783@section Predefined Target Types 40784@cindex target descriptions, predefined types 40785 40786Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types 40787from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead, 40788standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental 40789types. The currently supported types are: 40790 40791@table @code 40792 40793@item bool 40794Boolean type, occupying a single bit. 40795 40796@item int8 40797@itemx int16 40798@itemx int32 40799@itemx int64 40800@itemx int128 40801Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits. 40802 40803@item uint8 40804@itemx uint16 40805@itemx uint32 40806@itemx uint64 40807@itemx uint128 40808Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits. 40809 40810@item code_ptr 40811@itemx data_ptr 40812Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and 40813any dedicated return address register may be marked as code 40814pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic 40815address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers 40816may be marked as data pointers. 40817 40818@item ieee_single 40819Single precision IEEE floating point. 40820 40821@item ieee_double 40822Double precision IEEE floating point. 40823 40824@item arm_fpa_ext 40825The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers. 40826 40827@item i387_ext 40828The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers. 40829 40830@item i386_eflags 4083132bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86. 40832 40833@item i386_mxcsr 4083432bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86. 40835 40836@end table 40837 40838@node Enum Target Types 40839@section Enum Target Types 40840@cindex target descriptions, enum types 40841 40842Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags} 40843register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}. 40844 40845Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs. 40846 40847@smallexample 40848<enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}"> 40849 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/> 40850 @dots{} 40851</enum> 40852@end smallexample 40853 40854Enums must be defined before they are used. 40855 40856@smallexample 40857<enum id="levels_type" size="4"> 40858 <evalue name="low" value="0"/> 40859 <evalue name="high" value="1"/> 40860</enum> 40861<flags id="flags_type" size="4"> 40862 <field name="X" start="0"/> 40863 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/> 40864</flags> 40865<reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/> 40866@end smallexample 40867 40868Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register 40869would be printed as: 40870 40871@smallexample 40872(gdb) info register flags 40873flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ] 40874@end smallexample 40875 40876@node Standard Target Features 40877@section Standard Target Features 40878@cindex target descriptions, standard features 40879 40880A target description must contain either no registers or all the 40881target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then 40882@value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on 40883the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the 40884default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be 40885described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN} 40886can recognize them. 40887 40888This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements 40889which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features 40890with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers; 40891if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required 40892feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target 40893description. You can add additional registers to any of the 40894standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if 40895they were added to an unrecognized feature. 40896 40897This section lists the known features and their expected contents. 40898Sample XML documents for these features are included in the 40899@value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}. 40900 40901Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the 40902company or organization which selected the name, and the overall 40903architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature 40904containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}. 40905 40906The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose 40907of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display 40908registers using the capitalization used in the description. 40909 40910@menu 40911* AArch64 Features:: 40912* ARM Features:: 40913* i386 Features:: 40914* MicroBlaze Features:: 40915* MIPS Features:: 40916* M68K Features:: 40917* NDS32 Features:: 40918* Nios II Features:: 40919* PowerPC Features:: 40920* S/390 and System z Features:: 40921* TIC6x Features:: 40922@end menu 40923 40924 40925@node AArch64 Features 40926@subsection AArch64 Features 40927@cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features 40928 40929The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64 40930targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30}, 40931@samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}. 40932 40933The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present, 40934it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr}, 40935and @samp{fpcr}. 40936 40937@node ARM Features 40938@subsection ARM Features 40939@cindex target descriptions, ARM features 40940 40941The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile 40942ARM targets. 40943It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, 40944@samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}. 40945 40946For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} 40947feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain 40948registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, 40949and @samp{xpsr}. 40950 40951The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it 40952should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}. 40953 40954The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present, 40955it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and 40956@samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon}, 40957@samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional. 40958 40959The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it 40960should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If 40961they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included. 40962@value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from 40963halves of the double-precision registers. 40964 40965The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not 40966need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the 40967VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the 40968quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers. 40969If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also 40970be present and include 32 double-precision registers. 40971 40972@node i386 Features 40973@subsection i386 Features 40974@cindex target descriptions, i386 features 40975 40976The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64 40977targets. It should describe the following registers: 40978 40979@itemize @minus 40980@item 40981@samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386 40982@item 40983@samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64 40984@item 40985@samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es}, 40986@samp{fs}, @samp{gs} 40987@item 40988@samp{st0} through @samp{st7} 40989@item 40990@samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff}, 40991@samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop} 40992@end itemize 40993 40994The register sets may be different, depending on the target. 40995 40996The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should 40997describe registers: 40998 40999@itemize @minus 41000@item 41001@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386 41002@item 41003@samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64 41004@item 41005@samp{mxcsr} 41006@end itemize 41007 41008The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the 41009@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should 41010describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers: 41011 41012@itemize @minus 41013@item 41014@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386 41015@item 41016@samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64 41017@end itemize 41018 41019The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel 41020Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers: 41021 41022@itemize @minus 41023@item 41024@samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64. 41025@item 41026@samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64. 41027@end itemize 41028 41029The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should 41030describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}. 41031 41032The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the 41033@samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should 41034describe additional @sc{xmm} registers: 41035 41036@itemize @minus 41037@item 41038@samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64. 41039@end itemize 41040 41041It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers: 41042 41043@itemize @minus 41044@item 41045@samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64. 41046@end itemize 41047 41048It should 41049describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers: 41050 41051@itemize @minus 41052@item 41053@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386. 41054@item 41055@samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64. 41056@end itemize 41057 41058It should 41059describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers: 41060 41061@itemize @minus 41062@item 41063@samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64. 41064@end itemize 41065 41066@node MicroBlaze Features 41067@subsection MicroBlaze Features 41068@cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features 41069 41070The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze 41071targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, 41072@samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr}, 41073@samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid}, 41074@samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}. 41075 41076The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional. 41077If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr} 41078 41079@node MIPS Features 41080@subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features 41081@cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features 41082 41083The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets. 41084It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo}, 41085@samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending 41086on the target. 41087 41088The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should 41089contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause} 41090registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41091 41092The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though 41093it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should 41094contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and 41095@samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41096 41097The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should 41098contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through 41099@samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should 41100be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41101 41102The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should 41103contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the 41104Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls. 41105 41106@node M68K Features 41107@subsection M68K Features 41108@cindex target descriptions, M68K features 41109 41110@table @code 41111@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core} 41112@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core} 41113@itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core} 41114One of those features must be always present. 41115The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is 41116used. The feature that is present should contain registers 41117@samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp}, 41118@samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}. 41119 41120@item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp} 41121This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers 41122@samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and 41123@samp{fpiaddr}. 41124@end table 41125 41126@node NDS32 Features 41127@subsection NDS32 Features 41128@cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features 41129 41130The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32 41131targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through 41132@samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp}, 41133and @samp{pc}. 41134 41135The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present, 41136it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers 41137@samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7}, 41138@samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented. 41139 41140@emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point 41141registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision 41142floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if 41143not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the 41144overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit 41145single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the 41146support to it could be totally removed some day. 41147 41148@node Nios II Features 41149@subsection Nios II Features 41150@cindex target descriptions, Nios II features 41151 41152The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II 41153targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero}, 41154@samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}), 41155@samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through 41156@samp{mpuacc}). 41157 41158@node PowerPC Features 41159@subsection PowerPC Features 41160@cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features 41161 41162The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC 41163targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, 41164@samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and 41165@samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target. 41166 41167The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should 41168contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}. 41169 41170The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should 41171contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, 41172and @samp{vrsave}. 41173 41174The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should 41175contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} 41176will combine these registers with the floating point registers 41177(@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} 41178through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} 41179through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7. 41180 41181The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should 41182contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and 41183@samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in 41184@samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in 41185@samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine 41186these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the 41187user. 41188 41189@node S/390 and System z Features 41190@subsection S/390 and System z Features 41191@cindex target descriptions, S/390 features 41192@cindex target descriptions, System z features 41193 41194The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and 41195System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general 41196registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit 41197registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}. 41198S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers. 41199A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide 4120032-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general 41201register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their 41202lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}. 41203 41204The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should 41205contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and 41206@samp{fpc}. 41207 41208The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should 41209contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}. 41210 41211The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should 41212contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z 41213targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain 41214the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing 41215mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always 4121632-bit wide. 41217 41218The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should 41219contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct}, 41220@samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}. 41221 41222The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain 4122364-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be 41224combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0} 41225through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers 41226@samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should 41227contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through 41228@samp{v31}. 41229 41230@node TIC6x Features 41231@subsection TMS320C6x Features 41232@cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features 41233@cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features 41234The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x 41235targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15}, 41236registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}. 41237 41238The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should 41239contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16} 41240through @samp{B31}. 41241 41242The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should 41243contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}. 41244 41245@node Operating System Information 41246@appendix Operating System Information 41247@cindex operating system information 41248 41249@menu 41250* Process list:: 41251@end menu 41252 41253Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of 41254the operating system running on the target---for example the list of 41255processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the 41256mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the 41257target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses 41258on a different aspect of target. 41259 41260Operating system information is retrived from the target via the 41261remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata 41262read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and 41263the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched. 41264 41265@node Process list 41266@appendixsection Process list 41267@cindex operating system information, process list 41268 41269When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the 41270@samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is 41271an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in 41272@file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}. 41273 41274An example document is: 41275 41276@smallexample 41277<?xml version="1.0"?> 41278<!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd"> 41279<osdata type="processes"> 41280 <item> 41281 <column name="pid">1</column> 41282 <column name="user">root</column> 41283 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column> 41284 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column> 41285 </item> 41286</osdata> 41287@end smallexample 41288 41289Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value 41290of that column should identify the process on the target. The 41291@samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be 41292displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present, 41293should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process 41294is running on. Target may provide additional columns, 41295which @value{GDBN} currently ignores. 41296 41297@node Trace File Format 41298@appendix Trace File Format 41299@cindex trace file format 41300 41301The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description 41302section, and a trace frame section with binary data. 41303 41304The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is 41305@code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data, 41306while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values 41307in the future. 41308 41309The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text 41310separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a 41311variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such 41312as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will 41313ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end 41314of this section. 41315 41316@table @code 41317@item R @var{size} 41318Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the 41319size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size} 41320is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in 41321a single trace file. 41322 41323@item status @var{status} 41324Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus} 41325remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace 41326file. 41327 41328@item tp @var{payload} 41329Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as 41330@code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint 41331may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple 41332reply packets. 41333 41334@item tsv @var{payload} 41335Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as 41336@code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable 41337may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple 41338reply packets. 41339 41340@item tdesc @var{payload} 41341Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of 41342the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get 41343the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer} 41344@code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml} 41345file. Includes are not allowed. 41346 41347@end table 41348 41349The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames. 41350Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a 41351four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in 41352the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a 41353character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace 41354state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a 41355hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's 41356endianness. 41357 41358@c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section 41359 41360@table @code 41361@item R @var{bytes} 41362Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a 41363@code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the 41364actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding. 41365 41366@item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}... 41367Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte 41368address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by 41369@var{length} bytes. 41370 41371@item V @var{number} @var{value} 41372Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value 41373@var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}. 41374 41375@end table 41376 41377Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types 41378of blocks. 41379 41380@node Index Section Format 41381@appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format 41382@cindex .gdb_index section format 41383@cindex index section format 41384 41385This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save 41386gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is 41387DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this 41388description. 41389 41390The mapped index file format is designed to be directly 41391@code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is 41392represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an 41393@code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values 41394before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is 41395laid out such that alignment is always respected. 41396 41397A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order. 41398 41399@enumerate 41400@item 41401The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type} 41402unless otherwise noted: 41403 41404@enumerate 41405@item 41406The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete. 41407Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6. 41408Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4 41409and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the 41410symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units 41411(@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the 41412compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type. 41413 41414@value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices 41415by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}. 41416GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is 41417currently not flagged as deprecated. 41418 41419@item 41420The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list. 41421 41422@item 41423The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note 41424that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal 41425to the next offset. 41426 41427@item 41428The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area. 41429 41430@item 41431The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table. 41432 41433@item 41434The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool. 41435@end enumerate 41436 41437@item 41438The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian 41439values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is 41440the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second 41441element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU 41442elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the 414430-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then 41444conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of 41445CU indices. 41446 41447@item 41448The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit 41449little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset, 41450the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is 41451the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted. 41452 41453@item 41454The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address 41455entries. Each address entry has three elements: 41456 41457@enumerate 41458@item 41459The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. 41460 41461@item 41462The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like 41463@code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end. 41464 41465@item 41466The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value. 41467@end enumerate 41468 41469@item 41470The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of 41471the hash table is always a power of 2. 41472 41473Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type} 41474values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the 41475constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the 41476constant pool. 41477 41478If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This 41479is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a 41480valid index for both a string and a CU vector. 41481 41482The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an 41483iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an 41484initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in 41485the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the 41486index version: 41487 41488@table @asis 41489@item Version 4 41490The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}. 41491 41492@item Versions 5 to 7 41493The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}. 41494@end table 41495 41496The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash. 41497 41498The step size used in the hash table is computed via 41499@code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash 41500value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size 41501is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash 41502collision. 41503 41504The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We 41505don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization 41506algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read 41507the code. 41508 41509@item 41510The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized 41511so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by 41512strings. 41513 41514A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type} 41515values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector. 41516Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in 41517the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which 41518CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used. 41519See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry. 41520 41521A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated. 41522@end enumerate 41523 41524Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7. 41525If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one 41526CU index+attributes value for each use. 41527 41528The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows 41529(bit 0 = LSB): 41530 41531@table @asis 41532 41533@item Bits 0-23 41534This is the index of the CU in the CU list. 41535@item Bits 24-27 41536These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero. 41537@item Bits 28-30 41538The kind of the symbol in the CU. 41539 41540@table @asis 41541@item 0 41542This value is reserved and should not be used. 41543By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible 41544with previous versions of the index. 41545@item 1 41546The symbol is a type. 41547@item 2 41548The symbol is a variable or an enum value. 41549@item 3 41550The symbol is a function. 41551@item 4 41552Any other kind of symbol. 41553@item 5,6,7 41554These values are reserved. 41555@end table 41556 41557@item Bit 31 41558This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static. 41559 41560The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated. 41561The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in 41562@value{GDBN} sources. 41563 41564@end table 41565 41566This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and 41567global/static attributes in the index. 41568 41569@smallexample 41570is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external); 41571language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language); 41572switch (die->tag) 41573 @{ 41574 case DW_TAG_typedef: 41575 case DW_TAG_base_type: 41576 case DW_TAG_subrange_type: 41577 kind = TYPE; 41578 is_static = 1; 41579 break; 41580 case DW_TAG_enumerator: 41581 kind = VARIABLE; 41582 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA); 41583 break; 41584 case DW_TAG_subprogram: 41585 kind = FUNCTION; 41586 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA); 41587 break; 41588 case DW_TAG_constant: 41589 kind = VARIABLE; 41590 is_static = ! is_external; 41591 break; 41592 case DW_TAG_variable: 41593 kind = VARIABLE; 41594 is_static = ! is_external; 41595 break; 41596 case DW_TAG_namespace: 41597 kind = TYPE; 41598 is_static = 0; 41599 break; 41600 case DW_TAG_class_type: 41601 case DW_TAG_interface_type: 41602 case DW_TAG_structure_type: 41603 case DW_TAG_union_type: 41604 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type: 41605 kind = TYPE; 41606 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA); 41607 break; 41608 default: 41609 assert (0); 41610 @} 41611@end smallexample 41612 41613@node Man Pages 41614@appendix Manual pages 41615@cindex Man pages 41616 41617@menu 41618* gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page 41619* gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page 41620* gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program 41621* gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts 41622@end menu 41623 41624@node gdb man 41625@heading gdb man 41626 41627@c man title gdb The GNU Debugger 41628 41629@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb 41630gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}] 41631[@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}] 41632[@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}] 41633 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}] 41634[@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}] 41635[@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}] 41636 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}] 41637[@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}] 41638@c man end 41639 41640@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb 41641The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is 41642going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another 41643program was doing at the moment it crashed. 41644 41645@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of 41646these) to help you catch bugs in the act: 41647 41648@itemize @bullet 41649@item 41650Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior. 41651 41652@item 41653Make your program stop on specified conditions. 41654 41655@item 41656Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped. 41657 41658@item 41659Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the 41660effects of one bug and go on to learn about another. 41661@end itemize 41662 41663You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and 41664Modula-2. 41665 41666@value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads 41667commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN} 41668command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself 41669by using the command @code{help}. 41670 41671You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most 41672usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an 41673executable program as the argument: 41674 41675@smallexample 41676gdb program 41677@end smallexample 41678 41679You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified: 41680 41681@smallexample 41682gdb program core 41683@end smallexample 41684 41685You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want 41686to debug a running process: 41687 41688@smallexample 41689gdb program 1234 41690gdb -p 1234 41691@end smallexample 41692 41693@noindent 41694would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file 41695named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first). 41696With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename. 41697 41698Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands: 41699 41700@c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines. 41701@table @env 41702@item break [@var{file}:]@var{function} 41703Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}). 41704 41705@item run [@var{arglist}] 41706Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified). 41707 41708@item bt 41709Backtrace: display the program stack. 41710 41711@item print @var{expr} 41712Display the value of an expression. 41713 41714@item c 41715Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint). 41716 41717@item next 41718Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any 41719function calls in the line. 41720 41721@item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function} 41722look at the program line where it is presently stopped. 41723 41724@item list [@var{file}:]@var{function} 41725type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped. 41726 41727@item step 41728Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any 41729function calls in the line. 41730 41731@item help [@var{name}] 41732Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information 41733about using @value{GDBN}. 41734 41735@item quit 41736Exit from @value{GDBN}. 41737@end table 41738 41739@ifset man 41740For full details on @value{GDBN}, 41741see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 41742by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online 41743as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program. 41744@end ifset 41745@c man end 41746 41747@c man begin OPTIONS gdb 41748Any arguments other than options specify an executable 41749file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument 41750encountered with no 41751associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second, 41752if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file. 41753Many options have 41754both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also 41755recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is 41756present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option 41757arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the 41758more usual convention.) 41759 41760All the options and command line arguments you give are processed 41761in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x} 41762option is used. 41763 41764@table @env 41765@item -help 41766@itemx -h 41767List all options, with brief explanations. 41768 41769@item -symbols=@var{file} 41770@itemx -s @var{file} 41771Read symbol table from file @var{file}. 41772 41773@item -write 41774Enable writing into executable and core files. 41775 41776@item -exec=@var{file} 41777@itemx -e @var{file} 41778Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when 41779appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core 41780dump. 41781 41782@item -se=@var{file} 41783Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable 41784file. 41785 41786@item -core=@var{file} 41787@itemx -c @var{file} 41788Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine. 41789 41790@item -command=@var{file} 41791@itemx -x @var{file} 41792Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. 41793 41794@item -ex @var{command} 41795Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}. 41796 41797@item -directory=@var{directory} 41798@itemx -d @var{directory} 41799Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files. 41800 41801@item -nh 41802Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}. 41803 41804@item -nx 41805@itemx -n 41806Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files. 41807 41808@item -quiet 41809@itemx -q 41810``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These 41811messages are also suppressed in batch mode. 41812 41813@item -batch 41814Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command 41815files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited). 41816Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} 41817commands in the command files. 41818 41819Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to 41820download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this 41821more useful, the message 41822 41823@smallexample 41824Program exited normally. 41825@end smallexample 41826 41827@noindent 41828(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control 41829terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode. 41830 41831@item -cd=@var{directory} 41832Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory, 41833instead of the current directory. 41834 41835@item -fullname 41836@itemx -f 41837Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells 41838@value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard, 41839recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which 41840includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks 41841like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number 41842and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The 41843Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032} 41844characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame. 41845 41846@item -b @var{bps} 41847Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial 41848interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging. 41849 41850@item -tty=@var{device} 41851Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output. 41852@end table 41853@c man end 41854 41855@c man begin SEEALSO gdb 41856@ifset man 41857The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 41858If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 41859documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 41860 41861@smallexample 41862info gdb 41863@end smallexample 41864 41865@noindent 41866should give you access to the complete manual. 41867 41868@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 41869Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 41870@end ifset 41871@c man end 41872 41873@node gdbserver man 41874@heading gdbserver man 41875 41876@c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger 41877@format 41878@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver 41879gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}] 41880 41881gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 41882 41883gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 41884@c man end 41885@end format 41886 41887@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver 41888@command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine 41889than the one which is running the program being debugged. 41890 41891@ifclear man 41892@subheading Usage (server (target) side) 41893@end ifclear 41894@ifset man 41895Usage (server (target) side): 41896@end ifset 41897 41898First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto 41899the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as 41900@command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by 41901the @value{GDBN} running on the host system. 41902 41903To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver} 41904program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of 41905your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is: 41906 41907@smallexample 41908target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...] 41909@end smallexample 41910 41911For example, using a serial port, you might say: 41912 41913@smallexample 41914@ifset man 41915@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>. 41916target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt 41917@end ifset 41918@ifclear man 41919target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt 41920@end ifclear 41921@end smallexample 41922 41923This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and 41924to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now 41925waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it. 41926 41927To use a TCP connection, you could say: 41928 41929@smallexample 41930target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt 41931@end smallexample 41932 41933This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are 41934going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means 41935that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port 419362345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you 41937want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP 41938ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host 41939@value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if 41940you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will 41941print an error message and exit. 41942 41943@command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs. 41944This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is: 41945 41946@smallexample 41947target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 41948@end smallexample 41949 41950@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't 41951necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process. 41952 41953To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run 41954or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option. 41955In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start 41956the program you want to debug. 41957 41958@smallexample 41959target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 41960@end smallexample 41961 41962@ifclear man 41963@subheading Usage (host side) 41964@end ifclear 41965@ifset man 41966Usage (host side): 41967@end ifset 41968 41969You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since 41970@value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally 41971would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the 41972@option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.) 41973That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only 41974new command you need to know about is @code{target remote} 41975(or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either 41976a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT} 41977descriptor. For example: 41978 41979@smallexample 41980@ifset man 41981@c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>. 41982(gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb 41983@end ifset 41984@ifclear man 41985(gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb} 41986@end ifclear 41987@end smallexample 41988 41989@noindent 41990communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and: 41991 41992@smallexample 41993(gdb) target remote the-target:2345 41994@end smallexample 41995 41996@noindent 41997communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where 41998you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for 41999TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote' 42000command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like 42001`Connection refused'. 42002 42003@command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once, 42004described in 42005@ifset man 42006the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs} 42007-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}. 42008@end ifset 42009@ifclear man 42010@ref{Inferiors and Programs}. 42011@end ifclear 42012In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant: 42013 42014@smallexample 42015(gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345 42016@end smallexample 42017 42018The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such 42019case. 42020@c man end 42021 42022@c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver 42023There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}: 42024 42025@itemize @bullet 42026 42027@item 42028Debug a specific program specified by its program name: 42029 42030@smallexample 42031gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}] 42032@end smallexample 42033 42034The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate 42035with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line), 42036a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use 42037stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to 42038debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the 42039program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the 42040connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit. 42041 42042@item 42043Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running 42044program: 42045 42046@smallexample 42047gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 42048@end smallexample 42049 42050The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID 42051of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything 42052else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits, 42053@value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit. 42054 42055@item 42056Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process: 42057 42058@smallexample 42059gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 42060@end smallexample 42061 42062In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which 42063command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not 42064close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can 42065debug several processes in the same session. 42066@end itemize 42067 42068In each of the modes you may specify these options: 42069 42070@table @env 42071 42072@item --help 42073List all options, with brief explanations. 42074 42075@item --version 42076This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit. 42077 42078@item --attach 42079@command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is: 42080 42081@smallexample 42082target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid} 42083@end smallexample 42084 42085@var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't 42086necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process. 42087 42088@item --multi 42089To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run 42090or process ID to attach, use this command line option. 42091Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start 42092the program you want to debug. The syntax is: 42093 42094@smallexample 42095target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm} 42096@end smallexample 42097 42098@item --debug 42099Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging 42100process. 42101This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to 42102the developers. 42103 42104@item --remote-debug 42105Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output. 42106This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to 42107the developers. 42108 42109@item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]} 42110Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line 42111of debugging output. 42112@xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}. 42113 42114@item --wrapper 42115Specify a wrapper to launch programs 42116for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the 42117wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then 42118@kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments. 42119 42120@item --once 42121By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that 42122additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver} 42123with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further 42124connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. 42125 42126@c --disable-packet is not documented for users. 42127 42128@c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by 42129@c QDisableRandomization. 42130 42131@end table 42132@c man end 42133 42134@c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver 42135@ifset man 42136The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 42137If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 42138documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 42139 42140@smallexample 42141info gdb 42142@end smallexample 42143 42144should give you access to the complete manual. 42145 42146@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42147Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 42148@end ifset 42149@c man end 42150 42151@node gcore man 42152@heading gcore 42153 42154@c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program 42155 42156@format 42157@c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore 42158gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid} 42159@c man end 42160@end format 42161 42162@c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore 42163Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}. 42164Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process 42165crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump 42166limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains 42167running without any change. 42168@c man end 42169 42170@c man begin OPTIONS gcore 42171@table @env 42172@item -o @var{filename} 42173The optional argument 42174@var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. 42175If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, 42176where @var{pid} is the running program process ID. 42177@end table 42178@c man end 42179 42180@c man begin SEEALSO gcore 42181@ifset man 42182The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 42183If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 42184documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 42185 42186@smallexample 42187info gdb 42188@end smallexample 42189 42190@noindent 42191should give you access to the complete manual. 42192 42193@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42194Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 42195@end ifset 42196@c man end 42197 42198@node gdbinit man 42199@heading gdbinit 42200 42201@c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts 42202 42203@format 42204@c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit 42205@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT 42206@value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT} 42207@end ifset 42208 42209~/.gdbinit 42210 42211./.gdbinit 42212@c man end 42213@end format 42214 42215@c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit 42216These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during 42217@value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands, 42218described in 42219@ifset man 42220the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences} 42221-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}. 42222@end ifset 42223@ifclear man 42224@ref{Sequences}. 42225@end ifclear 42226 42227Please read more in 42228@ifset man 42229the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup} 42230-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}. 42231@end ifset 42232@ifclear man 42233@ref{Startup}. 42234@end ifclear 42235 42236@table @env 42237@ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT 42238@item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT} 42239@end ifset 42240@ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT 42241@item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation) 42242@end ifclear 42243System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified 42244@value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}. 42245See more in 42246@ifset man 42247the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration} 42248-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}. 42249@end ifset 42250@ifclear man 42251@ref{System-wide configuration}. 42252@end ifclear 42253 42254@item ~/.gdbinit 42255User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified 42256@value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}. 42257 42258@item ./.gdbinit 42259Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with 42260@value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}. 42261See more in 42262@ifset man 42263the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory} 42264-- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}. 42265@end ifset 42266@ifclear man 42267@ref{Init File in the Current Directory}. 42268@end ifclear 42269@end table 42270@c man end 42271 42272@c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit 42273@ifset man 42274gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup} 42275 42276The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual. 42277If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo 42278documentation are properly installed at your site, the command 42279 42280@smallexample 42281info gdb 42282@end smallexample 42283 42284should give you access to the complete manual. 42285 42286@cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger}, 42287Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991. 42288@end ifset 42289@c man end 42290 42291@include gpl.texi 42292 42293@node GNU Free Documentation License 42294@appendix GNU Free Documentation License 42295@include fdl.texi 42296 42297@node Concept Index 42298@unnumbered Concept Index 42299 42300@printindex cp 42301 42302@node Command and Variable Index 42303@unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index 42304 42305@printindex fn 42306 42307@tex 42308% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the 42309% meantime: 42310\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill 42311\centerline{The body of this manual is set in} 42312\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,} 42313\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}} 42314\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.} 42315\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},} 42316\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and} 42317\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}} 42318\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill} 42319\page\colophon 42320% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991. 42321@end tex 42322 42323@bye 42324